As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on September 29, 2006.


 
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
____________________
 
FORM 20-F
 
(Mark one)
 o
REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b)
OR (g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
 
 
 
OR
 
 x  
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d)
OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
for the fiscal year ended: March 31, 2006
 
   
OR
 
 o  
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d)
OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period from __________ to __________ 
 
 
 
OR
 
 
 o
 
SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d)
OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT 0F 1934
Date of event requiring this shell company report __________
COMMISSION FILE NUMBER 1-14917
 
____________________
 
NASPERS LIMITED
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)
 
Republic of South Africa
(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)
 
40 Heerengracht
Cape Town, 8001
The Republic of South Africa
(Address of principal executive offices)
 
Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act.
 
N/A
(Title of Class)
N/A
(Name of each exchange on which registered)
   
Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act.
 
Class N ordinary shares, nominal value Rand 0.02 per share*
American Depositary Shares, each representing one Class N ordinary share, nominal value Rand 0.02 per share
(Title of Class)
Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act.
None
(Title of Class)
Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the annual report.
315,113,700
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.
Yes       X        No              
 

 
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.
Yes       X        No              
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non-accelerated filer. See definition of “accelerated filer and large accelerated filer” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act:
 
Large Accelerated filer x  Accelerated filer o  Non-Accelerated filer o
 
Indicate by check mark which financial statement item the Registrant has elected to follow.
Item 17               Item 18       X      

If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark if registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934). Yes [  ] No [X]
 
*Not for trading, but only in connection with registration of American Depositary Shares.

 

 
 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
 
 
 
 Page No.
 
 
Our Use of Terms and Conventions in this Annual Report
1
   
Accounting Periods and Principles
1
   
Forward Looking Statements
1
   
PART I     
     
ITEM 1.
Identity of Directors, Senior Management and Advisers
ITEM 2.
Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable
ITEM 3.
Key Information
ITEM 4.
Information on the Company
17
ITEM 5.
Operating and Financial Review and Prospects
53 
ITEM 6.
Directors, Senior Management and Employees
82 
ITEM 7.
Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions
94 
ITEM 8.
Financial Information
97 
ITEM 9.
The Offer and Listing
101 
ITEM 10.
Additional Information
102 
ITEM 11.
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
114 
ITEM 12.
Description of Securities Other than Equity Securities
 115
     
PART II
   
     
ITEM 13.
Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies
116
ITEM 14.
Material Modification to the Rights of Security Holders and Use of Proceeds
116
ITEM 15.
Disclosure Controls and Procedures
116
ITEM 16A.
Audit Committee Financial Expert
116
ITEM 16B.
Code of Ethics
116
ITEM 16C.
Principal Accountant Fees and Services
117
ITEM 16E.
Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers
118
     
PART III
   
     
ITEM 17.
Financial Statements
118
ITEM 18.
Financial Statements
118
ITEM 19.
Exhibits
E-1
 
 
i




OUR USE OF TERMS AND CONVENTIONS IN THIS ANNUAL REPORT
 
Unless otherwise specified or the context requires otherwise in this annual report on Form 20-F:
 
 
·
references to “Naspers”, “Naspers group”, “group”, “we”, “us” and “our” are to Naspers Limited together with its subsidiaries, unless the context suggests otherwise;
     
 
·
references to “MIH Limited” are to MIH Limited together with its subsidiaries with respect to any period prior to December 20, 2002, and to MIH (BVI) Limited together with its subsidiaries thereafter;
     
 
·
references to “Rand” and “R” are to South African Rand, the currency of South Africa; 
     
 
·
references to “U.S. dollar(s)”, “dollar(s)”, “U.S. $” and “$” are to United States dollars and cents, the currency of the United States; 
     
 
·
references to “Euro” and “€” are to the currency introduced at the start of the third stage of the European Economic and Monetary Union pursuant to the Treaty establishing the European Economic Community, as amended by the Treaty on the European Union; 
     
 
·
references to “Pound sterling” are to United Kingdom pounds sterling, the currency of the United Kingdom; 
     
 
·
references to “Renminbi” are to Chinese Renminbi, the currency of the People’s Republic of China; 
     
 
·
references to “Naira” are to Nigerian Naira, the currency of Nigeria; and 
     
 
·
references to “Brazilian Real” and “Real” are to Brazilian Real, the currency of Brazil.
 
 
 ACCOUNTING PERIODS AND PRINCIPLES
 
Unless otherwise specified, all references in this annual report to a “fiscal year” and “year ended” of Naspers refer to a twelve-month financial period. All references in this annual report to fiscal 2006, fiscal 2005, fiscal 2004, fiscal 2003 or fiscal 2002 refer to Naspers’ twelve-month financial periods ended on March 31, 2006, March 31, 2005, March 31, 2004, March 31, 2003 or March 31, 2002, respectively. References in this annual report to fiscal 2006 refer to the period beginning April 1, 2005 and ending March 31, 2006. Our group consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this annual report have been prepared in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”), which differ in certain respects from accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (“U.S. GAAP”). See note 39 to Naspers’ audited consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this annual report.
 
During the year ended March 31, 2006, the group adopted IFRS for the first time in accordance with the JSE Limited (formerly the JSE Securities Exchange South Africa) (“JSE”) Listing Requirements. Financial information provided in this annual report and in our audited consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this annual report have been presented in accordance with IFRS as required in terms of the requirements of the JSE and the Securities and Exchange Commission in the United States of America (“SEC”). Previously the group prepared its financial statements under South African Statements of Generally Accepted Accounting Practice (“SA GAAP”) as effective at that time. For a description of the impact of the first time adoption of IFRS on the Group’s reported results of operations and financial position, see note 2 to our annual financial statements. Additionally, the US GAAP reconciliation as of and for fiscal year ended March 31, 2005 has also been adjusted to reflect the adjustments between IFRS and the previously reported SA GAAP information.
 
FORWARD LOOKING STATEMENTS
 
The SEC encourages companies to disclose forward looking information so that investors can better understand a company’s future prospects and make informed investment decisions. This annual report contains historical and forward looking statements concerning the financial condition, results of operations and business of Naspers. All statements other than statements of historical fact are, or may be deemed to be, forward looking statements.
 
 
1


 
Forward looking statements are statements of future expectations that are based on management’s current expectations and assumptions and involve known and unknown risks and uncertainties that could cause actual results, performance or events to differ materially from those expressed or implied in these statements. Forward looking statements include, among other things, statements concerning the potential exposure of Naspers to market risks and statements expressing management’s expectations, beliefs, estimates, forecasts, projections and assumptions.
 
These forward looking statements are identified by their use of terms and phrases such as “anticipate”, “believe”, “could”, “estimate”, “expect”, “intend”, “may”, “plan”, “objectives”, “outlook”, “probably”, “project”, “will”, “seek”, “target” and similar terms and phrases. These statements are contained in the sections entitled “Key Information”, “Risk Factors”, “Information on the Company”, and “Operating and Financial Review and Prospects”, and in other sections of this annual report. The following factors, among others, could affect the future operations of Naspers and could cause those results to differ materially from those expressed in the forward looking statements included in this annual report:
 
 
·
economic, political and social risks which exist in all countries in which Naspers, its associated companies and joint ventures operate;
     
 
·
adverse regulatory developments;
     
 
·
market risks related to fluctuations in the exchange rates and interest rates in all countries in which Naspers, its associated companies and joint ventures operate;
     
 
·
the level of Naspers’ debt (including finance leases) and funding difficulties Naspers may face;
     
 
·
restrictions imposed by exchange control regulations and the possibility that Naspers may not be able to access cash flows from its subsidiaries, associated companies and joint ventures;
     
 
·
difficulties associated with successfully completing acquisitions and integrating acquired companies;
     
 
·
the lack of control we have over companies we make minority investments in and other risks associated with such investments; 
     
 
·
dependence on suppliers and partners for the provision of services and expertise and on local governments;
     
 
· 
the possibility that satellites used by Naspers, or its printing equipment or facilities, may fail to perform or may be damaged; 
     
  · 
competitive pressures which may result in declining subscriber and circulation levels; 
     
  · 
unauthorized access to Naspers’ programming signals; 
     
 
 
·
trade union activity and labour instability;
     
 
·
the ability to enforce foreign judgments against Naspers and its directors and officers;
     
 
·
cyclical fluctuations in the demand for advertising;
     
 
·
the rapid pace of technological change;
     
 
·
reliance on software and hardware systems, which are susceptible to failure;
     
 
·
reliance on content developed by third parties and susceptibility to claims made in connection with such content;
     
 
·
the degree to which our intellectual property rights are protected; and 
     
 
· 
changes in accounting standards.
 
All subsequent forward looking statements are expressly qualified in their entirety by the cautionary statements contained or referred to in this section. You should not place undue reliance on forward looking statements. Each forward looking statement speaks only as of the date of the particular statement. Naspers undertakes no obligation to publicly update or revise any forward looking statement as a result of new information, future events or other information. In light of these risks, Naspers’ results could differ materially from the forward looking statements contained in this annual report.
 
 
2



 
PART I
 
ITEM 1.      IDENTITY OF DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND ADVISERS
 
Not applicable.
 
ITEM 2.         OFFER STATISTICS AND EXPECTED TIMETABLE
 
Not applicable.
 
ITEM 3.         KEY INFORMATION
 
3.A.                 Selected Financial Data
 
The following tables show selected consolidated financial data for Naspers as of and for the fiscal years ended March 31, 2005 and 2006 under IFRS and as of and for the fiscal years ended March 31, 2002 through 2006 under U.S. GAAP. We derived the selected consolidated financial data from our audited consolidated financial statements. You should read this selected consolidated financial data together with “Operating and Financial Review and Prospects” and Naspers’ audited consolidated financial statements and the notes thereto appearing elsewhere in this annual report.
 
In accordance with the JSE Listing Requirements, Naspers was required to prepare its first annual consolidated financial statements in accordance with IFRS for the year ended March 31, 2006. As Naspers publishes comparative information in its financial statements, the date for transition to IFRS is April 1, 2004, which represents the beginning of the earliest period of comparative information to be presented pursuant to the requirements of the JSE and the SEC.
 
Naspers’ audited consolidated financial statements have been prepared in Rand. Amounts shown in U.S. dollars have been translated for convenience from Rand amounts to U.S. dollars at the noon buying rate on September 15, 2006 of Rand 7.38 per U.S. $1.00. You should not view such translations as a representation that such Rand amounts actually represent such U.S. dollar amounts, or could be or could have been converted into or at any other rate.

   
Year ended March 31
         
   
2002 
 
2003
 
2004 
 
2005 
 
2006 
 
2006 
 
   
     Rand in millions, except per share data
U.S. $ in millions,
except per share data 
 
                           
Consolidated Income Statement Data:
                         
IFRS:
                         
Revenue, net 
                     
13,517.9
   
15,706.4
   
2,128.2
 
Operating expenses: 
                                     
Cost of providing services and sale of goods 
                     
(7,725.8
)
 
(8,753.7
)
 
(1,186.1
)
Selling, general and administration 
                     
(3,311.5
)
 
(3,948.7
)
 
(535.1
)
Other losses, net 
                     
(11.7
)
 
   
 
Operating profit
                     
2,468.9
   
3,004.0
   
407.0
 
Financial costs, net(1) 
                     
(217.0
)
 
(11.4
)
 
(1.5
)
Share of equity accounted results 
                     
88.6
   
151.3
   
20.5
 
Profit/(loss) on sale of investments 
                     
(0.3
)
 
74.4
   
10.1
 
Dilution profits 
                     
368.0
   
   
 
Profit before tax and minorities 
                     
2,708.2
   
3,218.3
   
436.1
 
Profit from continuing operations 
                     
2,334.8
   
2,126.3
   
288.1
 
Profit from discontinuing operations 
                     
50.0
   
31.8
   
4.3
 
Profit arising on discontinuance of operations 
                     
   
1,032.1
   
139.9
 
Net profit attributable to equity holders of the group  
                     
2,384.8
   
3,190.2
   
432.3
 
 
 
3

 
                                       
Per share amounts
                                     
Basic
                                     
Profit from continuing operations 
                     
8.42
   
7.49
   
1.01
 
Profit from discontinuing operations 
                     
0.18
   
0.11
   
0.01
 
Profit arising on discontinuance of operations 
                     
   
3.64
   
0.49
 
Net profit attributable to equity holders of the group 
                     
8.60
   
11.24
   
1.52
 
                                       
Diluted
                                     
Profit from continuing operations 
                     
7.97
   
7.08
   
0.96
 
Profit from discontinuing operations 
                     
0.17
   
0.11
   
0.01
 
Profit arising on discontinuance of operations 
                     
   
3.44
   
0.47
 
Net profit attributable to equity holders of the group 
                     
8.14
   
10.63
   
1.44
 
                                       
Weighted average shares outstanding
                                     
Basic 
                     
277,293,544
   
283,718,859
   
283,718,859
 
Diluted 
                     
293,126,268
   
300,242,781
   
300,242,781
 
                                       
Dividend per A ordinary share (cents)(2)
                     
7.0
   
14.0
   
1.9
 
Dividend per N ordinary share (cents)(2)
                     
38.0
   
70.0
   
9.5
 
                                       
Consolidated Income Statement Data:
                                     
U.S. GAAP:
                                     
Revenue, net 
   
9,861.4
   
11,208.6
   
11,526.1
   
13,189.4
   
15,751.3
   
2,134.3
 
Operating profit / (loss) 
   
(2,355.8
)
 
(63.0
)
 
1,042.6
   
2,463.7
   
3,076.7
   
416.9
 
Profit / (loss) from continuing operations 
   
(2,582.0
)
 
(889.6
)
 
495.3
   
2,243.9
   
1,801.0
   
244.0
 
Profit / (loss) from discontinued operations 
   
(2,665.0
)
 
528.0
   
   
42.0
   
715.8
   
97.0
 
Cumulative effect of change in accounting principle 
   
18.4
   
(531.5
)
 
   
   
   
 
Net profit / (loss)(3) 
   
(5,228.5
)
 
(893.1
)
 
495.3
   
2,285.9
   
2,516.8
   
341.0
 
                                       
Per share amounts
                                     
Basic
                                     
Profit / (loss) from continuing operations 
   
(17.73
)
 
(5.04
)
 
1.92
   
8.10
   
6.36
   
0.86
 
Discontinued operations 
   
(18.29
)
 
2.99
   
   
0.15
   
2.53
   
0.34
 
Cumulative effect of change in accounting principle(4) 
   
0.13
   
(3.01
)
 
   
   
   
 
Net profit / (loss) 
   
(35.89
)
 
(5.06
)
 
1.92
   
8.25
   
8.89
   
1.20
 
                                       
Per share amounts
                                     
Diluted
                                     
Profit / (loss) from continuing operations 
   
(17.73
)
 
(5.04
)
 
1.87
   
7.63
   
5.98
   
0.81
 
Profit / (loss) from discontinued operations 
   
(18.29
)
 
2.99
   
   
0.14
   
2.38
   
0.32
 
Cumulative effect of change in accounting principle(4) 
   
0.13
   
(3.01
)
 
   
   
   
 
Net profit / (loss)  
   
(35.89
)
 
(5.06
)
 
1.87
   
7.77
   
8.36
   
1.13
 
                                       
Consolidated Balance Sheet Data (at period end):
                                     
IFRS:
                                     
Total assets 
                     
14,042.6
   
17,339.4
   
2,349.5
 
Net assets 
                     
5,093.3
   
7,290.0
   
987.8
 
Share capital(5)  
                     
5,391.2
   
5,561.3
   
753.6
 
Total long-term debt(6) 
                     
2,275.6
   
2,355.6
   
319.2
 
Minority interests 
                     
227.3
   
171.5
   
23.2
 
Capital and reserves attributable to the company’s equity holders 
                     
4,866.0
   
7,118.4
   
964.6
 
U.S. GAAP:
                                     
Total assets 
   
23,750.5
   
12,896.2
   
11,318.1
   
16,190.1
   
19,707.4
   
2,670.4
 
Net assets 
   
11,116.8
   
3,306.5
   
3,376.1
   
6,570.4
   
8,989.5
   
1,218.1
 
Total long-term debt(6) 
   
5,742.6
   
3,843.9
   
2,815.6
   
2,675.9
   
2,590.0
   
350.9
 
Minority interests 
   
7,967.6
   
257.4
   
187.3
   
295.9
   
281.0
   
38.1
 
Total shareholders’ equity 
   
3,149.2
   
2,779.1
   
3,188.9
   
6,274.5
   
8,708.5
   
1,180.0
 
 
4

 
 
                                       
Other Data:
                                     
                                       
IFRS:
                                     
Cash flow from operating activities 
                     
2,367.9
   
3,166.4
   
429.1
 
Cash utilized in investing activities 
                     
(877.1
)
 
(335.4
)
 
(45.4
)
Cash (utilized in)/from financing activities 
                     
(513.7
)
 
24.5
   
3.3
 
U.S. GAAP:
                                     
Cash (utilized in)/from operating activities 
   
(346.1
)
 
1,128.9
   
1,692.3
   
2,347.0
   
3,393.0
   
459.8
 
Cash (utilized in)/from investing activities 
   
(1,088.0
)
 
42.5
   
(534.1
)
 
(683.6
)
 
(133.6
)
 
(18.1
)
Cash from/(utilized in) financing activities 
   
768.0
   
(942.6
)
 
(1,332.6
)
 
(364.3
)
 
(420.4
)
 
(57.0
)
______________
 
(1)
Includes interest expense, interest income, preference dividend income, foreign exchange gains and losses and fair value adjustments on derivative instruments.
 
(2)
Based on the U.S. dollar exchange rate at the respective payment dates of the 2006, 2005, 2004, 2003 and 2002 dividends, the U.S. dollar equivalent of the dividend per Class N ordinary share was U.S $0.09, U.S. $0.06, U.S. $0.04, U.S. $0.03 and U.S. $0.02, respectively. The dividend per Class A ordinary share amounted to U.S. $0.03 or less at these respective dates.
 
(3)
For U.S. GAAP reporting purposes, effective April 1, 2002, Naspers adopted Financial Accounting Standards No. 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets” (“SFAS No. 142”). Under SFAS No. 142, goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are not amortized but rather are tested at least annually for impairment. If this standard would have been adopted for fiscal year 2002 the adjusted net loss would have been Rand 3,842,228 and basic and diluted earnings per share for fiscal 2002 would have been Rand 26.37 and Rand 26.37, respectively.
 
(4)
The cumulative effect of change in accounting principle for fiscal 2003 relates to the adoption of SFAS 142. Upon completion of the transitional test, Naspers recorded an initial goodwill impairment of Rand 531.5 million. The cumulative effect of change in accounting principle for fiscal 2002 of Rand 18.4 million relates to the fair value of fair value hedges recorded on adoption of SFAS 133 “Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities”.
 
(5)
Excludes treasury shares and redeemable preferred stock.
 
(6)
Includes long-term liabilities in respect of capitalized finance leases, concession liabilities, interest-bearing loans, program and film rights liabilities and non-interest bearing loans.
 
 
Exchange Rate Information
 
The following tables show, for the periods and dates indicated, certain information regarding the U.S. dollar/Rand exchange rate. The information is based on the noon buying rate in the City of New York for cable transfers in Rand as certified for United States customs purposes by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York. On September 15, 2006, the rate was Rand 7.383 per U.S. $1.00.
 
Year ended March 31,
Average Rate(1)
(Rand per U.S. $1.00)
   
2002
9.643
2003
9.572
2004
7.161
2005
6.253
2006
6.398
________________
 
(1)
The average rate is calculated as the average of the noon buying rate on the last day of each month during the period.
 
5



 
High
Low
 
(Rand per U.S. $1.00)
March 2006
6.335
6.136
April 2006
6.166
5.985
May 2006
6.706
5.999
June 2006
7.430
6.634
July 2006
7.230
6.830
August 2006
7.198
6.723
September 2006 (until September 15, 2006)
7.433
7.163

For other important information, you should read the discussion of South African exchange controls in Item 10 of this annual report under the heading “Exchange Controls”.
 
3.D.                 Risk Factors
 
Risks relating to countries in which Naspers and its joint ventures operate
 
Naspers’ multinational operations expose it to a variety of economic, social and political risks
 
There is an element of risk in all countries in which Naspers operates. Naspers may be affected by political, social and economic changes in countries where the group has operations. The incidence of HIV/AIDS infection in a number of markets in which Naspers operates is high and may increase. Those at risk may include both Naspers’ employees, giving rise to increased sickness and disability costs, and its customers, resulting in a reduction in sales and an inability to grow Naspers’ revenue base.
 
A majority of Naspers’ revenue comes from its operations in South Africa. There has been a period of significant change in South Africa since the democratic government came to power in 1994. The Government continues to introduce policies designed to alleviate or redress inequalities suffered by the majority of citizens under the previous government. It is not possible to predict to what extent the government will continue introducing legislation or other measures designed to empower previously disadvantaged groups nor can it assess the potential impact of these reforms. MultiChoice South Africa and Media24 are preparing for broad-based Black Economic Empowerment (BEE) share schemes, aligned to the BEE legislation and the draft codes of good practice applicable to South Africa. These codes are not final yet and, although work has started in the South African companies of the Naspers Group to ensure compliance with these draft codes, Naspers can only assess its compliance once the codes are final.
 
Many emerging market countries have experienced high levels of unemployment and crime in recent years. These problems have impeded inward investment into these countries and have prompted some emigration of skilled workers. As a result, attracting and retaining suitably qualified employees in these countries may be difficult. Against the background of political tensions and the current transition to stable democratic governments, it is not possible to predict the future economic or political direction of these countries. Matters that may affect emerging market countries’ future economic and political direction include whether their governments can address the various political, social and economic challenges and the effect of the continuing integration of these economies both regionally and with the economies of the rest of the world.
 
Naspers operates in emerging economies, including many African countries, China, Brazil and more recently India and Russia. Naspers’ operations in these markets may involve economic and operating risks. Many countries in emerging markets have in the past experienced difficulties resulting from currency fluctuations, high interest rates, increases in corporate bankruptcies, stock market declines, terrorist attacks, threats and ransom, epidemics and other factors that may materially and adversely affect Naspers’ business. Although governments in many of these countries have taken steps toward addressing these problems, it is not possible to predict whether or to what extent these steps will succeed in achieving their objectives.
 
South Africa’s economy has recently experienced periods of moderate growth and inflation and high unemployment but growth could slow and inflation could increase
 
The South African economy has recently been growing at a moderate rate, and inflation has been relatively low. The growth in South Africa’s GDP was 2.8% for 2003, 3.7% for 2004 and 4.9% for 2005. South Africa’s unemployment rate was 26.7% in September 2005. The depreciation in value of the Rand against the U.S. dollar during the latter part of 2001 put upward pressure on South Africa’s inflation rate (CPIX) during the 2002 calendar year, peaking at 11.3%. Since 2003, the inflation rate
 
 
6


 
decreased as the Rand appreciated in value against the U.S. dollar. The South African Reserve Bank has stated that it targets South Africa’s inflation rate at between 3% and 6% per year. Despite such intentions, there can be no assurance that these inflation targets will be met. A future increase in inflation would increase financing and other costs in a manner that could adversely affect Naspers’ profitability.
 
South African exchange control restrictions could hinder Naspers’ normal corporate functioning
 
South Africa’s exchange control regulations provide for a common monetary area consisting of South Africa, the Kingdom of Lesotho, the Kingdom of Swaziland and the Republic of Namibia. Exchange controls may continue to operate in South Africa for the foreseeable future. As a consequence of these exchange controls, an acquisition of shares or assets of a South African company by a non-resident purchaser will require exchange control approval if the payment for the acquisition is in the form of shares of a non-resident company or if the acquisition is financed by a loan from a South African resident. Denial of any required regulatory approval may result in the acquisition not occurring.
 
South Africa’s interest rates may increase Naspers’ borrowing costs
 
The volatility of the Rand in the past has impacted the inflation rate in South Africa, causing the South African Reserve Bank to respond by using interest rates to manage inflation. The depreciation of the Rand has therefore resulted in interest rates being higher in South Africa than in most developed countries. The prime lending rate (the benchmark rate used by South African banks to determine lending rates for their customers) reached a high of 25.5% in 1998. The prime lending rate of 10.5% on September 15, 2005 was at its lowest level over the past 20 years, mainly due to the strengthening of the Rand against most major currencies over the past three years. The prime lending rate as at September 15, 2006 was 11.5%. An increase in interest rates in South Africa would increase Naspers’ cost of borrowings and hence the cost of capital.
 
Naspers could suffer losses as a result of fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates
 
Naspers’ reporting currency is the Rand. Naspers will continue to conduct business transactions in currencies other than its reporting currency. Approximately 23.6% of Naspers’ revenue was generated outside South Africa during fiscal 2006. Naspers is exposed to foreign exchange risk arising from various currency exposures primarily with respect to the U.S. dollar, the Naira, the Renminbi, the Euro and the Brazilian Real against the Rand, which have in the past affected and could in the future affect Naspers’ revenues, financing costs and general business and financial condition. In addition, fluctuations in the exchange rate of these currencies could affect the comparability of Naspers’ performance between financial periods, since a portion of Naspers’ sales are in currencies other than Rand while Naspers’ financial statements are stated in Rand.
 
A significant portion of Naspers’ cash obligations, including payment obligations under satellite transponder leases and contracts for pay-television programming and channels, are denominated in the currencies of countries in which Naspers has limited operations, such as U.S. dollars. Where Naspers’ revenue is denominated in local currency, a depreciation of the local currency against the U.S. dollar adversely affects Naspers’ earnings and Naspers’ ability to meet its cash obligations. Many of Naspers’ operations are in countries or regions where there has been depreciation of the local currency against the U.S. dollar in recent years. Naspers cannot provide assurances that the hedge transactions that Naspers enters into to mitigate currency risk will fully protect it against currency fluctuations or that Naspers will be able to hedge effectively against these risks in the future. Naspers can in most instances only hedge its foreign currency exposures for a limited period, therefore Naspers can not hedge 100% of its exposure.
 
The Rand, the Renminbi, the Naira and the Brazilian Real have at times in the past depreciated against the currencies of their major trading partners by more than the inflation rate differential between South Africa, China, Nigeria and Brazil and their major trading partners. Historically, the performance of the Rand against other currencies has been characterized by periods of rapid depreciation followed by periods of stability. In particular, the Rand rapidly depreciated against the U.S. dollar and other major currencies during the latter part of 2001. The value of the Rand against the U.S. dollar remains difficult to predict and vulnerable to depreciation. Since December 2001, the Rand has appreciated against the U.S. dollar, ending fiscal 2006 at Rand 6.15. The Rand depreciated after March 31, 2006 to Rand 7.38 on September 15, 2006. Any strengthening of the Rand will have a negative impact on the U.S. dollar based earnings of the group, but a positive impact on its dollar based expenses. Collectively, a strengthening of the Rand against the U.S. dollar has a positive net profit impact on Naspers. Naspers cannot predict the future relative strength of the Rand, Renminbi, Naira or Brazilian Real against the U.S. dollar and expects that these currencies will remain volatile against major currencies like the U.S. dollar and the Euro.
 
7


 
In addition, fluctuations in the exchange rate between the Rand and the U.S. dollar could adversely affect the market value of Naspers American Depositary Shares (“ADSs”) in the United States and the real value of dividends paid on Naspers’ ADSs.
 
The activity of trade unions could adversely affect Naspers’ business
 
As of March 31, 2006, trade unions represented some of Naspers’ employees. In the past, trade unions have had influence as vehicles for social, economic and political reform and in the collective bargaining process. The cost of complying with labor laws may adversely affect Naspers’ operations. The risks and associated costs with labor strikes are difficult to manage and predict.
 
Because Naspers is a South African company, you may not be able to enforce judgments against Naspers and its directors and officers that are obtained in U.S. courts
 
Naspers is incorporated in South Africa. Most of Naspers’ directors and executive officers reside outside the United States. Substantially all the assets of Naspers, its directors and executive officers are located outside the United States. As a result, it may not be possible for investors to effect service of process within the United States upon Naspers or its directors or executive officers, or to enforce against such persons judgments of the United States courts based upon the civil liability provisions of the Federal securities laws or other laws of the United States or any of its states. Although foreign judgments are recognized by South African courts, they are generally not directly enforceable in South Africa and can only be enforced by way of execution of an order to that effect made by a competent South African court, the latter court basing its order upon the judgment of the foreign court.
 
The policy of South African courts is to award compensation only for loss or damage actually sustained by the person claiming the compensation. The award of punitive damages is generally not recognized by the South African legal system, on the grounds that such awards are contrary to public policy. Whether a judgment is contrary to public policy depends on the facts of each case. Exorbitant, unconscionable or excessive awards will generally be contrary to South African public policy. South African courts cannot consider the merits of a foreign judgment and cannot act as a court of appeal or review over the foreign court. South African courts will usually observe their own procedural laws and, where an action based on a contract governed by a foreign law is brought before a South African court, the capacity of the parties to contract may under certain circumstances be determined in accordance with South African law. A plaintiff who is not resident in South Africa may be required to provide security for costs where proceedings are initiated in South Africa. In addition, the Rules of the High Court of South Africa require that documents executed outside South Africa must be authenticated by way of the apostille procedure in terms of the Hague Convention 1961 before they are used in South Africa. Also, foreign judgments concerning the ownership, use or sale of any matter or material connected with South African commerce (such as production, import and export) require consent from the South African Minister of Trade and Industry to be enforced in accordance with the South African Protection of Business Act, 1978. Naspers has been advised by Webber Wentzel Bowens, its South African counsel, that there is doubt as to the enforceability against Naspers and its directors and officers in South Africa of liabilities predicated solely upon the Federal securities laws of the United States.
 
Risks relating to Naspers’ business
 
Naspers’ level of debt could adversely affect its business and competitive position
 
Naspers has an amount of debt that may adversely affect its business in numerous ways. As of March 31, 2006, Naspers had total debt (including finance leases and debt in respect of program and film broadcasting rights) of approximately Rand 4.42 billion, or U.S. $598.9 million. On the same basis, Naspers’ ratio of total debt to equity would have equaled 0.61. Naspers’ debt could, among other things:
 
 
·
increase its vulnerability to adverse economic conditions or increases in prevailing interest rates, particularly where borrowings are or will be made at variable interest rates;
     
 
· 
limit its ability to obtain additional financing that may be necessary to operate, develop or expand its business; 
     
  ·  require Naspers to dedicate a portion of its cash flow from operations to service its debt, which in turn reduces the funds available for operations, future business opportunities and dividends; and 
     
 
 
8

 
 
  ·  potentially place Naspers at a competitive disadvantage relative to competitors with less debt. 
 
Naspers’ ability to make payments on its debt will depend upon its future operating performance, which is subject to general economic and competitive conditions, many of which are outside Naspers’ control. If the cash flow from Naspers’ business and its operating subsidiaries is insufficient to make payments on its debt or is otherwise unavailable, Naspers may have to delay or reduce capital expenditures, attempt to restructure or refinance its debt, sell assets or raise additional equity capital. Naspers may not be able to take these actions on satisfactory terms, in a timely manner or at all. The sale of additional shares, or the possibility of such a sale, may adversely affect the price of our outstanding shares, including the Class N Shares.
 
Naspers depends on access to cash flows from its subsidiaries, associated companies and joint ventures, and limitations on accessing the cash flow may adversely affect Naspers’ business operations and financial condition
 
Naspers Limited has no significant business operations or assets other than its interests in its subsidiaries, associated companies, joint ventures and other investments. Accordingly, Naspers relies upon distributions from its subsidiaries, associated companies, joint ventures and other investments to generate the funds necessary to meet the obligations and other cash flow requirements of the combined group. Naspers’ subsidiaries, associated companies, and joint ventures are separate and distinct legal entities that have no obligation to make any funds available to Naspers, whether by intercompany loans or by the payment of dividends. The ability of Naspers to utilize the cash flows from some of its subsidiaries, associated companies and joint ventures is subject, in South Africa, China, Brazil and other countries, to foreign investment and exchange control laws and also to the availability of a sufficient quantity of foreign exchange. In particular, substantially all the cash flow generated by Naspers’ South African businesses cannot be currently utilized outside South Africa without exchange control approval. Naspers’ non-South African subsidiaries may be subject to similar restrictions imposed by their respective home countries. In addition, because the consent of some of Naspers’ joint venture partners is required for distributions from Naspers’ joint ventures, Naspers’ ability to receive distributions from the joint ventures is dependent on the co-operation of its joint venture partners. The interests of the minority shareholders of some of Naspers’ subsidiaries and associates must be considered when those subsidiaries and associates make distributions. Accordingly, Naspers may not be able to obtain cash from its subsidiaries, associated companies, joint ventures and other investments at the times and in the amounts required by Naspers. Any failure by Naspers to receive distributions from its businesses could restrict Naspers’ ability to provide adequate funding to the combined group and otherwise meet its obligations. Naspers’ business units may face funding and liquidity difficulties under the terms of the financing arrangements upon which they depend. Each Naspers business relies on its own separate credit facility and financing, to the extent necessary. Naspers has not to date provided any parent company guarantees in respect of bank borrowings. Several of the credit facilities and other financing arrangements contain financial covenants and other similar undertakings and requirements. If these covenants, undertakings or requirements are violated, the financing may not be available and the relevant business unit could face liquidity difficulties. In addition, many of the different group credit facilities must be renewed annually by the relevant lenders.
 
Naspers has only limited influence over its minority investments and the value of Naspers stake in such investments could decrease
 
Naspers holds minority stakes in a number of companies, including a 36.1% interest in Tencent Holdings Limited (“Tencent”) and a 30% interest in Abril S.A. Although Naspers exercises influence with respect to certain of the affairs of these and other companies in which it holds a minority stake, Naspers minority voting position has and may continue to have several important consequences for Naspers, including precluding us from controlling the businesses, limiting our ability to implement strategies we favor and allowing the business to adopt strategies and take actions which may in some cases be contrary to our preferred strategies and actions. As with many minority investments, differences in views among the principal shareholders may result in delayed decisions or in failures to agree on major matters, potentially adversely affecting the business and operations of the joint venture and in turn Naspers business and operations.
 
The acquisitions and investments that Naspers has made and may make in the future may not be successful and may create unanticipated problems
 
Naspers has experienced growth and development through successful acquisitions and investments in the past and intends to continue to pursue acquisitions in order to meet its strategic objectives. Integrating the operations and personnel of acquired businesses is a complex process. Naspers may not be able to integrate the operations of its acquired businesses with its operations rapidly or without encountering difficulties. The diversion of the attention of management to the integration effort and any difficulties encountered in combining operations could adversely affect Naspers’ business and operations. In addition, although Naspers has grown through successful acquisitions in the past, no assurance can be given that it will be able to identify, acquire and
 
 
9

 
 
successfully integrate additional companies in the future. Future acquisitions Naspers does undertake could result in potentially dilutive issuances of additional equity and the incurrence of debt and contingent liabilities.
 
Naspers’ businesses operate in highly competitive and rapidly changing industries and increased competition could adversely affect Naspers’ results of operations and financial condition
 
Pay-television. Although Naspers is currently the leading provider of pay-television services in most of its markets, Naspers competes directly with both state owned and private national free-to-air broadcast networks and regional and local broadcast stations for audience share, programming and advertising revenue and indirectly with motion picture theatres, video rental stores, mobile telephones, lotteries, gaming and other entertainment and leisure activities for general leisure spending. Naspers cannot determine the nature or extent of future competition it may face in the pay-television market. In South Africa licenses will be granted in the future to other operators. In Sub-Saharan Africa and Cyprus various competitors have entered the pay-television market. The entry of additional competitors into any of the pay-television markets where Naspers operates remains a continuous possibility. In addition, the sale of DVDs, ADSL broadband, mobile and wireless technologies providing digital pay-television content may erode Naspers’ pay-television subscriber base.
 
Internet. The market for internet access, communication, portal and related services is highly competitive. Naspers anticipates that competition will continue to intensify as the use of the internet grows. The African and Asian internet markets are characterized by an increasing number of entrants. Naspers’ competitors will compete in these markets. Many of these competitors have longer operating histories and substantially greater financial, technical, marketing and personnel resources and better recognized brand names than Naspers. Some of Naspers’ internet businesses may therefore never reach profitability.
 
Newspapers, Magazines and Printing. Revenues in the print media industry are dependent primarily upon paid circulation, advertising and printing revenues. Competition for circulation and advertising revenue comes from local, regional and national newspapers, magazines, radio, television, direct mail and other communications and advertising media that operate in the same markets. In addition, the rapid development of online internet advertising could have a negative impact on print media advertising. The extent and nature of such competition is, in large part, determined by the location and demographics of the markets and the number of media alternatives available in these markets. Naspers may face increased competition as both local and international publishers introduce new niche titles. Internationally recognized titles also continue to be introduced in South Africa. Many of the print media markets are overpopulated, with too many titles relative to the size of the readership base. Competitors that are active in the same markets as Naspers attempt to increase their market share, circulation and advertising revenues by changing the style and layout of their publications to win new customers at the expense of Naspers’ magazines and newspapers and by launching new titles. In addition, Naspers’ competitors may reduce the cover prices of their publications to increase their circulation. Naspers may be forced to decrease the prices it charges for magazines and newspapers in response or make other changes in the way it operates. Naspers’ business and results of operations may be harmed as a result.
 
Other businesses. The markets for the products and services currently offered by Irdeto, Naspers’ conditional access technology business, Entriq, Mediazone and Naspers’ book publishing and education businesses are highly competitive. All these businesses operate in fragmented markets and some compete with large international players. Irdeto competes with numerous entities, including subsidiaries of other pay-television providers, many of which have greater financial resources than Naspers. Entriq and Mediazone compete with a variety of players. Via Afrika Limited (Via Afrika), the book publishing subsidiary of Media24 Limited (“Media24”), faces competition from several South African publishers as well as large international publishing houses, which have substantially greater resources and strong brand names. Educor Holdings Limited (Educor), the private education subsidiary of Media24, faces competition from many different South African public universities and private educators, as well as from international educators, many of whom have substantially greater resources and better recognized brand names than Educor.
 
MultiChoice South Africa has applied for a broadcast license and the level of competition emanating from the license application process has increased

The Independent Communications Authority of South Africa (ICASA) issued its invitation to apply for satellite and cable licenses on January 31, 2006 and indicated that it expected to license new operators by mid 2007. The closing date for applications was July 31, 2006 which date was later extended to August 31, 2006. MultiChoice Africa (Proprietary) Limited (“MultiChoice”) submitted its application for a subscription broadcasting license on 31 August 2006.  ICASA has received a number of applications including applications from traditional telecommunications operators and existing broadcasters, as well as potential new entrants.
 
 
10

 
 
Steady or declining subscriber levels may prevent further growth of some of or all of Naspers’ businesses
 
Naspers’ largest businesses are generally in mature markets and may face difficulties in maintaining or growing the number of subscribers. Naspers’ pay-television business in Greece has in the past experienced high levels of annual subscriber churn. High levels of churn and decreasing or flat subscriber numbers may be caused by competition from new entrants to the pay-television market and from other sources competing for discretionary income, economic and other local difficulties, the loss of popular sports and movie programming content and seasonality associated with the markets in which Naspers operates. Increases in prices can also lead to churn and subscriber terminations. Declining subscriber levels also adversely affect Irdeto, because Naspers’ pay-television operators constitute some of Irdeto’s primary customers. Naspers’ print media business has experienced declining circulation of some of its more established publications due to the maturity of some of its magazine titles and newspapers in South Africa and the introduction into the market of a large number of competing magazines and newspapers. Steady or declining subscriber levels make it difficult for Naspers to grow its businesses.
 
A reduction in demand for advertising may adversely affect Naspers’ businesses and revenues
 
A large portion of Naspers’ revenue is generated by advertising revenues. Advertising revenues are cyclical and are dependent upon general economic conditions. Traditionally, spending by companies on advertising and other marketing activities, and hence Naspers’ advertising and commercial printing revenue, decreases significantly in times of economic slowdown or recession. In particular, Naspers’ advertising revenues are subject to risks arising from adverse changes in domestic and global economic conditions and fluctuations in consumer confidence and spending. Consumer confidence and spending may decline as a result of numerous factors outside of Naspers’ control, such as terrorist attacks or acts of war. Global economic downturns and declining levels of business activity of Naspers’ advertisers have in the past and could in the future adversely affect Naspers’ results of operations. Newspaper and magazine advertising may decline relative to television, radio and outdoor advertising. Such trends would adversely affect Naspers’ results and financial condition.
 
Increases in newsprint and magazine paper costs could adversely affect Naspers’ results
 
Newsprint and magazine paper costs represent the single largest raw material expense for Naspers’ print media businesses and are among Naspers’ most significant operating costs. Newsprint and magazine paper costs fluctuate from time to time due to numerous factors beyond Naspers’ control, especially due to demand and supply forces, and exchange rate fluctuations between the Rand and other currencies such as the U.S. dollar and the Euro. An increase in newsprint and magazine paper costs will adversely affect Naspers’ earnings and cash flow.
 
Naspers’ business environment is subject to rapid technological change which could render Naspers’ products and services obsolete
 
Naspers operates pay-television and technology businesses through its holding in MIH Holdings Limited (“MIH Holdings”) and internet businesses through Media24 and its holding in MIH Holdings. The rate of technological change currently affecting the pay-television and internet industries is rapid compared to other industries. Trends, such as the migration of television from analog to digital transmission and the convergence of television, the internet, mobile telephones and other media, are creating an unpredictable environment. New technologies or industry standards have the potential to replace or provide lower-cost alternatives to products and services sold by Naspers. Naspers’ print media, publishing and education businesses also operate in markets that continue to change in response to technological innovations and other factors. In particular, the means of delivering Naspers’ products, and the products themselves, may be subject to rapid technological change.
 
Naspers cannot predict whether technological innovations will, in the future, make some of its products and services wholly or partially obsolete or adversely affect the competitiveness of its businesses. Naspers may be required to continue to invest significant resources to further adapt to changing technologies, markets and competitive environments.
 
Naspers’ substantial investment in internet related business may not produce positive returns
 
A part of Naspers’ strategy is to further develop its internet businesses. Naspers has invested, and will continue to invest, significant amounts to develop and promote its internet initiatives and electronic platforms. Naspers has made these investments through Media24 and through its shareholding in MIH Holdings. The provision of products and services over the internet and otherwise in electronic form is highly competitive and is in relatively early stages of development.
 
 
11

 
 
Naspers may experience difficulties developing this aspect of its business due to a variety of factors, many of which are beyond Naspers’ control. These factors may include:
 
 
  ·  the extent of acceptance of Naspers’ internet initiatives and related electronic platforms by customers; 
     
  ·  competition from comparable and new technologies; 
     
  · 
government regulation and control of the content and medium; 
     
  ·  customers not accepting or not continuing to use the internet and electronic media; and 
     
  ·  failures or difficulties with the data networks and infrastructures upon which Naspers depends. 
 
Moreover, Naspers relies on third parties for the provision of local and international bandwidth.
 
Naspers’ long-term success depends on the continued development of the internet as a commercial medium. As a result of rapidly changing technology, developing industry standards and frequent new product and service introductions, demand and market acceptance for recently introduced products and services on the internet are subject to uncertainty. Critical issues concerning the commercial use of the internet, including the perceived lack of security of commercial data, such as credit card numbers, and capacity constraints resulting in delays, transmission errors and other difficulties may impact the growth of internet use. These and other issues affecting the internet industry may be aggravated in countries with less developed internet cultures and infrastructures in which Naspers currently conducts or may in the future conduct its internet business, including South Africa, Thailand, China and Brazil. If the market for internet access services develops more slowly than expected or becomes saturated with competitors, or if the internet access and services offered by Naspers are not broadly accepted, Naspers’ growth strategy could be adversely affected.
 
Naspers’ business interests in China are dependent upon indirect relationships with third parties and mobile operators which are subject to various operational and competitive risks
 
Companies in which MIH Holdings has invested, including Tencent, provide internet, mobile and telecommunications value-added services to subscribers in China through a series of contracts with companies, which are licensed to operate these services.  MIH Holdings, however, does not hold any direct or indirect equity interests in the licensed operating companies and instead relies on a series of contracts in order to recognize and receive the economic benefit of the business and operations of these companies. As a result, MIH Holdings may not be able to fully recognize and receive the economic benefits of the China business and operations and may not be able to effectively control the China operations.
 
The revenue generated by services provided over mobile telephone networks or fixed line networks are principally recognized and received under contracts with Chinese mobile telephony and network operators. If these operators commit errors in recording revenue or fail to pay fees due to service providers, or if existing contracts are not renewed or less favorable terms are imposed, the financial condition, results of operations and profitability of the companies in which MIH Holdings has invested would be adversely affected. Also, if the business conditions of the mobile telephony operators deteriorate or if these mobile operators impose penalties or restraints on service providers, the business operations and financial condition of the companies in which MIH Holdings has invested may be materially and adversely affected.
 
The Chinese mobile telecommunications markets are highly competitive, rapidly developing and subject to economic, regulatory and other uncertainties. The size of the future customer base and user activity will be affected by a number of factors, many of which are outside of Naspers’ control, such as the regulatory regime governing the provision of telecommunication services in China and the general economic conditions in the region.
 
Naspers’ businesses rely on software and hardware systems that are susceptible to failure
 
Interruptions to the availability of Naspers’ internet services or increases in the response times of Naspers’ services caused by the failure of Naspers’ software or hardware systems could reduce user satisfaction, the amount of internet traffic and Naspers’ attractiveness to advertisers and consumers. Naspers’ publishing business also depends upon the timely functioning of software and hardware used to print newspapers and magazines and to publish books. Naspers is also dependent upon web browsers, telecommunication systems and other aspects of the internet infrastructure that have experienced system failures and electrical outages in the past. Naspers’ operations are susceptible to outages due to fire, floods, power loss,
 
 
12

 
 
telecommunications failures, break-ins, industrial actions and similar events. Despite Naspers implementing network security measures, Naspers’ servers are vulnerable to computer viruses, break-ins and similar disruptions from unauthorized tampering with its computer systems.
 
Naspers’ business may suffer if it cannot obtain attractive programming or if the cost of television receivers increases
 
The continued success of Naspers’ pay-television business depends upon its ability to continue to obtain attractive film, sports and other programming on commercially reasonable terms. For most of the programming, Naspers contracts with suppliers who in turn purchase programming from content providers. Much of Naspers’ premium programming is sourced through Electronic Media Network Limited (“M-Net”) and SuperSport International Holdings Limited (“SuperSport”). Naspers’ film studio and sport programming contracts are up for renewal from time to time. In the event the supply contracts or underlying programming arrangements are not renewed or are cancelled, Naspers will be required to seek alternative programming from other sources. Naspers cannot be sure whether alternative programming would be available on commercially reasonable terms or whether the alternative programming would appeal to Naspers’ subscribers. Naspers’ business strategy also depends on its ability to offer attractive programming on an exclusive basis. Political, regulatory and competitive pressures may make it more difficult to maintain exclusive rights to programming.
 
Naspers’ growth depends in part upon its ability to attract new pay-television customers. Many new customers are required to purchase the equipment necessary to receive Naspers’ broadcasts. The cost of this equipment may discourage potential subscribers, and Naspers’ market penetration and growth may be impeded if the cost of this equipment increases.
 
Satellite failures could adversely affect Naspers’ business and ability to grow
 
Naspers’ digital programming is transmitted to its customers through different satellites around the world, and in some regions Naspers’ terrestrial analog signal is also transmitted to regional broadcast points through satellites. In addition, Naspers receives a significant amount of its programming through satellites. Satellites are subject to significant risks such as defects, launch failure, incorrect orbital placement and destruction and damage that may prevent or impair proper commercial operations. All satellites have limited useful lives, which vary as a result of their construction, the durability of their components, the capability of their solar arrays and batteries, the amount of fuel remaining once in orbit, the launch vehicle used and the accuracy of the launch. The operation of satellites is beyond Naspers’ control. Future launch failures or disruption of the transmissions of satellites that are already operational could adversely affect Naspers’ operations. Some satellites used by Naspers’ pay-television operations have experienced technical failures in the past. In addition, Naspers’ ability to transmit its programming following the end of the expected useful lives of the satellites Naspers currently uses and to broadcast additional channels in the future will depend upon Naspers’ ability to obtain rights to utilize transponders on other satellites. In the event of a satellite failure, Naspers would need to make alternative arrangements for transponder capacity. Naspers may not be able to obtain alternative capacity rights on commercially reasonable terms or at all. In the event that Naspers has to obtain alternative transponder capacity, it may need customers to realign their satellite dishes to receive the broadcasting signals, which could prove impractical and very expensive to implement.
 
Naspers’ business may suffer if its printing equipment or facilities are damaged or fail to perform
 
Some of Naspers’ newspapers, magazines and educational textbooks, and a number of third party publications, are printed on printing equipment and facilities owned by the group. If printing facilities were damaged or if operations were interrupted due to a natural disaster or otherwise, the publication of some titles or textbooks could be interrupted and Naspers’ operating results could be adversely affected. In the event of such damage or destruction, Naspers would need to make alternative arrangements for printing to be outsourced. Naspers may not be able to obtain alternative printing services on commercially reasonable terms or at all.
 
Unauthorized access to Naspers’ programming signals may adversely affect Naspers’ revenues and programming arrangements
 
Naspers faces the risk that its programming signals will be accessed by unauthorized users. The delivery of subscription programming requires the use of encryption technology to prevent unauthorized access to programming, or “piracy”. Naspers currently utilizes encryption technology supplied by Irdeto. This encryption technology, to remain effective in preventing unauthorized access, needs to continually be updated or replaced with newer technology. Naspers will continue to incur substantial expenditures to replace or upgrade its encryption technology in the future. Encryption technology cannot completely prevent all piracy, and virtually all pay-television markets are characterized by varying degrees of piracy that manifest themselves in different
 
 
13

 
 
ways. In addition, encryption technology cannot completely prevent the illegal retransmission or sharing of a television signal once it has been decrypted. If Naspers fails to adequately prevent unauthorized access to its transmissions, its ability to contract for programming services could be adversely affected and in any event it will lose subscribers who can then receive pirated signals.
 
Government regulations may adversely affect Naspers’ ability to conduct its businesses and generate operating profits
 
All media operations are subject to governmental regulation in the countries in which Naspers operates. Governmental regulation can take the form of price controls, service requirements, programming content restrictions, ownership restrictions, licensing requirements and restrictions on the amount of fees paid for advertising. Failure or delays in obtaining or renewing any necessary regulatory approvals could adversely affect Naspers’ ability to offer some of or all its services. In most of the countries in which Naspers conducts its pay-television businesses, it operates under licenses obtained from governmental or quasi governmental agencies. These licenses are subject to periodic renewal, and Naspers may not be able to renew the licenses on terms as favorable as the existing licenses or at all. Adverse changes in the regulatory framework of any country in which Naspers operates may occur in the short or long term. The media and competition regulatory frameworks everywhere are subject to change, and the relevant regulatory authorities may increase their regulation of Naspers’ businesses in these countries. Naspers cannot predict the likely impact that any such action by applicable competition and regulatory authorities could have on the operation of its businesses. In addition, there are several legislative proposals and other initiatives underway in some markets that could materially impact how Naspers conducts its business.
 
Failure to maintain Naspers’ relationships with its partners, suppliers and local governments could disrupt Naspers’ businesses
 
Many of Naspers’ operations have been developed in cooperation or partnership with key parties. With regard to these operations, Naspers is dependent on its partners to provide knowledge of local market conditions and to facilitate the acquisition of any necessary licenses and permits. Any failure by Naspers to form alliances with such partners, or the disruption of existing alliances, could adversely affect Naspers’ ability to penetrate and compete successfully in many important markets. Naspers’ businesses are dependent on their relationships with international suppliers, including major film studios and book publishers.
 
Some of Naspers’ businesses may also be vulnerable to local governmental or quasi governmental entities or other third parties who wish to renegotiate the terms and conditions of their agreements or other understandings with Naspers or who wish to terminate these agreements or understandings. Adverse developments with respect to Naspers’ relationships with its partners or with local governmental or quasi governmental entities could adversely affect Naspers’ business strategy and results of operations in important markets. Such developments could also lead to the introduction of additional taxes.
 
Consolidation in the markets in which Naspers operates could place it at a competitive disadvantage
 
Some of the markets in which Naspers operates have experienced consolidation. In particular, the combinations of traditional media content companies and new media distribution companies have resulted in new valuation methods, business models and strategies. Naspers cannot predict the extent to which these types of business combinations may continue to occur in the future or the success that these combined businesses may achieve. The on-going consolidation could potentially place Naspers at a competitive disadvantage with respect to scale, resources and its ability to develop and exploit new media technologies.
 
Naspers’ intellectual property rights may not be adequately protected under current laws in some jurisdictions, which may adversely affect its results and ability to grow
 
Naspers’ products are largely comprised of intellectual property content that is delivered through a variety of media, including magazines, newspapers, books, television and the internet. Naspers relies on trademark, copyright, trade secret and other intellectual property laws and employee and third party non-disclosure agreements to establish and protect its proprietary rights in these products. Naspers conducts business in some countries where the extent of the legal protection for its intellectual property rights is not well-established or is uncertain.
 
Even where the legal protection for Naspers’ intellectual property rights is well-established, Naspers intellectual property rights may be challenged, limited, invalidated or circumvented. Despite patent, trademark and copyright protection, third parties may be able to copy, infringe or otherwise profit from Naspers’ intellectual property rights without its authorization. The lack of internet specific legislation relating to trademark and copyright protection creates a further challenge for Naspers to protect content delivered through the internet and electronic platforms. If unauthorized copying or misuse of Naspers’ products were to
 
 
14

 
occur to any substantial degree, Naspers’ business and results of operations could be adversely affected. Litigation may be necessary to protect Naspers’ intellectual property rights, which could result in substantial costs and the diversion of Naspers’ efforts away from operating its business.
 
Legal claims in connection with content that Naspers distributes may require Naspers to incur significant costs or to enter into royalty or licensing agreements, which could adversely affect Naspers’ competitive position
 
The content Naspers makes available to customers through its publishing, pay-television and internet businesses could result in claims against it based on a variety of grounds, including defamation, negligence, copyright or trademark infringement, obscenity or facilitating illegal activities. In particular, Naspers expects that software developers will increasingly be subject to claims asserting the infringement of other parties’ proprietary rights as the number of products and competitors providing software and services increases.
 
Any such claim, with or without merit, could result in costly litigation or might require Naspers to enter into royalty or licensing agreements. These royalty or licensing agreements, if required, may not be available on terms acceptable to Naspers or at all. As a result of infringement claims, a court could also issue an injunction preventing the distribution of certain products. Naspers may incur significant costs defending these claims.
 
Naspers may need to improve its internal controls over financial reporting and Naspers’ independent auditors may not be able to attest to their effectiveness, which could adversely affect Naspers’ business operations, reputation and profitability
 
Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 requires that Naspers document its internal control systems and processes over financial reporting, evaluate the adequacy of the design of these respective controls and test that these controls are operating effectively. Naspers is currently evaluating its internal controls over financial reporting in order to allow management to report on, and its independent auditors to attest to, the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, as required by Section 404. Naspers is still in the process of evaluating the adequacy of design and testing the effectiveness of these various internal control activities over financial reporting. Certain potential significant deficiencies and material weaknesses have been identified to date which, if not remedied, could adversely impact our reporting obligations under Section 404.
 
If Naspers is not able to implement the requirements of Section 404 by March 31, 2007, its independent auditors may not be able to attest to the adequacy and effectiveness of the internal controls over its financial reporting. In such an instance, Naspers may be subject to sanction or investigation by regulatory authorities, such as the SEC. As a result, there could be a negative reaction in the financial markets due to a loss of confidence in the reliability of Naspers’ financial statements. In addition, Naspers may be required to incur costs in improving its internal control systems. Any such action could negatively affect Naspers’ results and have an adverse effect on its business operations, reputation and profitability.
 
Changes in accounting standards or interpretations issued by standard-setting bodies for IFRS and U.S. GAAP may adversely affect Naspers’ reported revenues, profitability and financial results

Our financial statements are subject to the application of IFRS and U.S. GAAP, which are periodically revised. The application of accounting principles is also subject to varying interpretations over time. In particular, IFRS, as a relatively new set of accounting principles, is subject to further change. Accordingly, Naspers is required to adopt new or revised accounting standards or comply with revised interpretations that are issued from time to time by the relevant authoritative bodies. Those changes could adversely affect Naspers’ reported revenues, profitability and financial results. For example, with the increased focus on fair value accounting, changes in the market valuation of certain financial instruments will be reflected in the reported results before those gains or losses are actually realized and this could have a significant impact on the income statement. IFRS standards now also require certain items that previously had no income statement impact to be expensed through the income statement . This can in some instances cause the reported financial results to not reflect what Naspers’ believes is the economic reality of its business.
 
Naspers believes that it complies with the appropriate regulatory requirements concerning its financial statements and disclosures. However, other companies have experienced investigations into potential non-compliance with accounting and disclosure requirements that have resulted in significant penalties.
 
 
15

 
 
Risks relating to the Class N ordinary shares and Naspers ADSs
 
Existing Class A ordinary shares of Naspers have more voting rights than, and a liquidation preference over, the Class N ordinary shares and ADSs of Naspers
 
Naspers’ issued capital at March 31, 2006 consists of 712,131 Class A ordinary shares and 315,113,700 Class N ordinary shares. The Class N ordinary shares are listed on the JSE and on a poll carry one vote per share. The Class A ordinary shares are not listed on a stock exchange and on a poll carry 1,000 votes per share. Naspers, through Heemstede Beleggings (Proprietary) Limited, a wholly owned subsidiary of Naspers, holds 49% of Naspers Beleggings Limited which, in turn, holds 49.15% of the Class A ordinary shares, which carry approximately 34.09% of the total voting rights in respect of Naspers’ ordinary shares. Keeromstraat 30 Beleggings Limited holds 30.80% of the Class A ordinary shares, which represents 21.36% of the total voting rights in respect of Naspers’ ordinary shares. Some members of the board of directors of Keeromstraat 30 Beleggings Limited, Naspers Beleggings Limited and Heemstede Beleggings (Proprietary) Limited are also members of the board of directors of Naspers Limited. As a result, the controlling shareholders and these directors significantly influence the outcome of any action requiring approval of shareholders, including amendments to Naspers’ memorandum and articles of association for any purpose, the issuance of additional Class A or Class N ordinary shares, and mergers and other business combinations. If the interests of Naspers’ controlling shareholders and directors diverge from the interests of other shareholders, they may be in a position to cause or require Naspers to act in a way that is inconsistent with the general interests of holders of Class N ordinary shares and ADSs.
 
If Naspers is liquidated, holders of Class A ordinary shares will be paid the nominal value of such shares before any payment is made to holders of Class N ordinary shares or ADSs. Based on the outstanding Class A ordinary shares, this amounted to approximately Rand 14.2 million as of March 31, 2006.
 
In terms of South African company law, resolutions passed by Naspers’ shareholders and the lower voting rights of the Class N ordinary shares relative to Class A ordinary shares could deter a change in control and may adversely affect Naspers’ share price
 
Some of the provisions of the South African Companies Act, 1973 (the Companies Act) and some of the resolutions passed annually by Naspers’ shareholders in general meeting may discourage attempts by other companies to acquire or merge with Naspers, which could reduce the market value of Class N ordinary shares and ADSs. The Companies Act requires that 75% of the total votes exercisable by all shareholders at a meeting (subject to a quorum of shareholders holding at least 25% of the total number of votes present, in person or by proxy, at the meeting) approve changes to certain provisions of Naspers’ memorandum and articles of association. In addition, Naspers’ shareholders in general meeting may annually pass resolutions that authorize Naspers’ board of directors to issue certain Class N ordinary shares and certain Class A ordinary shares without the specific approval of the holders of Class N ordinary shares.
 
The lower voting rights of the Class N ordinary shares relative to Class A ordinary shares could prevent or hinder a merger, takeover or other business combination involving Naspers or discourage a potential acquirer from otherwise attempting to obtain control of Naspers.
 
Your ability to sell a substantial number of ADSs may be restricted by the liquidity of shares traded on the Nasdaq
 
The only trading market for Class N ordinary shares is the JSE. The only trading market for Naspers ADSs is the Nasdaq Stock Market (“Nasdaq”). Trading volumes of Naspers ADSs on Nasdaq have been low. As a result, the ability of a holder to sell a substantial number of ADSs on Nasdaq in a timely manner may be restricted. From July 1, 2005 through June 30, 2006, 220.1 million Class N ordinary shares (70% of the total issued) were traded on the JSE and 3.7 million ADSs were traded on Nasdaq.
 
 
16

 
 
ITEM 4.          INFORMATION ON THE COMPANY
 
4.A.                  History and Development
 
Naspers was incorporated in Cape Town on May 12, 1915 under the laws of the then Union of South Africa as a public limited liability company. Naspers conducts its operations primarily through its subsidiaries and other affiliates. Its principal executive offices are located at 40 Heerengracht, Cape Town, 8001, South Africa (telephone: +27 21 406 2121).
 
Naspers started as a printer and publisher of newspapers and magazines in 1915. Later, book publishing operations were founded. Naspers’ print media operations developed of such an extent over the years that Naspers is now one of the leading media groups in Africa.
 
With the advent of electronic media, Naspers expanded its activities in the 1980s to incorporate pay-television and later internet platforms. In 1985, Naspers and several other South African media companies formed an electronic pay-media business, M-Net. M-Net was listed on the JSE in 1990. In October 1993, M-Net was divided into two companies. The subscriber management, signal distribution and cellular telephone businesses, together with a holding in FilmNet (a pay-television operator in Europe) were placed into a new company called MultiChoice Limited (later named MIH Holdings Limited).
 
In December 2002, Naspers conducted a reorganization pursuant to which the minority interests in MIH Holdings and MIH Limited were swapped for shares in Naspers itself. Holders of MIH Limited shares, resident in any country other than South Africa, received their interest in Naspers shares in the form of Naspers ADSs. MIH Holdings shares were delisted from the JSE and MIH Limited’s shares were delisted from Nasdaq. At the same time, Naspers’ ADSs were listed on Nasdaq.
 
In May 2001, the group acquired a 46.5% interest in Tencent, the operator of an instant messaging platform in China called QQ. The business developed into the leading instant messaging business in China. Tencent listed on the Hong Kong Stock Exchange in June 2004, whereafter Naspers’ interest decreased to 36.1%.
 
Naspers acquired an additional interest in M-Net and SuperSport and subsequently they were both delisted from the JSE and Nigerian Stock Exchange with effect from April 15, 2004.
 
In December 2004, Naspers acquired a 9.9% interest in the Beijing Media Corporation (“BMC”) for a cash consideration of Rand 273.2 million. BMC is a media company principally engaged in the sale of advertising space for the Beijing Youth Daily, production of newspapers and trading of print-related materials. On December 22, 2004 BMC listed its shares on the Hong Kong Stock Exchange.
 
On March 31, 2005, Naspers consolidated all its print media, book publishing (Via Afrika) and private education (Educor) assets under the Media24 umbrella in order to simplify the group structure.
 
In January 2006, Naspers sold its entire interest in United Broadcasting Corporation plc (“UBC”), Thailand’s leading pay-television operator, and MKSC World Dot Com Co.(“MKSC”), a leading Thai ISP, and recognized a profit on discontinuance of operations of Rand 1,032.2 million on the transaction. Details relating to this transaction are highlighted in note 28 to Naspers’ audited consolidated financial statements.
 
In April 2006, Naspers acquired, through Irdeto, the CryptoTec Conditional Access business from Koninklijke Philips Electronics NV for a cash consideration of Rand 230.7 million. The business is involved in the development and selling of content security systems.
 
In May 2006, Naspers acquired a 30% interest in Abril S.A. (“Abril”) for a cash consideration of Rand 2,557.3 million. Abril is the largest magazine publisher in Brazil and one of the largest media companies in Latin America. In addition, Abril owns the country’s leading educational book publisher and a pay-television network.
 
In August 2006, MIH Print Media Holdings Limited (“MIH Print Media”) acquired a 20.2% interest in Titan, a leading company in the field of Chinese sports publishing, for a cash consideration of approximately Rand 114.5 million. It is anticipated that through a further acquisition MIH Print Media’s shareholding will increase to 37%.
 
 
17

 

 
In September 2006, Naspers announced that, in furtherance of its empowerment objectives, the group intends to implement a Broad-Based Black Economic Empowerment ownership initiative in relation to Media24 Limited (“Media24”) and MultiChoice South Africa (“MCSA”).
 
The BEE transactions are expected to result in the acquisition by qualifying Black Persons and Black Groups of ordinary shares in the issued share capital of Welkom Yizani Investments Limited (“Welkom Yizani”), which will hold ordinary shares in the issued share capital of Media24 Holdings (Proprietary) Limited (“Media24 Holdings”), the holding company of Media24 as well as Phuthuma Nathi Investments Limited (“Phuthuma Nathi”), which will hold ordinary shares in the issued share capital of MultiChoice South Africa Holdings (Proprietary) Limited (“MCSA Holdings”), the holding company of MCSA.
 
Naspers will sell up to 14.6 million shares in Media24 Holdings to Welkom Yizani for a consideration of approximately Rand 730 million. Welkom Yizani will fund the acquisition through cash and the issuance of preference shares to Naspers. MIHH will sell up to 45 million shares in MCSA Holdings to Phuthuma Nathi, for a consideration of approximately Rand 2,250 million. Phuthuma Nathi will fund the acquisition through cash and the issuance of preference shares to MIHH.
 
The empowerment transactions are subject to Welkom Yizani and Phuthuma Nathi undertaking the public offers to the General Black Public to subscribe for ordinary shares in Welkom Yizani and Phuthuma Nathi. The number of Media24 Holdings and MCSA Holdings ordinary shares to be acquired by Welkom Yizani and Phuthuma Nathi will depend on the amount raised by Welkom Yizani and Phuthuma Nathi in terms of the public offers. The closing date for the public offers is expected to be at the end of October 2006. The public offers may not ultimately be undertaken and the final terms of the empowerment transactions are subject to change.
 
For information on Naspers’ principal investments and capital expenditures and divestitures, see the description of Naspers’ business in “Item 4.B. Business Overview” and “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects”.
 
4.B.                 Business Overview
 
Overview
 
Naspers is a multinational media company with principal operations in electronic media (including pay-television, internet and instant-messaging subscriber platforms and the provision of related technologies) and print media (including the publishing, distribution and printing of magazines, newspapers and books, and the provision of private education services). Naspers’ most significant operations are located in South Africa, where it generates approximately 76.4% of its revenues, with other operations located elsewhere in Sub-Saharan Africa, Greece, Cyprus, the Netherlands, the United States, Thailand and China. Naspers creates media content, builds brand names around it, and manages the platforms distributing the content. Naspers delivers its content in a variety of forms and through a variety of channels, including television platforms, internet services, newspapers, magazines and books. Many of Naspers’ businesses hold leading market positions, and Naspers capitalizes on these strong positions when expanding into new markets.
 
Naspers’ business comprises two core segments:
 
Electronic Media
 
The electronic media segment comprises pay-television, internet and related technology activities and is operated principally through MIH Holdings. MIH Holdings owns or operates pay-television and internet subscriber platforms in Africa, Greece, Cyprus, Thailand and China. This segment contributed approximately 65.1% (2005: 64.6%) to Naspers’ total revenue and 82.1% (2005: 77.6%) of operating profit in fiscal 2006 before the elimination of inter-company transactions.
 
Print Media
 
Media24 encompasses the newspaper and magazine publishing and printing interests of Naspers. It also includes the internet activities of Media24 Digital. Media24 is a large publisher of magazines and newspapers as well as one of the largest printers and distributors of magazines and related products in Africa.
 
Via Afrika is a leading African book publisher, seller and distributor of innovative and quality reading, learning, listening, and viewing products in various formats. Educor is a leading provider of private education in South Africa. It offers face-to-face full-time, part-time and block release programs, as well as distance learning education and training programs. The print
 
18



media segment contributed approximately 35.0% (2005: 35.4%) to Naspers’ total revenue and 19.8% (2005: 24.5%) to operating profit in fiscal 2006 before the elimination of inter-company transactions.
 
Strategy
 
Naspers focuses on media businesses in growing markets in which it has attained or hopes to attain sustainable market positions. Geographically the group is focused on the BRICSA countries (Brazil, Russia, India, China, South and sub-Saharan Africa), which we believe present above-average growth opportunities. During the current fiscal year, Naspers acquired a 30% equity stake in a leading Brazilian media company, Abril, and also established development offices in Russia and India. Naspers uses content, brands and distribution channels from existing businesses to grow in other markets and to develop new businesses. Naspers has integrated the internet into each of its businesses to better reach customers and increase the value of its content. Naspers’ key objectives are as follows:
 
·      
Focus on Investments and Technology. Naspers has made substantial investments in recent years to upgrade and enhance its subscriber platforms. Naspers intends to consolidate the leading positions it holds in many markets and to expand into new ones. Most of Naspers’ pay-television platforms offer digital subscriptions and feature interactive or enhanced services. Naspers is presently researching the opportunity of broadcasting television channels to mobile devices. Naspers has expanded its printing facilities by investing in advanced printing and related facilities. Additional newspaper and magazine titles have been launched when market opportunities present themselves. Naspers has further launched several internet related businesses.
 
·      
Build Digital Subscriber Base. Naspers seeks to continue to expand MIH Holdings’ digital pay-television subscriber base, both by converting its current analog customers to the digital service and by gaining new digital customers. MIH Holdings offers subscribers movie and sports programming, and is adding interactive services to its bouquets (the term used to describe the channels offered by a pay-television provider on a given platform).
 
·      
Grow Internet Businesses. Naspers intends, by offering content and superior service, to grow M-Web Holdings as an internet service provider and content portal in Africa. Naspers is also focused on e-commerce opportunities and on internet service provider (ISP) operations. Naspers has an interest in the operations of China’s leading instant messaging platform, Tencent. It will continue to develop such interests in China and elsewhere. Naspers’ print media and book publishing businesses are using their core competencies to create new business opportunities over the internet.
 
·      
Maintain Local Approach. Naspers has a track record of establishing or acquiring businesses in developing markets such as Africa, the Mediterranean, Asia and, more recently, Brazil. Naspers believes that a component of its success in these markets is its emphasis on taking a local approach. This may involve local partners and management teams and incorporating linguistically and culturally tailored local content in its service offerings. Naspers’ strategy is to continue to take a local approach to content as it expands its pay-television and internet businesses.
 
·      
Provide Quality Service. Naspers views its subscriber platform business primarily as a service business and, accordingly, places emphasis on providing customer service. Naspers believes that this helps build customer loyalty and reduce “churn” (a term used to describe subscriber loss). Naspers seeks to achieve quality customer service by operating service centers and utilizing advanced computer systems, which allow customer service representatives to address customer concerns more quickly.
 
 
19

 
Segments
 
Naspers’ business is comprised of two core segments - Electronic Media and Print Media. The following table shows revenues, revenues expressed as a percentage of total revenues and the percentage change in revenues from the prior period for Naspers’ core business segments for the last two fiscal years:
 
           
 Revenue (Rand millions except percentages)
 
   
R
Millions
 
2006
% of
revenues
 
% change
from 2005
 
2005
R
millions
 
% of revenues
 
                       
Electronic Media
                     
    — Pay-television
 
8,903
 
56.7
 
14.9
 
7,747
 
57.3
 
    — Internet
 
898
 
5.7
 
29.0
 
696
 
5.1
 
    — Conditional access
   
352
   
2.2
   
38.0
   
255
   
1.9
 
    — Entriq
   
66
   
0.4
   
94.1
   
34
   
0.3
 
Print Media
                               
    — Newspapers, magazines and printing
   
3,983
   
25.4
   
18.0
   
3,374
   
25.0
 
    — Books
   
981
   
6.2
   
13.9
   
861
   
6.4
 
    — Education 
   
536
   
3.4
   
(2.0
)
 
547
   
4.0
 
Corporate services
   
(13
)
 
   
   
4
   
 

The following table shows operating profit/(loss) and the percentage change in operating profit/(loss) from the prior period for Naspers’ business segments for the last two fiscal years:
 
   Operating profit/(loss) (Rand millions except percentages)
   
2006
R millions
 
% change from
2005
 
2005
R millions
 
Electronic Media
             
    —Pay-television 
 
2,785
 
31.4
 
2,120
 
    —Internet 
 
(153)
 
125.0
 
(68)
 
    —Conditional access 
 
 
 
(47)
 
    —Entriq 
 
(165)
 
85.4
 
(89)
 
Print Media
             
    —Newspapers, magazines and printing 
 
612
 
15.9
 
528
 
    —Books  
   
67
   
26.4
   
53
 
    —Education 
   
(84
)
 
   
23
 
Corporate services 
   
(58
)
 
13.7
   
(51
)


The following table shows revenues, revenues expressed as a percentage of total revenues and the percentage change in revenues from the prior period by geographic market for the last two fiscal years: 
 
           
     
Revenue (Rand millions except percentages)
 
   
2006
 
2005
 
   
R
Millions
 
% of revenues
 
% change
from 2005
 
R
millions
 
% of
revenues
 
                       
South Africa 
 
11,994
 
76.4
 
18.3
 
10,140
 
75.0
 
Rest of Sub-Saharan Africa
 
1,838
 
11.7
 
19.0
 
1,545
 
11.4
 
Greece and Cyprus 
   
1,469
   
9.4
   
2.5
   
1,433
   
10.6
 
Asia 
   
78
   
0.5
   
(66.1
)
 
230
   
1.7
 
United States 
   
49
   
0.3
   
4.3
   
47
   
0.3
 
Other
   
278
   
1.8
   
126.0
   
123
   
0.9
 
 
 
20

 
 
Electronic Media
 
Overview
 
The electronic media segment comprises pay-television platforms, internet operations and instant messaging services and related technologies, and is principally operated through MIH Holdings. These businesses do not all develop at the same rate and are at varying stages of growth. The internet is already providing much of the content and services that are available through interactive enabled television sets and mobile devices and will effectively become a backbone to the delivery of these services. The electronic media activities are conducted through various subsidiaries, joint ventures and associated companies primarily in Africa, Greece, Cyprus, the United States and China.
 
Pay-television
 
The following table sets out the services offered and subscriber numbers for the group’s pay-television subsidiaries and joint ventures by region and service as at the end of fiscal 2006:
 
 
LAUNCH
DATE
SERVICE
SUBSCRIBERS AS   
AT MARCH 31, 2006
AFRICA
       
South Africa 
1986
M-Net (analog)
217,440
 
 
1995
DStv (digital)
1,033,093
 
Rest of Sub-Saharan Africa
1991
M-Net (analog)
819
 
 
1996
DStv (digital)
384,216
 
MEDITERRANEAN
       
Greece
1994
FilmNet/SuperSport (analog)
71,994
 
 
1999
NOVA (digital)
239,536
 
Cyprus
1993
Ltv & Alpha (analog)
42,552
 
 
2004
NOVA Cyprus (digital)
20,369
 

 
From fiscal 2002 to fiscal 2006, on a comparable basis, the group increased the total number of subscribers under management from 1,598,563 to 2,010,019, or 25.7%. Over the same period, the group’s digital subscribers as a percentage of its total subscribers increased from 56% to 83%. During fiscal 2006, the digital subscriber base increased by 229,956 to 1,677,214 subscribers, representing 16% growth. The group continues to migrate subscribers from the analog service to the higher revenue and higher margin digital service. The South African pay-television market is relatively mature, and the group does not expect the total number of subscribers in that market to increase substantially.
 
The following table shows the growth of subscribers in each of the group’s markets:
 
   
March 31,
 
   
2006
 
2005
 
2004
 
2003
 
2002
 
CAGR(1)
SUBSCRIBERS (THOUSANDS)
                         
AFRICA
                         
South Africa 
 
1,251
 
1,148
 
1,076
 
1,045
 
1,057
 
4.30
%
Rest of Sub-Saharan Africa 
 
385
 
336
 
292
 
260
 
224
 
14.50
%
Total Africa 
   
1,636
   
1,484
   
1,368
   
1,305
   
1,281
   
6.31
%
MEDITERRANEAN
                                     
Greece 
   
311
   
304
   
291
   
256
   
265
   
4.08
%
Cyprus 
   
63
   
60
   
60
   
54
   
53
   
4.42
%
Total Mediterranean 
   
374
   
364
   
351
   
310
   
318
   
4.14
%
Total Subscribers 
   
2,010
   
1,848
   
1,719
   
1,615
   
1,599
   
5.89
%
___________
 
(1)
Compounded annual growth rate calculated from March 31, 2002 until March 31, 2006.
 

21


Africa
 
The African business is operated through MultiChoice and MultiChoice Subscriber Management Service (Proprietary) Limited (“MSMS”) (collectively “MultiChoice South Africa”), and MultiChoice Africa Limited (“MultiChoice Africa”), each an indirect wholly owned subsidiary of Naspers Limited. The African business provides pay-television and subscriber management services in 48 countries throughout Africa and the adjacent Indian Ocean islands. The group has ownership interests through MultiChoice South Africa and MultiChoice Africa in subsidiaries and joint ventures operating in Kenya, Ghana, Uganda, Nigeria, Tanzania, Zambia, Namibia and Botswana. In many other Sub-Saharan African nations, MultiChoice Africa operates through agents or franchisees. The agents and franchisees conduct marketing and advertising activities to build MultiChoice Africa’s subscriber base and collect subscription revenues on behalf of MultiChoice Africa. They retain a portion of the subscription revenues they collect as compensation for their services and remit the balance to MultiChoice Africa.
 
The pay-television service consists of terrestrial analog networks as well as direct-to-home digital satellite television (DStv) bouquets on four separate satellites: Eutelsat W4 KU-band, Eutelsat SESAT Ku-Band, PAS 10 C-band and PAS 7 KU-band. In Namibia, the terrestrial analog network was replaced with a Digital Terrestrial Transmission (“DTT”) network.
 
South Africa 
 
MultiChoice South Africa offers customized M-Net premium analog terrestrial services consisting of sport and movies, as well as the premium DStv digital bouquet consisting of 74 video channels (including 6 Indian and 3 Portuguese), 8 data channels, 40 audio music channels and 25 radio channels. Viewer favorites are M-Net (Africa’s premier pay-television channel), the SuperSport channels, M-Net Movies 1  & 2, M-Net Series, Discovery Channel, National Geographic Channel and Animal Planet. During fiscal 2006, enhancements to the DStv bouquet in South Africa included the addition of 5 video channels to the DStv digital bouquet - MK 89 (Afrikaans Youth Music Channel), Boomerang (Kids animation channel), The Home Channel (Lifestyle Channel broadcasting on weekends only), CCTV 9 (English-language 24-hour news channel with a Chinese perspective) and SuperSport 8 (Portuguese Soccer Channel). In addition to 5 permanent video channels, DStv also broadcasted Events Channels (M-Net Holiday Channel, CNN/ MultiChoice Africa Journalist of the Year and Idols) and made enhancements to the Travel Channel, M-Net’s Academy Awards Broadcasts, Temptation and Carte Blanche as well as M-Net Series, BBC Food and Mindset Learn.
 
MultiChoice South Africa’s aggregate subscriber base in South Africa as of March 31, 2006 was 1,250,533 subscribers, an increase of 102,662 or 8.9% from 1,147,871 subscribers at March 31, 2005. The digital subscriber base in South Africa grew by 137,747 subscribers during fiscal 2006 (from 895,346 to 1,033,093 subscribers) and as of March 31, 2006 accounted for 83% of the total number of pay-television subscribers in South Africa. The lower priced bouquet aimed at the emerging market (“DStv Compact”) grew to 42,000 subscribers. MultiChoice launched a personal video recorder (“PVR”) in October 2005 and sold 27,500 units during fiscal 2006 which contributed to the growth in the digital subscriber base. The analog subscriber base declined to 217,440 subscribers during the same period, primarily due to subscribers upgrading from the analog to the digital platform. As of March 31, 2006, MultiChoice South Africa’s subscriber base represented approximately 17% of South Africa’s television households.
 
South Africa is Africa’s largest economy, with a population of approximately 44 million people, and is Africa’s third largest television market, with approximately 7.5 million television households. The South African market is relatively mature. The joint venture companies M-Net and SuperSport continue to play a role in growing the subscriber base through the delivery of premium thematic channels and exclusive content. M-Net provides premium entertainment channels and SuperSport provides sports channels carried by MultiChoice South Africa and MultiChoice Africa on their pay-television platforms in Africa. Naspers owns directly or indirectly 60.1% of each of M-Net and SuperSport.
 
M-Net has output deals with all the major film and television studios, enabling it to screen quality movies, series and miniseries. M-Net compiles 15 entertainment channels for broadcast across the African continent. These channels are carried on various satellite platforms all of which are operated by MultiChoice Africa under the DStv brand.
 
SuperSport produces nine sports channels for distribution across Sub-Saharan Africa. These comprise three primarily live 24-hour channels, including a dedicated pan-African football channel (football is also known as soccer), a sports update channel, a 24-hour highlights channel, a dedicated interactive sports channel and three ad hoc sports channels, covering more than 100 different genres of sport. The football channel screens South African Premier Football League and various Confederation of African Football games, extensive live English Premier League games, Italian Serie A and Bundesliga football. Extensive coverage of South African and international cricket, rugby, golf and tennis are also offered on other SuperSport
 
22

 

 
channels. The SuperSport Zone channel provides information, live scores and statistics on specific sporting events. SuperSport has recently launched a 3G mobile service to South African mobile service providers.
 
MultiChoice South Africa services its South African subscriber base through its customer care and billing center in Johannesburg and branches in Durban and Cape Town. The center in Johannesburg provides customers with walk-in and phone-in service, while the branches provide customers with a walk-in service.
 
The analog service is sent to transmission towers either terrestrially over fiber optic cables or microwave links, or via satellite. The towers transmit the signal to MultiChoice South Africa’s customers’ homes, where it is received by an antenna and decrypted by a set-top box. A satellite transmits the digital satellite signal. MultiChoice South Africa leases 9 KU-band (KU-band refers to a frequency range used for satellite downlink transmissions that falls within the 12 to 14 GHz range of the electromagnetic spectrum) transponders on this satellite, and its uplink facilities are provided by Orbicom (Proprietary) Limited and British Telecom. Digital customers receive the signal from this satellite using a 90 cm satellite dish located on or near their homes. The signal is then descrambled and decompressed for viewing using a conditional access system, set-top box and smart card. MultiChoice Africa and MultiChoice South Africa utilize the Irdeto conditional access system and third party set-top box technology that incorporates Irdeto’s software for their analog and digital platforms. Smart cards are credit card-sized devices that have embedded processors that provide entitlement functions and store decryption keys and digital signatures. MultiChoice Africa and MultiChoice South Africa utilize the Irdeto encryption and set-top box technology for their analog and digital platforms.
 
During the year ended March 31, 2006, MultiChoice South Africa experienced an average monthly net churn (net churn is the percentage of customers who terminate their subscription in a given period minus the number of former customers who reconnect in that period) of approximately 1.92% on its analog subscriber base and 1.2% on its digital subscriber base. This compares to an average monthly net churn of approximately 2.02% on its analog subscriber base and 0.96% on its digital subscriber base during fiscal 2005. The net churn for the analog subscriber base excludes customers who upgraded to the digital service.
 
MultiChoice South Africa bills its subscribers monthly, in advance, in Rand. The following table sets forth certain pricing information for the South African businesses:
 
 
Subscribers
Monthly
Subscription Price
Equipment Price(1) (4)
Purchase
 
March 31,
 
2006
2005
2004
Rand
U.S. $(3)
Rand
U.S. $(3)
 
(thousands)
       
               
Analog 
217
253
301
229.00(2)
31.03
550
74.53
Digital 
1,033
895
775
419.00(2)
56.78
650
88.08
___________
 
(1)
Excludes price of satellite receiver in the case of digital service.
 
(2)
Includes price increase that occurred in April 2006.
 
(3)
Converted at the noon buying rate at September 15, 2006. (U.S. $1 = Rand 7.38)
 
(4)
In October 2005, MultiChoice launched a dual-view personal video recorder which retails at Rand 2,999.00. (U.S. Dollar 406.37)
 
 
 
Rest of Sub-Saharan Africa
 
The group offers terrestrial analog, digital terrestrial and digital satellite pay-television services to Sub-Saharan Africa through MultiChoice Africa and various subsidiaries, joint ventures, agents and franchises. MultiChoice Africa offers many of the same premium channels in Sub-Saharan Africa as MultiChoice South Africa offers in South Africa, including those broadcasting exclusive premium films and popular sports. MultiChoice Africa’s digital service features various bouquets with some 75 video channels (including the customized M-Net channel and many major international network channels), 8 data channels and up to 65 audio channels, which are transmitted to 48 countries in Sub-Saharan Africa, and adjacent islands. As of March 31, 2006, MultiChoice Africa and its subsidiaries and joint ventures had 384,216 Sub-Saharan African subscribers to its DStv digital satellite and terrestrial services and 819 Sub-Saharan African subscribers to its terrestrial analog service, compared to 333,781 digital and 2,373 analog subscribers as of March 31, 2005. This represents an increase of 14.5% from fiscal March 2005 to March 2006.
 
 
23

 
 
The marketing efforts of MultiChoice Africa’s Sub-Saharan pay-television business are focused on the major cities in each of the countries served on the basis that households in these major metropolitan areas are more likely to be able to afford its services than rural households. In line with the focus on serving niche markets, a new satellite, SESAT, was introduced during fiscal 2005 to accommodate the expansion of the digital subscriber base for the French and Portuguese bouquets. A dedicated sports channel for the Portuguese bouquet was introduced during the year to further cater for the Portuguese market. The addition of a number of new English language channels has allowed the premium DStv bouquet to maintain its position as the leading offering in the market. The company has intensified its focus on providing localized programming to subscribers especially in Africa - this includes the enhancement of the Africa Magic channel and the addition of free-to-air channels in Zambia, Zimbabwe, Mozambique, Uganda and Botswana.
 
During fiscal 2006, its Sub-Saharan African operations experienced an average monthly net churn of approximately 1.46% on the digital subscriber base, as compared to average monthly net churn of approximately 1.65% on the digital subscriber base for fiscal 2005.
 
The following table sets out certain pricing information for MultiChoice Africa’s Sub-Saharan African businesses: 
 
 
Subscribers
Monthly    
Subscription Price(1)    
Equipment Price(2)  
 
March 31,
 
2006
2005
2004
 
(thousands)
   
           
Analog 
1
2
9
U.S.$ 35.00
N/A
Digital 
384
334
283
U.S.$ 58.00
U.S. $ 200
___________
 
(1)
Represents the average price across all of MultiChoice Africa’s Sub-Saharan African businesses.
 
(2)
Includes the price of the satellite receiver.
 
MultiChoice Africa’s digital service is transmitted direct-to-home, on PAS10 C-band satellite transponders (C-band refers to the frequency range of the electromagnetic spectrum used for satellite transmission, having an uplink frequency at 6 GHz and a downlink frequency at 4 GHz), the Eutelsat W4 KU-band, Eutelsat SESAT KU-band and PAS7 KU-band transponders. Customers receive these signals on a satellite dish mounted on or near their homes. The signal is then descrambled and decompressed for viewing using a conditional access system, set-top box and smart card. MultiChoice Africa utilizes the Irdeto conditional access system and third party set-top box technology that incorporates Irdeto’ software for both its analog and digital platforms. Smart cards are credit card-sized devices that have embedded processors that provide entitlement functions and store decryption keys and digital signatures. The smart cards are inserted in a set-top box to gain access to encrypted digital programming.
 
MultiChoice Africa delivers analog services terrestrially to Sub-Saharan Africa by transmitting its programming signal by satellite to local receiving stations in two countries. These stations relay the signal to a broadcast tower that transmits it as a standard encrypted scrambled television signal. When received by a customer, a decoder in a set-top box descrambles the signal and provides it to the customer’s television receiver. MultiChoice Africa is systematically shutting down its analog terrestrial networks on a country by country basis as more and more analog subscribers migrate to digital, making the terrestrial analog networks uneconomical on a selective basis. The analog transmission network will be closed down completely during the 2006 calendar year. In Namibia, the analog service was replaced with an innovative new Digital Terrestrial Transmission (“DTT”) service. Subscribers are now able to receive multiple channels in digital quality.
 
Mediterranean 
 
Naspers offers terrestrial analog and digital pay-television services in Greece and digital satellite pay-television in Cyprus through its subsidiary NetMed NV (“NetMed”). At March 31, 2006 Naspers owned 74.9% of NetMed. Global Capital Investors II LP (“Global”), an investment fund managed by Global Finance SA, owned 8.5% of NetMed, Antenna Pay-TV Limited (“Antenna”), a subsidiary of Antenna SA, owned 4.1% of NetMed, and Teletypos owned 12.5% of NetMed. In terms of Agreements with Global and Antenna, Global and Antenna exercised their right to put their shares to MIH BV. After an extended valuation and negotiation process, MIH acquired from Global and Antenna their shares in NetMed for the sum of Euro 67.3 million on July 19, 2006. Naspers now owns 87.5% of NetMed with the remaining 12.5% owned by Teletypos.
 
 
24

 

 
NetMed manages its Mediterranean pay-television business through the following operating subsidiaries:
 
·      
MultiChoice Hellas and MultiChoice Cyprus Limited manage the subscriber base and market and sell pay-television services in Greece and Cyprus, respectively. NetMed, through Myriad Development B.V., controls 96.4% of MultiChoice Hellas. The remaining shares of MultiChoice Hellas are held by Lumiere Television Limited (“LTV”).
 
·      
NetMed owns 69.04% of MultiChoice Cyprus Holdings Limited and the remaining 30.96% is held by LTV. MultiChoice Cyprus Holdings owns 50.9% of MultiChoice (Cyprus) Public Company Limited (“MCC”), a company listed on the Cypriot Stock Exchange. Following a public offer in February 2006, LTV holds a further 32% direct stake in MCC. The remaining shares are publicly held.
 
·      
NetMed, directly and indirectly through its subsidiary, Myriad Development BV, owns 100% of NetMed Hellas SA (NetMed Hellas). NetMed Hellas operates the FilmNet and SuperSport premium pay-television channels in Greece.
 
·      
Synergistic Network Development S.A. is 100% owned by NetMed and is responsible for signal transmission and distribution.
 
NetMed’s Nova bouquet includes 50 channels, of which 44 are Greek channels or foreign channels dubbed or sub-titled in Greek. Subscribers also get access to more than 250 other European channels which are available on the same satellite as the Nova bouquet. The Greek language channels that are included in the Nova service (such as FilmNet, SuperSport and those of the Greek commercial and state broadcasters) are either produced in Greece or are foreign thematic channels customized for this market. These include Discovery, MGM, TCM, National Geographic, Animal Planet, Jetix Kids and E! entertainment. SuperSport features exclusive sporting events for the Greek and Cypriot markets.
 
FilmNet provides a combination of exclusive, first run movies, along with some original and imported series. NetMed’s analog service consists of three channels; FilmNet, SuperSport and Jetix Kids transmitted on two analog frequencies.
 
Greece has a population of approximately 10.9 million people and approximately 3.5 million television households, giving NetMed’s pay-television services a market penetration of approximately 9% of television households.
 
The total number of the group’s pay-television subscribers for the Mediterranean region was 374,451 households at the end of fiscal 2006, up from 363,739 at the end of fiscal 2005, an increase of 2.9%. During fiscal 2006, the analog subscriber base in Greece declined by 22,732 to 71,994 households, while Nova (the digital satellite television service) maintained its leading position in the region by adding 30,224 digital subscribers to end the fiscal year with 239,536 subscribers. As of March 31, 2006, NetMed had 62,921 subscribers in Cyprus. During fiscal 2006, NetMed experienced an average monthly net churn of approximately 1.4% (2005: 1.1%) on its total subscriber base in Greece.
 
NetMed experienced a decline in subscribers from 2001 to 2003 due to market confusion as a result of the launch and subsequent liquidation of a competing pay-television service in Greece, Alpha Digital Synthesis S.A. (“Alpha Digital”). In September 2002, Alpha Digital entered into liquidation. Recent events have also seen the emergence of a new administration for the A Division of Greek football league, which has been renamed the SuperLeague. Despite the new administration, further turmoil is expected in future seasons.
 
NetMed has secured the rights to a significant volume of games (112 of a total of 125 games per season) of Europe’s premier football club competition, The Champions League, for the next three seasons commencing, 2006/07. The remaining thirteen games (per season) will be broadcast by the Greek state broadcaster. The acquisition of The Champions League programming rights should help reduce NetMed’s dependence on Greek football although complete success will be dependent on the participation of Greek teams, whose performance tends to be erratic. NetMed secured the television rights to 13 of the 16 Greek football teams for the 2006/07 season. The Greek state broadcaster has entered the market and secured the rights to 3 teams, including the rights to the top team in Greece, for the next three seasons. The status of football in Greece, however, remains uncertain, with several clubs, including one of the four most popular, facing financial difficulties. Despite these difficulties, clubs have received no tax relief from the Greek government and are unlikely to do so in the near future. NetMed has withdrawn from all court cases pertaining to the broadcasting rights of football teams, but continues to pursue teams for damages where they have breached their broadcasting agreements, although there is no certainty as to the outcome and the legal process is proving to be extremely lengthy.
 
25


NetMed markets its Nova digital service as an upscale alternative to the premium analog package. It expects the majority of the growth in its digital platform to come from new subscribers supported by the acquisition of the critical mass of the SuperLeague and Champions League. Previously digital growth has come largely from subscribers that upgrade from the analog service. Through March 31, 2006, approximately 20% of the growth in NetMed’s Greek digital subscriber base comprised analog subscribers who converted to the digital service. Overall, 32% of the total current Greek digital subscriber base was analog subscribers in the past.
 
In February 2006, the attention of NetMed was drawn to press reports in Cyprus of negotiations between LTV and the large Cyprus telecommunications provider (“CYTA”) for the supply of channels by LTV to CYTA for distribution on its broadband network. At the time, LTV was a 30.96% shareholder in MultiChoice Cyprus Holdings and 10.98% shareholder in MCC. NetMed was of the view that the proposed arrangements with CYTA would be in breach of a number of agreements between LTV and NetMed and/or its affiliates, including MCC. Various legal proceedings, including arbitration proceedings under the London Court of International Arbitration (“LCIA”), injunction proceedings in the Cyprus courts and complaints to the Cyprus Commission for the Protection of Competition (“CPC”), have been initiated in order to protect the interests of MCC and its affiliates, and some of these proceedings are continuing. On February 28, 2006, LTV made a public offer for the shares in MCC which it did not already own.
 
On June 1, 2006, LTV announced that this Offer had been accepted by 27% of the shareholders of MCC, resulting in LTV becoming the direct owner of 32% of the shares of MCC.
 
On July 7, 2006, LTV withdrew the carriage of its channel on the Nova Cyprus platform thus depriving Nova Cyprus of one of its premium channels. Nova Cyprus in turn has added elements of the premium Nova Greece channels (FilmNet and SuperSport) to its platform. However without the main driver of Cyprus football and other European football championships on the platform, churn is expected on the Nova Cyprus platform at the commencement of the various football championships during August 2006. As at August 31, 2006 Nova Cyprus had 20,947 subscribers.
 
On July 19, 2006, MCC began to experience difficulty in administering its analog subscriber base. MCC subsequently discovered that communications links between MCC and its subscribers had been severed by LTV. Attempts by MCC to gain access to its equipment located on LTV’s premises were refused and MCC was notified by LTV that it had terminated its analog channel carriage arrangement with MCC. MCC does, therefore, not provide analog service anymore.
 
MultiChoice Hellas has entered into a three year Agreement with Sigma in Cyprus for the carriage of Sigma Sports 1 & 2 channels, specializing in the broadcast of The Champions League.
 
Thailand
 
MIH disposed of its shares in UBC and MKSC for a total cash consideration of Rand 999.3 million, effective January 6, 2006. MIH’s sale of its shareholding in UBC to True Corp., which was already UBC’s largest shareholder, is in line with Naspers’ strategy to focus on its core competencies and allowed True Corp. to fully integrate UBC into its existing business.
 
Competitors and Competitive Position
 
MultiChoice South Africa’s digital and analog platforms in South Africa compete directly with the four free-to-air television channels in South Africa (which are also carried on MultiChoice South Africa’s digital bouquet) and indirectly with the internet, all live sporting events, motion picture theatres, video rental stores, mobile telephones, lotteries, gaming and other forms of entertainment.
 
MultiChoice Africa is the leading provider of pay-television services in Sub-Saharan Africa. In the countries in which MultiChoice Africa broadcasts, however, there are numerous public and private free-to-air television stations, as well as, localized pay-television operations (both licensed and unlicensed). Digital direct-to-home (“DTH”), Cable, Digital Terrestrial (“DTT”) and Internet Protocol Television (“IPTV”) competitors have launched or are expected to launch pay-television operations across Sub-Saharan Africa. During the course of fiscal 2005, three DTH competitors launched their services in Nigeria. A new continental operator, MyTV, has launched a DTH service in Sub-Sahara Africa. We also saw the launch of some country specific cable and DTT pay-television operations. MultiChoice Africa believes that its wide selection of programming, distributed both terrestrially and on DStv, appeals to the broader African market.
 
 
26

 
 
MultiChoice South Africa recently lodged its application for a broadcasting license. The regulations applicable to this license have been finalized and the due date for all license applicants was August 31, 2006. The process of evaluating and granting of the license may take some time to conclude. At the conclusion of this process additional conditions may be imposed. The impact of these conditions will only be known at the time of granting of the license. Several other organizations will also be applying for a license. The number of broadcasting competitors will only be known at the conclusion of the licensing process. 
 
In Greece and Cyprus, NetMed competes directly with free-to-air broadcast channels, including national Greek networks (such as ERT, Mega, Antenna, Alpha and Star) and four national Cypriot networks (Cyprus Broadcasting Corp., Sigma, Mega and Antenna).
 
Greek media law allows multiple licenses to be granted for satellite pay-television platforms, and two other entities, Intersat SA and Alpha Digital, had been granted licenses. Both had their licenses revoked, as Intersat failed to launch a digital television platform and Alpha Digital entered into liquidation. The Greek Post, Telecommunication & Telegraph (PTT) company, OTE launched a national satellite called HellasSat, serving Greece, the Balkans and greater Europe. The Greek regulatory process for issuing terrestrial licenses has been frozen for more than five years, a fact that may continue to retard the development of commercial opportunities for NetMed. ERT has launched DTT including a free-to-air movie channel and sports channel. This could dampen demand for pay-television movie and sports channels offered by NetMed if ERT deploys its channels commercially and further create pressure on rights acquisitions as ERT seeks content for these channels. Delays in acquiring DTT frequencies for pay television could also prevent NetMed from developing other TV distribution platforms which would form a natural extension.
 
New technologies have been adopted in Cyprus where a broadband network has been laid down by CYTA. A further independent broadband platform, Primetel, has also launched a package consisting of basic and premium pay-television channels as well as high speed internet and bundled telephony services. A rival digital satellite pay-television operation on HellasSat, named AthinaSat, launched in May 2005, with a basic and premium package of 12 channels. In addition, over the last few months LTV has begun offering its premium channel (including exclusive Cypriot football) to CYTA and PrimeTel, a DSL operator, and deals with other satellite and cable operators are pending. Since the carriage of LTV’s premium channel on MCC’s bouquets was terminated in June 2006 (digital) and July 2006 (analog), discussions have taken place about the renewed carriage of such channel by MCC, but no agreement has been reached.
 
Seasonality
 
The group’s pay-television business experiences an increase in the level of subscriber churn during the respective summer holiday seasons, particularly in Greece and Cyprus where the conclusion of the football and basketball seasons coincide with summer, when many subscribers travel away from their primary residence and engage in other forms of leisure. In Africa, the start of the European Football season is normally characterized by subscriber growth.
 
Technology
 
Irdeto

The group’s subsidiary, Irdeto, provides content protection solutions to subscriber platform operators and other providers of valuable digital content. Irdeto products enable pay-media operators and corporate users to encrypt and decrypt their broadcast or multicast signals. The products control subscriber access to content, services and events across all media platforms, including digital television, internet protocol (IP) streaming media and delivery of video services on mobile platforms. Irdeto offers customers over 40 years of experience in the pay-media industry and a range of skilled resources and properties.
 
As at March 31, 2006, Irdeto had 194 customers (including the affiliated companies MultiChoice South Africa, MultiChoice Africa and NetMed) in more than 40 countries. During the year ended March 31, 2006, Irdeto sold approximately 5.8 million personalized digital smart cards and other devices with a total of approximately 21 million shipped to date since 1995 when digital smart cards were first launched. Smart cards are credit card-size devices with embedded processors that provide entitlement functions and store decryption keys and digital signatures that are inserted in set-top boxes for access to subscription television services. During the year, Irdeto acquired 50 new customers in all regions of the world.
 
Irdeto continues to innovate and improve the security-related aspects of its products. On-going action against pirate networks continued to deter pirates from attempting to compromise Irdeto technology.
 
 
27

 
 
In April 2006, Irdeto acquired a competitor, Philips CryptoTec, which was the conditional access business of Philips, based in Eindhoven, The Netherlands. The acquisition brought expert staff and market share, increasing Irdeto’s customers to 300 in 60 countries.

Entriq
 
Entriq is investing in content protection and subscriber management services for new broadband markets. Consumption of broadband media on the internet continues to grow and in some markets like Korea and China, is now the dominant form of internet usage. During the last year, Entriq continued to invest in content protection, subscriber management technologies and ASP services for broadband markets including a turnkey digital store solution.

Entriq made further progress on the development of its global network for media authorization. This is a secure, reliable service for distribution and selling media online and across platforms including PC, mobile telephones and extending into IPTV.

Entriq’s clients are in three major market sectors: sports, music and entertainment. Some of Entriq’s clients include: The Winter Olympics by nbcolympics.com and Intel ViiV platform, Viacom for Comedy Central, Channel 4 for Big Brother in the UK, Pro Sieben for distribution of content in Germany, UEFA for European Champions League, MTV US (radio channels on Sprint) and MTV UK integrating with major UK carriers.

MediaZone

Broadband presents an opportunity to reach small audiences not otherwise serviced through traditional distribution channels. Mediazone has invested in building web portals where niche content is aggregated and offered via subscription packages. These channel categories include sports (e.g. rugby), international (e.g. ChinaPortal and KuduClub) and lifestyle. Current events covered include Wimbledon, Fiba Basketball Championship and Super 14 Rugby.

Competitors and Competitive Position
 
The extent and nature of competition among smart card manufacturers is in large part determined by the ability to provide secure products that effectively combat piracy at competitive prices, the ability to offer superior customer service and the ability to acquire new clients, as the cost of switching for existing customers can be high. Irdeto’s main competitors are NDS Group plc and Nagravision S.A., which provide conditional access systems to operators utilizing a range of platforms.
 
Competition for Entriq’s products and services are determined by the ability to provide content protection and subscriber management services to enable customers to sell pay media online and to mobile devices. Entriq faces competition in all the individual elements of its overall service offering such as DRM, billing and subscriber management, mobile content management and rendering. Entriq’s competitors include companies like The Platform, Extend Media and Brightcove. It is expected that new competition could enter the market as forecasts continue to grow, especially for delivery of pay media over broadband and media rich content to mobile devices. Entriq’s license billing and subscriber software competes with products from companies such as CSG Systems.
 
MediaZone competitors for consumer-facing aggregated paid video service include JumpTV, Setanta, RooTV, TotalVid, PlanetVu.  On a more generalized “video content aggregation & delivery to consumers” level, competition would include traditional cable and satellite providers such as Comcast and Dish, especially those offering a Video on Demand model.
 
Internet
 
Naspers’ approach to the internet is to draw on its existing strengths and areas of expertise. Naspers continues to regard internet technology as important. It has impacted traditional ways of doing business, including the relationship between clients and suppliers, and has transformed the competitive landscape in many industries. Naspers believes in an “anytime, anywhere” philosophy, which enables its subscribers to access its content platforms via television, internet and wireless technologies. In the future, the group expects to deploy its expertise in order to manage interactive services.
 
 
28

 
South Africa
 
Naspers conducts most of its internet business in South Africa through its indirect wholly owned subsidiary, M-Web Holdings. M-Web Holdings provides the infrastructure for MultiChoice South Africa’s interactive platform.

The South African internet market currently has approximately 3.6 million internet users and between 800,000 and 1 million dial-up subscriber homes. Growth in the dial-up internet market has slowed dramatically. Broadband access has shown some growth in recent years and there are currently about 175,000 broadband users in South Africa but the number of users lags comparable economies.
 
M-Web Holdings had approximately 300,000 dial-up subscribers and 44,000 broadband ADSL subscribers at March 31, 2006, which translates to an approximate 37% market share of the internet subscription market in South Africa.
 
The following table summarizes subscriber numbers and subscription fees for M-Web Holdings’ dial-up, ADSL broadband and web hosting services.
 
   
Subscribers
 
Monthly
Subscription Price
 
   
March 31,
 
     
2006
 
 
2005
 
 
2004
   
Rand
   
U.S. $(1)
 
 
 
(thousands)
           
                                 
Dial-up 
   
299.6
   
324.0
   
242.0
   
145
   
20
 
ADSL Broadband
   
44.4
   
19.4
   
4.6
   
258
   
35
 
Web and server hosting 
   
7.5
   
7.5
   
2.1
   
316
   
43
 
___________
 
(1)
Converted at the noon buying rate at September 15, 2006. (U.S. $1=Rand 7.38)
 
M-Web Holdings is also active in the business-to-business (B2B) and business-to-consumer (B2C) e-commerce markets. The business division of M-Web Holdings offers integrated commerce solutions to retailers and is a leader in the B2C e-commerce market. It offers various on-line services to large corporations and to the small and medium enterprise (SME) and small-office-home-office (Soho) markets. These services include web and server hosting, business mail solutions, domain name registrations, leased line access, application service provision, web development and e-commerce solution development.
 
Commercezone, a division of M-Web Holdings, is active in the B2B e-commerce market with products ranging from strategic sourcing to e-procurement platforms for the group and external customers. The on-line advertising and e-commerce markets are at an early stage of development in South Africa. M-Web Holdings estimates that neither is likely to start emerging as a significant generator of revenue in the near future. On-line consumer retail and true retail e-commerce will only develop once the necessary financial infrastructure and consumer markets mature. The business division of M-Web Holdings offers support to the increasing number of e-commerce web sites by making its portal and its dial-up subscriber base available to corporate customers.
 
Thailand
 
During the year ending March 31, 2006, the group disposed of its ISP assets, comprising 62.5% interest in Internet Knowledge Service Center Company, an entity that holds a majority stake in KSC Commercial Internet Company. The group’s internet investments in Thailand now comprise M-Web (Thailand) Limited (“M-Web (Thailand)”). As of March 31, 2006, the group held an effective economic interest of 100% in M-Web (Thailand).
 
The group believes that there are approximately seven million consumer internet users in Thailand and that advertising and on-line consumer retail e-commerce will only develop once the necessary financial infrastructure and consumer markets mature. Revenue from these sources in Thailand will not be significant for some years.
 
M-Web (Thailand) provides a comprehensive internet experience in the Thai language, which is tailored to the Thai culture via the portal Sanook! (www.sanook.com). M-Web (Thailand) extended its operations during the year ended March 31, 2006 through the introduction of broadband streaming services offering both audio and video content. The business also
 
 
29

 
extended its search capabilities via a commercial arrangement with Google. Significant revenues from these sources are not expected in the medium term.
 
China
 
Tencent


As at March 31, 2006, Naspers had a 36.1% interest in Tencent. Tencent is a provider of services based on the “QQ” instant messaging platform to Tencent Computer and Shiji Kaixuan, the licensed instant messaging operator in China. Tencent’s core market is mainland China, with QQ services also deployed in Taiwan, Japan, Thailand and South Africa.

Tencent is a leading provider of internet services and mobile value-added services in China, with the largest instant messaging (“IM”) community in China, according to iResearch. Tencent’s IM platform, branded QQ, allows users to communicate in real-time across the internet as well as mobile and fixed line telecommunications networks using various terminal devices. Tencent has attracted internet and mobile users to pay for its consumer-oriented internet and mobile value-added services and products, including the download of avatars (images representing a user’s virtual identity) and the participation in online casual games. As of March 31, 2006, Tencent had 220.5 million active user accounts. In addition, Tencent has been able to leverage the traffic in its online community to market online advertising services to its corporate clients.
 
Tencent provides services and products which have evolved into a variety of value-added services for IM users, including various fee-based IM service packages, entertainment and information content services, e-mail, chat rooms, dating services, casual games, massive multiple-player online games and user home pages. Tencent’s QQ Game Portal has become the leading casual game portal in China. Tencent’s mobile and telecommunications value-added services include mobile chat, Interactive Voice Response services, ringback tones, mobile music and pictures, mobile news and information content services, mobile games and other telecommunications value-added services.
 
In early 2005, revenues from Tencent’s IM services were negatively affected by the deactivation and related fee reversal of inactive customer accounts undertaken by Chinese mobile operators. In addition, revenues from mobile chat services declined as a result of the termination of the fee sharing arrangement with China Mobile for Tencent’s 161 Mobile Chat service, which was finalized in the quarter ended June 30, 2005.
 
The operation of telecommunications businesses in China, including Tencent’s internet related IM, internet content provision, online entertainment, online advertising businesses and other telecommunications value-added services, is subject to extensive regulation by the Chinese government. Due to such regulation, the internet services and mobile and telecommunications value-added services are provided by Tencent’s wholly-owned subsidiaries in China, pursuant to contractual arrangements with Tencent and two domestic Chinese companies wholly-owned by Tencent’s founding shareholders. In compliance with both IFRS and U.S. GAAP, Tencent consolidates the financial statements of these two domestic companies because, in substance, the contractual arrangements give Tencent control over the voting rights of these domestic companies.
 
Tencent currently has three principal lines of business: Internet value-added services, mobile and telecommunications value-added services and online advertising.
 
Internet value-added services provide the main platform on which Tencent’s user community is built. IM is at the core of Tencent’s internet value-added service platform. QQ is a comprehensive service platform that utilizes IM and other value-added services to create an online community. Internet value-added services also include community services such as the QQ.com portal and entertainment services such as casual games, avatars, massive multiple-player online games, electronic pets and user home pages that include blogs and photo albums. For the quarter ended March 31, 2006, the peak number of simultaneous online user accounts was 19.6 million, and during the 16-day period ended March 31, 2006, the average number of daily user hours was 272.2 million and the average number of messages sent daily was 2,883.8 million.
 
Mobile and telecommunications value-added services are also an important segment of Tencent’s business. Mobile QQ is a mobile based extension of Tencent’s QQ service, which allows its users to access the QQ network via their mobile phones and communicate in real-time with other QQ users. Value-added services include Mobile chat, ringback tones, mobile music, image and picture download services, mobile news and mobile games. As of March 31, 2006, there were approximately 9.5 million registered subscriptions for fee-based mobile and telecommunication value-added services provided directly by Tencent or through mobile operators.
 
 
30

 
 
On July 6, 2006 China Mobile, one of China’s largest mobile operators, announced new regulations regarding the provision of Mobile value added services (“MVAS”) to its users. These new regulations require MVAS providers to give new subscribers one month’s free trial of their services and obtain double confirmation of new subscriptions. They also require fixed fee subscriptions in place of pay per message billings for existing subscribers and MVAS providers to send monthly reminders to existing subscribers that the service is still active, giving them the opportunity to cancel. These regulations may impact Tencent’s MVAS revenues going forward.
 
Online advertising has been growing as well. Tencent sells advertising space on its QQ software client and websites that generate significant impressions daily. The QQ software client enables targeted advertisements such as “log-in flashes” and “system messages” to deliver high resolution images to the end user’s PC screen. Tencent began generating advertising revenues relating to Internet searching functions in recent periods.
 
Competitors and Competitive Position
 
In South Africa, M-Web Holdings’ main competitors in the internet access business are Telkom SA, ABSA and various other ISPs that operate in this market. The country’s main mobile operators, Vodacom and MTN, have also begun to offer internet access subscription services through their 3G networks. Telkom SA is pursuing customers before a second network operator becomes operational. Once operational, the second network operator may enter the residential and corporate access internet market with competitive pricing. A number of companies offer e-commerce solutions to retailers. In the hosting and web development market, the competition is strong with some well-known companies, including UUNet and Internet Solutions, a subsidiary of Dimension Data.
 
Regulatory developments, including the granting of licenses to new operators, may affect the competitive position of Naspers’ internet operators and must be taken into consideration when evaluating competitive positions. You should read “—Regulation” for more information about the regulatory environment in Naspers’ key markets.  
 
The market for internet and telecommunications value-added services in China is highly competitive and competition is expected to increase continuously. As the industry is relatively new and is rapidly evolving, the basis of competition is expected to shift frequently, offering opportunities for new competitors to enter our markets. In addition, as China continues to open its telecommunications value-added services market to foreign investors, Tencent may face increased competition from international competitors that may establish joint venture companies with local companies to provide services based on the foreign investors’ technology and experience developed in overseas markets. Several of Tencent’s existing competitors, as well as a number of new potential competitors, may have significantly greater financial, technical and marketing resources than Tencent.
 
Tencent’s main competitors in the overall internet and telecommunications value-added services market in China are local internet portals. Tencent competes directly with these portals to provide comprehensive Internet and mobile and telecommunications value-added services to Chinese consumers. In addition to these horizontal portals, other foreign competitors such as MSN, Yahoo and AOL, which have substantial brand recognition and large user bases outside China, may leverage such strengths to increase their market position in the China Instant Messaging (IM) market. Some of China’s domestic telecommunications operators may have plans to launch their own branded mobile chat or IM services with the telecommunications services they are currently offering, further increasing the level of competition in this sphere. In the area of mobile and telecommunications value-added services, Tencent also faces competition from a large number of competitors that provide an expanding range of product offering.  Tencent believes the visibility for this highly competitive sector is still low due to the recent policy changes introduced by the mobile operators, and local players may market their services more aggressively to increase their market share thereafter. In the online entertainment market, Tencent also faced competition from a number of local game developers and operators in the mini casual games, advanced casual games and massive multiplayer online game (“MMOG”) market.
 
The enterprise IM market in China is in an early stage of development. MSN, AOL and Yahoo may have plans to enter the enterprise market upon interoperability. Enterprise software companies in China may also provide IM functionality in their products in the future.
 
 
31

 
Print Media 
 
Overview 
 
Media24 is a leading print media concern in Africa, with its main operations in South Africa. The Media24 group is a large publisher of magazines and newspapers and a printer and distributor of magazines, newspapers and related products in Africa. In addition, Media24 is establishing internet businesses that compliment and draw from existing strengths and areas of expertise and are rapidly evolving as leaders in their specific segments. Media24 is also the holding company for Via Afrika, the book publishing and distribution business, and the group’s private education business, Educor. The print media segment consists of three sub-segments, namely Newspapers, Magazines and Printing, Books and Education.
 
Newspapers, Magazines and Printing
 
Media24’s current newspaper portfolio consists of more than 50 titles and the magazine publishing division publishes approximately 57 titles. At March 31, 2006 Naspers owned a 92.1% interest in the Paarl Media group, which is engaged in providing a printing service to both our own magazines as well as third party magazine publishers. NND24 does most of the distribution of the magazines for the group, as well as for external customers. Approximately 17% of total newspaper circulation revenue and 6% of total magazine circulation is generated from subscribers; the balance is achieved via delivery to a wide network of retail and smaller merchandisers.
 
Media24 acquired an additional interest of 7.5% in Paarl Media Holdings (Proprietary) Limited (“Paarl Media Holdings”) for a cash consideration of Rand 180.0 million during April 2005. Media24 now has an interest of 92.1% in Paarl Media Holdings.
 
The print media industry in South Africa is fairly mature. Media24 has expanded its business over the past few years by adding a series of new titles to its stable and through a series of small acquisitions.
 
Media24 streamlined its printing operations in 2000 by merging with the Paarl Post Web group to establish Paarl Media Holdings. Media24 has established new infrastructure and production resources and buildings as part of a comprehensive replacement and refurbishment program. A new litho web printing plant costing approximately Rand 175 million was commissioned in September 2005 in Gauteng. This plant will concentrate on commercial printing and some magazine printing.
 
Further capital investments of approximately Rand 120 million and Rand 40 million will be incurred over the next eighteen months at the newspaper printing presses in Johannesburg and Cape Town, respectively, to provide additional capacity for the circulation of the recently launched tabloids, Daily Sun and Son.
 
Newspapers
 
Media24 conducts its newspaper publishing and printing business through its newspaper division. The current newspaper portfolio consists of more than 50 titles. A number of new titles were added to the portfolio in recent years.
 
The five Media24 daily newspapers, Die Burger, Beeld, Volksblad, The Natal Witness (50% shareholding) and the Daily Sun, provide regional news coverage. The Daily Sun, based in Gauteng and now the largest selling daily in South Africa, was rolled out into the Free State, KwaZulu Natal and the Eastern Cape in the latter half of 2003. The Afrikaans tabloid Son is now published every weekday in the Western Cape. The Sunday papers, Rapport, City Press and Sunday Sun, are printed in three cities and distributed nationally. Media24 also has a strong group of regional and community newspapers.
 
The significant newspaper titles and related information published by Media24 are summarized below:
 
Newspaper
Circulation(1)
Year Established
Region
Language
         
Dailies
       
Daily Sun
463,691
2002
Gauteng
Eastern Cape
KwaZulu Natal
Free State
English
Beeld 
105,114
1974
Gauteng
 
Afrikaans
 
 
 
 
32

 
 
     
Mpumalanga
Limpopo 
 
Die Burger 
99,288
1915
Eastern Cape
Western Cape
Afrikaans
Volksblad 
27,669
1904
Free State
North West
Afrikaans
Natal Witness 
23,603
1846
KwaZulu Natal
English
         
         
Weeklies
       
Soccer Laduuma 
295,833
1997
National
English
Son
184,179
2003
Eastern Cape
Gauteng
Afrikaans
Sunday
       
Rapport 
313,528
1970
National
Afrikaans
Sunday Sun 
195,850
2001
National
English
City Press 
187,741
1982
National
English
Community Newspapers
       
Paarl Post 
17,006
1905
Paarl
Afr/Eng
District Mail 
13,855
1926
Somerset West
Afr/Eng
Worcester Standard
10,338
1880
Worcester
Afr/Eng
Weslander 
10,175
1972
Vredenburg
Afr/Eng
Vaalweekblad 
10,100
1964
Vanderbijlpark
Afrikaans
Vaal Weekly 
9,981
1998
Vanderbijlpark
English
Eikestadnuus  
8,266
1950
Stellenbosch
Afr/Eng
Hermanus Times 
7,319
1949
Hermanus
Afr/Eng
Potchefstroom Herald
7,209
1908
Potchefstroom
Afr/Eng
Carltonville Herald 
5,480
1966
Carltonville
Afr/Eng
Vrystaat 
4,423
1975
Bethlehem
Afr/Eng
Freesheets
       
City Vision (Johannesburg) 
272,617
1992
Johannesburg
English
TygerBurger 
268,122
1972
Cape Town
Afr/Eng
PE Express 
89,798
1983
Port Elizabeth
Afr/Eng
MetroBurger 
83,340
1980
Cape Town
Afr/Eng
City Vision (Cape Town) 
70,000
1992
Khayalitsha
English
Vaal Vision 
64,850
1989
Vanderbijlpark
Afr/Eng
Express 
50,210
1991
Bloemfontein
English
Bloemnuus 
42,342
1982
Bloemfontein
Afr/Eng
Vista 
37,601
1971
Welkom
Afr/Eng
Ons Stad 
37,196
1983
Bloemfontein
Afr/Eng
Noordwes Gazette 
30,000
1997
Potchefstroom
Afr/Eng
UD Nuus 
29,911
1971
Uitenhage
Afr/Eng
Vanderbijl Ster
24,544
1980
Vanderbijlpark
Afr/Eng
Goudveld Forum 
23,178
1983
Welkom
Afr/Eng
Vereeniging Ster
22,306
1980
Vereeniging
Afr/Eng
Noordkaap 
22,079
1982
Kimberley
Afr/Eng
Sasolburg Ster
11,601
1996
Sasolburg
Afr/Eng
Kroonnuus 
8,462
1986
Kroonstad
Afr/Eng
Maluti 
7,939
1991
Bethlehem
Afr/Eng
Meyerton Ster 
7,193
1997
Meyerton
Afr/Eng
Noord Vrystaat Gazette 
6,457
2000
Parys
Afr/Eng
__________

(1)
Audited Bureau for Circulation (“ABC”) figures: average per issue, last three months (above: April - June 2006).
 
The newspaper division is equipped with a modern network of newsprint facilities. All five of the major print facilities have been upgraded or completely replaced since 1997. These projects, which required significant capital expenditures,
 
 
33

 
are expected to yield advantages over the lifetime of the printing presses due to expected lower future operating costs, improved quality and an increase in third party commercial work. Further capital investments are planned to provide additional capacity.
 
Magazine Publishing
 
Media24 is a leading publisher of consumer magazines in South Africa. This division publishes a portfolio of consumer magazines in South Africa which include the family magazines Huisgenoot, You, Drum, tvplus and Move!, the women’s magazines Sarie, Fairlady and True Love, the creative living magazines, Ideas (formerly known as Woman’s Value and Dit), Tuis and Home, as well as the leading financial magazine, Finweek. The Touchline-subsidiary with its magazines, such as Men’s Health, Shape, Sports Illustrated, Golf Digest, Kick Off, Bicycling SA and Runner’s World also forms part of this segment. This division has entered into partnerships with international partners such as Emap plc to publish international titles, such as FHM and Heat. In 2005 they entered into a license agreement to publish Readers Digest. In fiscal 2006 new title launches included Go! (which was launched due to the success of the Afrikaans outdoor magazine, Weg!), Shop and Lééf met hart en siel, Your Child, Men’s Health Living, Real Simple (under license from Time Inc) and MaxPower (under license from Emap plc). In July 2006, Media24 acquired the motoring portfolio of magazines including TopCar, TopDeal and TopBike titles as well as a television magazine program TopCar for Rand 15.5 million. The existing titles are being repositioned and TopCar was relaunched with an Afrikaans language edition called TopMotor.
 
The following is a summary of the significant titles published by Media24’s magazine division:
 
Magazine
Circulation(2)
Year Established
Frequency
Language
         
Finance
       
Finweek 
29,457
1979/1984
Weekly
English/
Afrikaans
         
General interest
       
Huisgenoot 
354,266
1916
Weekly
Afrikaans
You 
227,879
1987
Weekly
English
tvplus  
164,626
1999
Fortnightly
English/
Afrikaans
Heat
78,429
2004
Weekly
English
Drum 
75,367
1951
Weekly
English/Zulu
Reader’s Digest
62,399
2005
Monthly
English
Landbouweekblad 
42,164
1919
Weekly
Afrikaans
Insig 
14,044
1987
Monthly
Afrikaans
         
Men’s
       
FHM
111,260
1999
Monthly
English
Men’s Health 
89,249
1997
Monthly
English
         
Parenting
       
Your Pregnancy(3) 
30,058
1998
Alternate-monthly
English
Baba & Kleuter 
25,463
2000
Monthly
Afrikaans
Your Baby 
24,609
1995
Monthly
English
Your Child(3)
15,133
2005
Alternate-monthly
English
         
Sport
       
Kick Off SA
62,113
1994
Fortnightly
English
Sports Illustrated 
37,806
1986
Monthly
English
Golf Digest 
28,821
1995
Monthly
English
Bicycling SA(3)
20,347
2002
Alternate-monthly
English
Runner’s World 
18,702
1993
Monthly
English
Zigzag Surfing Magazine(3) 
15,282
1976
Monthly
English
The Wisden Cricketer(3)
10,728
2004
Alternate-monthly
English
         
Teen /Youth
       
Saltwater Girl(3)
45,360
2001
Monthly
English
 
 
34

 
 
Seventeen
39,546
2003
Monthly
English
National Geographic Kids
27,695
2004
Monthly
English
Blunt(3)
13,207
1997
Monthly
English
         
Women’s
       
Sarie
131,280
1949
Monthly
Afrikaans
True Love
117,819
1972
Monthly
English
Cosmopolitan
114,340
1984
Monthly
English
Fair Lady 
82,881
1965
Monthly
English
Move!
72,208
2005
Fortnightly
English
Shape  
46,975
2000
Monthly
English
Leef
43,794
2005
Monthly
Afrikaans
Real Simple
34,502
2005
Monthly
English
         
Creative Living
       
Tuis/Home
86,933
2004
Monthly
Afrikaans/ English
Idees (formerly Dit)
79,097
2001
Monthly
Afrikaans
Ideas (formerly Woman’s Value)
56,349
1980
Monthly
English
         
Other niche
       
Weg
95,054
2004
Monthly
Afrikaans
         
(2)
ABC figures: average per issue, last three months (above: April - June 2006).
 
(3)
ABC figures: average per issue, last six months (above: January - June 2006).
 
Printing and Distribution
 
Media24 has a 92.1% interest in Paarl Media Holdings. Media24’s printing interests are divided into its newspaper print facilities (which are included in and managed as part of the newspaper business) and Paarl Media Holdings (which encompasses all print interests other than newspapers).
 
Paarl Media (Proprietary) Limited, a wholly-owned subsidiary of Paarl Media Holdings, specializes in publication of gravure and litho-web magazines, brochures and advertising material printing at its advanced facilities in Montague Gardens, Cape Town (called Paarl Gravure), Paarl (called Paarl Web and Paarl Print) and the newly commissioned Paarl Web Gauteng facility in Johannesburg. Gravure is a printing process mainly used for high-speed production of large print runs at constant speed and of high-quality. It closely resembles the photographic process. Litho-web presses use a photo chemical process based on the principle that water and oil do not mix. In respect of all publication gravure and heatset web printing work performed by the facilities, including pamphlets, inserts and advertising material, Paarl Media Holdings processes an estimated 40% of such printing work in the South African market. All four plants (Paarl Gravure, Paarl Web, Paarl Web Gauteng and Paarl Print) are able to process digital material. Paarl Print offers, in addition to the printing of books, diaries and magazines, heatset web print for commercial work, labels (UV flexo, self-adhesive and litho), and specialized bindery services. This includes luxury binding for bibles, hard and soft cover/sewing/PUR binding/perfect binding/saddle stitching.
 
With respect to books, Paarl Print holds an estimated 25% share of the South African book printing market.
 
Media24’s business also incorporates distribution networks, which complement the editorial and printing functions. NND24, a division of Media24, distributes Media24 and third party magazines and newspapers.
 
24.com
 
The group’s position has enabled it to establish several consumer related internet businesses. These businesses command a large proportion of South Africa’s internet traffic although many of them are still in a start up phase. The most popular properties draw as many as 2.5 million unique visitors per month. The group’s key consumer related internet businesses have now been combined, together with the development expertise within MWEB into a single unit known as 24.com.
 
 
35

 
 
24.com is a general consumer portal offering various consumer and e-commerce services and is underpinned by an array of special interest properties which provide services and content relating to news; women’s interest; motoring; property; health; finance and food.
 
Seasonality
 
Media24’s business performance is stronger during the Christmas season. Advertising revenues accelerate from October to December and then decrease in January and February, normally recovering in March. Similarly, in the rush to prepare for the Christmas season, printing and distribution activities build up from October to November, before slowing down in January. As Naspers’ fiscal year ends on March 31, the financial results for the second six months are typically stronger than those for the first six months, barring contrary general economic trends.
 
Raw Materials
 
Paper and ink (and related chemicals) are the principal raw materials required for publishing activities. Media24 has not experienced and does not anticipate severe difficulties in obtaining adequate supplies of paper or ink and chemicals for its operations, with sourcing available from suppliers, locally and internationally. Prices, however, do fluctuate as is the case with most commodities. For Media24, pricing can be affected by the volatility of the Rand and in some respects the price of international crude oil since the key ingredients for manufacturing the ink (or, if the ink is imported as a finished product, the ink itself) are sourced from outside of South Africa and because some inks are oil based. Media24 therefore expects production costs to be impacted by the volatility of the Rand and the increase in the oil price. Contracts with the two main newsprint suppliers are typically for two or three years. One contract will be renewed in calendar 2006 and the other in calendar 2007.
 
Competitors and Competitive Position
 
Media24’s main competitors in South Africa include:
 
·      
Caxton Printing and Publishing Limited (“Caxton”), a JSE listed company, with significant interests in newspaper, magazine and book printing facilities, magazine publishing and some newspapers.
 
·      
Independent Group—part of Independent plc (Ireland), a large newspaper publisher and printer in South Africa with multiple titles, including The Star, Business Report, The Argus and Cape Times. It recently launched a daily tabloid in the Western Cape, the Daily Voice, which competes directly with Media24’s Son product. Independent plc (Ireland) also publishes two Conde Nast titles in South Africa under license (GQ and Conde Nast House & Garden).
 
·      
Johnnic Communications Limited (“Johncom”), a JSE listed company, with newspaper and magazine publishing interests, owns the Sunday Times and 50% of the Financial Mail and Business Day. They have acquired the Sowetan and the Sunday World from New Africa Investments Limited.
 
The two key indicators of competitive position are circulation and advertising revenue. Competition for circulation and advertising revenue comes from local, regional and national newspapers, magazines, radio, television, direct mail and other communications and advertising media that operate in the same markets as Media24. The extent and nature of such competition is, in large part, determined by the location and demographics of the markets and the number of media alternatives available in these markets. Media24 competes for advertising revenue with other forms of media based on the ability to offer an effective means for advertisers to reach their target audience.
 
In the printing market, competitive factors include the quality and location of printing presses, distribution capabilities and technological advancements. In printing, Caxton, Interpak and Intrepid Printers (Proprietary) Ltd are the main competitors.
 
 
36

 
 
Books
 
Overview
 
Via Afrika is a leading African book publisher, seller and distributor of innovative and quality reading, learning, listening and viewing products in various formats. Via Afrika controls a number of different businesses operating as independent business units in two segments as follows:
 
·      
Publishers and agents: including general, religious, educational and academic publishers as well as digital content providers.
 
·      
Retail and distribution: traditional niche academic bookstores, book and music clubs and warehousing and distribution services.
 
The following provides a brief summary of Via Afrika’s various book related business units:
 
 Business Unit  Nature of Business  Brand Names and Imprints
 
Publishing and Agencies
   
NB Publishers
General publishing in Afrikaans and English
Tafelberg, Human & Rousseau, Pharos, Kwela and Best Books
Jonathan Ball Publishers
(including Book Promotions and Horizon Library Services)
Publishing and distribution of general English books
Jonathan Ball, AD Donker, Sunbird
Agent and distributor for Harper Collins, Hodder Headline, Simon & Schuster, Orion, Bloomsbury, Scholastic and others
Lux Verbi.BM (50%)
Publisher of Christian books and products
Lux Verbi.BM, NG Kerk Uitgewers, Protea, Hugenote and Waterkant.
Nasou Via Afrika (70%)
Publishing of educational school text books
Nasou, Via Afrika, Action, Juta Gariep and Idem.
Collegium (Botswana) (55%)
Publishing of educational school text books in Botswana
Collegium
Van Schaik Publishers (70%)
Publishing of academic text books
Van Schaik Publishers
Future Entrepreneurs (70%)
Publishing of learning and teaching support materials for schools in digital formats
Future Entrepreneurs
     
Retail and Distribution
   
Afribooks (40%)
Retail distributor of school text books and stationery
Afribooks
Van Schaik Bookstores
Academic book retail and content manager
Van Schaik Bookstores
     
     
Leisure Books and Leserskring
Direct marketing clubs for books, music, videos, DVD’s and related products
Leisure Books, Leserskring
On the Dot Distribution
Distribution of books, music, stationery and certain electronic products
On the Dot Distribution
Content Solutions
Print-on-demand service provider of customized academic course packs.
Content Solutions

During February 2005, Nasou Via Afrika (Proprietary) Limited acquired the publishing rights and author contracts of Juta Gariep for a consideration of Rand 26.0 million. The publishing rights were mainly for school text books, but also included some educational products and toys, branded Idem.
 
 
37


 
During July 2005, Via Afrika sold the entire issued share capital of its wholly owned subsidiary Computicket (Proprietary) Limited to Shoprite (Proprietary) Limited for a purchase price of approximately Rand 69.0 million.

On June 1, 2006, Via Afrika acquired a 70% interest in Ailenroc Bemarking en Opleiding (Proprietary) Limited which trades under the name Future Entrepreneurs. The purchase consideration consisted of an upfront cash payment of Rand 12.3 million and an additional Rand 6.5 million that is contingent on whether the business achieves certain earn-out targets over the next two years. Future Entrepreneurs produces learning and teaching support material for the school market in electronic and other formats.

During June 2006, Via Afrika closed its religious book retail division, Lux Verbi Retail, as it was no longer economically viable.
 
Seasonality
 
Via Afrika’s book businesses are seasonal. The production and sale of learning support materials for primary, secondary and tertiary education occurs mostly from January to March, the beginning of the South African academic year. Accordingly, most revenues are generated at the beginning of the calendar year, which is Naspers’ fiscal fourth quarter. The fiscal third and fourth quarters also are favorably affected by the usual increase in general book publishing driven by the Christmas and Easter holidays.

Raw Materials
 
Like most businesses in the media sector, Via Afrika is indirectly exposed to rising paper and ink costs. In addition, the Van Schaik Bookstore and Jonathan Ball businesses import most of their products, making them further susceptible to the volatility of the Rand versus pound sterling and U.S. dollar exchange rates.
 
Competitors and Competitive Position
 
Publishers compete by developing a portfolio of books that are in demand by continually seeking out and promoting talented writers and by offering their works at competitive prices. Via Afrika mainly competes with other publishers of fiction and non-fiction books, including international publishers with a presence in South Africa such as Random House, Penguin and MacMillan as well as with South African publishers, most notably Maskew Miller Longman, jointly owned by Pearsons and Caxton, the leading school textbook publishers in South Africa.
 
Private Education
 
Educor is the leading provider of private education in South Africa. It offers programs ranging from adult basic education and training to higher education and corporate training. Educor is primarily involved in the delivery of further education and training and higher education in South Africa. The further education and training programs provide the foundation for higher education and focus on the returning adult and not just the school leaver. Educor operates its private education business through a number of subsidiaries, the large majority of which are wholly owned, and is structured in two divisions as follows:
 
Damelin (face to face education)
 
Educor’s key brand Damelin is represented in all major South African business centers and has over 45 campuses throughout South Africa. Educor’s programs are delivered in three principal ways: face-to-face in the classroom and on campus, via supplementary distance learning and through corporate on-site executive education.
 
Damelin focuses on higher education and further education and training for full and part time learners. Damelin also focuses on higher education and further education and training, providing programs such as sound engineering, game ranging and sports club management. The Graduate Institute of Management and Technology (“GIMT”) offers customized education for corporate executives and runs public programs for management.
 
Midrand Graduate Institute (“MGI”) provides higher education covering the arts, commerce and technology fields as well as the Cambridge A and O level programs to prepare learners for higher education programs. Milpark Business School provides both undergraduate and post-graduate education such as masters in business administration (“MBAs”).
 
 
38

 
International Colleges Group (“ICG”) (distance education)
 
ICG provides vocational education to over 50,000 students. ICG specializes in distance education, sometimes enhanced by contact sessions. ICG operates traditional distance learning colleges Intec and Damelin, as well as Academy for Mathematics and Lyceum College.
 
The private education sector in South Africa is increasingly subject to government regulation. Some of the changes will negatively affect Educor’s business. The Department of Education, for instance, is imposing stricter controls on the accreditation and registration of private education programs and courses. The Department of Education has, in particular, expressed concerns regarding the number of MBAs offered in South Africa and has recently revoked accreditation of a number of institutions. Educor’s MBA program, offered by Milpark Business School, has been provisionally accredited. Educor and the other institutions that have been provisionally accredited have been given two years to introduce some specified changes to the programs to ensure that the accreditation becomes unconditional.
 
Seasonality
 
Educor’s business is seasonal as approximately 60% of its students sign up in the first three calendar months of the year (the beginning of the South African academic year). Marketing plans and sales initiatives need to be prepared by October of the prior year, meaning that operating costs leading up to that period are typically higher than during the remainder of the year.

Competitors and Competitive Position
 
Educor competes with international and local universities and creators of educational materials. Competition is based on the ability to deliver quality products at competitive prices that appeal to the school boards, educators and government officials making purchasing decisions. Public universities are Educor’s main competitors in South Africa. International competitors include Bond University and the University of Southern Queensland. Some of the international competitors’ MBA programs have recently lost their accreditation and the indicators are that some of them will exit the South African market. Local competitors include Adcorp Holdings Limited, Advtech Limited and Privest Group Limited.
 
MIH Print Media24
 
The print media investments outside of South Africa are conducted by MIH Print Media, a division of the MIH group.
 
China
 
MIH Print Media has a 9.9% interest in BMC. BMC is a media company principally engaged in the sale of advertising space, production of newspapers and trading of print-related materials. BMC’s revenue is mainly derived from the sale of advertising space in Beijing Youth Daily, Beijing’s second largest newspaper in terms of circulation. BMC also performs the layout and arranges for the printing of Beijing Youth Daily and supplies paper and other print-related materials to printers of Beijing Youth Daily and other publications.
 
BMC’s revenue depends substantially on the demand for advertising space in Beijing Youth Daily, which is driven by readership profile and circulation figures. These in turn depend on readers’ satisfaction with the content of the Beijing Youth Daily, over which BMC has no control. Advertisements in Beijing Youth Daily are derived, amongst others, from the Beijing real estate market. A downturn in the Beijing real estate market or stricter regulation of it would adversely affect BMC’s advertising revenue.
 
Subsequent to the year end, MIH Print Media acquired a 20.2% interest in Titan, a leading company in the field of Chinese sports publishing. It is anticipated that through a further acquisition MIH Print Media’s shareholding will increase to 37%.
 
Rest of Sub-Saharan Africa
 
MIH Print Media trades in Africa as Media24 Africa. It has a 50% interest in East Africa Magazines, a joint venture magazine publisher with the Kenyan Nation Media group. The products published in Kenya include True Love East Africa and Drum. In Nigeria Media24 Africa has been publishing Kick Off Nigeria since 2002 and True Love West Africa since 2005. A
 
 
39

 
weekly soccer newspaper, Goal, was recently launched in Nigeria. Servicing the Angolan market, Media24 Africa recently launched a television magazine called TV24.
 
Brazil
 
In May 2006, MIH acquired, through its offshore subsidiary MIH B.V., a 30% stake in the leading Brazilian media company, Abril, for a cash consideration of Rand 2,557.3 million. The transaction provides Naspers with an opportunity to participate in the growing Brazilian media market through a leading enterprise.
 
Abril is the largest magazine publisher in Brazil and one of the largest media companies in Latin America. It has a 54% share of magazine circulation and 58% of magazine advertising revenues in Brazil. It publishes five of the top ten magazine titles in Brazil. Its flagship newsweekly, Veja, is the fourth highest selling weekly in the world, has a weekly circulation of approximately 1.1 million and an average readership of 8 million, the largest of any magazine globally not owned by a US-based group. In addition, Abril owns the country’s leading educational book publisher.
 
Intellectual Property
 
Naspers relies on a combination of patents, licensing arrangements, trade names, trademarks, copyrights and proprietary technology to protect its intellectual property rights. Naspers or its subsidiaries own, or have been assigned or licensed, the rights to several patents and have several patent applications in various jurisdictions relating to their proprietary technology. In addition, Naspers or its subsidiaries currently have numerous trademarks (pending and registered) in countries where they conduct business or could potentially conduct business in the future. Some of Naspers’ major trademarks include the names and logos of DStv, M-Net, SuperSport, MultiChoice, M-Web, QQ, Entriq and Irdeto. In respect of the internet, a number of domain registrations have been secured, also as a mechanism to protect print brands. The publishing activities of Media24, Via Afrika and Educor generally enjoy copyright protection. Naspers believes it has taken appropriate available legal steps to protect its intellectual property in the relevant jurisdictions.
 
Naspers may file additional patent and trademark applications in the future, although there can be no assurance that Naspers will be successful in obtaining patents or trademark registrations based upon these applications. Naspers intends to vigorously protect its intellectual property rights. It may be possible, however, for a third party to copy or otherwise obtain and use its content and technology without authorization or to develop similar technology independently. Furthermore, the laws of certain countries in which Naspers sells its products and services do not protect Naspers’ intellectual property rights to the same extent as do the laws of the United States.
 
Regulation
 
Naspers is subject to laws which regulate its business practices in the different jurisdictions in which it operates. The following discussion focuses on South Africa, Greece, Thailand and China, the principal countries in which Naspers conducts its operations. For a discussion of the regulation of education in South Africa and its impact on Educor, you should review “ —Private Education (Educor)” above. Broadcasting is also regulated in some countries in Sub-Saharan Africa in which the group conducts pay-television activities. For more information please see “- Sub-Saharan Africa” below.
 
South Africa
 
Regulation of Anti-Competitive Practices in South Africa
 
The Competition Act 1998 regulates anti-competitive practices in South Africa. The Competition Act also places emphasis on ensuring that opportunity exists for historically disadvantaged persons to participate in the South African economy.
 
The Competition Act created a Competition Commission, a Competition Tribunal (which has the status of a High Court) and a Competition Appeal Court. The prohibitions against restrictive horizontal practices, restrictive vertical practices, the prohibitions against abuse of positions of dominance and the provisions regulating mergers are the main prohibitions in the Competition Act which may affect Naspers.
 
The Competition Act provisions may be enforced by:
 
·      
injunctions in respect of contraventions of the Competition Act;
 
 
40

 
 
·      
orders against third parties to remedy anti-competitive activity;
 
·      
the imposition of administrative fines;
 
·      
orders for divestment of assets or businesses; and
 
·      
claims for damages by persons injured by a contravention of the Competition Act.
 
The impact of the Competition Act on Naspers is difficult to predict, although it may make completing acquisitions in South Africa more difficult, and in many cases not feasible, for Naspers. Any action taken by the Competition Commission against Naspers could have a material impact on Naspers’ operations in South Africa.
 
The Independent Communications Authority of South Africa (“ICASA”) and the Competition Commission have concurrent jurisdiction over the investigation, evaluation and analysis of mergers, acquisition transactions and competition-related complaints involving telecommunications and broadcasting matters, and have published a Memorandum of Understanding to regulate the manner in which they will cooperate on such issues.

Print and Electronic Media Regulation in South Africa
 
The Independent Communications Authority of South Africa Act, 2000 created ICASA. ICASA regulated broadcasting under the Independent Broadcasting Authority Act (the “IBA Act”) and the Broadcasting Act, 1999 and telecommunications under the Telecommunications Act, 1996 (“Telecoms Act”).
 
The Electronic Communications Act 36 of 2005 (“ECA”) became effective on July 19, 2006. The new law was intended to usher in further liberalization, competition and convergence. It repealed the IBA Act, most of the Broadcasting Act and Telecommunications Act. Both broadcasting and telecommunications are now predominantly regulated in terms of a single statute, though broadcasting still has a distinct chapter. The ECA substantially alters the current licensing framework and regulatory regime. Previously frequency was assigned together with the broadcasting license. Now the frequency will be licensed separately to the broadcasting service license. There are two additional license categories. These are electronic communications services and electronic communication networks. Licenses will be converted into the new framework. M-Net will therefore get a broadcasting and a frequency license. Orbicom’s broadcasting signal distributor’s license will be converted into an electronic communications network license. MultiChoice Subscriber Management Services’ (“MSMS”) value added network service (“VANS”) license will be converted into an electronic communications service license. The ECA also divides licenses into individual and class licenses. Individual licenses are expected to be more heavily regulated than class licenses which merely require registration. We expect that all the licenses currently held within the Naspers group will be converted into individual licenses.
 
The ECA also vests ICASA with the power to impose additional conditions on operators who have significant market power. It is difficult to predict the impact this may have on licenses within the Naspers group. The ECA introduced new levies for broadcasters that did not exist previously. Broadcasters are now required to make a contribution to the Universal Service and Access Fund, but are allowed to offset the annual Media Development and Diversity Agency (“MDDA”) contributions they make.
 
The IBA Act stipulated that no person may provide a broadcasting service except under and in accordance with a broadcasting license issued by ICASA under that Act. The jurisdiction of the IBA Act in relation to broadcasting was limited to broadcasting frequency bands and therefore excludes the regulation of satellite broadcasting which operates in a telecommunications frequency band. However, the Broadcasting Act provided for the regulation of satellite broadcasting and required satellite broadcasters to obtain a broadcasting license and authorization of all channels included in their service prior to such inclusion.
 
In order to accommodate satellite broadcasters operating prior to the enactment of this legislation, such as MultiChoice South Africa, the Broadcasting Act provided that a satellite broadcasting service which existed at the date of the commencement of that Act (June 30, 1999) would, on application for a broadcasting license in respect of that service, be deemed to have the necessary permission to continue broadcasting until such time as ICASA decided on that application. Prior to the Broadcasting Act coming into effect, MultiChoice South Africa submitted an application for a license. ICASA at that time indicated that they were expecting amendments to the legislation and would not consider applications until after such amendments had been effected.
 
 
41

 
The Broadcasting Amendment Act, 2002 made certain amendments to these provisions. Persons who, immediately before the commencement of this Act, provided a broadcasting service, were deemed to have permission to continue such service if such persons applied to ICASA for the necessary license within six months after the commencement of the Broadcasting Amendment Act 2002. MultiChoice South Africa applied for such license, and ICASA confirmed in writing that MultiChoice South Africa had satisfied the requirements in the Broadcasting Amendment Act and was deemed to have the necessary permission to provide its broadcasting service. The Broadcasting Amendment Act further provided that any person who immediately before the commencement of that Act provided an unlicensed broadcasting service consisting of more than one channel, was deemed to have permission to continue to include all such channels in its service, provided that the broadcaster applied to ICASA for authorization of the channels within three months after the publication of regulations prescribing the procedure and the conditions for channel authorization. ICASA has not as yet published these regulations. The ECA has in its transitional provisions protected these permissions.
 
ICASA released a Discussion Paper on Subscription Broadcasting on April 23, 2004. The Discussion Paper commenced the inquiry to determine the appropriate licensing and regulatory framework for subscription broadcasting services. ICASA requested commentary on how best to regulate subscription broadcasting services. The discussion paper covered a variety of issues relating to, amongst others, local content, license fees, duration of the license and must carry rules. MultiChoice South Africa made written representations in response to the discussion paper. On June 1, 2005, ICASA published its Position Paper on Subscription Broadcasting which set out its policy on the regulations on local content, a code of conduct for subscription broadcasters, license fees, advertising limits and the process for authorizing channels. ICASA further indicated that it would not regulate technology standards, packaging of bouquets, electronic program guides (“EPGs”), conditional access systems and the exclusive acquisition of content, as they believed general competition law would suffice.
 
ICASA issued its invitation to apply for satellite and cable licenses on January 31, 2006. The closing date for applications was July 31, 2006 which date was later extended to August 31, 2006. MultiChoice South Africa submitted its application before this deadline. MultiChoice expects a number of players, including traditional telecommunications operators, to apply.
 
M-Net’s broadcasting license was renewed on June 1, 2002 on substantially the same terms and conditions as its previous license. The new license expires on March 31, 2010.
 
On June 9, 2004 ICASA gave notice in the Government Gazette that it was considering the amendment of the subscription television broadcasting service license of M-Net. The amendments under consideration were the closure of open-time and the re-wording of the ownership and control clause. M-Net made written representations opposing these amendments. Subsequently, ICASA confirmed the closure of open time, but did not proceed with any changes to the ownership and control provision. The amendment will take effect on April 1, 2007.
 
In 2002 ICASA reviewed the existing limitations on control of broadcasting services. The IBA Act prohibits one or more foreign persons from, directly or indirectly, exercising control (as defined) over, or having an interest in excess of 20% in, a commercial broadcasting licensee. In addition, no person may, directly or indirectly, exercise control over more than one commercial television broadcasting license. The Act also prohibits a person in a position to control a newspaper from controlling a television license, in cases where the newspaper has a circulation of 20% of the total newspaper readership in an area that overlaps substantially with the relevant television license area. ICASA has considered these rules in respect of commercial broadcasters (other than multi-channel broadcasters). ICASA has recommended that the percentage limitation on foreign ownership should be raised to 25%. While relaxing the rules in respect of radio, no material changes were made for television or the cross media control rules except to tighten the drafting in respect of the latter. The Minister has yet to table these recommendations in Parliament.
 
In respect of multi-channel broadcasters such as M-Net and MultiChoice South Africa, the Broadcasting Act mandates ICASA to assess whether these rules should be applicable to multi-channel broadcasters. ICASA may make recommendations for the amendment of these provisions to the Minister of Communications, who has to table them in the South African Parliament. Until such recommendations have been adopted by Parliament they do not apply to multi-channel broadcasters. ICASA is considering this question as part of the subscription inquiry referred to above. ICASA, in the aforementioned Position Paper on Subscription Broadcasting, made the recommendation that these rules should not apply to subscription broadcasters (such as M-Net and MultiChoice South Africa). These recommendations have been sent to the Minister of Communications for tabling in Parliament. The Minister has yet to table these recommendations in Parliament.
 
The Broadcasting Act provides that subscription broadcasting services may not acquire exclusive rights for the broadcast of national sporting events identified by ICASA in consultation with the Ministers of Communications and Sport. In July
 
 
42

 
 
2003 ICASA published a position paper and regulations on sports broadcasting rights. The regulations identify national sporting events which cannot be acquired exclusively for broadcasting by subscription television broadcasting licensees, and which are required to be broadcast live or delayed live or delayed by free-to-air television broadcasting licensees. This prohibition has been retained in the ECA.
 
In terms of the Telecoms Act, the provider of a VANS (defined as a telecommunication service provider to one or more customers concurrently, during which value is added for the benefit of customers), is required to hold a license to provide such service. This includes internet service providers. In terms of the Act, a VANS may not be used for the carriage of voice and may only be provided by means of facilities provided by Telkom SA, the incumbent fixed-line operator or the second national operator (“SNO”). The SNO has now been licensed but has yet to launch commercially. The prohibition on VANS providing voice service has been lifted in the ECA, provided the VANS provider obtains the necessary license.
 
MSMS, as an internet service provider, is required to hold a VANS license under the Telecoms Act. Nevertheless, Section 40(1)(b) of the Telecoms Act provides that any person who, immediately prior to May 20, 1996, provided a VANS in terms of certain agreements, is deemed to be a holder of a license to provide such services, provided that such person applies to the Authority within six months or such extended period as the Authority may allow, for a license in terms of the Act. In addition, this section of the Telecoms Act provides that the Authority must grant the application and issue a license to such person. In accordance with the aforesaid legislation, and after repeatedly extending the period within which deemed VANS licensees would have to apply for a VANS license, ICASA notified all affected parties during the first quarter of 2004 of a three month period within which VANS providers would have to reapply for their licenses. On May 20, 2005, the Minister of Communications published regulations for VANS services. The regulations require VANS operators to pay a variable license fee of 0.1% of their license fee income and to have 15% equity ownership by historically disadvantaged individuals within one year and 30% equity ownership in 2 years, from the date of the issuance of the license. ICASA has since issued MSMS a VANS license which is valid for a period of 10 years and may be renewed.
 
Sentech Ltd (a parastatal entity) became the first entrant into the fixed mobile broadband internet provision market when it began offering its MyWireless service. Sentech derives its regulatory entitlement from a Multimedia Service license which it was granted in 2002. Sentech could therefore become a competitor to MultiChoice South Africa and MSMS.
 
The Regulation of Interception of Communications and Provision of Communication-Related Information Act, 70 of 2002 (“the Interception Act”) was passed on January 22, 2003, but is yet to come into effect. The Interception Act imposes requirements on telecommunication service providers (such as M-Web Holdings) licensed under the Telecoms Act to provide telecommunication services which have the capability to be intercepted and to store communication-related information. The cost incurred in enabling this telecommunications service of being intercepted and the storage of the communication-listed information must be borne by the telecommunications service provider concerned. The Interception Act also requires telecommunications service providers, at their own cost, to acquire facilities and devices, determined in terms of a directive, with the capability to intercept and store communication-related information. Telecommunication service providers must also contribute to an ISP assistance fund. For approximately 12 months, Telkom, the mobile operators and the ISPs, either individually or by way of their industry bodies, have been engaged in a consultation process with the government in an attempt to agree on regulations setting the parameters of their obligations in terms of the Interception Act. Technical standards, data storage periods and costs have been some of the issues under discussion.
 
The Electronic Communications and Transactions Act of 2002 intended, among other things, to facilitate and regulate electronic communications and transactions and e-commerce. The Act’s effects include, but are not limited to:
 
·      
providing for the recognition of electronic records, data messages and electronic signatures, the admissibility of data messages as evidence and facilitation of electronic contracting;
 
·      
requiring the registration of cryptography providers, which would appear to include any provider of encryption services and products, such as MSMS; MSMS has now registered as a cryptography provider;
 
·      
providing for the voluntary registration of authentication service providers, which would include products relating to electronic signatories and digital certificates, and may have an impact on M-Web Holdings;
 
 
43

 
 
 
·      
providing for consumer protection in relation to electronic transactions, including providing certain information and ensuring payment systems are secure;
 
·      
establishing voluntary personal data protection provisions and the requirement for registration of critical databases;
 
·      
establishing a .za internet domain name authority by the Minister of Communications;
 
·      
providing for the limitation of liability of service providers, including ISPs, in certain circumstances; and
 
·      
providing for “cyber inspectors”, with powers, among other things, to monitor and inspect web sites or information systems and to investigate the activities of cryptography service providers. The cyber inspectors will have fairly extensive powers of search and seizure.
 
The Media Development and Diversity Agency Act, 2002 establishes an agency which, among other things, aims to support media development and diversity projects. Depending on the content of future regulations under this Act, participants in the media industry will make agreed contributions for this purpose. Media24 has agreed to contribute Rand 1.2 million per year for the next four years. In addition, MultiChoice South Africa, M-Net and SuperSport have agreed to collectively contribute Rand 1.2 million per year for the next four years.

The Information Communications Technology (“ICT”) sector has submitted a draft charter to the Minister of Communications. In order to be published as a Code of Good Practice, the draft charter must be published in the Government Gazette for public comment for a period of 60 days. Thereafter the charter will be finalized as a Code of Good Practice. The draft charter has yet to be published in the Gazette. Naspers will comment on the charter when it is published in the Gazette. The ICT draft charter has set targets in respect of ownership, management and control, human resource development, procurement, enterprise development, corporate social investment and access to ICTs. The primary objects of the charter are to enable the meaningful participation of black people in the sector. The charter, once finalized, is likely to have a material impact on ICT companies within the Naspers group.
 
As in other countries, the print media is governed by a number of laws which restrict the content of published information.
 
Rest of Sub-Saharan Africa
 
Regulation of Pay-Television in Sub-Saharan Africa
 
MultiChoice Africa is licensed to operate terrestrial rebroadcast pay-television services in Botswana, Ghana, Malawi, Namibia, Nigeria, Uganda and Zambia, either directly or through a local joint venture partner or representative. In a number of these countries the regulatory systems are undergoing change, thereby imposing new compliance obligations on the group.
 
Pay-television services are licensed in Nigeria and Ghana. Namibia and Uganda operate on the basis of authorization granted by the regulatory authorities. In Ethiopia, Kenya and Tanzania discussions are underway with the relevant regulatory authorities concerning the licensing and regulation of pay-television services. In Zambia, the Independent Broadcasting Authority Act was passed in December 2002, but the regulatory authority set up in terms of that Act, is yet to be established. MultiChoice Africa has, in terms of the Act, applied for authorization of its pay-television services and continues to operate legally until such time as the regulatory authority is established and pronounces on its application.
 
In Botswana, following extensive discussions with the regulatory authorities, MultiChoice Africa has instituted review proceedings against the terms of the broadcasting license issued by the authorities to the joint venture operation in Botswana. In Angola, the government has promulgated a Press Law which could have foreign ownership limitation implications for MultiChoice Africa. MultiChoice Africa is currently engaging with the regulators in each of these territories on the appropriateness of such regulation to pay television and specifically to a multi-channel satellite operator.
 
We expect other countries on the continent, where MultiChoice Africa has not previously been regulated, to follow suit and start regulating pay television.
 
 
44

 
 
Greece
 
Regulation of Pay-Television in Greece
 
Overview. The regulatory framework governing the establishment and operation of free-to-air television stations in Greece is provided by Law 2328/95 on the “Legal Status of Private Television and Local Radio, Regulation of Several Issues related to the Radio Television Market and Other Provisions”, as modified by Law 3166/2003, (the “Free-to-Air Law”) and by Law 2863/2000 “National Radio and Television Council and other Authorities and Bodies of the Audiovisual Services Sector” (the “RTC Law”). The pay-television regulatory framework is governed by Law 2644/98 on “The provision of pay-television and radio services and other provisions”, as modified by Law 3166/2003, which regulates the issue of pay-television licenses (via satellite, terrestrial relays or cable) by the use of analog or digital methods of transmission (the “Pay-Television Law”). Prior to the enactment of the Pay-Television Law, pay-television was regulated by the Free-to-Air Law, some provisions of which survive, as described below.
 
The Free-To-Air Law. Before the enactment of the Pay-Television Law, the Free-to-Air Law granted Greek Radio Television SA, the state owned broadcasting entity, the exclusive right to broadcast encrypted television signals in Greece. Greek Radio Television was permitted to further assign such rights to third parties. Based on this legislation, NetMed Hellas entered into an agreement with Greek Radio Television on October 15, 1994, pursuant to which NetMed Hellas’ encrypted service was transmitted on frequencies allocated by Greek Radio Television. This agreement has been approved by a joint decision of the Minister of Press and Mass Media and the Minister of Finance and ratified by Law 2328/95. The October 1994 agreement was extended and supplemented by a further agreement dated December 29, 1995, which relates to the transmission of a second encrypted service on frequencies allocated by Greek Radio Television and was also approved by a joint ministerial decision. These agreements require NetMed Hellas to pay certain fees to Greek Radio Television equal to 6.5% of subscription fees payable by subscribers who subscribe to only one service and 5.0% of subscription fees payable by subscribers who subscribe to both services. NetMed Hellas is required to provide a bank guarantee in an amount of approximately Euro 2.9 million each year to secure these payments.
 
While the cooperation agreements between NetMed Hellas and Greek Radio Television are in force, regulations concerning the share capital composition of free-to-air television companies are not applicable to NetMed Hellas, which, instead is subject to the terms of the aforementioned agreements. Additionally, NetMed Hellas must obtain Greek Radio Television’s approval to transfer a majority of its shares and must notify Greek Radio Television of its intention to transfer any shares which are less than a majority of its shares. Greek Radio Television also has the right to be provided with detailed information if new shareholders enter or new share capital is invested into NetMed Hellas. These provisions are applicable for the entire term of the agreements. The regulations under the cooperation agreements ensure that NetMed and NetMed Hellas (or any other company which has the control of the group of companies to which NetMed Hellas belongs) shall be liable to Greek Radio Television for the fulfillment of the obligations of NetMed Hellas in accordance with the cooperation agreements.
 
Pay-Television Law. Under the Pay-Television Law and the RTC law, the rights to provide pay-television through terrestrial, satellite or cable broadcast can be secured either by obtaining a license directly from the RTC or by signing a cooperation agreement with any holder of a license. The existing agreements between NetMed Hellas and Greek Radio Television have been extended until the licenses for the provision of terrestrial pay-television services have been granted in accordance with the Pay-Television Law and the RTC law. The Minister of Press announced the frequencies to be used for providing terrestrial pay-television services and MultiChoice Hellas submitted an application for such license on February 1, 2000, and again in November 2001, after the first licensing procedure was cancelled. In September 2002, pursuant to Law 3051/2002, all the pending license applications were cancelled on the ground that, after the review of the Greek Constitution, the relevant authority to grant licenses had been transferred to the RTC. The same law provides that until terrestrial pay-television licenses are provided by the RTC, the agreements that Greek Radio Television has drawn up continue in force. The extension of these agreements was approved by the Minister of Press and Mass Media. Pursuant to this Law, an agreement was signed between Greek Radio Television and NetMed Hellas on July 9, 2003. This agreement extends the arrangements between the parties until the terrestrial pay-television licenses are granted by the RTC. This extension was approved by the Minister of Press. Should terrestrial licenses be granted in the future, NetMed Hellas could elect to cooperate with a license holder instead of seeking a license directly. Under the pay-television law and the RTC Law, no single shareholder of a company having a terrestrial license may hold more than 40% of the share capital of such company.
 
A 15-year digital transmission license for the provision of pay-television and radio services via satellite was granted to MultiChoice Hellas on July 15, 1999. On December 20, 1999, MultiChoice Hellas and the Greek government completed the concession agreement required by the terms of the digital transmission license.
 
Synergistic Network Development S.A., a wholly owned subsidiary of NetMed, acquired a ten-year telecommunications license in December 1999 to uplink data and video from Greece..
 
 
45

 
Digital Terrestrial TV and new rules. The Greek Government has announced that it will propose a new law for media which will govern digital terrestrial television, the licensing of terrestrial free to air television stations, the shareholding structure of media companies and the transmission of television on new media networks dedicated to television.
 
The draft bill has not been officially circulated yet and the new regulations will affect the business of NetMed and the competitive environment in which it operates.
 
EU Regulation. The EU Broadcasting Without Frontiers Directive of October 3, 1989, as amended by EC Directive 97/36 of June 30, 1997, established the basic principles for the regulation of broadcasting activity in the EU. In essence, it provides that each EU broadcasting service should be regulated by the authorities of one member state and that certain minimum standards should be required by each member state of all broadcasting services regulated by that state’s authorities. Currently, the directive requires member states to ensure, “where practicable and by appropriate means,” that the broadcasters reserve “a majority proportion of their transmission time” for programs produced in Europe. In applying this rule, broadcast time for news, games, advertisements, sports events, infomercials and teletext services are excluded. The directive recognizes that member states are to move progressively towards requiring their broadcasters to devote a majority of relevant transmission time to programs produced in Europe, having regard to the broadcaster’s informational, educational, cultural and entertainment responsibilities to the viewing public.
 
China
 
Regulation of the internet in China
 
Overview. The operation of telecommunications businesses, including internet related businesses, in the People’s Republic of China is subject to regulation by the government. The Ministry of Information Industry is the primary regulator of internet businesses, with other government authorities also participating in the regulation of foreign investment, advertising, security, encryption and content.
 
Internet Access and Information Services. Both internet access and internet information services in China are governed by the Telecommunications Regulations. The Catalog of Classes of Telecommunications Businesses is part of the Telecommunications Regulations and provides that internet access and internet information services are value added telecommunications businesses. Internet access services can be operated by any non-foreign invested domestic Chinese company, regardless of whether such company is state owned, as long as such company has received a permit from the Ministry of Information Industry or its relevant local counterpart.
 
Internet information service provider is defined by the Administrative Measures on internet Information Services as an entity that engages in “providing information to on-line users through the internet.” Internet information service providers who are compensated for their services are required to obtain a permit from the Ministry of Information Industry or its relevant local counterpart. Those who provide such services without compensation are required to file with the appropriate governmental authority; “without compensation” has been narrowly interpreted by officials to apply only to not-for-profit governmental or charitable organizations.
 
The Administrative Measures on Internet Information Services also set forth a list of prohibited types of content. Internet information service providers are required to monitor their websites, including chat rooms and electronic bulletin boards, for prohibited content and remove any such content that they discover on their websites. Some of the specific types of prohibited content are vague and subject to interpretation and, therefore, the potential liability of internet information service providers is unclear.
 
Internet information service providers are subject to an array of other regulations with respect to types of content and services, for which providers must obtain approval from various agencies. In particular, in June 2002 the State Press and Publication Administration and the Ministry of Information Industry issued the Interim Regulations on internet Publishing, requiring all entities engaging in internet publishing to be approved by the General Administration Press and Publication Administration (“GAPP”). Internet publishing is broadly defined in the interim regulations, and it is currently unclear whether all internet information service providers will require approval from GAPP. Also, internet information service providers that provide a range of “cultural activities” for profit must obtain approval from the Ministry of Culture pursuant to the Interim Regulations on the Administration of Internet Culture, which were promulgated in 2003 and amended on July 1, 2004. Those who provide cultural activities not for profit only need to file with the local counterpart of the Ministry of Culture. “Internet cultural activities” are broadly defined to include, inter alia, producing, reproducing, importing, wholesaling, retailing, leasing and coordinating internet cultural products. These products include audio-visual products, game products, art products and other cultural products.
 
 
46

 
 Furthermore, the State Administration of Radio, Film and Television (“SARFT”) issued the revised Administrative Measures on the Dissemination of Audio-visual Programs through Information Networks such as the internet in 2004 (the “SARFT Administrative Measures”), providing that enterprises which engage in disseminating audio-visual programs through the internet to various devices, including computers, television sets and mobile phones, should obtain a permit from SARFT. Audio-visual programs, as defined by the SARFT Administrative Measures, include programs with a similar manifestation as radio or television programs or films, i.e. they are composed of successively moving images or sounds that can be successively listened to. Dissemination is broadly defined to include launch, live or on-demand broadcasting, integration, transmission and downloading. In addition, on April 13, 2005, SARFT issued a notice to provide that only state-owned entities are permitted to launch audiovisual program services or news websites. As new regulations about specific types of content are still being issued, certain types of content for which approval is not now required may require approval in the future. In addition, because of the lack of specificity in some of these regulations, it is not always clear if the activity engaged in by a specific internet information service provider actually requires approval.
 
Foreign Investment. Foreign investment is governed by the Provisions on the Administration of Foreign Invested Telecommunications Enterprises and restrictions that comply with the commitments made are set forth in the Foreign Investment Industrial Guidance Catalog (the “Catalog”) issued by the former State Development Planning Commission and the former Ministry of Foreign Trade and Economic Cooperation on March 11, 2002. Foreign investors are permitted to own up to 50% equity in value added telecommunications services enterprises which provide services committed by China in connection with its WTO accession and as specified in the Catalog.
 
The Provisions on the Administration of Foreign Invested Telecommunications Enterprises set forth the minimum capital requirements and approval procedures for establishing a foreign invested telecommunications enterprise. A foreign invested telecommunications enterprise providing value added telecommunications services in more than one province must have a registered capital of at least Renminbi (“Rmb”) 10 million. If a foreign invested telecommunications enterprise provides value added telecommunications services only within one province, the minimum registered capital is Rmb 1 million. “Within one province”, as interpreted by officials, apply to the providers who own servers located in only one province. The establishment of a foreign invested telecommunications enterprise must be approved by the Ministry of Information Industry. In addition, approval from the Ministry of Commerce or its relevant local counterpart is also required for such establishment.
 
All value added telecommunication service providers, whether foreign invested telecommunication enterprises or domestic companies, must obtain an operating permit from the Ministry of Information Industry or its relevant local counterpart. In July 2006, the Ministry of Information Industry issued a notice to regulate the cooperation between foreign investors and domestic operators of value-added telecommunications services (“Operating Companies”). The notice prohibits Operating Companies from leasing, transferring or reselling operating permits or provide resources, premises or facilities to foreign investors in any disguised form. Pursuant to the notice, the Operating Company or its shareholders must own the domain names and trademarks used in a value-added telecommunications business. The premises and infrastructure (such as servers), which the Operating Company requires for its business, must be located within the geographic area for which the Operating Company has obtained its permit to operate value-added telecommunications services.
 
Regulation of Publishing in China
 
The publication of print media (including newspapers, periodicals and books) is regulated in China. Different regulatory requirements apply to the editorial, publishing, advertising and distribution functions of print media. GAPP is the primary regulator for print media, but the State Administration of Industry and Commerce (“SAIC”) authorizes publishing houses to disseminate advertisements and regulates advertising agencies.
 
Publishing. Publishers of newspapers and periodicals must obtain a publication permit from GAPP before conducting publishing business. Newspaper and periodical publishers must be wholly state-owned entities; foreign investment is not permitted.
 
For each newspaper or periodical a publisher wishes to publish, it must obtain a “publication number” or kan hao. Such publication number will only be issued after examination and approval by GAPP. Pursuant to the publication number, the periodical would be permitted for publication and for domestic circulation and, in certain circumstances, for circulation overseas. Each kan hao is issued by GAPP for a particular publication for a specified frequency of publication, number of pages and circulation. A publisher may not change any of these elements without GAPP’s approval.
 
Foreign publishers are permitted to enter into copyright cooperation agreements with Chinese publishers. Under such agreements, the Chinese publisher, as holder of the kan hao, remains the publisher of the periodical and exercises a final review right with regard to all content included in the periodical. The foreign party to the cooperation agreement may provide
 
 
47

 
content to the Chinese publisher and license the foreign title to the Chinese publisher for inclusion on the cover page of the periodical. Copyright cooperation is not permitted for newspapers and for all other periodicals must be approved by GAPP. The legal framework for copyright cooperation is currently under review by the Chinese government.
 
Advertising. Publishers must obtain an advertising operating license from SAIC to be permitted to publish advertisements in newspapers or periodicals. Publishers may sell advertising space to advertisers either directly or through advertising agents. Advertising agency companies in China must be approved by SAIC. Foreign investors with two years operating history who conduct advertising operations may hold up to 70% equity interest in a Chinese advertising company. After December 11, 2005, foreign investors with three years operating history whose principal business is advertising may establish wholly foreign-owned advertising companies in China.
 
The Advertising Law of China requires that advertisements must be true and lawful and must not contain false information or deceive or mislead consumers. Advertisements must include specific information, which is listed in the Advertising Law, regarding the products or services they promote. Publishers and advertising agents are required to verify the content of advertisements and may be held liable for damages incurred by consumers as a result of deceptive or misleading information contained in advertisements. Publishers and advertising agents may also be subject to fines and confiscation of revenue by SAIC in relation to the publication of advertisements that violate the requirements under the Advertising Law.
 
Printing. Foreign investors are allowed to set up joint venture enterprises in China to engage in the business of the printing, packaging and decoration of publications and other printing products, provided that the enterprises must be majority-owned and controlled by the Chinese investors. For the investment to be approved, the foreign investor must be able to provide advanced printing methods and experience, advanced printing technology and equipment, and substantial funding. The Chinese investor must have direct or indirect printing operation management experience. If foreign-invested printing companies are commissioned by publishers to print publications, they must verify whether the publishing of such publications has been approved by the appropriate authorities; if they are commissioned to print publications intended to be distributed outside of China, such publications must be for export only and are not permitted to be distributed within China.
 
Distribution. Chinese law distinguishes between “general”, wholesale and retail distribution of print media. In principle, the publisher is also authorised to act as general distributor of the periodicals it publishes, or it may appoint a licensed general distribution company to exercise the right for it. The publisher may also appoint wholesale or retail distributors to perform all distribution functions on an exclusive or non-exclusive basis. Foreign-invested enterprises are allowed to engage in wholesale or retail distribution of books, newspapers and periodicals, but not in general distribution. To be authorized to establish distribution enterprises, both foreign and Chinese investors must have the capacity to distribute books, newspapers and periodicals. In April 2005, the Chinese government issued a notice permitting enterprises in which the State has at least 51-percent equity to engage in distribution. In August 2006, a notice issued jointly by several Chinese government departments, including GAPP, reiterated that foreign investment is prohibited in the general distribution of publications. Foreign investors must not disguise its investments in publishing or other propaganda-related businesses by operating activities such as publication distribution, printing or advertising.
 
 
48

 

4.C.                         Organizational Structure
 
Naspers Limited is the ultimate parent of the Naspers group. Its shares are listed on the JSE under the symbol “NPN”, and its ADSs are listed on the Nasdaq Stock Market under the symbol “NPSN”.
 
The following organizational chart presents a Naspers’ group structure and the legal ownership of some of Naspers’ significant subsidiaries, associated companies and joint ventures, by economic interest (excluding interests held by employee share trusts) as at September 15, 2006.
 
(1)
MultiChoice Africa (Proprietary) Limited is held directly by MIH Holdings. The pay-television operations in South Africa are conducted through MultiChoice Africa (Proprietary) Limited.
 
(2)
MultiChoice Africa Limited is held through MIH BV, a wholly-owned subsidiary of MIH Holdings, and owns interests in various subsidiaries that operate pay-television businesses in Sub-Saharan Africa.
 
(3)
The operations in Greece are conducted through NetMed Hellas and MultiChoice Hellas. NetMed Hellas is an indirectly owned subsidiary of MIH Holdings. NetMed, through Myriad Development BV, owns 96.4% of MultiChoice Hellas.
 
(4)
The operations in Cyprus are conducted through MultiChoice (Cyprus) Public Company Limited, of which 50.9% is owned by MultiChoice Cyprus Holdings Limited. NetMed has a 69.04% interest in MultiChoice Cyprus Holdings Limited.
 
(5)
M-Web (Thailand) is an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of MIH Holdings.
 
49


 
(6)
During July 2006, MIH acquired from Global and Antenna their shares in Netmed. MIH now owns 87.5% of Netmed and the remaining 12.5% is owned by Teletypos.
 
The following table presents each of Naspers’ significant subsidiaries (including direct and indirect holdings), the area of business, the country of incorporation and percentage of shares of each subsidiary owned by Naspers as of March 31, 2006.
 
Name of Subsidiary
Percentage Ownership(1)
Business
Country of Incorporation
Electronic Media
     
MIH Investments (Proprietary) Limited
100.0
Holding company
South Africa
MIH Holdings Limited
100.0
Holding company
South Africa
MIH (BVI) Limited
100.0
Holding company
British Virgin Islands
   Myriad International Holdings BV 
100.0
Holding company
The Netherlands
MultiChoice Africa (Proprietary) Limited
100.0
Pay-television operator in South Africa
South Africa
MultiChoice Africa Limited
100.0
Pay-television operator in Sub-Saharan Africa
Mauritius
NetMed NV
74.9(2)
Holding company in the Mediterranean
The Netherlands
NetMed Hellas SA
74.9(2)
Content provider in Greece
Greece
MultiChoice Hellas SA
44.9
Pay-television operator in Greece
Greece
   MultiChoice Cyprus Holdings Limited 
51.7
Holding company in Cyprus
Cyprus
MultiChoice (Cyprus) Public Company Limited
26.4
Pay-television operator in Cyprus
Cyprus
M-Web Holdings (Proprietary) Limited
100.0
Internet content provider in Africa
South Africa
M-Web (Thailand) Limited
100.0
Internet service provider in Thailand
Thailand
   Shanghai Sportscn.com Information Technology Company Limited
87.7
Online sport content provider in China
China
Irdeto Access BV
100.0
Pay-television content protection technology
The Netherlands
Entriq Inc.
100.0
Media management and protection technology
United States of America
Print Media
     
Media24 Limited
100.0
Print media
South Africa
Paarl Media Holdings (Proprietary) Limited
92.1
Printing
South Africa
   Touchline Media (Proprietary) Limited 
100.0
Magazine publishing
South Africa
   Boland Newspapers (Proprietary) Limited 
75.0
Newspaper publishing
South Africa
Via Afrika Limited
100.0
Book publishing
South Africa
Educor Holdings Limited
100.0
Adult training and higher education
South Africa
___________
 
(1)  
The percentage ownership refers to the effective ownership percentage of the group, excluding any shares held by stock compensation plans in the group.
 
(2)  
During July 2006, MIH acquired from Global and Antenna their shares in NetMed. MIH now owns 87.5% of NetMed and the remaining 12.5% is owned by Teletypos.
 

 
The following table presents each of Naspers’ significant joint ventures (including direct and indirect holdings), the area of business, the country of incorporation and percentage of shares in the joint venture owned by Naspers as of March 31, 2006.
 
Name of Joint Venture
Percentage Ownership(1)
Business
Country of Incorporation
Electronic Media
     
MNH Holdings (1998) (Proprietary) Limited
50.0
Holding company
South Africa
Electronic Media Network Limited
60.1
Pay-television content provider in Africa
South Africa
SuperSport International Holdings Limited
60.1
Pay-television content provider in Africa
South Africa
   Myriad International Programming Services BV 
80.0
Programme content acquisition
The Netherlands
 
 
   
Print Media
     
The Natal Witness Printing and Publishing Company
(Proprietary) Limited
 
50.0
Newspaper publishing and printing
South Africa
___________
 
 
50

 

(1)
The percentage ownership refers to the effective ownership percentage of the group, excluding any shares held by stock compensation plans in the group.
 
4.D.                 Property, Plant and Equipment
 
Naspers, Media24 and Via Afrika have their corporate offices in Cape Town. MIH Holdings has principal corporate offices in Hoofddorp (The Netherlands) and Johannesburg (South Africa).
 
The following table summarizes certain information regarding the principal facilities of the Naspers group as of August 31, 2006:
 
Description/Use
Location
(In South Africa, unless noted)
Size
m sqr
Owned/Leased
       
General & technology office (MIH & Irdeto) 
Hoofddorp, the Netherlands
7,136
Leased
Subscription television office (MultiChoice) 
Johannesburg
24,000
Leased
Subscription television decoder warehouse (MultiChoice)
Johannesburg
5,500
Leased
Subscription television regional office (MultiChoice)
Cape Town and Durban
4,380
Leased
Subscription television office (MultiChoice Cyprus) 
Nicosia, Cyprus
1,265
Leased
Subscription television office (NetMed) 
Athens, Greece
13,555
Leased
Corporate office (MIH China)
Beijing, China
881
Leased
Subscriber Internet Office (M-Web South Africa)
Cape Town
9,765
Leased
Subscriber Internet Office (M-Web Thailand)
Bangkok, Thailand
2,330
Leased
Subscriber Internet Office (Tencent)
Shenzhen, China
39,904
Leased
Subscriber Internet Office (Tencent)
Beijing, China
8,308
Owned
Technology Office (Entriq)
Carlsbad, USA
2,893
Leased
Technology Office (MediaZone)
Redwood City, USA
757
Leased
Technology Office (Irdeto)
Seattle, USA
2,062
Leased
Technology Office (Irdeto)
Seoul, Korea
945
Leased
Technology Office (Irdeto)
Beijing, China
2,379
Leased
General offices (Media24/Via Afrika)
Cape Town
32,500
Owned
Head office (Media24) 
Auckland Park, Johannesburg
5,500
Owned
Printing - City Deep (Media24) 
Johannesburg
8,835
Owned
Printing & offices (Media24) 
Milnerton, Cape Town
31,263
Owned
Printing & offices (Media24) 
Paarl
22,000
Owned
Printing & offices (Media 24)
Paarl
25,370
Owned
Printing & offices (Media 24)
Sandton
16,000
Owned
Printing & offices (Media 24)
Marlboro
16,500
Owned
Warehouse (On the Dot, Via Afrika)  
Bellville, Cape Town
25,973
Owned
Warehouse (Via Afrika)
Umtata
4,875
Owned
Damelin Braamfontein (Educor)
Johannesburg
10,569
Leased
Damelin Randburg (Educor)
Johannesburg
35,000
Leased
ICG offices (Educor) 
Cape Town
6,000
Owned
Milpark Business School (Educor) 
Johannesburg
14,479
Owned
ICG Gauteng (Educor)
Braamfontein
5,935
Leased

Environmental Matters
 
Naspers’ operations are subject to various environmental laws and regulations. Environmental legislation authorizes administrative bodies to impose certain control measures and may require businesses whose activities may have an impact on the environment, to obtain permits to legalize those activities. Non-compliance with such control measures and permits will generally lead to criminal or civil liability, as the case may be. In addition, South African environmental management legislation imposes a duty of care and remediation of environmental damage on every person who causes, has caused or may cause significant pollution or degradation of the environment, requiring these persons to take reasonable measures to prevent pollution or
 
 
51

 
degradation of the environment from occurring, continuing or recurring. Naspers has developed an environmental management policy that is applicable to all its business units, with the objectives of implementing and integrating an environmental management system in all of Naspers’ business activities. The policy provides for the compliance with all existing environmental legislation and internal standards. Naspers is in compliance in all material respects with all applicable environmental requirements. However, certain Naspers ongoing operations, particularly the printing business, may expose it to the risk of liabilities with respect to environmental matters, and material costs may be incurred in connection with such liabilities, if Naspers fails to comply with applicable environmental requirements.
 
While Naspers is not aware of any material environmental claims pending or threatened against it, and Naspers does not believe that it is subject to any material environmental remediation obligations, it cannot provide assurances that a material environmental claim or compliance obligation will not arise in the future.
 
 
52

 
 
ITEM 5.          OPERATING AND FINANCIAL REVIEW AND PROSPECTS
 
The following discussion and analysis of Naspers’ financial condition and results of operations should be read in conjunction with Naspers’ consolidated financial statements and related notes included elsewhere in this annual report.

The Naspers consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with IFRS, which differ in certain respects from U.S. GAAP. See note 39 to Naspers’ consolidated financial statements for a reconciliation between IFRS and U.S. GAAP with regard to Naspers’ net profit/(loss) and shareholders’ equity, and the related description of the principal differences between IFRS and U.S. GAAP as they relate to Naspers.
 
Factors affecting comparability of historical results of operations and financial condition

For the year ended March 31, 2005 Naspers prepared its financial statements under SA GAAP as effective at that date. In accordance with the JSE Listing Requirements, the group was required to prepare its first annual consolidated financial statements in accordance with IFRS for the year ended March 31, 2006. As the group publishes comparative information in its financial statements, the date for transition to IFRS is April 1, 2004, which represents the beginning of the earliest period of comparative information to be presented as required in terms of the requirements of the JSE and the SEC.
 
In order to describe the impact of IFRS on the group’s reported results of operations and financial position, the group has restated information previously published under SA GAAP to the equivalent basis under IFRS. This restatement is described in note 2 of the annual financial statements and follows the guidelines set out in IFRS 1. Accordingly, the US GAAP reconciliation of and for fiscal year ended March 31, 2005 has also been adjusted to reflect the adjustments between IFRS and the previously reported SA GAAP information.
 
5.A.                 Operating Results
 
Introduction
 
Naspers was incorporated in 1915 under the laws of the Republic of South Africa. Naspers is a multinational media company with principal operations in electronic media (including pay-television, internet and instant-messaging subscriber platforms and the provision of related technologies) and print media (including the publishing, distribution and printing of magazines, newspapers and books, and the provision of private education services). Naspers’ activities are conducted through subsidiaries, joint ventures and associated companies. Naspers’ most significant operations are located in South Africa, with other operations located in Sub-Saharan Africa, Greece, Cyprus, China, Brazil, The Netherlands and the United States. The activities undertaken by Naspers’ business segments are described below.
 
Electronic Media
 
Pay-television
 
In Africa, MultiChoice Africa and MultiChoice South Africa provide television and subscriber management services to analog and digital pay-television platforms in countries throughout Africa and the adjacent Indian Ocean islands, and South Africa, respectively. The pay-television services comprise a variety of DTH digital satellite television (DStv) bouquets (the term used to describe the channels offered by a pay-television provider on a given platform) and terrestrial analog networks. The digital service in South Africa consists of approximately 74 video channels, eight data channels, 40 audio music channels and 25 radio channels. The digital service in Sub-Saharan Africa and adjacent islands consists of approximately 75 video channels, eight data channels and up to 65 audio channels.
 
The aggregate subscriber base in Africa (including South Africa) was approximately 1.64 million as of March 31, 2006 (2005: 1.48 million). The pay-television market in South Africa is now relatively mature, with approximately 1.25 million households as of March 31, 2006 (2005: 1.14 million). The digital base in Africa (including South Africa) grew by 188,182 subscribers to 1,417,309 in fiscal 2006 and now accounts for 87% of the total number of our subscribers on the African continent. Growth in revenue from digital subscribers was in part offset by the churn in analog subscribers.
 
M-Net and SuperSport continue to play a role in growing the subscriber base through the delivery of premium thematic channels and exclusive content. M-Net has output deals with film and television studios, enabling it to screen the best quality movies, series and miniseries. M-Net compiles 15 channels for broadcast across the African continent. SuperSport produces
 
 
53


 
three 24 hour-a-day channels for DStv, covering more than 100 genres of sport. SuperSport has a pan-African sports channel, focusing mainly on football. The channel screens South African Premier Football League and various Confederation of African Football games, English Premier League, Italian Serie A and Bundesliga football. Extensive coverage of South African and international rugby, cricket, golf and tennis is offered on other SuperSport channels.
 
MultiChoice Africa also has direct investments with fully staffed offices for pay-television services in Zambia, Nigeria, Ghana, Uganda, Kenya and Tanzania, and MultiChoice South Africa in Namibia and Botswana.
 
In the Mediterranean, NetMed operates analog and digital platforms in Greece and Cyprus. The total number of pay-television subscribers for the Mediterranean region amounted to 374,451 households as of March 31, 2006 compared to 363,739 households as of March 31, 2005. In October 2001, Alpha Digital entered the pay-television market in Greece and launched a 20-channel digital pay-television service. This contributed to the decline in the analog subscriber base in Greece during fiscal 2002 and 2003. In September 2002, Alpha Digital entered liquidation leaving NetMed as the sole pay-television operator in Greece. However, NetMed’s subscriber numbers did not fully recover when the commercial television company, AST, took over Alpha Digital’s contract with the majority of A Division Greek football teams. During fiscal 2006, the analog base in Greece declined by 22,732 to 71,994 households, while, Nova (the digital television service), maintained its leading position in the region by increasing its subscriber base from 209,312 as of March 31, 2005 to 239,536 as of March 31, 2006.
 
Technology
 
Naspers’ subsidiary, Irdeto, provides content protection solutions to subscriber platform operators and other providers of valuable digital content. Irdeto has been providing encryption technology for more than 30 years, and specializes in designing, developing and marketing end-to-end solutions to manage and protect content from unauthorized access in both the television broadcast and internet environments. Irdeto provides conditional access products to 194 customers in more than 40 countries, and has issued approximately 21 million smartcards to subscribers. Smartcards are credit card-size devices with embedded processors that provide entitlement functions and store decryption keys and digital signatures that are inserted in set-top boxes for access to subscription television services.
 
Naspers’ subsidiary Entriq, which is in the early phase of development, offers products and services to fill the needs of pay media clients while guiding them into broadband and attracting the business of new broadband-specific players. Entriq is actively pursuing customers looking to sell and protect content on the internet. As broadband penetration increases and related access prices decrease, the opportunities in this sector will grow.
 
Internet
 
M-Web Holdings has developed a leading position in the African internet market, ending fiscal 2006 with approximately 300,000 dial-up subscribers, 44,000 ADSL broadband subscribers and 1,262 leased-line clients. M-Web Holdings’ “anytime, anywhere” philosophy enables its subscribers to access its content platforms via television, internet and wireless technologies.
 
M-Web (Thailand), Naspers’ internet platform in Thailand, is the leading local content service provider in Thailand and consists of nine consumer focused web sites.
 
Naspers’ principal investment in China is a 36.1% interest in Tencent, a provider of innovative community, real-time communications, entertainment, content and wireless and professional services based on the market leading consumer instant messaging platform known as “QQ”. Platform services are also deployed in Taiwan, Hong Kong, Macau, Japan and Thailand.
 
Print media
 
Newspapers, magazines and printing
 
Media24, Naspers’ print media subsidiary, publishes, prints and distributes a large number of newspapers and magazines in Southern Africa. Media24 has office and printing facilities in Cape Town, Bloemfontein, Port Elizabeth, Paarl and Johannesburg, and distribution facilities and infrastructure located throughout South Africa. Media24 publishes more than 50 newspaper and 57 magazine titles.
 
 
54


 
Books
 
Via Afrika is a leading South African book publisher, seller and distributor of innovative and quality reading, learning, listening and viewing products in various formats and provider of private education services. Via Afrika controls a number of different businesses operating as independent business units in three segments. The publishers and agents division includes general, religious, educational and academic publishers as well as digital content providers. The traders and distributors division includes traditional niche academic and religious bookstores, book and music clubs, online retailing as well as warehousing and distribution services.
 
Private education
 
The education segment includes Damelin and ICG, who offer face-to-face full-time, part-time and block release educational programs, as well as e-learning and distance learning education and training programs at its campuses and training centers across South Africa. These services are available for distance, secondary and higher education learning and corporate training.
 
Operating Results
 
A key strategy of the Naspers group over the past years has been to seek opportunities in global markets to ensure growth in its electronic media platform business segment for television, internet and interactive services. Consequently, losses have been incurred as MIH Holdings invested heavily in these businesses in an effort to increase growth. Naspers incurred operating losses for each of the four fiscal years ended March 31, 2002. In fiscal 2003, Naspers returned to profitability with an operating profit of Rand 226.3 million, and during fiscal 2005 and 2006 Naspers made further progress with operating profits of Rand 2,469 million and Rand 3,004 million, respectively, as the profitability of Naspers’ pay-television businesses in its electronic media segment improved. Global or local economic challenges may impact the level of future operating profits.
 
Naspers’ operating results are affected by a number of factors, including the number of households subscribing to its pay-television platform and internet access services, the circulation of its newspapers and magazines, the number of students enrolling for educational courses, the level of advertising across its various media products, the number of books published and sold, seasonality, general economic conditions, competition, regulatory developments and fluctuations in foreign exchange rates. Foreign exchange rates can have an effect on Naspers’ reported earnings as it generates revenues predominantly in the local currencies of the countries in which it operates, while a substantial portion of its expenses are incurred in U.S. dollars and Euros.
 
Revenues. Revenues comprise pay-television and internet subscription revenue (52.4%), hardware sales (3.2%), technology revenue (2.5%), circulation revenue (5.8%), advertising revenue (15.9%), printing and distribution fees (5.7%), revenue from the publishing and sale of books (5.5%), tuition fees (3.1%), e-Commerce revenue (1.9%) and other revenues (4.0%). Naspers’ primary source of revenue is pay-television services, internet services and the advertising in and selling of magazines and newspapers. Hardware sales relate to revenue generated from the sale and maintenance of set-top boxes. Technology revenues include revenue generated from conditional access systems. Circulation revenue includes the cover price revenue received from the sale of newspapers and magazines. Advertising revenues include revenue received for advertisements placed in Naspers’ newspapers, magazines, internet sites and on its pay-television platforms. Printing and distribution revenue consists mainly of fees received from the printing and distribution of newspapers, magazines, books and related products. Tuition fees include the course fees paid by students to participate in the various educational courses and programs offered by Educor. Other revenues include mainly revenue relating to the sale of rights to backhaul charges and certain e-commerce services.
 
Cost of Providing Services and Sales. The cost of providing services and sales includes programming content, editorial and content, subscriber management, set-top box purchase, transmission, printing, distribution and teaching costs. Programming costs include the cost of licensing third party programs and the production cost of programs produced by the Naspers group, as well as the amortization of programming rights for sporting events and films. Editorial and content costs include the cost of acquiring content from third party content providers for the Naspers group’s internet services, books, magazines and newspapers, as well as the employment and related costs of journalists employed by Naspers and other content creators. Subscriber management costs include the direct cost of servicing and maintaining equipment installed at subscribers’ homes and the cost of providing customer service. Set-top box purchase costs include the purchase of set-top boxes by Naspers for use or resale to customers. Transmission costs consist of transmission, uplinking and backhauling charges paid by subsidiaries in the Naspers group to various satellite vendors under operating lease agreements. Printing costs include raw materials such as paper and ink, and other direct costs relating to the printing process. Distribution costs include storage costs and the costs relating to operating a large delivery vehicle
 
 
55

 
fleet. Teaching costs include mainly employment and related costs of Educor’s lecturers and teachers who run Educor’s educational programs and courses, and the related course material costs.
 
Selling, General and Administration Expenses. These costs include overhead costs from various departments such as marketing, public relations, subscriber sales, warehousing, information systems, finance and accounting, accounts receivable, accounts payable and human resources departments.
 
Depreciation and Amortization. These costs include charges relating to the amortization of intangible assets arising from acquisitions and the depreciation of Naspers’ tangible property, plant and equipment, including buildings, transponders, set-top boxes, manufacturing plant and equipment, vehicles and office equipment and assets under capital leases (mainly satellite leases). These charges are allocated between cost of providing services and sales and selling, general and administration expenses.
 
Critical Accounting Policies
 
Naspers’ consolidated financial statements include the financial position, results of operations and cash flows of Naspers and its subsidiaries. These financial statements are prepared in conformity with IFRS and include a reconciliation of consolidated net profit and consolidated shareholders’ equity to their equivalents under U.S. GAAP. IFRS and U.S. GAAP require management to make estimates that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses. Naspers evaluates its estimates, including those related to tangible and intangible assets, bad debts, inventories, provisions and income taxes, on an ongoing basis. Naspers bases its estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that management believes to be reasonable under the circumstances. These estimates form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. Actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions or conditions.
 
Naspers believes that the following accounting policies used in preparation of its financial statements prepared in accordance with IFRS are its critical accounting policies as they require management to make estimates that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses. All of these critical accounting policies have been discussed with the audit committee.
 
Revenue recognition
 
Subscription fees. Pay-television and Internet subscription fees are earned over the period the services are provided. Subscription revenue arises from the monthly billing of subscribers for pay-television and internet services provided by the Group. Revenue is recognized in the month the service is rendered. Any subscription revenue received in advance of the service being provided is recorded as deferred revenue and recognized in the month the service is provided. Naspers believes that the accounting policy relating to the recognition of subscription fees is a critical accounting policy as subscription related revenue accounts for approximately 52.4% of Naspers’ total revenue.
 
Software Development Contracts. Revenue from software development contracts of less than six months’ duration is recognized using the completed contract method and for longer-term contracts generally using the percentage of completion method. Under the percentage of completion method, the extent of progress towards completion is measured based on actual costs incurred as a proportion of total estimated costs which are based on the total cost of previous projects. Provisions for estimated losses on uncompleted contracts are made in the period in which estimated losses are determined. Revenues from integration services and software development contracts are included in other revenues.
 
Licenses. Naspers recognizes product license revenue upon shipment of the related product to a third-party if a signed contract exists, delivery has occurred, the fee is fixed and determinable and collection of the resulting receivable is probable.
 
Mobile and Telecommunications Value-added Services. Naspers recognizes mobile and telecommunications value-added services revenues based on the full amount of fees charged to end-users by mobile operators after the operators’ adjustments for uncollectible fees and after deducting the applicable business tax and related taxes. In general, uncollectible fees arise due to end-user payment delinquencies or “dropped messages”. We recognize revenue from mobile and telecommunications value-added services on an accrual basis as the services are rendered. As noted below, Naspers relies on information provided by mobile operators in their periodic statements for final billing, settlement and collection of revenues, which is normally received between 15 and 90 days after each month-end. For revenues not supported by final confirmation from the mobile operators at the time of reporting our financial results, we estimate the amounts based on the number of subscriptions and the volume of data transmitted between our network gateway and the mobile operators’ network gateways as confirmed by the operators. Management estimates
 
 
56

 
utilize the most recent three-month history of revenues actually derived from the operations and incorporate developing trends in customer payment delinquencies. Specifically, management estimates revenue performance based on the following factors:
 
·     
the operational raw data captured by the network gateway, which is the system capturing the transaction flows, and the server capturing the subscriber database maintained by the group. The gateway records each single transaction processed by the mobile operators while the database maintains the number of subscribers of the group;
 
·     
the monthly fixed subscription rates for certain services;
 
·     
the expected billable transaction volume; and
 
·     
the expected delinquency rates experienced in the most recent three month period.
 
Based on these factors, if revenues are not supported by the periodic final confirmations received from network operators, management estimates the amount of revenues for services rendered in a reporting period. The revenue estimation procedures are applied by management for each province or city in which the group has operations.
 
If actual revenues based on the final confirmations subsequently received from the mobile operators are higher or lower than the estimated amounts, due to routine adjustments or deactivation of customer accounts, adjustments are made in revenue in the period the final confirmations are received. To date, Naspers has not experienced any material discrepancies between the estimated revenues and the actual revenues. The actual remittance to us by mobile operators of our shares of the fees after all adjustments is typically 30 to 90 days after services are rendered.
 
Internet Value-added Services. Naspers recognizes revenue from internet value-added services similar to revenue from Mobile and Telecommunications Value-added Services described above. With respect to revenues collected for pre-paid services, revenues are deferred and recognized over the estimated consumption period on a straight-line basis.
 
Naspers believes that its revenue recognition policies are critical accounting policies as the recognition of revenue involves in many instances estimates and assumptions to be made.
 
Doubtful accounts
 
Naspers reviews its doubtful accounts on a monthly basis for estimated losses resulting from the inability of its customers to make the required payments. The Naspers group’s customer base is dispersed across many geographic areas and is primarily residential in nature. Naspers generally does not require collateral from its customers.
 
The Naspers group analyzes, among other things, historic bad debt experience, customer credit worthiness, current economic trends in each country where its customers are located and customer payment history when evaluating the adequacy of the allowance for doubtful accounts. If the financial condition of the Naspers group’s customers was to deteriorate, resulting in an impairment in their ability to make payments, additional charges may be required. The estimate may also change if the Naspers group experiences service failures or the number of disputes with customers increases.
 
Naspers believes that the accounting estimate relating to doubtful accounts is a critical accounting estimate because changes in the estimated level of doubtful debts may materially affect net profit. The estimate for doubtful accounts is a critical accounting estimate for all of Naspers’ businesses. The net bad debt expense as a percentage of sales over the last couple of fiscal years was approximately 0.5%. A 0.1% increase in bad debt expense as a percentage of sales would decrease operating profit by approximately Rand 15.7 million.
 
Useful lives of property, plant and equipment
 
Naspers calculates depreciation of property, plant and equipment on a straight-line basis so as to write off the cost of the assets over their expected useful lives less the residual value. The economic life of an asset is determined based on existing physical wear and tear, economic and technical ageing, legal or other limits on the use of the asset and obsolescence. If some of these factors were to deteriorate materially, impairing the ability of the asset to generate future cash flows, Naspers may accelerate depreciation charges to reflect the remaining useful life of the asset or record an impairment loss.
 
Leased transponders and transmitters, which are held in the electronic media—pay-television segment, represent approximately 32.8% (2005: 39.8%) of Naspers’ property, plant and equipment as of March 31, 2006. All of the Naspers group’s
 
 
57

 
 
current transponder leases are capitalized and amortized over their expected useful life because the term of the lease covers at least 75% of the transponder’s estimated useful life.
 
The useful life of satellite transponders depends upon various factors. These factors include the success of the launch and the amount of fuel required for the satellite to be placed in the correct orbital location. In addition, various factors can impact on a transponder satellite’s useful life once it is in orbit. Satellites are, however, designed with operational redundancies that may minimize or eliminate service disruptions if a critical system fails. These may include backup and separate on-board propulsion systems, backup transponders and conservative system margins. Naspers obtains information on the satellites’ useful lives from information provided publicly by the satellite service providers and this information forms the basis for determination of potential impairment. However, in most cases contractual terms in the satellite lease agreements stipulate remedial measures that should be taken by the provider should a satellite fail to operate as intended.
 
Naspers considers this to be a critical accounting policy because any material change in the useful lives of Naspers’ property, plant and equipment would impact Naspers’ ability to generate future cash flows, depending on the asset, would have a material impact of the value of the property, plant and equipment stated on Naspers’ balance sheet and may decrease Naspers’ profitability. Naspers has had no significant changes in useful lives or book values of property, plant and equipment in recent years.
 
Valuation of goodwill and intangible assets
 
Naspers amortizes intangible assets with finite useful lives on a straight-line basis so as to write off the cost of the assets over their expected useful life. Goodwill is tested annually for impairment and allocated to cash-generating units for the purpose of impairment testing. The Naspers group also evaluates the carrying value of its tangible and intangible assets whenever indicators of impairment exist.
 
Naspers believes that the accounting estimate relating to asset impairment is a critical accounting estimate because it is highly susceptible to change from period to period because it requires Naspers’ management to make assumptions about future sales volumes and the cost of providing services over the life of the asset and discount rates for media-based businesses in emerging markets and recognizing an impairment could have a material impact on the value of the intangible assets reported on the Naspers group’s balance sheet and the level of its net profit. Management’s assumptions about future sales volumes, prices and discount rates involve significant judgment as some of Naspers’ businesses are in the start-up phase and consequently actual sales prices and volumes have fluctuated in the past and are expected to continue to do so in the future.
 
Goodwill is tested annually for impairment under both IFRS and U.S. GAAP. The goodwill impairment test under U.S. GAAP is performed by comparing the carrying value of each reporting unit to its fair value, which is based on discounted cash flows or market value of listed companies, whereas under IFRS, impairment is determined by comparing the carrying value of the cash-generating unit with its recoverable amount. The discount rates applied to the cash flows, the growth rate to extrapolate the cash flows and the basis for determining the recoverable amount are disclosed per cash-generating unit in note 6 to the consolidated annual financial statements. Naspers believes that the accounting estimate relating to goodwill impairment is a critical accounting estimate because, similar to the assessment of other intangible assets, the discounted cash flows are highly susceptible to change from period to period because it requires Naspers’ management to make assumptions about future sales volumes and the cost of providing services over the life of the goodwill and discount rates for media-based businesses in emerging markets and recognizing an impairment could have a material impact on the value of the goodwill reported on the Naspers group’s balance sheet and the level of its net profit.
 
Business acquisitions
 
Naspers accounts for its business acquisitions under the purchase method of accounting. The total value of consideration paid for acquisitions is allocated to the underlying net assets acquired, based on their respective estimated fair values determined by the group using internal or external valuations. The Naspers group uses a number of valuation methods to determine the fair value of assets and liabilities acquired including discounted cash flows, external market values and others and believes that it uses the most appropriate measure or combination of measures to value each asset or liability. In addition, the group believes that it uses the most appropriate valuation assumptions underlying each of these valuation methods based on the current information available including discount rates, market risk rates, entity risk rates, cash flow assumptions and others. The accounting policy for valuation of business acquisitions is considered critical because the judgments made in determining the estimated fair value and expected useful lives assigned to each class of assets and liabilities acquired can impact the value of the asset or liability, including the impact on deferred taxes, the respective amortization periods and ultimately net profit. Therefore, the use of other valuation
 
58

 
methods, as well as other assumptions underlying these valuation methods, could impact the determination of the financial position and results of operations.
 
Inventory obsolescence
 
Naspers values its inventories, which consist mainly of raw materials (paper and ink), finished products (books) and set-top boxes and associated components, at the lower of cost or expected net realizable value, based on assumptions about future demand, market conditions and the useful life of the set-top boxes used by the Naspers group. Naspers monitors inventory levels periodically based on the expected usage of such inventory. If actual market conditions prove to be less favorable than those projected by management, additional inventory write downs may be required. No significant inventory write downs were made during the financial years ended March 31, 2006 or 2005. Naspers believes that its policy relating to inventory write downs is a critical accounting policy due to the assumptions and estimates that management is required to make in the determination of the expected realizable value of inventories.
 
Income taxes
 
Naspers records the estimated future tax effect of temporary differences between the tax bases of its assets and liabilities and the amounts reported in Naspers’ consolidated balance sheet for such assets and liabilities, as well as the future tax effect of operating losses and tax credit carry forwards. The Naspers group follows specific and detailed guidelines regarding the recoverability of any tax assets recorded on the balance sheet. Naspers assesses the probability that there will be adequate future taxable income generated to utilize the benefits relating to the deferred tax assets. If circumstances change, or if the expected level of future taxable income is not generated, Naspers would reassess the recoverability of the deferred tax assets recorded in its balance sheet, which could lead to a write-down of such assets.
 
A valuation allowance is recorded to reduce deferred tax assets to the amount that is probable to be realized. Naspers considers future taxable income, ongoing prudent and feasible tax strategies and the timing of reversals of assets and liabilities in determining the need for a valuation allowance. If Naspers determines that in the future it will be able to realize deferred tax assets in excess of the net recorded amount of deferred tax assets stated on its balance sheet, the resulting adjustment to the stated amount of deferred tax assets would increase income in the period that such determination was made.
 
Naspers considers this to be a critical accounting policy because if in the future the value of the deferred tax asset is determined to be less than or exceeds the recorded amount, there could be a material adjustment to the deferred tax asset stated on Naspers’ balance sheet as well as a material impact on Naspers’ net profit.

During fiscal 2005, Naspers released valuation allowances against certain deferred tax assets in its Greek pay-television and South African book publishing operations, since it determined that the underlying future expected profitability will be such that it is probable that the deferred tax assets will be realized. The release of valuation allowances during fiscal 2005 resulted in the creation of additional net deferred taxation assets in the Greek pay-television business and South African book publishing operations of Rand 412.9 million and Rand 56.7 million, respectively. This did not recur to the same extent during fiscal 2006. As at March 31, 2006, Naspers has raised an aggregate valuation allowance against deferred taxation assets of Rand 727.4 million (2005: Rand 919.1 million). The timing and the amounts to be released from the valuation allowance or the creation of additional valuation allowances in the future is uncertain, as it mainly depends on the future profitability of the various business units to which these allowances relate.

Legal matters
 
Naspers is involved in legal disputes through its normal course of business. The outcome of these legal claims can have a material impact on Naspers’ balance sheet as well on Naspers’ net income. Naspers’ management estimates the potential outcome of these legal claims based on the most objective evidence on hand from internal and external legal advisors until such time that ultimate legal resolution has been finalized. Due to the uncertain nature of these issues, any changes in these estimates based on additional information as it becomes available could result in material changes to the financial statements in subsequent periods. As at March 31, 2006, Naspers has provided Rand 24.5 million (2005: Rand 25.9 million) for pending litigation matters. For more detail on these matters refer to “Item 8.A. - Legal Proceedings”.
 
 
59

 
 
 
Post-retirement medical liability
 
The group operates a number of post-retirement medical benefit schemes. The group provides for post-retirement medical aid benefits using the Projected Unit Credit method prescribed by IAS19,“Employee benefits”. Future benefits valued are projected using specific actuarial assumptions and the liability for in-service members is accrued over expected working lifetime. The liability is calculated by considering some key actuarial assumptions such as (1) the rate of healthcare cost inflation, (2) discount rate, (3) percentage members continuing after retirement and (4) average retirement age of members. The key actuarial assumptions made are disclosed in note 18 to the consolidated financial statements.

Any change in these assumptions could result in a material adjustment to the post-retirement medical liability stated on Naspers’ balance sheet as well as a material impact on Naspers’ net profit. A one percentage point increase in the rate of health care cost inflation would increase the post-retirement medical liability by approximately Rand 25.1 million, where as a one percentage point reduction in the rate of health care cost inflation would decrease the liability by Rand 17.6 million as at March 31, 2006. An average retirement age of one year younger than the assumed average retirement age will increase the liability by Rand 1.8 million, where as a one year older average age would result in a reduction of Rand 1.7 million in the liability at March 31, 2006.
 
Equity compensation benefits
 
The group grants share options/share appreciation rights (SARs) to its employees under a number of equity compensation plans. In accordance with IFRS 2, the group has recognised an employee benefit expense in the income statement, representing the fair value of share options/SARs granted to the group’s employees. A corresponding credit to equity has been raised for equity-settled plans, whereas a corresponding credit to liabilities has been raised for cash-settled plans. The fair value of the options/SARs at the date of grant under equity-settled plans is charged to income over the relevant vesting periods, adjusted to reflect actual and expected levels of vesting. For cash-settled plans, the group re-measures the fair value of the recognised liability at each reporting date and at the date of settlement, with any changes in fair value recognised in profit or loss for the period
 
Naspers considers this to be a critical accounting policy because any material change in the assumptions used to estimate the fair value of the share options/SARs issued could have a material impact on the value of the equity reserve or share-based payment liability stated on Naspers’ balance sheet as well as a material impact on Naspers’ net profit. Naspers has had no significant changes in the assumptions used to estimate the fair value of share options/SAR’s issued since the adoption of IFRS 2.
 
Currency policies
 
Naspers’ functional currencies are generally the local currencies of the countries in which it operates (currency of the primary economic environment), except for pay-television businesses in certain African countries where the functional currency is the U.S. dollar. Monetary assets and liabilities in currencies other than functional currencies are translated based on the exchange rates prevailing at year-end. Any resulting exchange rate gains or losses are included in current results. Exchange rate gains and losses relating to hedge transactions are recognized in net earnings in the same period as the exchange differences on the items covered by the hedge transactions. Hedged items that meet the hedging criteria set forth in IAS 39 and FAS 133 receive similar treatment under both IFRS and U.S. GAAP. Gains and losses on transactions that do not meet the hedging criteria are marked-to-market and reflected in the profit or loss for each respective period.
 
On consolidation, assets and liabilities of subsidiaries denominated in foreign currencies are translated to Rand based on the exchange rates prevailing at fiscal year-end. Income and expense items are translated using annual weighted average rates of exchange or, where known or determinable, at the exchange rate on the date of the transaction.
 
Goodwill and fair value adjustments arising on the acquisition of a foreign entity are treated as local currency assets and liabilities of the foreign entity and are translated at exchange rates prevailing at the time the transaction is completed. Adjustments arising from currency translations are recorded in shareholders’ equity and are reflected in net earnings only upon sale or liquidation of the underlying investments.
 
Naspers operates internationally and is exposed to foreign exchange risk arising from various currency exposures primarily with respect to the Rand and Euro against the U.S. dollar. Although a substantial portion of the Naspers group’s revenue is denominated in the currencies of the countries in which it operates, a significant portion of the group’s cash obligations, including payment obligations under satellite transponder leases and contracts for pay-television programming and channels, are denominated in U.S. dollars. Where Naspers’ revenue is
 
 
60

 
 
denominated in local currency such as Rand or Euro, a depreciation of the local currency against the U.S. dollar adversely affects Naspers’ earnings and its ability to meet its cash obligations.
 
Historically, the performance of the Rand against other currencies has been characterized by periods of rapid depreciation (by more than the inflation rate) followed by periods of stability. In particular, the Rand rapidly depreciated against the U.S. dollar and other major currencies during the latter part of 2001. Since December 2001, the Rand appreciated against the U.S. dollar and at March 31, 2006, the exchange rate was Rand 6.15 per U.S. $1.00. At September 15, 2006, the exchange rate was Rand 7.38 per U.S. $1.00.
 
Some companies in the Naspers group use forward contracts to hedge their exposure to foreign currency risk in the local reporting currencies. At the Naspers group level, external foreign exchange contracts are designated as hedges of foreign exchange risk on specific assets, liabilities or future transactions.
 
The Naspers group hedges the foreign currency exposure of its contractual commitments to purchase goods, services and film rights mainly in U.S. dollars and Euros. The forward contracts typically expire within one to two years, consistent with the related contractual commitments. Naspers generally hedges all major exposures in foreign currencies to an amount between 80% and 100% of the contract value.
 
Results of Operations
 
The following table is derived from our audited consolidated financial statements as at and for the years ended March 31, 2006 and 2005 which have been prepared in accordance with IFRS, and sets forth the results of Naspers’ operations for the periods indicated:
 
   
Year ended March 31
 
       
2005
 
2006
 
   
(Rand in millions)
 
Revenues:
             
Electronic media
             
Pay-television
     
7,746.6
 
8,903.3
 
Internet
     
696.3
 
898.0
 
Conditional access
     
255.3
 
352.3
 
Entriq
         
33.9
   
65.9
 
Print media
                   
Newspapers, magazines and printing 
         
3,374.1
   
3,983.1
 
Books 
         
860.6
   
980.9
 
Education 
         
547.2
   
536.3
 
Corporate services 
         
3.9
   
(13.4
)
Total revenues, net
         
13,517.9
   
15,706.4
 
                     
Operating expenses:
                   
Cost of providing services and goods 
         
(7,725.8
)
 
(8,753.7
)
Selling, general and administrative 
         
(3,311.5
)
 
(3,948.7
)
Other gains/(losses) - net 
         
(11.7
)
 
 
                     
Operating profit 
         
2,468.9
   
3,004.0
 
                     

61



Operating profit/(loss) analyzed by business segment:
         
Electronic media
         
Pay-television
 
2,119.9
 
2,785.4
 
Internet
 
(67.6)
 
(152.6)
 
Conditional access 
 
(46.5)
 
(0.4)
 
Entriq
   
(89.2
)
 
(165.2
)
Print media
             
Newspapers, magazines and printing 
   
528.2
   
612.1
 
Books 
   
52.8
   
66.8
 
Education 
   
22.6
   
(83.8
)
Corporate services 
   
(51.3
)
 
(58.3
)
Operating profit
   
2,468.9
   
3,004.0
 
               
Finance costs, net 
   
(217.0
)
 
(11.4
)
Share of equity accounted results 
   
88.6
   
151.3
 
Profit/(loss) on sale of investments 
   
(0.3
)
 
74.4
 
Dilution profits 
   
368.0
   
 
Profit before tax 
   
2,708.2
   
3,218.3
 
Taxation 
   
(256.5
)
 
(934.8
)
Profit/(loss) after tax 
   
2,451.7
   
2,283.5
 
Minority interest 
   
(116.9
)
 
(157.2
)
Profit/(loss) from continuing operations 
   
2,334.8
   
2,126.3
 
Loss from discontinuing operations 
   
50.0
   
31.8
 
Profit arising on discontinuing of operations 
   
   
1,032.1
 
Net profit for the year 
   
2,384.8
   
3,190.2
 

 
Results of Operations: 2006 Compared to 2005
 
Revenues
 
Total revenues increased by Rand 2,188.5 million, or 16.2%, to Rand 15,706.4 million during fiscal 2006 from Rand 13,517.9 million in fiscal 2005. The increase in revenues arose mainly as a result of increased subscription revenues, advertising revenues and book publishing and sales. The depreciation of the Rand in fiscal 2006 against the U.S. dollar had a positive impact on Naspers’ revenue earned outside of South Africa when reported in Rand. The Rand appreciated against the U.S. dollar from Rand 6.211 at March 31, 2005 to Rand 6.149 at March 31, 2006, a 1.0% appreciation. The average exchange rate between the Rand and the U.S. dollar for fiscal 2006 was approximately Rand 6.392 compared to Rand 6.215 for fiscal 2005, representing a depreciation against the dollar of 2.8%.
 
The table below sets out revenues by revenue type:
 
   
Year ended March 31,
 
   
2005
 
2006
 
   
(Rand in millions)
 
           
    Subscription 
 
7,136.2
 
8,236.7
 
    Hardware sales 
   
436.6
   
510.3
 
    Technology 
   
280.9
   
390.7
 
    Circulation 
   
796.8
   
915.1
 
    Advertising 
   
2,035.9
   
2,489.9
 
    Printing and distribution  
   
752.3
   
891.2
 
    Book publishing and sales 
   
709.8
   
856.9
 
    Tuition fees 
   
480.4
   
485.9
 
    e-Commerce revenue 
   
229.7
   
304.3
 
    Other revenue 
   
659.3
   
625.4
 
    Total revenues, net 
   
13,517.9
   
15,706.4
 


62


Subscription revenues. Subscription revenues increased by Rand 1,100.5 million, or 15.4%, from Rand 7,136.2 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 8,236.7 million in fiscal 2006. The increase was mainly a result of growth in the number of subscribers to the group’s pay-television services, an increase in subscription prices and the continued migration of pay-television subscribers from the analog system to the higher margin digital system.
 
Naspers’ digital pay-television subscribers in South Africa increased by 137,747, or 15.4%, to 1,033,093 subscribers at March 31, 2006 from 895,346 subscribers at March 31, 2005. The analog pay-television subscribers in South Africa decreased by 35,085 subscribers, or 13.9%, from 252,525 at the end of fiscal 2005 to 217,440 subscribers at March 31, 2006. The reduction in the number of analog subscribers in fiscal 2006 resulted primarily from Naspers’ strategy of migrating customers from analog to digital service. Where an analog subscriber converts to the digital service, the subscriber must purchase a digital signal set-top box, a smartcard and a satellite dish. Naspers estimates that approximately 11.2% of the connections to digital pay-television service in South Africa in fiscal 2006 resulted from subscribers migrating from analog to digital service. An increasing number of first-time pay-television customers purchase the digital service rather than purchasing analog service initially and then subsequently migrating to digital service.
 
The growth in digital subscriber numbers, the migration from the analog to digital service and a subscription price increase were the main factors allowing the South African region to grow its subscription revenues by Rand 694.4 million, or 17.6%, during fiscal 2006 from Rand 3,950.1 million to Rand 4,644.5 million. Prices of pay-television subscriptions were increased during fiscal 2006. This increase in subscription prices increased revenues by approximately Rand 205.6 million, or 5.2%. The increase in revenue derived from the migration of subscribers from analog to digital service, without taking account of any incremental price increase, is approximately Rand 31.3 million, or 0.8%. The increase in the number of new digital subscribers contributed approximately Rand 216.0 million or 5.5% to the increased level of subscription revenue.
 
Digital pay-television subscribers in Sub-Saharan Africa increased by 50,435, or 15.1%, during fiscal 2006 from 333,781 to 384,216 subscribers at the end of fiscal 2006. The analog pay-television subscription base in Sub-Saharan Africa decreased by 1,554 subscribers during fiscal 2006 to 819. Subscription revenue increased by Rand 255.6 million, or 19.3%, to Rand 1,583.1 million in fiscal 2006 from Rand 1,327.5 million in fiscal 2005. Subscription prices in Sub-Saharan Africa are either charged in U.S. dollars or its equivalent in the respective local currencies, and therefore, the depreciation in the average Rand exchange rate against the U.S. dollar during fiscal 2006 by 2.8% had a positive impact on subscription revenues when reported in Rand. In U.S. dollar terms subscription revenue in the Sub-Saharan Africa region increased by 15.9%.
 
Pay-television subscribers for the Mediterranean region (Greece and Cyprus) amounted to 374,451 households at the end of fiscal 2006 compared to 363,739 households at the end of fiscal 2005. The analog subscriber base in Greece showed a decline of 22,732 subscribers, or 23.9%, to 71,994 from 94,726 subscribers at the end of fiscal 2005, mainly due to the migration of analog subscribers to the digital service. The digital service maintained its leading position in the region by increasing its subscriber base by 14.4%, or by 30,224 subscribers, from 209,312 subscribers at March 31, 2005 to 239,536 at March 31, 2006. The subscribers to the analog service in Cyprus decreased by 8,330 subscribers, or 16.4%, to 42,552 at March 31, 2006 from 50,882 at March 31, 2005. This decrease in the analog base is mainly the result of the launch in fiscal 2005 of a digital service in Cyprus. The subscribers to the digital service increased by 131.0%, or by 11,550 subscribers, from 8,819 subscribers at March 31, 2005 to 20,369 at March 31, 2006.
 
Subscription revenue for the Mediterranean region increased by Rand 63.6 million, or 5.2%, to Rand 1,283.1 million for fiscal 2006 from Rand 1,219.5 million for fiscal 2005. This increase was mainly caused by the growth in digital subscribers, as well as a subscription price increase in October 2005, but was dampened by the appreciation of the Rand against the Euro during fiscal 2006. Subscription prices in Greece and Cyprus are charged in Euro and Cypriot pound, respectively, and therefore, the appreciation in the average Rand to Euro exchange rate during fiscal 2006 by 1.1% had a negative impact on subscription revenues when reported in Rand. In Euro terms, the subscription revenue in the Mediterranean region increased by 6.4%.
 
In South Africa, the number of internet subscribers remained static at approximately 344,000. In general, the number of internet subscribers in South Africa has shown slow growth due to high telephone costs and the high cost of broadband services. Subscription revenues in South Africa increased in fiscal 2006 by Rand 194.6 million, or 46.1%, to Rand 616.5 million from Rand 421.9 million at the end of fiscal 2005. This increase was mainly attributable to the acquisition of the additional subscribers from the Tiscali internet business during the latter portion of fiscal 2005.
 
 
63

 
 
Subscription revenue relating to subscribers of the group’s magazines and newspapers increased in fiscal 2006 by Rand 7.1 million, or 6.4%, from Rand 110.4 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 117.5 million. This increase was mainly due to circulation growth achieved by the group’s newspapers and magazines, cover price increases and an increased marketing focus on new newspaper and magazine subscriptions.  
 
Hardware sales. Hardware sales increased by Rand 73.7 million, or 16.9%, to Rand 510.3 million during fiscal 2006 from Rand 436.6 million in fiscal 2005. Hardware sales were primarily generated in Africa and the Mediterranean region. Hardware sales in Africa increased by Rand 84.2 million, or 23.0%, to Rand 450.1 million in fiscal 2006 from Rand 365.9 million in fiscal 2005. Hardware sales in the Mediterranean region decreased by Rand 10.6 million, or 15.0%, to Rand 60.1 million in fiscal 2006 from Rand 70.7 million in fiscal 2005. The decrease in this region is due to lower selling prices as a result of outsourcing digital installations. The South African Revenue Service (“SARS”) is currently investigating the base costs used by MultiChoice South Africa in determining its ad valorem taxes payable to the SARS for set-top boxes. The case is pending at the High Court and the outcome of this investigation is still uncertain.
 
Technology revenues. Technology revenues increased by Rand 109.8 million, or 39.1%, to Rand 390.7 million during fiscal 2006 from Rand 280.9 million in fiscal 2005. This increase was mainly due to Irdeto increasing its revenues from Rand 255.3 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 352.3 million in fiscal 2006 due to the increase in volume of both smartcard shipments and new customer growth. Naspers expects market conditions to remain highly competitive in the near future with continued pressure on technology margins and revenues.
 
Circulation revenues. Circulation revenues from newspaper and magazine sales increased by Rand 118.3 million, or 14.8%, to Rand 915.1 million in fiscal 2006 from Rand 796.8 million in fiscal 2005. The increase in revenue was mainly due to increases in the cover prices of newspapers and magazines and due to the growth in recently launched magazine and newspaper titles.
 
Circulation revenue from Naspers’ newspapers increased by Rand 137.6 million, or 38.9%, from Rand 353.4 million in fiscal 2005, to Rand 491.0 million in fiscal 2006. Circulation revenue increased mainly due to the growth in circulation of the daily tabloid newspaper, Daily Sun, as well as, Soccer Laduuuuuma. Daily Sun reached an average circulation figure for the period July 2005 to December 2005 of 444,061 copies per day, up from an average circulation figure of 364,356 per day in the corresponding period in the prior year. Soccer Laduuuuuma increased its circulation over the same period to an average of 288,882 per week, from an average of 244,509 in the corresponding period in the prior year. Naspers expects the circulation of its titles aimed at the emerging black market in South Africa, Daily Sun and Sunday Sun, to continue their growth path in the foreseeable future, albeit at a slower rate of growth. Circulation of the established Afrikaans daily newspapers Die Burger and Volksblad, and the Afrikaans Sunday title, Rapport, remained fairly stable.
 
Circulation revenue from Naspers’ magazines increased by Rand 60.6 million, or 13.7%, from Rand 443.4 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 504.0 million in fiscal 2006. Although there was a slight decline in circulation numbers of the mass-market general interest family titles (e.g., Huisgenoot and You), these titles still have the highest circulation of all Naspers’ magazine titles. New niche magazine titles Leef met hart en siel, tuis/home and Move! grew circulation and contributed positively towards circulation revenue in fiscal 2006.
 
Advertising revenues. The Naspers group increased advertising revenues by Rand 454.0 million, or 22.3% from Rand 2,035.9 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 2,489.9 million in fiscal 2006. In fiscal 2006, approximately 50.8% and 25.4% of the Naspers group’s advertising revenues were earned by its newspapers and magazines. The Naspers group’s newspapers increased advertising revenue by 23.2% in fiscal 2006 to Rand 1,265.0 million and magazines increased advertising revenue for the same period by 14.2% to Rand 633.0 million. Advertising revenue from newspapers and magazines is expected to remain fairly stable in the near future. Advertising revenues from television increased during fiscal 2006 by 23.4% to Rand 539.6 million. Television advertising revenue is expected to remain stable in the foreseeable future. The closure of the open-time window of M-Net from April 1, 2007 could however negatively impact advertising revenue in fiscal 2008. Advertising revenues from the internet reached Rand 24.0 million in fiscal 2006, mainly from advertising revenue earned from Media24 Digital.
 
Printing and distribution revenue. Revenue from the printing and distribution of magazines, newspapers and related products increased by Rand 138.9 million, or 18.5%, to Rand 891.2 million for fiscal 2006 from Rand 752.3 million for fiscal 2005. Growth in revenue is mainly due to increases in printing rates and increased volumes of magazine printing. Printing revenue on its own increased to Rand 751.4 million in fiscal 2006 from Rand 654.8 million in fiscal 2005. Media24 increased its distribution revenue from Rand 97.5 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 139.8 million in fiscal 2006. Distribution revenue increased with the increase in the distribution of external publications and the growth in the On the Dot distribution division.
 
 
64

 
 
Book publishing and sales revenue. Revenue earned from the publishing and sale of books increased by Rand 147.1 million to Rand 856.9 million in fiscal 2006 from Rand 709.8 million in fiscal 2005. This increase in revenue was mainly due to increased sales of educational material and improved sales at the academic retail outlets.
 
Tuition fees. Tuition fees from private education programs and courses increased by Rand 5.5 million, or 1.1%, from Rand 480.4 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 485.9 million in fiscal 2006. This was mainly due to a decline in student numbers in the face-to-face business, as the business repositioned itself in the market away from higher education to further education and training.
 
e-Commerce revenue. e-Commerce revenues increased by Rand 74.6 million or 32.5% from Rand 229.7 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 304.3 million for the year ended March 31, 2006. The internet businesses saw growth in e-commerce related products, hosting services, mail services and mobile content revenues.
 
Other revenues. Other revenues decreased by Rand 33.9 million, or 5.1%, to Rand 625.4 million in fiscal 2006 from Rand 659.3 million in fiscal 2005. Other revenue mainly consists of revenue earned from selling excess satellite capacity, set-top box repair and maintenance, ticket sales, sale of scrap paper and student financing services.
 
The following is a discussion of revenues by segment as defined and set out in the notes to Naspers’ consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this annual report. The analysis is based on Naspers’ primary reporting format under IFRS. Naspers’ method of internal reporting disaggregates its businesses by service or product. The information set forth below is also summarized in the table directly under the heading “Results of Operations”.
 
Electronic Media—Pay-television. Revenues increased by Rand 1,156.7 million, or 14.9%, from Rand 7,746.6 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 8,903.3 million for the year ended March 31, 2006. Growth in subscription revenue was mainly driven by the continued migration of subscribers from analog to digital service, subscription price increases and the overall growth in the number of subscribers by 162,255 across the various pay-television platforms. The Electronic Media—Pay-television segment’s revenues were further increased by the growth in advertising revenue in the year ended March 31, 2006 by Rand 102.3 million, or 23.4%, from Rand 437.3 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 539.6 million.
 
Electronic Media—Internet. Revenues increased by Rand 201.7 million, or 28.9%, to Rand 898.0 million in fiscal 2006 from Rand 696.3 million in fiscal 2005. This increase is mainly a result of the acquisition of the South African internet business of Tiscali International BV on February 1, 2005. M-Web South Africa increased its revenue contribution by Rand 327.2 million, or 60.5%, to Rand 868.4 million in fiscal 2006 from Rand 541.2 million in fiscal 2005. During fiscal 2005, the group changed the accounting for its interest in Tencent from proportionate consolidation to equity accounting. Tencent contributed Rand 106.9 million to the segment’s revenue in fiscal 2005.
 
Electronic Media—Conditional access. Irdeto, the content security solution business, reported record shipments of almost six million units leading to revenues increasing by Rand 97.0 million, or 38.0%, from Rand 255.3 million during fiscal 2005 to Rand 352.3 million for the year ended March 31, 2006. Irdeto recently acquired a competitor, Philips CryptoTec and continued its expansion into the rapidly developing mobile TV segment. Its agreement with TU Media in Korea is the first such mobile TV service launched in the world. Irdeto will capitalize on its lead by further developing its technology for safeguarding content in the broadband, internet and mobile environment.
 
Electronic Media—Entriq. The consumption of broadband media on the internet is becoming the dominant form of internet use. This has lead to Entriq’s revenue increasing by Rand 32.0 million, or 94.4%, from Rand 33.9 million during fiscal 2005 to Rand 65.9 million for the year ended March 31, 2006. Major clients that Entriq has secured include NBC, Viacom, MTV, ProSieben and the Intel ViiV-platform. Entriq has also developed a broadband product, MediaZone, which aggregates and offers niche content to the market for subscription.
 
Print Media—Newspapers, Magazines and Printing. Revenues increased from Rand 3,374.1 million for the year ended March 31, 2005 to Rand 3,983.1 million for the year ended March 31, 2006, which represents a Rand 609.0 million, or 18.0%, increase. The increase in revenue was mainly due to increased advertising revenue, which increased by Rand 351.7 million, or 22.0%, to Rand 1,950.3 million in fiscal 2006 from Rand 1,598.6 million in fiscal 2005. Circulation revenue increased by Rand 118.4 million, or 14.9%, from Rand 796.7 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 915.1 million in fiscal 2006. The net additional contribution in fiscal 2006 of printing and distribution revenue, e-Commerce revenue and other revenue, mainly being revenue from ad-hoc contract publishing, amounted to Rand 131.5 million.
 
Print Media—Books. Revenues increased by Rand 120.3 million, or 14.0%, from Rand 860.6 million in the year ended March 31, 2005 to Rand 980.9 million in fiscal 2006. This growth in revenue was mainly due to increased sales volumes achieved by Via Afrika’s school book publisher, Nasou Via Afrika.
 
 
65

 
 
Print Media—Education. Revenues decreased from Rand 547.2 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 536.3 million in fiscal 2006, which represents a Rand 10.9 million, or 2.0%, decrease. This was mainly due to reduced student numbers as the business repositioned itself in the market.
 
Operating expenses
 
The cost of providing services and goods increased by Rand 1,027.9 million, or 13.3%, from Rand 7,725.8 million for the year ended March 31, 2005 to Rand 8,753.7 million in fiscal 2006. The increase relates mainly to the growth in revenues of 16.2% which was offset by costs decreasing in the electronic media - pay television and electronic media - conditional access segments.
 
Programming costs for MultiChoice South Africa increased by Rand 277 million, or 14.3%, from Rand 1,935.9 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 2,212.9 million for the year ended March 31, 2006. This increase was mainly due to the increase in digital subscribers in South Africa to 1,033,093 as at March 31, 2006 from 895,346 as at March 31, 2005. The programming costs per digital subscriber are higher than per analog subscriber, due to the fact that a digital subscriber receives many more channels than an analog subscriber. In Sub-Saharan Africa programming costs increased by Rand 105.1 million, or 21.5%, from Rand 488.8 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 593.9 million in fiscal 2006. The increase was mainly due to increased programming costs relating to the growth in digital subscribers from 333,781 subscribers at the end of fiscal 2005 to 384,216 at the end of fiscal 2006. Future trends in these costs will depend largely on the foreign currency exchange rate between the Rand and the U.S. dollar and the growth in the number of subscribers and the subscription rate payable per subscriber.
 
In the Mediterranean region, programming costs increased by Rand 20.9 million, or 3.6%, to Rand 600.3 million in fiscal 2006 from Rand 579.4 million in fiscal 2005. This increase was offset by other costs of providing services that decreased by Rand 36.2 million, or 11.5%, to Rand 279.7 million in fiscal 2006 from Rand 315.9 million in fiscal 2005. This decrease relates mainly to Euro 6.5 million costs awarded in the settlement of litigation.
 
The cost of set-top box sales in South Africa increased by Rand 112.5 million, or 36.5%, to Rand 420.8 million in fiscal 2006 from Rand 308.3 million in fiscal 2005. This increase was due to sales of the personal video recorder (PVR) which was introduced into the market in October 2005. In Sub-Saharan Africa the cost of set-top box sales decreased by Rand 12.1 million during fiscal 2006 to Rand 110.7 million. This was mainly due to a reduction in the cost of set-top boxes. In the Mediterranean region the cost of set-top box sales decreased to Rand 81.8 million in fiscal 2006 from Rand 86.8 million in fiscal 2005. This 5.8% decrease is due to the outsourcing of digital installations.
 
Irdeto’s cost of providing services in the electronic media segment increased by 21.7%, or Rand 22.0 million, from Rand 101.4 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 123.4 million in fiscal 2006, predominantly due to an increase in the volume of units, both smart cards and surface mounted (smart cards in a microchip form) sold.
 
Entriq’s cost of providing services in the electronic media segment more than doubled from Rand 11.7 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 25.2 million in fiscal 2006 with selling, general and administration costs increasing from Rand 132.1 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 213.3 million in fiscal 2006 mainly as a result of increased development activity. Substantial investment is expected in the short term to consolidate on the progress that Entriq has achieved in its technologies.
 
Cost of providing services in the print media - newspapers, magazines and printing segment increased during the financial year ended March 31, 2006 by Rand 1,195.5 million or 56.5% from Rand 2,114.4 million for the financial year ended March 31, 2005 to Rand 3,309.9 million. This increase is mainly due to the increase in circulation of new newspaper and magazine titles launched during the last couple of years, such as the Daily Sun, Son and Weg. Editorial costs also increased due to the increase in the number of titles published by Media24.
 
Book publishing costs increased by 14.9% to Rand 620.6 million due to strong growth in sales volumes of school text books during fiscal 2006.
 
Costs to provide tuition services increased by Rand 19.4 million, or 7.5%, to Rand 277.0 million in fiscal 2006 mainly due to increased regulatory costs associated with accrediting institutions as well as registration of courses.
 
Selling, general and administrative costs increased by Rand 637.2 million, or 19.2%, from Rand 3,311.5 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 3,948.7 million in fiscal 2006. This increase was primarily due to staff costs which increased by Rand 459.6 million or 18.5% from Rand 2,487.5 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 2,947.1 million in fiscal 2006. The depreciation in the value of
 
66

 
the average Rand exchange rate against the U.S. dollar further increased the costs denominated in U.S. dollar when translated into Rand.
 
Depreciation, amortization and impairment charges increased in the aggregate by Rand 129.5 million, or 20.6%, to Rand 758.9 million in fiscal 2006 from Rand 629.4 million in fiscal 2005.
 
Depreciation expense increased by Rand 40.0 million from Rand 555.5 million to Rand 595.5 million. Amortization expense for other intangible assets increased by Rand 38.3 million to Rand 95.7 million for fiscal 2006 from Rand 57.4 million in fiscal 2005. This is mainly as a result of the reassessment of the carrying values of individual items of property, plant and equipment and other intangible assets in terms of the requirements of IFRS 1 at the date of transition to IFRS. These adjustments have changed the previously recorded carrying values and subsequent depreciation and amortization charges for fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005. A new printing plant was also commissioned during fiscal 2006.
 
Naspers recognized impairment losses on goodwill of Rand 69.0 million during fiscal 2006 compared to Rand 8.0 million during fiscal 2005. The impairment charges were due to the fact that the recoverable amounts of certain cash-generating units that were based on value-in-use discounted cash flow calculations were less than their carrying amounts. The goodwill impairments related to the electronic media - pay television segment (Rand 9.1 million) and the print media - books (Rand 4.0 million) and education segments (Rand 55.9 million). Similar impairments relating to other intangible assets amounted to Rand 0.8 million during fiscal 2006 compared to Rand 5.0 million for fiscal 2005.
 
Operating profit
 
An operating profit of Rand 3,004.0 million was achieved during fiscal 2006 compared to Rand 2,468.9 million for fiscal 2005. This is a result of the combined effect of the foregoing factors.
 
Electronic Media—Pay-television. Operating profit amounted to Rand 2,785.4 million in fiscal 2006, which represented an increase of Rand 665.5 million, or 31.4%, over operating profit of Rand 2,119.9 million in fiscal 2005. This increase is primarily a result of the continued growth in the digital subscriber base together with price increases and cost reduction initiatives. The pay-television platform in the Mediterranean more than doubled operating profits from Rand 169.6 million in fiscal 2005 to an operating profit of Rand 344.2 million in fiscal 2006.
 
Electronic Media—Internet. Operating losses increased by Rand 85.0 million, or 125.7%, from Rand 67.6 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 152.6 million for fiscal 2006. The internet segmental results for the current year exclude Tencent as this investment is now equity accounted. The prior year figures included Tencent’s operations for three months to June 2004. The increase in operating losses can mostly be attributed to the development of the internet portal business in Thailand and Sportscn in China. The internet operation in South Africa remains profitable.
 
Electronic Media—Conditional access. Operating losses decreased by Rand 46.1 million from Rand 46.5 million during fiscal 2005 to Rand 0.4 million in fiscal 2006, mainly due to record shipments reported of approximately six million units.
 
Electronic Media—Entriq. Operating losses increased by Rand 76.0 million from Rand 89.2 million during fiscal 2005 to Rand 165.2 million in fiscal 2006, mainly due to extensive investment in content protection, subscriber management technologies and application service provider services for broadband markets. Substantial investment is expected in the short term to consolidate on the progress that Entriq has achieved in its technologies.
 
Print Media—Newspapers, Magazines and Printing. Operating profit increased from Rand 528.2 million for fiscal 2005 to Rand 612.1 million in fiscal 2006, which represents a Rand 83.9 million, or 15.9%, increase. This increase in profitability was mainly due to strong growth in advertising revenue generated by the newspaper and magazine divisions and increased profitability in the printing division.
 
Print Media—Books. Operating profits increased by Rand 14.0 million from Rand 52.8 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 66.8 million in fiscal 2006. The increase in profitability was mainly due to improved trading conditions experienced in the school text book market.
 
Print Media—Education. Operating profit of Rand 22.6 million for fiscal 2005 decreased to an operating loss of Rand 83.8 million for the year ended March 31, 2006, mainly as a result of goodwill impairment of Rand 55.9 million and the repositioning of Damelin.
 
 
67

 
 
Finance costs, net
 
Net finance costs include interest paid on borrowings and finance leases, interest received on cash balances, preference dividends received, profits and losses on foreign exchange transactions and fair value adjustments on derivative instruments (mainly foreign exchange contracts). Net finance costs decreased by Rand 205.6 million, or 94.7%, to Rand 11.4 million during fiscal 2006 from Rand 217.0 million in fiscal 2005.
 
This decrease is primarily a result of the decrease in fair value adjustments on derivative financial instruments and the increase in interest received on cash balances. Naspers uses foreign exchange contracts to hedge mainly U.S. dollar and Euro programming, satellite leases and paper costs of its South African businesses. Where foreign exchange contracts entered into by Naspers do not meet the criteria for hedge accounting as stipulated by IAS39 under IFRS, changes in the fair value are calculated at each balance sheet date and any changes in their fair values are accounted for through the income statement. These fair value adjustments relating to foreign exchange contracts amounted to a loss of Rand 57.7 million in fiscal 2006 compared to a loss of Rand 167.7 million in the year ended March 31, 2005. The reason for the decrease is mainly due to the reduction in the volatility of the Rand exchange rate against the U.S. dollar during fiscal 2006. The average exchange rate between the Rand and the U.S. dollar amounted to 6.392, 6.215 and 7.161 for the fiscal years 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively, therefore reducing the change in the fair value of the foreign exchange contracts year to year. The level of foreign exchange contracts entered into by Naspers also decreased during fiscal 2006 from U.S. dollar 159.5 million as at March 31, 2005 to U.S. dollar 150.4 million as at March 31, 2006. This will continue to decrease in fiscal 2007 as certain of the major programming contracts are now Rand denominated. The profit relating to the fair value adjustments for embedded derivatives within the group’s programming contracts increased from a profit of Rand 58.8 million in fiscal 2005 to a profit of Rand 63.9 million in fiscal 2006, due to the reduction in the volatility of the Rand exchange rate against most major currencies like the U.S. dollar and the Euro. Overall the impact of fair value adjustments on derivative instruments changed to a profit of Rand 6.2 million in fiscal 2006 from a loss of Rand 108.9 million in fiscal 2005.
 
Included in finance costs are also net profits on foreign exchange transactions relating to the capitalization of finance leases in the electronic media—pay-television segment of Rand 49.2 million. Naspers capitalizes lease obligations where they meet certain capitalization criteria including where the term of the lease is greater than 75% of the leased asset’s useful life. The result of this accounting treatment is that a liability equal to the present value of the future lease payments is stated on the balance sheet, and at the inception of the lease an equivalent asset is stated on the balance sheet and depreciated over its estimated useful life. These lease liabilities are mostly denominated in U.S. dollars or Euro. Naspers accounted for a net profit on foreign exchange transactions relating to such transponder leases, due to the fact that the exchange losses relating to lease payments made during fiscal 2006 were less than the aggregate unrealized translation exchange gains on the capital outstanding over the period. Net foreign exchange differences increased by Rand 23.9 million from a profit of Rand 2.1 million during fiscal 2005 to a loss of Rand 21.8 million in fiscal 2006. This increase in foreign exchange losses was mainly due to the fact that the Rand depreciated against the U.S. dollar during fiscal 2006 and appreciated against the U.S. dollar in fiscal 2005.
 
Interest paid decreased from Rand 286.3 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 275.3 million in fiscal 2006. This decrease was mainly due to lower levels of borrowings by the South African operations. Imputed interest charges on the capitalized finance lease liabilities increased by Rand 3.3 million, due to the depreciation in value of the Rand against the U.S. dollar during fiscal 2006 compared to fiscal 2005. The average level of bank overdrafts and interest-bearing loans during fiscal 2006 was also lower than in fiscal 2005.
 
Interest received increased by Rand 103.4 million from Rand 176.1 million for fiscal 2005 to Rand 279.5 million in fiscal 2006, mainly due to higher average cash balances during fiscal 2006.
 
Share of equity accounted results
 
Naspers’ equity results in associated companies increased by Rand 62.7 million to Rand 151.3 million during fiscal 2006 from Rand 88.6 million in fiscal 2005. The increase relates mainly to the change in accounting for the group’s interest in Tencent. Naspers proportionately consolidated its interest in Tencent until June 16, 2004, the date of Tencent’s IPO when the group’s ownership percentage was diluted, and subsequently equity accounted for its stake. Tencent contributed Rand 150.2 million to the equity accounted results during fiscal 2006.
 
 
68


Profit/(loss) on sale of investments and dilution profits
 
Profit on sale of investments consists mainly of the sale of the group’s investment in Computicket that realized a profit of Rand 56.7 million. There were no transactions of a dilutive nature during fiscal 2006.
 
Taxation
 
Income tax increased by Rand 678.3 million to Rand 934.8 million during fiscal 2006 from Rand 256.5 million in fiscal 2005. The increase relates partly to the increased profitability of the group and partly to the creation of deferred taxation assets in fiscal 2005 of Rand 469.6 million which reduced the taxation charge in that year. During fiscal 2005, due to improved profitability and expected future taxable profit, valuation allowances against deferred taxation assets of Rand 412.9 million and Rand 56.7 million relating to the pay-television business in Greece and the South African book publishing business respectively, were released against income. The valuation allowance against deferred taxation assets decreased by Rand 191.7 million from Rand 919.1 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 727.4 million in fiscal 2006 mainly due to the release of the valuation allowance related to UBC in Thailand which was sold during fiscal 2006. Secondary taxation on companies decreased from Rand 37.8 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 21.2 million in fiscal 2006, due to the increase in dividend income for the group.
 
Minority interest
 
Minority interest was a charge of Rand 157.2 million for the year ended March 31, 2006 compared to a charge of Rand 116.9 million in fiscal 2005. The increase in the minority interest charge relates mainly to the Sub-Saharan pay-television businesses and the South African print media operations.
 
Discontinued operations
 
During fiscal 2006, the group sold its entire interest in UBC and MKSC to True Corp. for a cash consideration of approximately Rand 999.3 million. A profit on discontinuance of operations of Rand 1,032.1 million was realized on the transaction. The results of these operations were previously included in the pay-television and internet segments of the group. Total profit from discontinuing operations during fiscal 2006 amounted to Rand 31.8 million and Rand 50.0 million in fiscal 2005.
 
Net profit
 
As a result of the foregoing factors, Naspers recorded a net profit of Rand 3,190.2 million during fiscal 2006, compared with a profit of Rand 2,384.8 million for fiscal 2005.
 
5.B.                 Liquidity and Capital Resources
 
Naspers’ business and growth strategy has in the past required substantial capital for acquisitions, expansion of services, the financing of operating losses and working capital in the internet businesses and technology businesses. The requirement for externally generated funding has reduced substantially over fiscal 2006 as the profitability and cash generation of the group’s subscriber-based businesses increased.
 
Naspers relies upon distributions from its subsidiaries, associated companies, joint ventures and other investments to generate the funds necessary to meet the obligations and other cash flow requirements of the combined group. The ability of Naspers to utilize the cash flows from some of its subsidiaries, joint ventures and associated companies is subject, in South Africa and other countries, to foreign investment and exchange control laws and also the availability of a sufficient quantity of foreign exchange. In particular, the cash flow generated by the Naspers group’s South African pay-television and other businesses cannot currently be utilized outside South Africa without exchange control approval. While such restrictions have been liberalized in recent years, the ability of a South African company to raise and deploy capital outside South Africa remains subject to restrictions.
 
The operations of Naspers were funded in various ways in past fiscal years. The internet and technology businesses were primarily funded by cash generated by the pay-television businesses, and some debt financing. Media24 used its balance sheet and its capacity to generate cash to incur debt to finance its property, plant and equipment refurbishment and certain acquisitions. Via Afrika and Educor used their respective balance sheets to fund operations via debt. Naspers has also provided funding to Educor and Via Afrika, to assist those businesses through the seasonal nature of their operations and the resulting inconsistent cash flows.
 
 
69

 

Naspers and its subsidiaries did not undertake any major capital raisings in the past two fiscal years. As of March 31, 2006, Naspers had total debt (including finance leases and program and film broadcasting rights) of approximately Rand 4.42 billion, or U.S. $598.9 million. Naspers’ ratio of debt to equity as of that date was 0.61.
 
Naspers’ general business approach has been to acquire developing businesses and inject cash into those businesses sufficient to meet the cash needs of the business until it can, within a predictable period of time, become self-funding. This general approach was especially evident during fiscal 2002 in the technology and internet businesses. The focus since the 2003 fiscal year was more on increasing profitability and cash generation and with less of an emphasis on developing new business initiatives. The focus on increased profitability and cash flow generation will continue in the foreseeable future, although Naspers will continue to actively evaluate potential growth opportunities within its areas of expertise. Naspers may grow its business in the future through the acquisition of developing companies and making equity investments in developing companies. Naspers anticipates that it may fund future acquisitions and investments through issuances of debt or equity and available cash resources.
 
The Naspers group’s print media business is currently self-funding. The group’s book publishing and private education businesses are expected to only require modest levels of working capital funding from Media24 due to the seasonality of those businesses. The pay-television businesses in South Africa and Sub-Saharan Africa are currently self-funding. The pay-television businesses in Greece returned to profitability in fiscal 2005 and generated positive free cash flow for the first time. The pay-television business in Greece should not require any additional funding in the next year based on its current business plans. The technology businesses will require additional funding during fiscal 2007, due to increased development activities within Irdeto and Entriq. The internet businesses in Thailand, Africa and China continued to require funding in fiscal 2006 and are expected to require further funding during fiscal 2007. Tencent completed an IPO during June 2004, is profitable and generates free cash flow and will therefore not require any additional funding in the foreseeable future.
 
The Naspers group’s net cash from operating activities increased by Rand 798.5 million to Rand 3,166.4 million for fiscal 2006 from Rand 2,367.9 million for fiscal 2005. The improvement relates mostly to the increased cash generated by the pay-television businesses in South Africa, Sub-Saharan Africa and Greece and the print media businesses in South Africa.
 
Cash from operating activities (after working capital) increased to Rand 4,019.9 million in fiscal 2006 from Rand 3,051.3 million for fiscal 2005. The increase was driven by the increase in profitability of the pay-television and print media businesses as well as a decrease in the investment in working capital of Rand 336.5 million during fiscal 2006 when compared to fiscal 2005. The movement in working capital items like accounts receivable, inventory, program and film rights and accounts payable can have a significant influence on the level of cash generated from operations during a fiscal year.
 
Operating cash flows in the group are mainly derived from underlying subscription revenues, circulation, distribution and printing revenues and advertising revenues. Such subscription revenues represent 52.4% of the group’s revenue. Because the group currently has a growing level of subscribers and low churn in its pay-television and internet businesses, it provides a solid and predictable base for future operating cash flows. The overall circulation levels of newspapers and magazines in South Africa have been stable, thus providing solid cash flows from circulation, printing and distribution activities (11.5% of revenue). Advertising revenue is a much more volatile source of operating cash flow, as it is generally much more sensitive to changes in economic conditions. Advertising revenue, however, only amounts to 15.9% of the group’s total revenue, and therefore, the group’s exposure to advertising revenue volatility is somewhat limited.
 
Net finance costs paid during the year ended March 31, 2006 were reduced to Rand 78.5 million, compared to Rand 214.9 million in the financial year ended March 31, 2005. The reduction was mostly due to increased levels of cash on hand in the group which increased by Rand 2,741.7 million from March 31, 2005 to March 31, 2006. Interest received on loans and bank balances increased by Rand 103.4 million from fiscal 2005 to fiscal 2006 and interest paid decreased by Rand 11.0 million over the same period. Bank overdrafts were reduced by Rand 68.6 million over the same period.
 
Dividends paid by Naspers to its shareholders increased to Rand 208.9 million in fiscal 2006 from Rand 105.6 million in fiscal 2005. This was due to the increase in the dividend per Class N ordinary share to 70 cents in fiscal 2006 from 38 cents in the previous year. Dividends paid by subsidiaries to minority shareholders in the group increased in fiscal 2006 to Rand 127.0 million from Rand 98.4 million in fiscal 2005. The shareholders of Naspers approved a dividend of 120 cents per Class N ordinary share and 24 cents per Class A ordinary share at the annual general meeting on August 25, 2006. The dividend payable to Naspers shareholders during fiscal 2007 is therefore expected to be approximately Rand 378.3 million.
 
Taxation paid during fiscal 2006 increased by Rand 347.2 million to Rand 821.7 million. This increase in tax paid is due to the increased profitability of the pay-television and print media segments.
 
 
70


 
In the year ended March 31, 2006, net cash used in investing activities amounted to Rand 335.4 million compared to Rand 877.1 million in the corresponding period ended March 31, 2005. The decrease of Rand 541.7 million is due mainly to the net effect of an increase in capital spending of Rand 232.1 million less proceeds from the sale of UBC and MKSC of Rand 751.8 million. Naspers engaged in the following major cash investing activities during fiscal 2006:
 
Naspers invested Rand 809.7 million on property, plant and equipment during fiscal 2006, mainly relating to the acquisition of printing equipment in the print media - newspapers, magazines and printing segment (Rand 587.1 million) and computer and other equipment in the electronic media - pay-television segment (Rand 220.9 million). Currently budgeted capital expenditure (including commitments under contracts already in place at March 31, 2006 of Rand 445.4 million) amounts to Rand 1,094.8 million for the year ended March 31, 2007. The capital expenditure relates mainly to increasing the printing capacity and the establishment of new printing facilities in South Africa and elsewhere on the continent. Naspers does not expect to incur any other significant additional capital expenditures, other than those already budgeted for, during the next twelve months or the foreseeable period thereafter based on its current business plans.
 
An amount of Rand 180 million was used to acquire an additional 7.5% interest in Paarl Media Holdings (Proprietary) Limited. The group also used approximately Rand 44.2 million to acquire 100% of the equity of Orbicom (Proprietary) Limited during fiscal 2006.
 
The group disposed of its investment in Computicket (Proprietary) Limited for a cash consideration of approximately Rand 69.0 million during fiscal 2006. The group also sold its entire interest in UBC and MKSC during January 2006 for a cash consideration of approximately Rand 999.3 million.
 
Included in the investing activities cash flows, is an outflow of Rand 106.8 million relating to the acquisition of certain intangibles assets during fiscal 2006 and a cash inflow of Rand 46.0 million from the sale of certain items of property, plant and equipment.
 
Net cash from financing activities was Rand 24.5 million for the financial year ended March 31, 2006 compared to net cash utilized of Rand 513.7 million in fiscal 2005. The repayment of capitalized finance leases, mostly satellite lease liabilities, amounted to Rand 268.1 million for the year ended March 31, 2006, compared to Rand 369.0 million in fiscal 2005. Naspers received approximately Rand 167.0 million during fiscal 2006 from the sale of Naspers Class N ordinary shares by its equity compensation plans to participants of the plans. Naspers raised approximately Rand 460.9 million through long-term debt during fiscal 2006 compared to Rand 29.7 million in fiscal 2005.
 
At March 31, 2006 and March 31, 2005, Naspers had combined cash balances of Rand 6,775.5 million and Rand 4,033.8 million, respectively, and available unused overdraft borrowing facilities of Rand 1,806.7 million as at March 31, 2006. Some of these cash balances are restricted from immediate use according to agreements with banks and other financial institutions. A total amount of Rand 237.8 million was restricted at March 31, 2006, compared to Rand 58.1 million at the same time during fiscal 2005. Bank overdrafts and short-term loans decreased from Rand 433.3 million at the end of fiscal 2005 to Rand 364.8 million at March 31, 2006. Naspers is further restricted by exchange control regulations in various countries that it operates in, which can prohibit it from transferring its cash from one country to another. Most of the bank overdraft facilities and call loans in the group are subject to annual review and renewal by the various banks and financial institutions. Naspers expects that all of its current bank overdraft facilities will be renewed.
 
In May 2006, Naspers acquired a 30% interest in Abril for a cash consideration of Rand 2,557.3 million. The acquisition was funded from existing cash resources.
 
Although Naspers anticipates continuing to use further amounts of cash in connection with the operation of some of its businesses, Naspers believes that its cash and cash equivalents, and the expected cash inflows and other funding described above, will be sufficient to satisfy its expected needs for working capital and capital expenditure through March 31, 2007. In addition, several of Naspers’ subsidiaries have working capital bank facilities. Naspers anticipates funding its future operations and obligations through a combination of cash on hand, internally generated cash flows (primarily from the African pay-television and newspapers, magazines and printing businesses), the utilization of existing credit facilities and potential future equity raisings. Naspers’ liquidity resources are subject to change as market and general economic conditions change. Increases in liquidity could result from an increase in cash flows from operations or from a divestiture of assets. Decreases in liquidity could result from weaker than expected cash flow from operations caused by lower subscriber numbers and lower demand for the services Naspers offers, from exchange rate fluctuations which have been and are expected to be significant, or from lower prices for its products.
 
71

 
 In addition, any potential acquisitions in which all or a portion of the consideration would be payable in cash could reduce Naspers’ liquidity resources.
 
5.C.                 Research and Development
 
Naspers expenses research and development costs in the financial period during which they are incurred. The amounts spent by Naspers on research and development do not materially affect Naspers’ results of operations. The research and development costs amounted to Rand 54.9 million and Rand 10.1 million during fiscal 2006 and 2005, respectively.
 
5.D.                 Trend Information
 
The growth rate in subscribers to Naspers’ television platforms has slowed over the past couple of years. Total subscribers increased from 1,847,764 at March 31, 2005 to 2,010,019 at March 31, 2006. The number of subscribers to Naspers’ analog service continues to decrease. However, migration of subscribers from Naspers’ analog service to its digital service has increased the number of subscribers to Naspers’ digital platforms. Digital subscriber numbers now significantly exceed analog subscriber numbers. The Naspers group derives a higher revenue and profit margin per subscriber from digital subscribers than from analog subscribers. Accordingly, increasing the number of digital subscribers as a proportion of total subscribers improves the profitability of Naspers’ pay-television operations. However, the migration rate from analog to digital service has slowed and will continue to slow as fewer subscribers remain on the analog service. This may cause the digital subscriber base to grow at a slower rate than it has in the past.
 
In South Africa the total pay-television subscriber base has grown from 1,060,202 subscribers at March 31, 2001 to 1,250,533 subscribers at March 31, 2006, which represents annual compounded growth of 3.36% over the past five years. During this period the digital subscriber base has increased from 502,198 subscribers at March 31, 2001 to 1,033,093 subscribers at March 31, 2006, growing at an average growth rate of 15.5%. The analog subscriber base has decreased over this period from 558,004 subscribers to 217,440 subscribers in March 31, 2006. This decrease has been the result of the migration from the analog to the digital service.
 
The Sub-Saharan Africa pay-television business also tends to be somewhat seasonal, with a decrease in subscribers during the winter season when the European football season ends. Once the European football season starts again in August, there is an increase in the subscriber base as subscribers reconnect. During fiscal 2006, the digital subscriber base has increased from 333,781 subscribers at March 31, 2005 to 384,216 subscribers at March 31, 2006.
 
In the Mediterranean region, the broadcast television business tends to be seasonal, with a decrease in viewership occurring in the summer, when Greek viewers traditionally enjoy outdoor activities and travel, and when the football and basketball seasons have ended. The analog subscriber base declined by 24.0% to 71,994 households in the period between March 31, 2005 and March 31, 2006. Nova (the digital television service) maintained its leading position in the region by adding 30,224 digital subscribers, or 14.4%, to end fiscal 2006 with 239,536 subscribers. The rate of increase in the digital subscribers is slowing as the digital penetration rate increases in the Greece market.
 
Political and regulatory pressures are making it increasingly difficult to maintain exclusive rights to sports programming.
 
Advertising revenues from newspapers and magazines should remain robust if the strong performance of the South African economy continues. Advertising revenues from newspapers have increased over the last fiscal year from Rand 1,026.7 million to Rand 1,265.0 million. This growth represents an annual growth rate of 23.2%. Similarly the advertising revenue from magazines has increased over the same period from Rand 554.4 million to Rand 633.0 million, a growth of 14.2% per annum. Naspers does not expect its advertising revenue to be able to maintain these growth rates during fiscal 2007. Advertising revenues from television increased by an exceptional 23.4% during fiscal 2006 to Rand 539.6 million, which contributed to the overall increase in advertising revenue. Television advertising revenue is expected to remain stable in the foreseeable future, but it is unlikely that a similar increase will be experienced in fiscal 2007. Naspers does expect some growth in internet advertising in the foreseeable future.
 
Although the growth in e-commerce revenues experienced by the Naspers group’s internet platforms is encouraging, total e-commerce revenues remain low. Naspers expects e-commerce revenues to remain low until user acceptance of e-commerce initiatives accelerate.
 
 
72

 
 
Irdeto increased its revenues from Rand 255.3 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 352.3 million in fiscal 2006. Overall volumes were higher in both smartcard shipments and new customer growth. Naspers expects market conditions to remain highly competitive in the near future with continued pressure on technology margins and revenues.

According to long term data from the Audited Bureau for Circulation, or “ABC”, the newspaper market in South Africa is relatively mature and stable. Until the late 1980’s when Media24 acquired City Press, the Sunday newspaper title, Media24’s portfolio consisted mainly of Afrikaans titles. Over the last few years, Media24’s product mix has been broadened by strategic acquisitions and new launches and the English portion has increased with the launch and growth of the English language daily tabloid, the Daily Sun.
 
A number of titles have also been added to Media24’s magazine portfolio over the last couple of years. Media24 added these titles to its portfolio due to specific trends in the international magazine market that also were evident in South Africa. There has been a marked worldwide decline in the circulation levels of general interest, broad based magazines, and a fragmentation of the magazine market. The number of consumer titles available in South Africa has more than doubled over this period to in excess of 400 titles and an increasing number of international titles have become available in South Africa.
 
Media24 sold more than 900,000 copies of general interest magazines (Huisgenoot, You and Drum) per week during the July-December 1996 ABC period. That circulation has declined to 657,512 in the April-June 2006 ABC period.
 
To compensate for the decline in the circulation of general interest magazines, Media24 started a number of international titles in South Africa, some in partnership with other companies, or on a license or set fee basis. These include magazines such as Men’s Health, FHM, Golf Digest, Cosmopolitan, Shape, Runner’s World, heat, Seventeen and Bicycling SA.
 
Book publishing revenues were under pressure during fiscal 2003, but resumed growth during fiscal 2005 and 2006. However, the Naspers group is not expecting significant growth in the foreseeable future, mainly due to the fact that the market is quite mature in South Africa and highly competitive.
 
Private education revenues have remained fairly steady over the last couple of fiscal years. Naspers expects at best moderate growth in the future as student numbers are currently under pressure. Course fees should grow in line with South African inflation.
 
5.E.                 Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
 
Naspers has no significant off-balance sheet arrangements.
 
5.F.                  Tabular Disclosure of Contractual Obligations
 
The table below sets forth Naspers’ known contractual obligations as of March 31, 2006.
 

       
Payments due by period
 
Contractual obligations
 
Note to consolidated financial statements
 
Total
 
Less than
1 year
 
 
1-3 years
 
 
3-5 years
 
More than
5 years
 
 
       
(Rand in millions)
Long-Term Debt Obligations (1)
   
19
   
2,323
   
1,412
   
653
   
178
   
80
 
Capital (Finance) Lease Obligations(2)
   
19
   
2,327
   
407
   
757
   
595
   
568
 
Operating Lease Obligations(3)
   
22(e)
 
 
359
   
135
   
165
   
44
   
15
 
Purchase Obligations(4)
   
22(a) - (d)
 
 
2,501
   
1,605
   
661
   
220
   
15
 
Foreign exchange contracts
   
36
   
1,419
   
847
   
572
   
   
 
Other Long-Term Liabilities Reflected on the Company’s Balance Sheet under IFRS(5)
   
18
   
162
   
8
   
   
   
154
 
Total
         
9,091
                         
 
(1)
Long-term debt obligations include interest bearing loans of Rand 1,053.3 million, program and film rights obligations of Rand 636.8 million and non-interest bearing loans of Rand 633.2 million. It excludes bank overdrafts of Rand 364.8 million. Interest-bearing loans have been disclosed net of preference share investments and the right to subscription shares as per Naspers’ structured finance arrangements.
 
 
73

 
 
(2)
Capitalized finance leases include lease obligations relating to land and buildings, transmission equipment and satellites and vehicles, computers and office equipment.
 
(3)
Operating lease obligations includes future operating lease payments relating to land and buildings, satellites and transponders and other equipment.
 
(4)
Purchase obligations include committed future expenditure under contracts entered into by the group. These include contracts for capital expenditure, program and film rights, set-top boxes and various service agreements.
 
(5)
Other long-term liabilities reflected on the balance sheet include post-retirement medical benefit obligations.

At March 31, 2006 Naspers had gross long-term loans and liabilities of Rand 4,055.1 million (2005: Rand 3,193.2 million). Of these obligations, Rand 1,731.7 million (2005: Rand 1,983.1 million) consist of finance lease commitments, with Rand 1,507.9 million (2005: Rand 1,748.5 million) relating to transmission equipment, including satellites, transponders and transmitters, used by pay-television operations in Africa and the Mediterranean. The transmission equipment finance lease obligation decreased by Rand 240.6 million mainly due to the translation of the U.S. dollar and Euro denominated finance lease commitments to Rand and the repayments made during fiscal 2006. At March 31, 2006 these finance lease commitments were translated at Rand 6.15 (2005: Rand 6.21) to the U.S. dollar and Rand 7.46 (2005: 8.05) to the Euro. These leases have fixed implicit interest rates.
 
Other long-term debt increased to Rand 2,323.3 million as at March 31, 2006, consisting of interest bearing liabilities of Rand 1,053.3 million (2005: Rand 636.2 million), non-interest bearing liabilities of Rand 633.2 million (2005: Rand 99.7 million), concession liability of nil (2005: Rand 15.6 million) and program and film rights of Rand 636.8 million (2005: Rand 458.6 million). The increase in non-interest bearing liabilities is due mainly to the NetMed put option to purchase an additional interest from the minority shareholders (Rand 593.1 million).
 
Included in the interest bearing liabilities of the Naspers group are certain structured finance arrangements with a total gross value of Rand 305.8 million (2005: Rand 469.8 million). Since 1997, the Naspers group has replaced a significant amount of infrastructure, especially in its print media segment. The financing for the acquisition of various items of printing equipment and buildings has been completed by raising external debt from banks. The Naspers group has however structured these financing arrangements to provide a beneficial after-tax interest cost, as well as repayment terms that will allow the Naspers group to match future expected cash flows from these assets with such repayment terms. All the structured finance liabilities of the Naspers group have been reflected on Naspers’ balance sheet under both IFRS and U.S. GAAP. For IFRS purposes, certain assets have been presented net against the debt incurred to acquire the asset.
 
The South African Revenue Service (“SARS”) has adopted an aggressive approach to structured finance arrangements. The deductions and allowances that Naspers has taken in the past and may anticipate taking in the future in connection with some or all of these structured finance transactions may not be allowed by SARS. Any liability Naspers may incur as a result of the disallowance of such deductions or allowance claimed by Naspers is not expected to have a material adverse effect on the financial position of Naspers.
 
Media24 entered into a Rand 116.5 million syndicated loan agreement with CommerzBank and Futuregrowth in January 2004. This loan was utilized to reduce bank overdrafts as part of Media24’s drive to restructure its short-term debt profile. The loan is for a three year term and is repayable in 12 equal quarterly installments. The loan bears interest at a fixed rate of 10.5%.
 
Naspers Limited entered into a Rand 110.0 million loan agreement with FirstRand Bank Limited during April 2003. The proceeds of this loan were utilized to fund the repayment of bank overdrafts of Educor. The loan was a three year amortizing loan and was repaid during fiscal 2006.
 
MultiChoice Africa (Proprietary) Limited, the operating company for the South African pay-television businesses, entered into a loan agreement with Investec Bank Limited on April 16, 2004. The loan facility is for an amount of Rand 400 million as a general purpose facility. The loan is repayable in six equal monthly installments, starting September 30, 2004 until March 31, 2008. The company has pledged its 30.0% interest in M-Net and SuperSport as security against the loan facility. The facility bears interest at the Johannesburg inter-bank agreed rate (“JIBAR”) plus 2.8% and is subject to certain debt covenants. The loan has been fully settled subsequent to March 31, 2006 from available cash resources.
 
 
74

 
 
MultiChoice Africa Limited, the operating company for the Sub-Saharan pay-television businesses, entered into a loan agreement with ABSA Bank Limited on March 4, 2005. The agreement is for a revolving loan facility in an initial maximum amount of US$50 million that may be utilized by the Naspers group to fund the acquisition costs of businesses, interests in companies, intellectual property rights and rights to technology. If the Naspers group uses the facility to acquire businesses then it may also utilize the facility to fund the general corporate purposes of such businesses. The amount that may be drawn down under the facility reduces by approximately US$7 million every six months starting on March 4, 2007, until March 3, 2010 (when the then reduced facility ceases to be available). MultiChoice Africa Limited is required to repay any utilization of the facility in excess of the reduced level at the start of each such six month period.  The Naspers group has pledged 185,000,000 shares in Tencent Holdings Limited as security for the loan facility. The facility bears interest at the London Interbank Offer Rate (“LIBOR”) plus 2% and is subject to certain undertakings concerning debt and interest cover.
 
Liabilities in respect of program and film broadcasting rights increased from Rand 458.6 million in fiscal 2005 to Rand 636.8 million at March 31, 2006. Program and film broadcasting rights are non-interest bearing liabilities. In addition, Naspers had future commitments relating to program and film broadcasting rights of Rand 1,425.9 million at March 31, 2006. Although these commitments arise out of contracts entered into by the Naspers group, any future payments under those contracts are conditional on the occurrence of certain future events.
 
Naspers utilized overdraft of Rand 364.8 million at March 31, 2006, compared to Rand 433.3 million in fiscal 2005. As part of the process of managing the Naspers group’s mix of fixed and floating rate borrowings, the interest rate characteristics of new borrowings and the refinancing of existing borrowings are considered based on expected movements in interest rates. Where appropriate, the group uses derivative instruments, such as interest rate swap agreements, for hedging purposes. As at March 31, 2006, 50.5% of the long-term liabilities of Rand 4,055.1 million had fixed interest rate profiles, 18.2% of these liabilities were floating and 31.3% of these liabilities were interest-free.
 
The Naspers group had undrawn banking facilities of Rand 1,806.7 million as at March 31, 2006. Facilities which are on-call represented Rand 252.2 million and the balance of these undrawn facilities of Rand 1,554.5 million expire within one year. These facilities are in most instances subject to review and renewal within annual cycles. The Naspers group is in constant discussions with various financial institutions concerning changes to the terms of its existing facilities and future funding requirements.
 
Acquisitions and Dispositions
 
Year ended March 31, 2006

On April 1, 2005, Media24 acquired an additional interest of 7.5% in its subsidiary, Paarl Media Holdings (Proprietary) Limited (“Paarl Media”), for a cash consideration of Rand 180 million. This increased Media24’s effective financial interest in Paarl Media to 92.11%. This transaction was accounted for as a common control transaction, and the excess of the purchase consideration over the net asset value was recognized in equity.

During October 2005, Media24 disposed of its investment in Computicket (Proprietary) Limited for a cash consideration of approximately Rand 69.0 million. A profit on sale of investments of Rand 56.7 million was realized on this transaction and is included in profit from continuing operations.

On November 7, 2005, the Group publicly announced that it had entered into an agreement pursuant to which it would sell its entire interest in UBC and MKSC to True Corp. for a cash consideration of approximately Rand 999.3 million. A profit on the discontinuance of operations of Rand 1,032.2 million was realized on the transaction. Details relating to this transaction are highlighted in note 28 to the consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this annual report.

During December 2005, MIH acquired 100% of the equity of Orbicom (Proprietary) Limited (“Orbicom”) from MTN Group Limited (“MTN”) for a cash consideration of Rand 44.2 million. The total purchase consideration was allocated based upon an appraisal, as follows: net assets (Rand 35.1 million) and goodwill (Rand 9.1 million).

During February 2006, MIH QQ (BVI) Limited acquired a 25% interest in ChineseAll for a cash consideration of Rand 24.6 million. The total purchase consideration was allocated based upon an appraisal, as follows: net assets (Rand 1.7 million) and goodwill (Rand 22.9 million).
 
 
75

 

 
In April, 2006, Irdeto Eindhoven B.V. acquired the Cryptotec Conditional Access business from Koninklijke Philips Electronics NV for a cash consideration of Rand 230.7 million. MIH subscribed for new shares equal to a 25% interest in Tixa Tech Group Inc. for a cash consideration of Rand 60.5 million.

In May, 2006, Naspers Limited acquired, through its offshore subsidiary MIH B.V., a 30% stake in the leading Brazilian media company, Abril, for a cash consideration of Rand 2,557.3 million.
 
In August 2006, MIH Print Media Holdings Limited (“MIH Print Media”) acquired a 20.2% interest in Titan, a leading company in the field of Chinese sports publishing, for a cash consideration of approximately Rand 114.5 million. It is anticipated that through a further acquisition MIH Print Media’s shareholding will increase to 37%.
 
In September 2006, Naspers announced that, in furtherance of its empowerment objectives, the group intends to implement a Broad-Based Black Economic Empowerment ownership initiative in relation to Media24 Limited (“Media24”) and MultiChoice South Africa (“MCSA”).
 
The BEE transactions are expected to result in the acquisition by qualifying Black Persons and Black Groups of ordinary shares in the issued share capital of Welkom Yizani Investments Limited (“Welkom Yizani”), which will hold ordinary shares in the issued share capital of Media24 Holdings (Proprietary) Limited (“Media24 Holdings”), the holding company of Media24 as well as Phuthuma Nathi Investments Limited (“Phuthuma Nathi”), which will hold ordinary shares in the issued share capital of MultiChoice South Africa Holdings (Proprietary) Limited (“MCSA Holdings”), the holding company of MCSA.
 
Naspers will sell up to 14.6 million shares in Media24 Holdings to Welkom Yizani for a consideration of approximately Rand 730 million. Welkom Yizani will fund the acquisition through cash and the issuance of preference shares to Naspers. MIHH will sell up to 45 million shares in MCSA Holdings to Phuthuma Nathi, for a consideration of approximately Rand 2,250 million. Phuthuma Nathi will fund the acquisition through cash and the issuance of preference shares to MIHH.
 
The empowerment transactions are subject to Welkom Yizani and Phuthuma Nathi undertaking the public offers to the General Black Public to subscribe for ordinary shares in Welkom Yizani and Phuthuma Nathi. The number of Media24 Holdings and MCSA Holdings ordinary shares to be acquired by Welkom Yizani and Phuthuma Nathi will depend on the amount raised by Welkom Yizani and Phuthuma Nathi in terms of the public offers. The closing date for the public offers is expected to be at the end of October 2006. The public offers may not ultimately be undertaken and the final terms of the empowerment transactions are subject to change.
 
Year ended March 31, 2005

On April 1, 2004, Media24 acquired the remaining 50% interest it did not already own in Alchemy Publishing (Proprietary) Limited for a cash consideration of Rand 4.6 million. The total purchase consideration of Rand 4.6 million was allocated based upon an appraisal, as follows: net assets (Rand 0.7 million) and goodwill (Rand 3.9 million).

On April 13, 2004, Johnnic Communications Limited (“Johncom”) exercised a call option on Naspers relating to 39.1% of the M-Net and SuperSport ordinary shares acquired from minority shareholders in terms of Section 311 schemes of arrangement concluded during March 2004. Naspers sold 33 686 280 M-Net and SuperSport shares respectively for a total cash consideration of Rand 286.3 million resulting in a loss of Rand 27.9 million on disposal. Naspers retained an effective 60.12% interest in both M-Net and SuperSport.

Tencent completed an initial public offering of shares on June 16, 2004 and listed on the Hong Kong Stock Exchange. The Group’s interest in Tencent was diluted from 50% to approximately 36.1%. Tencent’s net proceeds were approximately HK$1.64 billion. The Group realized a dilution profit of Rand 358.4 million. The Group exercised joint control over the operations of Tencent until June 16, 2004 and therefore proportionately consolidated the results of Tencent until that date. After the listing of Tencent the Group retained significant influence over Tencent’s financial and operating policies, therefore Tencent was equity accounted by the Group from June 16, 2004.

NetMed announced on June 19, 2003, that, subject to the fulfilment of certain conditions precedent, it had reached an agreement with Teletypos SA (“Teletypos”), in terms of which Teletypos would exchange its interest in MultiChoice Hellas SA for approximately €6.6 million in cash and a 12.5% equity interest in NetMed. On September 22, 2004 the last regulatory approvals and conditions precedent were fulfilled, therefore this transaction was accounted for in the year ended March 31, 2005.
 
 
76

 
 
The Group realized a profit of Rand 215.7 million on the dilution of its interest in NetMed. Goodwill of Rand 312.9 million was accounted for on the acquisition of the remaining interest that the Group did not already own in MultiChoice Hellas.

Beijing Media Corporation Limited (“BMC”) completed an initial public offering of shares on December 22, 2004 and listed on the Hong Kong Stock Exchange. Naspers acquired an interest of 9.9% in BMC through its participation in the initial public offering. The group paid Rand 273.2 million in cash for its interest. The Group has classified the investment as an available-for-sale investment and is carrying it on its balance sheet at fair value.
 
On February 1, 2005, M-Web Holdings (Proprietary) Limited acquired from Tiscali International BV its South African ISP business (“Tiscali”) for a purchase consideration of Rand 309.3 million in cash. The purchase agreement stipulated that any net asset value acquired greater than Rand 44.5 million would be payable on a rand for rand basis to the seller. The group accordingly paid an additional Rand 11.7 million on closing of the transaction. This was recorded as an adjustment to goodwill. Included in the goodwill recognized are certain intangible assets that cannot be individually separated and reliably measured due to their nature, such as synergy benefits.

During the 2005 financial year the company disposed of the balance of its investment in Liberty Media Corporation for a consideration of Rand 141.6 million. A profit on sale of investments of Rand 18.7 million was realized on this transaction.
 
U.S. GAAP Reconciliation
 
Financial statements prepared in accordance with IFRS differ in certain material respects from financial statements prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP. The principal differences between IFRS and U.S. GAAP relating to Naspers’ consolidated financial statements for the periods presented include:
 
Business combinations - Certain differences between IFRS and U.S. GAAP in the application of the purchase method of accounting for business combinations include:
 
·      
Date of acquisition— prior to December 20, 2002, the date on which earnings of an acquired entity were included in the Group’s consolidated results of operations could be based on an effective date identified in the acquisition agreement when management control is ceded. Under US GAAP, when regulatory approval or other substantive conditions precedent exist, the consummation of the acquisition is not considered effective until such conditions are satisfied and irrevocable control of the company is obtained or consideration is exchanged.
 
·      
Value of purchase consideration— previously, the value of the purchase consideration was determined based on the market or fair value of the shares issued or cash paid on the date the transaction was consummated, normally the date the shares were exchanged or cash was paid. The purchase consideration did not include the fair value of options issued to replace vested options of the acquired company. Under US GAAP, the value of the purchase consideration, using shares, is determined by using the average market value of the shares a few days before and after the announcement date. In addition, under US GAAP, the fair value of options issued to replace vested options of the acquired company are also recorded as part of the purchase consideration based on the fair market value of the vested options outstanding at the acquisition date.
 
·      
Exchange of non-monetary assets— in prior years the Group has undertaken a number of transactions involving the exchange of non-monetary assets, normally the exchange or swap of shares. Previously, the gain recorded and cost of investments acquired were based on the value of the shares received. Under US GAAP, the gain recorded and cost of the investments acquired were based on the market value of the shares surrendered on the dates that the exchanges were consummated.
 
Goodwill - Goodwill recorded on acquisitions prior to April 1, 2000 was written off against retained earnings in the year of acquisition. For purposes of US GAAP prior to the adoption of FAS 142, “Goodwill and other intangible assets”, all goodwill written off against retained earnings has been reinstated as an asset on the balance sheet and amortized. Upon adoption of FAS 142 on April 1, 2002, the Group no longer amortizes goodwill and annually tests goodwill, by reporting unit, for impairment. Under IFRS, prior to April 1, 2004, goodwill was amortized over an estimated useful life not exceeding 20 years. As of April 1, 2004, the Group adopted IAS 36, “Impairment of Assets” and IFRS 3, “Business Combinations”, with retrospective application to December 20, 2002, and discontinued the amortization of goodwill which is consistent with the accounting treatment under US GAAP.
 
 
77

 
Although the statements are similar, the difference in the prospective adoption dates will give rise to a continuing equity difference between IFRS and US GAAP.
 
Intangibles assets - Patents, trademarks, title rights, subscriber bases and similar other intangible assets acquired before April 1, 2000 were written off against retained earnings in the year of acquisition. Under US GAAP, all other intangible assets written off against retained earnings have been reinstated as assets on the balance sheet and are being amortized using the straight-line method over a range of estimated useful lives of three to eight years. Upon adoption of FAS 142 on April 1, 2002, these intangible assets were determined to have a finite useful life and therefore continue to be amortized over their remaining estimated useful lives. Under both IFRS and US GAAP, the carrying value of other intangible assets is assessed for impairment whenever changes in circumstances indicate that the historical carrying value may not be appropriate.

Purchase of minority interests (successive acquisition), net - Under IFRS, when undertaking transactions with minorities in successive acquisitions, the entire difference between the purchase consideration and the net assets acquired of the remaining interest in an entity that it did not own was included within minority interests within equity. The minority interest is recorded at the minority’s proportion of the net fair value of the net assets acquired. Under US GAAP transactions with minorities are treated as a purchase business combination. The minority interest is valued at its historical cost book value and fair values are assigned upon the step up purchase of the minority interest.

Share based compensation - The Group accounts for its share options in accordance with IFRS 2, “Share-based Payments” and has recognized compensation expense in the income statement, representing the fair value of share options granted to employees. For US GAAP purposes, the Group accounts for its share options granted to employees based on the intrinsic value of the option in accordance with Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25 “Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees” (“APB 25”), as permitted by Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123 “Accounting for Stock Based Compensation” (“FAS 123”).
 
Put option liability - During fiscal 2006, minorities of NetMed NV exercised a put on their shares to the Group, requiring the Group to purchase a specified number of NetMed NV shares. Under US GAAP, the transaction was accounted for as a step acquisition at the time the option was exercised by recording the fair value of the put option liability and the percentage of the assets and liabilities acquired were increased to their current fair value. Under IFRS this put option with minority shareholders was considered outstanding from the time it was entered into, based on the amended guidance in IAS 32R. However, the Group elected the IFRS 1 allowance to present comparative information for IAS 32 and 39 in accordance with former GAAP and therefore this derivative liability has been recorded as of April 1, 2005 with a corresponding adjustment to shareholders’ equity since it is treated as a successive acquisition. The fair value movement between April 1, 2005 and March 31, 2006 has been recorded in the income statement. The movement between April 1, 2005 and January 2006 has been reversed for US GAAP.
 
Media24 entered into a contract containing a put option whereby the option holder can require Media24 to purchase the option holder’s remaining 7.5% interest. For IFRS purposes, the put option has been considered outstanding from the time that it was entered into and has been recorded as a derivative financial instrument liability in the financial statements.  For US GAAP purposes, the transaction will not be accounted for until the option is exercised.
 
Please refer to note 39 of Naspers’ consolidated financial statements and related notes included elsewhere in this annual report for the effect of the above differences between IFRS and U.S. GAAP, as well as other less significant differences, on total shareholders’ equity as of March 31, 2006 and 2005 and the consolidated net (loss)/income for the two years in the period ended March 31, 2006.
 
Initial Adoption of Accounting Policies
 
For the year ended March 31, 2005 Naspers prepared its financial statements under South African GAAP as effective at that date. In accordance with the JSE Limited (“JSE”) Listing Requirements the Group is required to prepare its first annual consolidated financial statements in accordance with IFRS for the year ended March 31, 2006.
 
As the Group publishes comparative information in its financial statements, the date for transition to IFRS is April 1, 2004, which represents the beginning of the earliest period of comparative information to be presented as required in terms of the requirements of the JSE and the SEC. In order to describe the impact of IFRS on the Group’s reported results of operations and financial position, the Group has restated information previously published under South African GAAP to the equivalent basis under IFRS. This restatement is described in note 2 of the consolidated annual financial statements and follows the guidelines set out in IFRS 1 “First-time Adoption of International Financial Reporting Standards” (“IFRS 1”).
 
 
78

 
 
New Accounting Standards
 
IFRS
 
NEW STANDARDS ADOPTED:

The amendment to IAS 19 - “Employee Benefits”, has been issued to allow the option of recognizing actuarial gains and losses in full in the period in which they occur, outside profit or loss, in a statement of recognized income and expenses. The amendment was issued during December 2004 with immediate effect. The Group will continue to apply option of recognizing the actuarial gains in losses in the income statement.

The amendments that have been made to IAS 39 included amendments to the accounting of Cash Flow Hedges of Forecasted Intragroup Transactions, the scope of IAS 39 to include Financial Guarantee Contracts and the amendment to the Fair Value Option. These amendments were made during April, August and June 2005 with immediate effect.

The amendment to IAS 1 - “Presentation of Financial Statements: Capital Disclosures” states that an entity shall disclose information that enables users of its financial statements to evaluate the entity’s objectives, policies and processes for managing capital.

NEW STANDARDS ISSUED, BUT NOT YET ADOPTED:

IFRS 7 - “Financial Instruments: Disclosures” was issued August 18, 2005, with an effective date of January 1, 2007. This new standard adds certain new disclosures about financial instruments to those currently required by IAS 32 - Financial Instruments: Presentation.

The IASB has also amended the accounting treatment of monetary items in IAS 21 - “The Effect of Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates” during December 2005 with immediate effect. The amendment stated that if a monetary item forms part of an entity’s investment in a foreign operation, the accounting treatment in the consolidated financial statements should not be dependent on the currency of the monetary item. Also, the accounting should not depend on which entity within the Group conducts a transaction with the foreign operation.

IFRIC Interpretation 4 - “Determining whether an Arrangement contains a Lease” was issued by the IASB and is effective for annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2006, and the Interpretation specifies that an arrangement that meets certain criteria is, or contains, a lease that should be accounted for in accordance with IAS 17 - “Leases”.

IFRIC Interpretation 6 - “Liabilities arising from Participating in a Specific Market - Waste Electronic and Electronic Equipment” clarifies when certain producers of electrical goods are required to recognise a liability under IAS 37 for the cost of waste management relating to the decommissioning of waste electrical and electronic equipment supplied to private households. IFRIC 6 is effective for annual periods beginning on or after December 1, 2005.

IFRIC Interpretation 8 - “Scope of IFRS 2” clarifies that IFRS 2 - “Share-based Payment” applies to arrangements where an entity makes share-based payments for apparently nil or inadequate consideration. IFRIC 8 is effective for annual periods beginning on or after May 1, 2006.

IFRIC Interpretation 9 - “Reassessment of Embedded Derivatives” clarifies that an entity shall assess whether an embedded derivative is required to be separated from the host contract and accounted for as a derivative when the entity first becomes a party to the contract. Subsequent reassessment is prohibited unless there is a change in the terms of the contract that significantly modifies the cash flows that otherwise would be required under the contract, in which case reassessment is required. IFRIC 9 is effective for annual periods beginning on or after June 1, 2006.
 
AC 503 - “Accounting for Black Economic Empowerment (“BEE”) Transactions” states that if equity instruments are granted at a discount to a BEE partner, this must be expensed. BEE credentials acquired as part of a business combination shall be subsumed in goodwill and not recognized as a separate intangible asset. Where the BEE transaction includes service conditions, the fair value of the equity instruments shall be measured at grant date and the expense should be recognized over the period of the service conditions. Where the BEE transaction includes no service conditions, the fair value of the equity instruments shall be measured at grant date and the expense should be recognized immediately on grant date. AC 503 is effective for annual periods beginning on or after May 1, 2006.
 
 
79


 
U.S. GAAP 
 
In December 2004, the FASB issued SFAS No. 123R, “Share-Based Payment,” (“SFAS 123R”) which is a revision of SFAS No. 123, “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation” (“SFAS 123”). Statement 123R supersedes APB Opinion No. 25, “Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees,” and amends SFAS No. 95, “Statement of Cash Flows.” Generally, the approach in SFAS 123R is similar to the approach described in SFAS 123. SFAS 123R requires all share-based payments to employees to be recognized in the income statement based on their grant date fair values over the corresponding service period and also requires estimation of forfeitures when calculating compensation expense. In April of 2005 the FASB revised the adoption date of this revised statement effective the first annual reporting period that begins after June 15, 2005. Accordingly, the Group will adopt this revised statement on April 1, 2006 using the modified prospective application approach. The Group is currently evaluating the impact of SFAS 123R on its financial position and results of operations.

In December 2004, the FASB issued SFAS No. 153 “Exchanges of Non-monetary Assets - An Amendment of APB Opinion No. 29”. SFAS No. 153 eliminates the exception to fair value accounting for exchanges of similar productive assets contained in APB Opinion No. 29 and replaces it with a general exception for exchange transactions that do not have commercial substance. The exception in APB Opinion No. 29 required certain non-monetary asset exchanges to be recorded on a carryover basis with no gain or loss recognition. Under SFAS No. 153, exchange transactions with commercial substance are required to be accounted for at fair value with gain or loss recognition on assets surrendered in exchange transactions. The group will be required to adopt SFAS No. 153 on April 1, 2006, and believes the adoption of this standard will not have a material impact on the Group’s financial statements.

In May 2005, the FASB issued SFAS 154, “Accounting Changes and Error Corrections - a replacement of APB Opinion No. 20 and FASB Statement No.3”. Among other things, SFAS 154 requires voluntary changes in accounting principle to be retrospectively applied in the financial statements. It also applies to changes required by an accounting pronouncement in the unusual instance that the pronouncement does not include specific transition provisions. When a pronouncement includes specific transition provisions, those provisions should be followed. The Group will be required to adopt SFAS 154 on April 1, 2006. The Group is currently evaluating the impact of SFAS 154 on its financial position and results of operations.

In November 2005, the FASB issued FSP Nos. FAS 115-1 and FAS 124-1, The Meaning of Other-Than-Temporary Impairment and Its Application to Certain Investments (FSP 115-1 and 124-1). This statement amends FASB Statements No. 115, Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities, and No. 124, Accounting for Certain Investments Held by Not-for-Profit Organizations, and APB Opinion No. 18, The Equity Method of Accounting for Investments in Common Stock. The guidance addresses the determination as to when an investment is considered impaired, whether that impairment is other than temporary, and the measurement of an impairment loss. The guidance also includes accounting considerations subsequent to the recognition of an other-than-temporary impairment and requires certain disclosures about un losses that have not been recognized as other-than-temporary impairments. The guidance includes three steps in determining when an investment is considered impaired, whether that impairment is other than temporary, and the measurement of an impairment loss. FSP 115-1 and 124-1 is effective for reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2005 and will be adopted by the group on April 1, 2006 and believes it will not have a material impact on the Group’s financial statements.

In April 2006, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position 46(R)-6 (FSP FIN 46(R)-6) to address how a reporting enterprise should determine the variability to be considered in applying FASB Interpretation No. 46 (revised December 2003), Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities, (FIN 46(R)).

The variability that is considered in applying FIN 46(R) affects the determination of (a) whether the entity is a variable interest entity (VIE), (b) which interests are variable interests in the entity, and (c) which party, if any, is the primary beneficiary of the VIE. That variability will affect any calculation of expected losses and expected residual returns, if such a calculation is necessary. The variability to be considered in applying FIN 46(R) is based on an analysis of the design of the entity by a) analyzing the nature of the risks in the entity and b) determining the purpose(s) for which the entity was created and determine the variability the entity is designed to create and pass along to its interest.

After determining the variability to consider, the reporting enterprise can determine which interests are designed to absorb that variability. FSP FIN 46(R)-6 provides examples of the cash flow and fair value methods that can be used to measure the amount of variability (that is, expected losses and expected residual returns) of an entity. However, a method that is used to measure the amount of variability does not provide an appropriate basis for determining which variability should be considered in applying FIN 46(R).
 
 
80


 
FSP FIN 46(R)-6 is effective the first day of the first reporting period beginning after June 15, 2006. The Group will adopt the provisions of this statement on April 1, 2007. The Group is evaluating the impact of this statement and believes that it will not have a material impact on our financial statements.

In June 2006 the FASB issued FASB Interpretation No. 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes (FIN 48) to clarify the accounting for uncertainty in income taxes recognized in an entity’s financial statements in accordance with FASB Statement No. 109, Accounting for Income Taxes. The guidance requires an entity to determine whether it is more likely than not that a tax position will be sustained upon examination, including resolution of any related appeals or litigation processes, based on the technical merits of the position. In evaluating whether a tax position has met the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold, the enterprise should presume that the position will be examined by the appropriate taxing authority that has full knowledge of all relevant information. A tax position that meets the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold is measured to determine the amount of benefit to recognize in the financial statements. The tax position is measured at the largest amount of benefit that is greater than 50 percent likely of being realized upon ultimate settlement.

Tax positions that previously failed to meet the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold should be recognized in the first subsequent financial reporting period in which that threshold is met. Previously recognized tax positions that no longer meet the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold should be derecognized in the first subsequent financial reporting period in which that threshold is no longer met. Use of a valuation allowance as described in Statement 109 is not an appropriate substitute for the derecognition of a tax position. The Group will be required to adopt FIN 48 on April 1, 2007 and is evaluating the expected impact on the financial statements.
 
In September 2006, The FASB issued SFAS No. 157 , Fair Value Measurements, (SFAS 157). This Statement defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring fair value and expands disclosures about fair value measurements. This Statement does not require any new fair value measurements, it emphasizes that fair value is a market-based measurement, not an entity-specific measurement. Therefore, a fair value measurement should be determined based on the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. SFAS 157 expands disclosures about the use of fair value to measure assets and liabilities in interim and annual periods subsequent to initial recognition. This statement applies for derivatives and other financial instruments measured at fair value under SFAS No. 133, Derivative Financial Instruments at initial recognition and in all subsequent periods. The group will be required to adopt SFAS 157 on April 1, 2008, and is currently evaluating the impact of SFAS 157 on its financial position and results of operations.
 
In September 2006, the SEC issued Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 108 (“SAB 108”). The interpretations in SAB 108 express the staff's views regarding the process of quantifying financial statement misstatements. The staff believes registrants must consider the impact of correcting all misstatements, including the effect of misstatements that were not corrected at the end of the prior year. These prior year misstatements should be considered in quantifying misstatements in current year financial statements. Thus, a registrant's financial statements would require adjustment when the assessment in the current year or in prior years results in quantifying a misstatement that is material, after considering all relevant quantitative and qualitative factors. The group will be required to adopt SAB 108 on April 1, 2007, and is currently evaluating the impact of SAB 108 on its financial position and results of operations.
 
 
 
81

 
 
ITEM 6.         DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND EMPLOYEES
 
6.A.                 Directors and Senior Management
 
The articles of association of Naspers provide that the board of directors must consist of not less than 4 members, nor more than 15 members at any time. The board currently consists of 12 members. In accordance with the JSE’s listing requirements, one-third of the non-executive directors comprising Naspers’ board are, on a rotating basis, obliged to retire and are eligible for re-election at each annual general meeting of shareholders. The business address for all the directors is 40 Heerengracht, Cape Town, 8001, South Africa. All the directors are South African citizens. All the directors are non-executive directors except for Koos Bekker and Steve Pacak.
 
As of September 1, 2006, the directors and senior management of Naspers, their respective ages, their position, the year in which they were first appointed and the year in which their current term expires, where applicable, are as follows:
 

Name
Age
Position
Year First Appointed
to Current Position
Expiration
of current term
Naspers directors:
       
Ton Vosloo 
69
Chairman of the Board of Directors
1997
2006
Koos Bekker 
53
CEO Naspers and Director
1997
2007
Steve Pacak 
51
CFO Naspers and Director
1998
Boetie van Zyl 
67
Director
1988
2008
Lourens Jonker 
67
Director
1996
2007
Neil van Heerden 
67
Director
1996
2007
Ben van der Ross 
59
Director
1999
2008
Prof. Jakes Gerwel 
60
Director
1999
2007
Prof. Hein Willemse 
49
Director
2002
2006
Adv. Francine-Ann du Plessis 
51
Director
2003
2006
Prof. Rachel Jafta 
45
Director
2003
2006
Fred Phaswana 
62
Director
2003
2006
         
Senior Management:
       
Cobus Stofberg 
55
CEO MIH Group
1998
Steve Ward 
52
CFO MIH Group
2000
Andre Coetzee 
54
General Counsel MIH Group
1999
Mark Sorour 
44
Chief Investment Officer
2002
Jim Volkwyn 
48
CEO Pay-television Platforms
2000
Antonie Roux 
48
CEO Internet Operations
2002
Jan Steenkamp 
43
CEO Entriq
2002
Graham Kill 
41
CEO Irdeto
1998
Nolo Letele 
56
CEO MultiChoice South Africa
1999
Kim Reid 
36
CEO M-Web South Africa
2003
Glen Marques 
46
CEO M-Net
2000
Heinrich Enslin 
44
CEO SuperSport International
2000
Hein Brand 
41
CEO Print Media Operations
2005
Francois Groepe 
36
CFO Media24
2003
Jan Malherbe 
58
CEO Media24 Newspapers
1983
Patricia Scholtemeyer 
44
CEO Media24 Magazines
2000
Stephen van der Walt  
37
CEO Paarl Media
2005
Musa Shezi 
46
MD Via Afrika
2005
Sheryl Raine 
49
CEO NetMed
1997
Imtiaz Patel 
42
CEO SuperSport South Africa
2005
Eben Greyling 
38
CEO MultiChoice Africa
2005

 
82


 
Directors
 
Ton Vosloo became the chief executive officer of Naspers in 1984 and subsequently served as executive chairman from 1992 to 1997. Mr. Vosloo was a journalist from 1956 to 1983 and editor of the daily newspaper Beeld from 1977 to 1983. Mr. Vosloo is chairman of Media24, MIH BV, MIH Holdings and independent non-executive chairman of the board of Naspers, a position he has held since 1977. He is also a former chairman of the World Wide Fund for Nature in South Africa, a director of the Cape Philharmonic Orchestra and a trustee for the Stigting vir Bemagtiging deur Afrikaans.  He is also a former chairman of Sanlam.
 
Koos Bekker led the founding team of M-Net in 1985 and was chief executive officer of MIH Holdings. Mr. Bekker was a founding director of MTN and served as chief executive officer of NetHold until 1997. He is a director of Media24, MIH BV, MIH Holdings, SuperSport, M-Net and other companies within the group. Mr. Bekker has been the chief executive officer of Naspers since 1997.
 
Steve Pacak joined the Naspers group in 1988 as chief financial officer of M-Net Limited. Currently, he is a director of Media24, MIH BV, MIH Holdings, SuperSport, M-Net and other companies within the group. In 1998, Mr. Pacak was appointed as executive director and CFO of Naspers.
 
Boetie van Zyl joined the Naspers group as director in 1988. Mr. van Zyl is a member of the board of directors of amongst others MIH BV, MIH Holdings, Sanlam and Murray & Roberts and a trustee of the Peace Parks Foundation in South Africa. He is a director of Media24, chairman of the audit and risk management committee and a member of the executive, human resources and nomination committee.
 
Lourens Jonker joined the Naspers group in 1996. Mr. Jonker, the owner of the Weltevrede wine estate near Bonnievale, is a member of the board of directors of ABSA. He is a former chairman of the KWV group.
 
Neil van Heerden joined the Naspers group in 1996. Mr. van Heerden is a trustee of the University of the Western Cape, former executive director of the South Africa Foundation, councilor of Business Unity South Africa and a member of the boards of directors of BMW (SA) and various other companies.
 
Ben van der Ross joined the Naspers group in 1999. Mr. van der Ross is the chairman of Bonatla Property Holdings and a member of the boards of directors of Momentum, FirstRand and Pick ‘n Pay Stores Limited. He is a former chief executive officer of Business South Africa. He is currently the chairman of the Naspers Welkom share scheme.
 
Prof. Jakes Gerwel joined the Naspers group in 1999. He is a previous director general in the office of former president Nelson Mandela, secretary to the cabinet and rector of the University of the Western Cape. Professor Gerwel, who is chancellor of Rhodes University, is chairman of Brimstone Investment Corporation, South African Airways and Educor. He is also a director of Media24, and a member of the executive and human resources and nomination committees of Naspers.
 
Prof. Hein Willemse joined the Naspers group as director in August 2002. He is a member of the boards of trustees of various organizations and community bodies, including the Shoma Education Trust and the Welkom share scheme. He is the head of the Department of Afrikaans at the University of Pretoria.
 
Advocate Francine-Ann du Plessis joined the Naspers group in 2003. She is a director of Loubser Du Plessis Inc, a firm of chartered accountants, the Industrial Development Corporation (IDC) of South Africa, the KWV group, Sanlam and Findevco. Advocate Du Plessis is also a member of the Naspers and Media24 audit and risk management committees.
 
Fred Phaswana joined the Naspers group in 2003. He is a director of Anglo American plc. He is chairman of BP Southern Africa, Transnet, the South African Energy Association, the Cape Town Graduate School of Business Board of Advisors and the South African Institute of International Affairs. Mr. Phaswana is vice chairman of the Business Leadership and honorary president of the Cape Town Press Club.
 
Prof. Rachel Jafta, who joined the Naspers group in 2003, is a senior lecturer in economics at the University of Stellenbosch. She is a member of the South African Economic Society and the New York Academy of Science. Professor Jafta is also a trustee of the Don Caldwell Trust and the Helen Suzman Foundation and a member of the South African Institute of Race Relations.
 
 
83


 
Senior Management
 
Cobus Stofberg began his affiliation with the Naspers group in 1985. He has held a variety of positions, including chief operating officer, within the MIH Holdings group of companies. Prior to this, Mr. Stofberg served as director of NetHold, NetMed and NetHold group companies. Currently, he is chief executive officer and a director of MIH BV.
 
Steve Ward joined the Naspers group in 2000. Prior to this, Mr. Ward was a partner with PricewaterhouseCoopers for 13 years, where he advised multinational companies. He is a Fellow of the Institute of Chartered Accountants in England and Wales and is a Dutch Registered Accountant. Mr. Ward is chief financial officer of MIH Holdings and a director of MIH BV and several other group companies, and serves as an alternate director for SuperSport and M-Net.
 
Andre Coetzee has been a legal advisor to the MIH group and associated companies since 1985. Before joining the Naspers group, Dr. Coetzee was a partner at Mallinicks Attorneys from 1984 to 1999. In June 1999 he became the MIH group’s general counsel.
 
Mark Sorour began his career with the Naspers group in 1994 involved with corporate finance. Prior to joining the Naspers group, Mr. Sorour was an investment banker with Hill Samuel and Banque Indosuez and held various positions in the audit and corporate finance division of PricewaterhouseCoopers. Currently, he is chief investment officer.
 
Jim Volkwyn began his career with the Naspers group in 1993 as finance manager of M-Net, where he remained until 1995. From 1996 to 1997, he was chief operating officer and finance manager of MultiChoice Africa. Subsequently, Mr. Volkwyn was chief executive officer of MultiChoice Africa for three years, where he remains on the board of directors. In 2000, he was appointed chief executive officer of MIH’s pay-television platforms.
 
Antonie Roux joined the Naspers group in 1979 and was a founding member of M-Net in 1985. In 1997, Mr. Roux was appointed chief executive officer of M-Web South Africa. Currently, he is chief executive officer of internet operations, a position he has held since 2002.
 
Jan Steenkamp has been with the Naspers group since 1985 serving in various management positions until he became chief executive officer of OpenTV in 1997. Mr. Steenkamp served as chairman of OpenTV until the group sold its interest in OpenTV in August 2002. Currently, he is the CEO of Entriq.
 
Graham Kill expanded his responsibilities from chief financial officer and operations director of Irdeto to chief executive officer in August 1998. Previous positions include business development associate at NetHold and FilmNet, and various management positions in UK-based companies.
 
Nolo Letele joined M-Net in 1990 and has held a number of senior positions within the MIH group. Prior to that he was a broadcasting engineer at the Lesotho National Broadcasting Service. Currently he is CEO of MultiChoice South Africa.
 
Kim Reid began his career with Naspers in 2000. He was the chief financial officer of MultiChoice before being appointed the chief executive officer of M-Web in 2003. Prior to joining the Naspers group, he held managerial positions at Barlows Limited, the Gary Player group and Sony Music.
 
Glen Marques began his career with the Naspers group in 1997 as director of business development for SuperSport International Holdings Limited and in 1999 he was appointed chief operations officer of SuperSport. Prior to joining the group, he worked as senior legal adviser to the South African Independent Broadcasting Authority and executive director of the National Association of Broadcasters. He was appointed as M-Net chief executive officer in May 2000.
 
Heinrich Enslin joined M-Net in 1990 and was appointed as the MIH group management accountant in 1997. In 1998 he was appointed as the chief financial officer of SuperSport and assumed his current position as chief executive officer of SuperSport in 2000.
 
Hein Brand joined the Naspers group in 1998 as finance executive. He is a former financial director of Bonnita (Proprietary) Ltd. He is a former chief executive officer of Via Afrika and financial director of Media24. He was appointed as chief executive of Media24 in April 2005.
 
 
84

 
 
Francois Groepe joined the Anglovaal Group in 1992. In 1995 he joined the South African subsidiary of the international re-insurer, Swiss Re and was later appointed as CFO. In 2002 he was transferred to the company’s head-office in Zurich, Switzerland, where he was senior group controller for the Life and Health Business Group. In August 2003 he returned to South Africa to take up the position of CFO at Media24. In 2004 he was appointed as an executive director of Media24.
 
Jan Malherbe joined the Naspers group in 1983 as Group Human Resource Manager, and has held a number of senior positions within the Media24 group. He is a director of Media24 and other companies within the group. Currently he is CEO of Media24 Newspapers.
 
Patricia Scholtemeyer began her career with the Naspers group in 2000 as the publisher of Media24’s woman’s magazines. Prior to joining the Naspers group, she was chief executive of trade and business titles at Johnnic Communication Limited. Currently she is CEO of Media24 Magazines, a division of Media24.
 
Stephen van der Walt began his career with the Naspers group in 2000 as group financial director of Paarl Media Holdings. In 2004 he was appointed chief operating officer of Paarl Media Holdings, and in 2005 chief executive officer of Paarl Media Holdings.
 
Musa Shezi joined the Naspers group in 2000, when he was appointed managing director of the National Education Group (NEG). Dr. Shezi started his career as a teacher in KwaZulu-Natal, subsequently becoming headmaster and executive president of the KwaZulu-Natal National Teachers’ Union. He is a member of several boards of directors, including vice president of the South African Institute of Race Relations. He was appointed managing director of the Via Afrika group in 2005.
 
Sheryl Raine began her affiliation with the Naspers Group in 1991 when she was appointed programme director of M-Net. She then moved to The Netherlands where she held the position of managing director of NetHold Electronic Media. She moved to Greece in 1997, first as CEO of the Digital Pay-TV Platform and was appointed CEO of the overall NetMed operations in Greece and Cyprus in October 1997.
 
Imtiaz Patel joined SuperSport in 2000 as Director of Enterprises. Prior to joining the group he was Director of Professional Cricket at the United Cricket Board (UCB), having held several positions at the UCB since 1991. He serves on the boards of Natal Sharks, Free State Rugby and Griqualand West Rugby, as well as Centurion Park Investments, Dolphins and Western Province Cricket. He is chief executive officer of SuperSport United Football Club and a member of the Premier Soccer League board. He is also secretary of the National Transformation Monitoring Committee of the United Cricket Board. In March 2005 he was appointed CEO of SuperSport South Africa.
 
Eben Greyling joined the MIH group in 1996 as group financial manager of MultiChoice. In 1997 he was appointed general manager operations and in 1999 CFO of MultiChoice. In 2000 he became CFO of MIH pay-television platforms, a position he held until his appointment as CEO of MultiChoice Sub-Saharan Africa in 2005. Eben is a Chartered Accountant and completed his articles at PricewaterhouseCoopers. He held various positions in the audit and corporate finance division of PricewaterhouseCoopers until 1995.
 
6.B.  Compensation
 
Directors
 
The individual non-executive directors of Naspers received the following compensation during fiscal 2006:
 
Non-executive Directors
Directors fees
Committee(1)
and trustee(2)
fees
Total
 
R’000
R’000
R’000
       
Ton Vosloo(3),(4),(5) 
1,863    
        
1,863    
Boetie van Zyl(3),(5) 
535    
460        
995    
Prof. Elize Botha 
157    
        
157    
Lourens Jonker 
175    
        
175    
Neil van Heerden 
175    
        
175    
Ben van der Ross 
        175    
4        
179    
Prof. Jakes Gerwel(3), (6) 
435    
60        
495    
 
 
85

 
 
Prof. Hein Willemse 
175    
3    
178    
Adv. Francine-Ann du Plessis 
175    
220    
395    
Prof. Rachel Jafta  
175    
150    
325    
Fred Phaswana 
175    
    
175    
Total 
4,215    
897    
5,112    
___________
 
(1)
Committee fees include fees for the attendance at the audit committee, the human resources and nomination committee, the budget committee and the executive committee meetings of the board.
 
(2)
Trustee fees include fees for attendance of the various retirement fund trustee meetings of the group’s retirement funds, as well as for the attendance at Welkom trustee meetings.
 
(3)
Directors’ fees include fees for services as directors of Media24.
 
(4)
Directors’ fees include fees for services as directors of Via Afrika.
 
(5)
Directors’ fees include fees for services as directors of MIH Holdings and MIH BV.
 
(6)
Directors’ fees include fees for services as directors of Educor Holdings Limited.
 
 
The individual executive directors of Naspers received the following salary, bonuses and related benefits compensation during fiscal 2006:
 
Executive directors
Salary
Bonuses
Pension and medical benefits
Total
         
 
R’000
R’000
R’000
R’000
         
Koos Bekker(1)
Steve Pacak
1,957
2,200
196
4,353
 
Mr. Pacak qualifies for salary and bonuses, as well as share allocations under the Naspers’ share incentive scheme. Details in respect of the participation by the executive directors of Naspers in scheme shares not yet released in the Naspers share incentive scheme are as follows:
 
Name
Date of Grant
Number of
Class N
ordinary shares
Purchase
Price Per
Share (Rand)
Future Vesting Date
         
Koos Bekker(1) 
October 1, 2002
817,470
23.35
October 1, 2006
 
October 1, 2002
817,471
24.50
October 1, 2007
 
December 17, 2002
745,426
30.37
December 17, 2006
 
December 17, 2002
745,428
31.54
December 17, 2007
Steve Pacak
January 2, 2003
166,666
23.50
January 7, 2007
 
January 2, 2003
166,668
23.50
January 7, 2008
 
September 9, 2004
33,333
50.00
September 9, 2007
 
September 9, 2004
33,333
50.00
September 9, 2008
 
September 9, 2004
33,334
50.00
September 9, 2009
___________
 
(1)   Mr. Bekker has allocations, as indicated above, in the share incentive scheme, in terms of which Naspers Class N ordinary shares can be acquired at certain prices, with vesting of three tranches taking place over periods of five years. The purchase prices relating to the allocations were set at the middle market price of the shares on the purchase date, but increased by anticipated inflation over the course of the vesting periods of three, four and five years respectively for each of the tranches. Inflation expectations were calculated by the Bureau for Economic Research of Stellenbosch University. Mr. Bekker does not earn any remuneration from the group, in particular no salary, bonus, car scheme, medical or pension contributions of any nature whatever are payable. Mr. Bekker’s current contract was approved by the shareholders in general meeting on August 30, 2002, and will expire on September 30, 2007. No compensation will be payable upon termination.
 
 
 
86


 
Senior Management
 
The aggregate salary, bonus and related benefits compensation paid by Naspers and the amount set aside by Naspers to provide pension, retirement and similar benefits to the named senior management as a group during fiscal 2006, was as follows:
 
 
Rand
(thousands)
   
    Short-term employee benefits
61,243
    Post-employment benefits
5,259
    Share-based payment charges
24,032
    Total
90,534
___________
 
The human resources and nomination committee of the Naspers board have approved a bonus incentive scheme for senior executives of Naspers. These bonus payments are based on performance objectives and are formally authorized by this committee.
 
6.C.                 Board Practices
 
See “Item 6.A. Directors and Senior Management” for a description of the terms for which the individual directors have held office.
 
Non-executive directors that are not re-elected will receive no additional benefits upon the termination of their appointment. The directors’ service contracts, as well as Mr. Bekker’s contract, do not provide for any pre-determined compensation as a result of termination.
 
Audit and risk management committee
 
The members of the audit and risk management committee during fiscal 2006 were Mr. JJM van Zyl (Chair), Advocate F-A du Plessis, Dr. RCC Jafta and Mr. T Vosloo (appointed on November 25, 2005). During fiscal 2006, the audit and risk management committee held four meetings.
 
The responsibilities of this committee also include risk management, as well as compliance with the JSE, the SEC and the Nasdaq requirements. A board-approved charter, which defines the committee’s mandate and responsibilities, has been adopted. The main responsibilities of the committee are to:
 
-
 
review and recommend to the board the company’s annual reports, including the annual report on Form 20-F, interim and provisional reports;
-
review and make recommendations to the board relating to the viability of the group companies and the group as an ongoing concern; 
-
 
receive, review and discuss the external auditors’ reports; 
-
 
evaluate and approve the external auditors’ plans, scope of findings and reports; 
-
 
evaluate the effectiveness of the internal auditing function, including its purpose, activities, scope, adequacy and costs, and approve the annual internal audit plan and any material changes thereto;
-
 
evaluate procedures and systems (including, without limitation, internal controls, financial reporting and disclosure controls and procedures, and information systems) introduced by management, ensuring that these are functioning effectively; 
-
 
review and approve the activities, scope, adequacy and effectiveness of the company’s risk management and associated regulatory procedures;
 
 
 
87

 
 
 
-
 
ensure compliance with the group’s code of ethics as well as the code for financial officers (as applicable);
-
 
determine the principles for the use of the external auditors for non-audit services;
-
 
evaluate legal matters which may affect the financial statements, and
-
  establish procedures for the receipt, retention and treatment of complaints received by the company regarding accounting, internal control or auditing matters.
 
 
The chairman and members of this committee are all non-executive directors. The committee meets at least three times a year with members of executive management, as well as with the internal and external auditors. Both the internal and external auditors have unrestricted access to this committee. It is a duty of the audit committee to ensure that the independence of the external auditor is not impaired. A policy regulating non-audit services provided by the external auditors has been adopted. An annual self-evaluation on the functioning of the committee is also performed.
 
6.D.                 Employees
 
General
 
As of March 31, 2006, Naspers and its subsidiaries had 12,067 full-time employees and 3,643 part-time employees. As of March 31, 2006, approximately 9.5% of Naspers’ employees in South Africa were represented by trade unions. Naspers believes that its labor relations are satisfactory. The following table relates to the employees employed by Naspers and its subsidiary companies.
 
   
2005
 
2006
 
   
Permanent
 
Temporary
 
Permanent
 
Temporary
 
Electronic media
                 
    - Pay-television
   
1,458
   
281
   
2,110
   
1,065
 
- Technology
   
427
   
19
   
298
   
45
 
    - Internet
   
1,079
   
213
   
1,406
   
210
 
Print media
   
   
             
    - Newspapers, magazines and printing
   
5,172
   
352
   
6,542
   
897
 
- Education
   
1,364
   
663
   
854
   
1,280
 
- Books
   
1,317
   
200
   
857
   
146
 
Total
   
10,817
   
1,728
   
12,067
   
3,643
 

 
Regulation of the South African Labor Market
 
In 1994, the South African government embarked on a program to reform South African labor laws. The primary purpose of the reforms was to secure greater protection for employees. The core of the new labor law framework is the Labour Relations Act, 1995 (the “Labour Relations Act”) which governs relations between employees and management.
 
The Labour Relations Act provides for more expansive rights of union organizations, wide powers to strike and the establishment of workplace forums. These reforms have promoted decentralization of day-to-day decision making to workplace and company levels while centralizing the major collective bargaining issues at industry sector levels. The Labour Relations Act has established simpler and more effective procedures for conciliation, mediation and arbitration and encourages employers to reach collective agreements with recognized union organizations. In the absence of any collective agreement between the union and the employer regulating collective bargaining issues, the provisions of the Labour Relations Act apply and provide specific requirements to allow for participative management between employers and employees.
 
The Labour Relations Act also seeks to protect employees from unfair dismissal. It specifies what types of conduct constitute unfair conduct on the part of an employer towards an employee and provides for specific rules relating to the relief an employee is entitled to in the event the employee is unfairly dismissed. Finally, in the context of a transfer of a business, the Labour Relations Act seeks to protect employees by providing for the automatic transfer of their employment contracts to the new owner of the business.
 
 
 
88

 
 
The Labor Relations Act has been extensively amended with effect from August 1, 2002. The most notable amendments are the right to strike in opposition of large retrenchment exercises and a more employer-friendly dispensation on compensation for unfair dismissal. The amendments also create presumptions in favor of “independent contractors”, making it possible for them to claim rights as employees. The amendments also seek to clarify the transfer of contracts of employment in the case of transfers of a business, trade or undertaking as a going concern.
 
In December 1998, new minimum labor standards legislation in the form of the Basic Conditions of Employment Act, 1997 came into force in South Africa. The most important rights granted to employees by the Basic Conditions are:
 
·      
the reduction of maximum ordinary hours of work from 48 to 45 hours per week;
 
·      
the increase in the rate of pay for overtime from time plus one-third to time plus one-half, except on Sundays and public holidays where the rate is doubled;
 
·      
the introduction of minimum daily (12 continuous hours) and weekly (36 continuous hours) rest periods;
 
·      
the requirement that night workers should receive a special night shift allowance or other compensation and transport facilities;
 
·      
the increase of the minimum annual period of paid leave to 15 working days;
 
·      
the increase of maternity leave to 4 consecutive months (the payment of maternity benefits are determined by the Minister of Labor subject to the provisions of the Unemployment Insurance Act 1966);
 
·      
the requirement that employees be granted family responsibility leave (in the event of a birth or death in the immediate family or illness of a child) of at least three days per year; and
 
·      
the introduction of minimum notice periods for termination of employment.
 
The Basic Conditions of Employment Act also provide for mandatory compensation in the event of termination of employment for operational reasons. This Act was amended with effect from August 1, 2002, to
 
·      
regulate the extension of overtime by collective agreement;
 
·      
regulate the payment of contributions to benefit funds;
 
·      
provide for the determination of categories of payment to calculate remuneration;
 
·      
provide for employees whose contracts of employment terminate due to insolvency to receive severance pay; and
 
·      
specify circumstances under which ordinary hours of work can be varied.
 
On March 24, 2003, the threshold of earnings for employees outside the scope of the Acts was increased to Rand 115,572. In addition, in a new regulation published on July 1, 2003, the term ‘remuneration’ is redefined to include certain benefits and allowances, thereby increasing the levels of notice pay, leave pay and severance pay payable under this Act.
 
The Employment Equity Act, 1998 (the “Employment Equity Act”) requires certain designated employers, including employers who employ 50 or more employees, to promote equal opportunity and fair treatment by eliminating unfair discrimination and to implement affirmative action measures designed to ensure that suitably qualified persons from previously disadvantaged groups have equal employment opportunities and are equitably represented in the workforces of the designated employers. Designated employers are required to implement an employment equity plan designed to achieve reasonable progress

89


towards such employment equity. The Employment Equity Act empowers the Director General of the Department of Labour and labor inspectors, through inspections, reviews and the referral of contraventions to the Labour Court, to enforce the employment equity obligations contained in the Employment Equity Act. In the event of a referral to the Labour Court, the Labour Court may make any appropriate order including an order:
 
·      
requiring the employer to comply with the provisions of the Employment Equity Act,
 
·      
requiring the employer to pay compensation or damages by an employer to an employee in certain circumstances; and
 
·      
imposing monetary fines up to a maximum of Rand 900,000 for contraventions of certain provisions of the Employment Equity Act.
 
The Skills Development Act, 1998 and the Skills Development Levies Act, 1999 provide for compulsory contributions by employers to Sector Educational and Training Authorities at a rate of 1.0% of an employer’s total expenditure on wages and salaries.
 
The Compensation for Occupational Injuries and Diseases Act 130 of 1993 (“COIDA”) covers injuries, disablement, disease and death caused by work-related activities. COIDA applies to most employment relationships, where either casual or full-time employees are as a result of a workplace accident or work-related disease, injured, disabled, or killed; or become ill. COIDA does not apply to workers who are, amongst others, totally or partially disabled for less than 3 days; domestic workers, anyone receiving military training; persons employed outside the RSA for 12 or more continuous months.
 
Unlike COIDA the Unemployment Insurance Fund Act 63 of 2001 (“UIF”), which provides compensation and relief to unemployed workers, applies to nearly all employment relationships. The only exclusions are persons working less then 24 hours a month, public servants, foreign nationals working on contract, persons who receive a State (old age) pension and those who only earn commission. Domestic workers are included in terms of the UIF since the amendments of April 2003.
 
6.E.                  Share Ownership
 
Almost all of Naspers’ executive directors and senior management participate in the Naspers share incentive scheme. A number also participate in one or more of the various share incentive schemes Naspers operates at a subsidiary level, most notably the MIH Holdings and MIH (BVI) Limited share incentive schemes. Pursuant to a resolution of Naspers shareholders taken on September 3, 2004, the total number of Class N ordinary shares, having regard to the number of Class N ordinary shares allocated to but not yet released to participants under the various share incentive schemes, shall not in the aggregate at any given time exceed 11% of the total issued Class N ordinary shares then in issue.
 
The trustees of the share incentive schemes may at any time, with the agreement of the beneficiaries, cancel any acquisition of scheme shares to the extent that delivery of the scheme shares has not yet occurred. In circumstances where the acquisition price (as defined in the share scheme) of scheme shares is substantially higher than the current market price thereof, the trustees may in their discretion determine that the current awards no longer serve as an incentive to beneficiaries and that they should be cancelled as permitted by the share scheme.
 
Upon the completion of the Naspers reorganization in 2002 (see “Item 4.A. History and Development”), the rights previously granted to employees to purchase MIH Limited Class A ordinary shares under the MIH Limited Share Trust were converted into a right to purchase 3.5 Class N ordinary shares or 0.35 Naspers ADSs, as the case may be, for each MIH Limited Class A ordinary share an employee would otherwise have been entitled to acquire. In addition, upon completion of the scheme of arrangement between Naspers and MIH Holdings (see “Item 4.A. History and Development”), the rights granted to employees to purchase MIH Holdings ordinary shares under the MIH Holdings Limited Share Trust were converted into a right to purchase one Class N ordinary share for every 2.25 MIH Holdings ordinary shares an employee would otherwise have been entitled to acquire. The MIH Limited and MIH Holdings trust deeds have been amended to reflect the changes to each share scheme resulting from the reorganization.
 
In April 2004, upon completion of the schemes of arrangement between Naspers, M-Net and SuperSport, the rights granted to employees to purchase M-Net and SuperSport ordinary shares under the Electronic Media Network Limited Share Trust and SuperSport International Holdings Limited Share Trust respectively, were converted into a right to purchase one Class N ordinary share for every 4.5 M-Net/SuperSport linked unit an employee would otherwise have been entitled to acquire. The
 
 
90

 
 
Electronic Media Network Limited Trust and SuperSport International Holdings Limited Share Trust deeds have been amended to reflect the changes to each share scheme resulting from the scheme of arrangement.
 
The aggregate number of Class N ordinary shares allocated to the executive directors and senior management, participating in the group’s share incentive plans at March 31, 2006 was 13,200,771 at purchase prices ranging from Rand 28.81 to Rand 123.50 and vesting periods until March 22, 2011.
 
Naspers Share Incentive Scheme
 
Pursuant to the deed constituting the Naspers Limited Share Trust, Naspers established the Naspers Limited Share Scheme on August 14, 1987, and appointed trustees to administer the share scheme. The share scheme is intended to provide an incentive to Naspers’ employees, by giving them an opportunity to acquire Class N ordinary shares. Voting control for the Naspers Share Trust is exercised by two trustees. They are non-executive directors of Naspers and are not allowed to participate in the share incentive scheme. Naspers may allocate to the Naspers Limited Share Trust a number of Class N ordinary shares which represent in aggregate, no more than 11% of the total number of issued Class N ordinary shares. These shares become “scheme shares” for the purpose of the share scheme and an amount equal to the total consideration payable in respect of the scheme shares is advanced by Naspers to the trust on the basis of an interest-free loan.
 
Under the share scheme, the trustees may make offers or grant options in respect of scheme shares to selected employees at a price equal to the higher of the nominal value or market price, or a price determined by the trustees within the Rules of the JSE. The employees are selected and the number of shares offered per participant are determined by the trustees within an allotment structure approved by the human resources and nomination committee of the Naspers board. Each offer sets forth the terms on which it may be accepted. The time period for acceptance is usually within 30 days from the date of the offer, and the maximum period which may be allowed for the payment of the purchase price is not later than 10 years after the effective date of the offer. Under the share scheme, irrespective of whether the purchase price has been paid or not, the shares will generally not be released before the third, fourth and fifth anniversaries of the effective date of the offer. The trustees may, however, in their discretion allow earlier release dates.
 
MIH Limited Share Incentive Scheme
 
Pursuant to the deed constituting the MIH Limited Share Trust, MIH Limited established the MIH Limited share scheme on March 25, 1999, and appointed trustees to administer the share scheme. MIH Limited could allocate to the trust a number of Class A Ordinary Shares which represented, in aggregate, no more than 10% of the total issued share capital of MIH Limited. Voting control for the trust was exercised by the trustees who were independent of the Naspers group. Class A ordinary shares which were allotted to the Trust for the purpose of the share scheme become “scheme shares” and an amount equal to the total consideration payable in respect of the scheme shares was advanced by MIH Limited to the Trust as an interest-free loan. Under the share scheme, the trustees offered or granted options in respect of MIH Limited shares to selected employees at a price determined by the trustees in accordance with the provisions of the trust deed, which price was the market value on the day on which an offer was made to an employee. The employees were selected and the number of shares was determined by the compensation committee of the MIH Limited board, which advised the trustees accordingly.
 
Each offer set forth the terms on which it could be accepted. The time period for acceptance was usually within 14 days from the date of the offer, and the maximum period which could be allowed for the payment of the purchase price was 5 years and 105 days from the effective date of the offer (where a beneficiary was a resident, for taxation purposes, in the Netherlands) or not later than 10 years after the effective date of the offer (in the case of all other beneficiaries). Under the share scheme, the purchase price could not be paid before the third and fourth anniversaries, respectively, of the date on which the offer was made and then not in respect of more than one-third and two-thirds respectively of the shares subject to the offer. After the fifth anniversary of the offer date, the purchase price could be paid in respect of all the shares subject to the offer. The trustees could, however, in their discretion allow earlier payment dates.
 
Similarly, each option set out the terms on which it could be exercised. The maximum period which could be allowed for the exercise of an option was 5 years and 105 days from the date the option was granted (where the beneficiary is a resident, for taxation purposes, in the Netherlands) or not later than 10 years after the date the option was granted (in the case of all other beneficiaries). However, options were generally exercisable immediately on (or within a short period after) the date on which they were granted. The implementation of the resulting contract (being the payment of the purchase price against delivery) could not be effected before the third and fourth anniversaries, respectively, of the grant date and then not in respect of more than one-third and two-thirds, respectively, of the shares subject to the option. After the fifth anniversary of the option date, the contract  
 
91

 
could be implemented in respect of all the shares subject to the option. The trustees could, however, in their discretion allow earlier implementation.

Upon completion of the merger between MIH Limited and MIH (BVI) Limited as part of Naspers’ 2002 reorganization, the share scheme and the underlying trust deed were amended so that, among other things, the shares in MIH Limited held by the trustees were exchanged for Class N ordinary shares and Naspers ADSs, and the name of the trust was changed to the MIH (BVI) Limited Share Trust. The rights of participating employees to acquire Class A ordinary shares in MIH Limited have been substituted by rights to acquire either Class N ordinary shares or Naspers ADSs in the manner set out above. The trustees may offer or grant options in respect of Class N ordinary shares or Naspers ADSs to selected qualifying employees.
 
On July 1, 2003 the trustees gave all MIH Limited share scheme participants an opportunity to convert their Naspers ADSs, listed on Nasdaq and payable in U.S. dollars, to Class N ordinary shares listed on the JSE and payable in Rand, and their Class N ordinary shares payable in U.S. dollar to being payable in Rand.
 
MIH Holdings Share Incentive Scheme
 
The MIH Holdings share scheme, which operates in a similar manner to the MIH (BVI) Limited share scheme, was amended upon completion of the Naspers 2002 reorganization so that the shares underlying the scheme are currently Class N ordinary shares in Naspers rather than shares in MIH Holdings.
 
The MIH Holdings share trust has three trustees; one is a non-executive director of Naspers, one is an executive director of Naspers and one is independent of the Naspers group. Voting control is exercised by the trustees.
 
Historically Mr. Pacak has been a participant under the MIH Holdings Share Incentive Scheme. In December 2002, Naspers Limited acquired all the MIH Holdings ordinary shares held by the MIH Holdings Share Trust in exchange for Naspers Class N ordinary shares. Participants exchanged their rights to MIH Holdings shares for Naspers Class N ordinary shares. On July 22, 2005, 44,444 Naspers Class N ordinary shares were delivered to Mr. Pacak upon payment of the amount at an average price of Rand 13.64 per share and on the same day, 5,333 Naspers N ordinary shares were delivered to Mr. Pacak upon payment of the amount at an average price of Rand 20.05 per share (the original average offer prices based on the listed market prices of MIH Holdings shares on the date of the offers) due to the MIH Holdings Share Trust. The closing price of a Naspers share on July 22, 2005 was Rand 92.35. Mr. Pacak still owns these shares. At March 31, 2006, a total of 66,531 (2005: 116,308) Naspers Class N ordinary shares had been allocated to Mr. Pacak with vesting periods until February 18, 2007.
 
SuperSport Share Incentive Scheme
 
Pursuant to the Naspers 2002 reorganization, SuperSport received Class N ordinary shares which it distributed to its shareholders by way of a capital reduction, in the ratio of 4.2365 Class N ordinary shares for every 100 SuperSport shares. SuperSport share incentive scheme participants also participated in the distribution of Class N ordinary shares in proportion to the SuperSport options they already held on the distribution date.
 
The SuperSport Share Incentive Scheme was amended upon completion of the scheme of arrangement in April 2004, so that the shares underlying the scheme are currently Class N ordinary shares in Naspers rather than shares in SuperSport International Holdings Limited.
 
The SuperSport Share Trust has two trustees; one is an executive director of Naspers and one is independent of Naspers. Voting control is exercised by the trustees.
 
Historically Mr. Pacak has been a participant under the SuperSport Share Incentive Scheme. In March 2003 SuperSport completed a capital reduction, in terms of which Naspers Class N ordinary shares were distributed to its shareholders, including the SuperSport Share Incentive Trust. In terms of his participation in the SuperSport Share Incentive Scheme, 2,119 Naspers Class N ordinary shares have been allocated to Mr. Pacak with vesting periods until August 26, 2004.

In March 2004 Naspers Limited acquired all the SuperSport ordinary shares held by the SuperSport Share Incentive Trust in exchange for Naspers Class N ordinary shares. Participants could exchange their rights to SuperSport shares for Naspers Class N ordinary shares. A total of 5,305 Naspers Class N ordinary shares have been allocated to Mr. Pacak with vesting periods until August 26, 2004.
 
 
92

 
 
M-Net Share Incentive Scheme
 
The M-Net Share Incentive Scheme was amended upon completion of the scheme of arrangement in April 2004, so that the shares underlying the scheme are currently Class N ordinary shares in Naspers rather than shares in M-Net.
 
The M-Net Share Trust has three trustees; one is a non-executive director of Naspers, one an executive director of Naspers and one is independent of Naspers. Voting control is exercised by the trustees.
 
Historically Mr. Pacak has been a participant under the M-Net Share Incentive Scheme. In March 2004 Naspers Limited acquired all the M-Net ordinary shares held by the M-Net Share Incentive Trust in exchange for Naspers Class N ordinary shares. Participants could exchange their rights to M-Net shares for Naspers Class N ordinary shares. A total of 5,805 Naspers Class N ordinary shares have been allocated to Mr. Pacak with vesting periods until August 26, 2004.
 
Share Holdings
 
The directors of Naspers beneficially and non-beneficially owned the following interests in Class A and Class N ordinary shares as of March 31, 2006:
 
   
Class N ordinary shares
 
Class A
ordinary shares
 
           
Ton Vosloo 
 
275,000
 
 
Koos Bekker 
 
4,917,316(1)
 
 
Steve Pacak 
 
508,484(2)
 
 
Boetie van Zyl 
   
224,154
   
745
 
Lourens Jonker 
   
68,000
   
 
Neil van Heerden 
   
1,300
   
 
Ben van der Ross 
   
   
 
Prof. Jakes Gerwel 
   
   
 
Prof. Hein Willemse 
   
   
 
Adv. Francine-Ann du Plessis 
   
500
   
 
Prof. Rachel Jafta  
   
   
 
Fred Phaswana 
   
630
   
 
Directors as a group 
   
10,634,889(3)
 
 
570,089(4)(5)
 
__________
 
(1)  
Vested Class N ordinary shares in the Naspers Share Incentive Scheme which have reached a vesting date.
 
(2)  
This includes 266,666 vested Class N ordinary shares in the Naspers Share Incentive Scheme which have reached a vesting date.
 
(3)  
This includes 4,639,505 Class N ordinary shares (excluding the shareholdings listed in note 1 and 2 above) held by the Naspers Share Incentive Trust, which shares may be considered to be beneficially owned by two directors of Naspers since these directors are also trustees of the Naspers Share Incentive Trust. In terms of the regulations of the JSE, the Naspers Share Incentive Trust is prohibited from voting in respect of certain types of shareholder resolutions.
 
(4)  
This includes the 569,344 Class A ordinary shares held by Naspers Beleggings Limited and Keeromstraat 30 Beleggings Limited, which shares may be considered to be beneficially owned by certain directors of Naspers since those directors are also directors of such entities and have voting power over these shares.
 
(5)  
As publicly announced, an agreement was reached in terms of which Sanlam Limited (“Sanlam”) sold 168,605 Naspers Beleggings Limited ordinary shares, 16,860,500 Keeromstraat 30 Beleggings Limited ordinary shares and 133,350  Naspers Class A ordinary shares into a new entity, Wheatfields 221 (Proprietary) Limited (“Wheatfields”). Sanlam owns 50% of Wheatfields, while Mr JP Bekker acquired an indirect 25% interest in Wheatfields.
 
 
93

 
 
ITEM 7.         MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
 
7.A.                 Major Shareholders
 
Naspers’ capital stock consists of Class A ordinary shares and Class N ordinary shares. Certain Class N ordinary shares are represented by ADSs. As of March 31, 2006, Naspers had 712,131 Class A ordinary shares outstanding and 315,113,700 Class N ordinary shares outstanding.

The Class N ordinary shares are listed on the JSE and carry one vote per share on a poll. Naspers ADSs are listed on the Nasdaq Stock Market in the United States, and holders of ADSs are entitled to the voting rights of the underlying Class N ordinary shares, subject to certain terms of the ADSs relating to voting procedures. From July 15, 2005, 1 ADS represents 1 class N ordinary share. The Class A ordinary shares are not listed on any stock exchange and carry 1,000 votes per share on a poll. The holders of the Class A ordinary shares collectively hold 69.3% of Naspers’ total voting rights. Naspers, through Heemstede Beleggings (Proprietary) Limited, a wholly owned subsidiary of Naspers, holds 49% of Naspers Beleggings Limited which, in turn, holds 49.15% of Class A ordinary shares. Keeromstraat 30 Beleggings Limited holds 30.80% of Class A ordinary shares. The members of the boards of directors of Keeromstraat 30 Beleggings Limited, Naspers Beleggings Limited and Heemstede Beleggings (Proprietary) Limited are mostly also members of the board of directors of Naspers Limited. Therefore, Naspers’ board will determine to a large extent the outcome of any shareholder votes.
 
The following table presents, as of June 30, 2006, the beneficial ownership of each class of Naspers’ ordinary shares by each person or entity which, to Naspers’ knowledge, owns more than 5% or more of either class of its ordinary shares, and all of Naspers’ directors as a group.
 
Unless otherwise indicated, to Naspers’ knowledge, all persons listed below have sole voting and investment power with respect to their ordinary shares, except to the extent applicable law gives spouses shared authority.
 
BENEFICIAL OWNER
 
NUMBER OF
CLASS A
ORDINARY
SHARES
 
PERCENTAGE
OF CLASS A
ORDINARY
SHARES
 
NUMBER OF
CLASS N
ORDINARY
SHARES
 
PERCENTAGE
OF CLASS N
ORDINARY
SHARES
 
TOTAL
VOTING
PERCENTAGE
 
                       
Coronation Fund Managers(1)  
   
   
   
37,595,752
   
12.20
%
 
3.66
%
Old Mutual Asset Managers(1)  
   
   
   
30,996,810
   
10.06
%
 
3.02
%
RMB Asset Management(1)  
   
   
   
22,588,646
   
7.33
%
 
2.20
%
Investec Asset Management(1)  
   
   
   
19,304,489
   
6.26
%
 
1.88
%
Allan Gray Ltd(1) 
   
   
   
18,709,851
   
6.07
%
 
1.82
%
Sanlam Investment Management(1)(2)(3) 
   
   
   
9,240,306
   
3.00
%
 
0.90
%
Wheatfields(3) 
   
133,350
   
18.73
%
 
   
   
12.98
%
Naspers Beleggings Limited(4) 
   
350,000
   
49.15
%
 
   
   
34.07
%
Keeromstraat 30 Beleggings Limited(4) 
   
219,344
   
30.80
%
 
   
   
21.35
%
Directors as a group 
   
745
   
0.10
%
 
11,830,434
   
3.75
%
 
1.22
%
Total 
   
703,439
   
98.78
%
 
150,266,288
   
47.69
%
 
82.03
%
___________
 
(1)
Asset managers whose shareholdings vary between fiscal years based upon their own portfolio management activities.
 
(2)
Mr. Boetie van Zyl and Adv. F du Plessis, both Naspers directors, are also directors of Sanlam Limited, the holding company of Sanlam Life Insurance Limited of which Sanlam Investment Management (Proprietary) Limited is a wholly-owned subsidiary. Five directors of Sanlam Limited are also directors of Sanlam Investment Management (Proprietary) Limited whilst four directors of Sanlam Life Insurance Limited. are also directors of Sanlam Investment Management (Proprietary) Limited. Both Mr Van Zyl and Adv. F du Plessis are directors of Sanlam Life Insurance Limited, as well as Dr Wilmot James who is a director of Media24 Limited, a major subsidiary of Naspers Limited. Adv. F-A du Plessis is a former director of Sanlam Investment Management (Proprietary) Limited.
 
(3)
During the year, as publicly announced, a transaction took place in terms of which Sanlam sold its holding of Naspers Class A ordinary shares to Wheatfields. Sanlam owns 50% of Wheatfields which holds 18.73% of the Naspers Class A ordinary shares.
 
(4)
Naspers directors also serve on the boards of these public companies.
 
The shareholders listed above do not have different voting rights than other shareholders of the same respective class.
 
 
 
94

 
 
The Public Investment Commission reduced their shareholding in Naspers over the last year. The Public Investment Commission is therefore not listed as a shareholder holding more than 5% of Naspers’ Class N ordinary share capital. Corronation Fund Managers and Allan Gray Limited increased their interests in Naspers during the past year to in excess of 5% of the Class N ordinary share capital of the group.
 
The board of directors of Naspers is not currently aware of any arrangements which may result in a change of control of Naspers.
 
As at the end of June 2006, as far as it has been practicable for Naspers to ascertain, there were no beneficial U.S. holders of Class A ordinary shares and there were 342 beneficial U.S. holders of Class N ordinary shares, totaling 53,623,891 Class N ordinary shares.
 
7.B.  Related Party Transactions
 
Channel Distribution Arrangements
 
Pursuant to channel distribution agreements between MultiChoice South Africa, MultiChoice Africa and M-Net, MultiChoice South Africa and MultiChoice Africa have the rights to distribute the M-Net channels by analog and digital distribution systems and the right to license the reception and distribution of, and to market, the M-Net channels by terrestrial analog and digital satellite distribution systems. M-Net, a joint venture company of Naspers, provides the M-Net, KykNET, K-TV, Channel O and Movie Magic channels and has obtained the rights to pay-television broadcast in many areas of Africa of movies from major movie studios, including Disney, Warner Brothers, Columbia Pictures, Sony, Miramax, Fox, Universal, MCA, Paramount, MGM and DreamWorks. Pursuant to the M-Net channel distribution agreements, MultiChoice South Africa and MultiChoice Africa pay M-Net fees based on subscriber numbers. Through the M-Net channel distribution agreements, MultiChoice South Africa and MultiChoice Africa also have the rights to distribute one of the sports channels and certain sports programming which are provided by SuperSport. SuperSport provides its remaining channels directly to MultiChoice South Africa and MultiChoice Africa. SuperSport has obtained the rights to broadcast certain South African cricket leagues, major international cricket events and the English FA Premier League. SuperSport has also obtained rights to broadcast the South African rugby leagues and major international rugby events. Cricket, rugby and football are three of the most popular sports in South Africa. Pursuant to the channel distribution agreements, MultiChoice South Africa and MultiChoice Africa pay SuperSport fees based on subscriber numbers. During the fiscal years ended March 31, 2006 and 2005, these amounts paid to M-Net and SuperSport totaled approximately Rand 2,182.7 million and Rand 1,909.9 million, respectively.
 
Tencent Holdings Limited
 
The group entered into a number of intellectual property and know-how licensing agreements with Tencent. On June 27, 2002, Tencent granted a sole and exclusive license to a group company to use, and to authorize its affiliates (“the operators”) which carry on business in sub-Saharan Africa (including South Africa), Indonesia, Thailand, Greece and Cyprus to use, certain proprietary intellectual property and know-how of Tencent for a license fee computed at 40% of gross revenue derived by the operators by using this proprietary information. The agreement is for a term of 15 years and expires in 2017.
 
Loans
 
On September 28, 2004, MultiChoice Africa entered into a Consolidated Loan Agreement, a Sales of Shares Agreement in MultiChoice Nigeria Limited and a Pledge and Cession Agreement with Mr. Ogunsanya, a shareholder and director of MultiChoice Nigeria Limited, whereby MultiChoice Africa has lent Naira 689.6 million (approximately U.S. dollar 5.2 million) to Mr. Ogunsanya to facilitate, amongst other things, the purchase of a further 10% shares in MultiChoice Nigeria Limited. The loan bears interest at a rate of 10.22% per annum. The Consolidated Loan Agreement supersedes the Loan Agreement of June 14, 2002 between the parties. Mr. Ogunsanya has ceded all future dividends relating to his shares in MultiChoice Nigeria Limited (which represent a 21% interest in MultiChoice Nigeria Limited) as security for the repayment of such loans. An impairment charge of Rand 30.9 million was raised during fiscal 2006 against the outstanding balance of Rand 39.0 million as this was not deemed recoverable. The remaining balance of Rand 8.1 million is due by March 31, 2007.

An advance of U.S. $0.4 million was made during the 2004 financial year to a minority shareholder in MultiChoice Ghana Limited (“MGL”). The MGL minority shareholders’ loan bears interest at 1% above LIBOR and is secured by a pledge of such shareholders’ shares in MGL. There was no outstanding balance on this advance at March 31, 2006.

 
95

 
 
M-Net and SuperSport
 
On March 31, 2003, M-Net and SuperSport ceded forward exchange contracts (“FECs”) totaling U.S. $49.9 million at no consideration to the group. The FECs ceded are at an average rate of Rand 12.16 to the U.S. dollar and matured between November 28, 2003 and March 31, 2005.
 
M-Net and SuperSport reduced their capital by paying a total of Rand 84.3 million and Rand 62.4 million respectively to their shareholders in March 2006. The group participated in this transaction to the extent of its shareholding in M-Net and SuperSport.
 
Antenna TV (Antenna)
 
In prior years, NetMed NV entered into agreements with Antenna for the purchase of a 5% interest (plus a 10% option) in NetMed NV and for the right to distribute three Antenna channels. In October 2001, Antenna completed the acquisition of 5% of the shares in NetMed NV for a consideration of approximately Rand 94.7 million. Two Antenna channels were aired in the current year. On January 2, 2006, Antenna exercised a put option to sell its stake in NetMed N.V. to Myriad International Holdings BV at a price equal to the fair value per share. The valuation process in respect of determining the fair value of each share was completed in July 2006.
 
Sanlam
 
In addition to being a director of Naspers, Mr. van Zyl and Adv. du Plessis are non-executive directors of Sanlam Limited. Sanlam Limited has three operating subsidiaries, Santam Limited, Sanlam Life Insurance Limited and Sanlam Investment Management (Proprietary) Limited, which provide certain services to Naspers in the ordinary course of business. Santam Limited provides reinsurance services in respect of insurance policies taken out by Naspers to cover general business risks and certain motor vehicle insurances. Sanlam Investment Management (Proprietary) Limited indirectly holds 18.73% of Class A ordinary shares through Wheatfields. Sanlam Investment Management (Proprietary) Limited provides asset management services in respect of some of Naspers’ pension funds. Mr. van Zyl and Adv du Plessis are not directors of Santam Limited nor of Sanlam Investment Management (Proprietary) Limited. Mr. Van Zyl, Adv. du Plessis as well as Dr. Wilmot James, who is a director of Media24, are directors of Sanlam Life Insurance Limited. Mr. Vosloo, the chairman of Naspers, was previously also non-executive chairman of Sanlam Limited, but resigned on June 2, 2004. No material services are provided by Sanlam Life Insurance Limited to Naspers.
 
ABSA
 
In addition to being a director of Naspers, Mr. Jonker is also a non-executive director of ABSA Bank Limited. ABSA provides certain banking services, including the granting of facilities and loans, to Naspers. The services provided are neither material to Naspers nor to ABSA and are provided on customary terms.
 
FirstRand Limited
 
In addition to being a director of Naspers, Mr. Van der Ross is also a non-executive director of FirstRand Limited. FirstRand provides certain banking services, including the granting of facilities and loans, to Naspers. The services provided are neither material to Naspers nor to FirstRand and are provided on customary terms.
 
Atlas Properties
 
In addition to being a director of Naspers, Mr. Van Zyl is also a non-executive director of Atlas Properties Limited (“Atlas”). Atlas provides certain property services to Naspers. The services provided are neither material to Naspers nor to Atlas and are provided on customary terms.
 
Other
 
In addition to the foregoing, the Naspers group has entered into other transactions and has other balances with related parties, including equity investors, directors, shareholders and entities under common control. These transactions are summarized in note 14 to Naspers’ audited consolidated financial statements.
 
 
96

 

ITEM 8.        FINANCIAL INFORMATION

8.A.       Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information
 
           See “Item 18 for Naspers’ consolidated financial statements”.
 
Legal Proceedings
 
Except as described below or elsewhere in this annual report, there are no legal or arbitration proceedings pending or threatened of which Naspers is aware involving Naspers which may have or have had a significant effect on the financial position of Naspers taken as a whole.
 
In December 2000, MultiChoice Hellas SA (“MCH”) received a tax assessment from the Greek tax authorities for approximately €5.4 million relating to the tax treatment of advertising and marketing costs and municipal duties. MCH challenged the assessment and the Court of First Instance found against the company. MCH appealed the decision and the Appeal Court found in favour of MCH. The tax authorities did not lodge a further appeal within the time permitted. However, in February 2006 the tax authorities sent MCH a further assessment for the same amount plus arrear interest amounting to approximately €8 million. MCH has advised the tax authorities that their claim is legally unjustified and, in any case, filed too late. Nevertheless, the authorities have indicated that they intend to pursue their claim in the Greek courts.
 
On November 22, 2001 David Zietsman, Gameplan International SA (Proprietary) Limited and Richard Clark launched proceedings against MultiChoice Africa, M-Net and Vodacom (Proprietary) Limited (the “Defending Companies”), for interdicts and damages arising from alleged breaches by the Defending Companies of confidentiality agreements relating to information which the plaintiffs maintain had been disclosed to MultiChoice Africa. MIH Holdings was joined as a defendant at a later stage in the proceedings. In the course of the litigation, the plaintiffs alleged that MultiChoice Africa personnel passed information to M-Net, MIH Holdings and OpenTV and that these companies used this information for their own benefit and to the detriment of the plaintiffs. The plaintiffs notified the Defending Companies on June 6, 2002 that they intend to increase the amount claimed from approximately Rand 2.9 million to approximately Rand 118 million. If such increase is formally effected and the claimants are fully successful in their action, then these proceedings may have a significant effect on the financial position of Naspers. However, the proposed increase has not yet been formally effected and no further steps have been taken in the proceedings by the plaintiff.
 
On July 26, 2002, NetMed, Myriad International Holdings BV (“MIH BV”) and Fidelity, among others, entered into a share subscription agreement and a share sale agreement under which Fidelity would have acquired a 22% interest in NetMed, for a cash purchase price of U.S. $5 million plus a cash payment equal to an amount which was to be calculated with reference to the value of a subscriber base to be acquired by NetMed. The completion of this transaction was subject to the unconditional approval of the Greek Competition Committee before a stipulated date. The required approval was not received within the contractually agreed upon period and accordingly NetMed and MIH BV believe that the agreements ceased to have any force or effect. As Fidelity disputed this, NetMed and MIH BV initiated arbitration proceedings under the auspices of the London Court of International Arbitration seeking confirmation from the tribunal that the agreements had lapsed. Fidelity counterclaimed for loss and damages allegedly suffered as a result of the actions of NetMed and MIH BV. Fidelity also initiated legal proceedings in the South African courts against Naspers, MIH Holdings and an employee of MIH BV claiming approximately U.S. $62 million (alternatively, approximately U.S. $114 million) on the grounds that these parties unlawfully caused NetMed to terminate its agreements with Fidelity, thereby causing Fidelity financial loss. The arbitration hearings were completed in September 2004 and an award was given in favor of NetMed and MIH BV in December 2004. Fidelity challenged the award in the English courts, but the challenge was dismissed on June 13, 2005. The South African proceedings have been withdrawn.
 
On March 12, 2003, Liberty Media Corporation advised the group that it is seeking indemnification under the agreement dated August 27, 2002 whereby the group sold its shares in OpenTV to Liberty in respect of a claim made against OpenTV by Thomas Weisel Partners LLC (“Weisel”). Weisel has claimed that OpenTV Inc. was required to pay Weisel a fee of approximately U.S. $1.9 million in connection with OpenTV’s acquisition of Wink Communications Inc.
 
A claim, first raised during fiscal 2003, from the Kenyan tax authorities that MultiChoice Kenya should have paid VAT on its agreements with subscribers (involving an amount of approximately U.S. $4.1 million) has been settled on the basis that MultiChoice Kenya pays the tax authorities 62.5 million Kenyan Schillings (approximately U.S. $800,000).
 
 
97

 
 
PaySmart Africa (Proprietary) Limited (“PaySmart”) has claimed approximately Rand 10.4 million from M-Net and Endemol South Africa Limited (“Endemol”) alleging that it would have this amount if M-Net and Endemol had granted it the rights to provide an SMS voting system for Big Brother Africa and Idols, two television shows, as allegedly contemplated in the Heads of Agreement executed by the parties in April 2003. In February 2004, M-Net and Endemol objected to PaySmart’s particulars of claim and since then PaySmart has not taken the proceedings any further.
 
In late December 2004, David Zietsman instituted an action in the South African Patent Court against Endemol South Africa (Proprietary) Limited, M-Net, MultiChoice South Africa, Vodacom and I-Touch South Africa (Proprietary) Limited for unquantified damages based on the alleged infringement by the defendants of one of Mr. Zietsman’s patents in the course of the Big Brother reality shows. The defendants are all defending the action.
 
Call Centre Nucleus (Proprietary) Limited (“CCN”) has claimed approximately Rand 13.5 million from M-Web Holdings arising out of the purchase by M-Web Holdings of a subscriber base from CCN. The matter has been referred to arbitration, but no further steps have been taken by CCN to proceed with the matter.
 
Three former employees of the group have made claims against the Royal Bank of Canada Trustees Limited, being the trustees of the Mindport Share Trust, alleging that the trustees used an incorrect valuation methodology in valuing their scheme shares at the time of the cessation of their employment. Since these claims were made, one of these former employees has started legal proceedings against the Royal Bank of Canada Trustees Limited, which proceedings are being defended.
 
The South African Revenue Service (the “SARS”) has alleged that participants in the Naspers and Media24 share incentive schemes should have paid additional income taxes on gains flowing from such participation and maintained that the employer companies in the group should have withheld such taxes. The group has operated deferred delivery employee share incentive schemes in a consistent manner for approximately 15 years.  Based on the allegation to date, assessments have been raised by SARS on various Naspers group companies totaling approximately Rand 13.6 million including interest charges. Based on the facts and legal advice received, Naspers believes that the claims of  SARS are unfounded and that no adjustment to the Naspers and Media24 share incentive schemes is required. Naspers therefore intends to vigorously defend the assessments raised in relation to the Naspers and Media24 share schemes, in court, if necessary.
 
In 2005 MCC instituted action against Lefkoniko, a Cypriot financial institution, to recover monies that it had invested with Lefkoniko. In order to expedite proceedings, MCC applied for summary judgment, alleging that Lefkoniko did not have a proper defence to its claim. The application was heard in October 2005 and on November 11, 2005 the court gave judgment in MCC’s favour. Since then, further proceedings have been instituted in the Cypriot courts to give effect to the summary judgment against Lefkoniko.
 
In September 2005, Malivision SARL instituted proceedings against MultiChoice Africa in Mali on the basis of an alleged breach by MultiChoice Africa of an exclusive distribution contract between them. Despite the fact that the contract stipulates South African law to govern the contract and the South African courts to handle any disputes, the Mali court heard the matter on June 14, 2006 and ordered MultiChoice Africa to pay Malivision CFA 400,000,000 (approximately U.S. $730,000). The court’s decision has been appealed and the matter is pending.
 
Akani Egoli (Proprietary) Ltd has instituted action against M-Net and Combined Artistic Productions in the High Court of South Africa for damages of Rand 10.6 million allegedly suffered by the plaintiff as a result of an alleged defamation in a television broadcast. On February 15, 2006, the defendants filed their plea and pleadings are now closed. The matter has been referred to M-Net’s insurers.
 
In February 2006, NetMed became aware of the fact that LTV, its co-shareholder in MultiChoice Holdings (Cyprus) Limited (“Holdings”) (which, in turn, owns the majority of the shares in a listed entity, MCC), had entered into arrangements with CYTA (the Cyprus Telecommunications Authority) which NetMed believed were in conflict with LTV’s contractual obligations to NetMed, Holdings, MCC and certain of NetMed’s affiliates, specifically such obligations as flowed from a Shareholders’ Agreement dated June 23, 2000 between NetMed, LTV and Holdings (“The Shareholders Agreement”), a Channel Distribution Agreement of June 21, 2004 between MCC and LTV (the “CDA”) and a programme supply agreement dated January 1, 2004 between LTV and affiliates of NetMed ) (the “PSA”). Pursuant to these facts various legal proceedings have been instituted against LTV in the London Court of International Arbitration (LCIA”) and in the Cypriot courts and are continuing.
 
In March 2006, LTV proposed a public offer offering the shareholders of MCC to acquire their shares in MCC either for cash or for shares in LTV. The public offer was conditional, inter alia, upon the Competition Commission of Cyprus (“CPC”) declaring the CDA and the non-compete provisions in the Shareholders’ Agreement to be invalid. On June 2, 2006 the CPC duly declared the entire Shareholders Agreement and the CDA invalid. As the conditions were fulfilled, the public offer became effective and acceptances from minority shareholders have resulted in LTV having an effective economic interest of more than 48% in MCC.
 
 
98

 
 
On February 23, 2006, NetMed Hellas Pay TV SA filed a request for arbitration under the auspices of the LCIA against the Greek football club PAE Akratitos (“Akratitos”) on the basis that Akratitos had breached its TV Rights Agreement with NetMed Hellas. The claimant maintains that Akratitos has breached the agreement and seeks specific performance and damages from Akratitos.
 
MCA is pursuing a claim against four former employees who defrauded the company through manipulating the IBS Billing System and collecting subscriptions for their own account the amount claimed is approximately Rand 11 million. Bank accounts of the defendants in the United Kingdom and Jersey have been frozen. The matter is pending.
 
Touchline Media (Proprietary) Ltd, a subsidiary of Media24, is a defendant in a defamation claim for damages for an amount of Rand 12 million (increased from a previous Rand 8 million). The claim results from articles and statements published in a magazine. The action is currently pending before a South African court.
 
Onshelf Trading Forth Floor (Proprietary) Ltd t/a Mail and Guardian Online (“Onshelf”) in which M-Web South Africa has a 65% shareholding, which had sold its Q business to Q-Online (Proprietary) Ltd, issued summons in the South African High Court against Q-Online for the payment of an outstanding portion of the purchase price of Rand 200,000. Q-Online then instituted a counterclaim for specific performance of the sale agreement and damages of between Rand 11.0 million and Rand 13.0 million. The litigation has reached the stage where the parties have exchanged discovery affidavits. M-Web believes that the damages claim is grossly inflated.
 
Dividend Policy
 
Either Naspers’ shareholders in general meeting or its board of directors may from time to time declare that final dividends and interim dividends are to be paid to one or more class or classes of shareholders. Naspers’ shareholders in general meeting may not declare a dividend in excess of the amount recommended by the board of directors.
 
Dividends are payable to persons registered as shareholders on a date determined by Naspers’ shareholders in a general meeting or by the board. This date may not be less than 14 days after the date of the publication of the announcement of the dividend, provided that the record date to receive the dividend is a Friday or, if the relevant Friday is not a business day, on the last preceding business day. Any dividend may be paid or satisfied, either in whole or in part, by the distribution of specific assets as the board may determine and direct.
 
Any dividend or other sum payable to a shareholder in respect of its shareholding may be transmitted by ordinary post to the address of the shareholder recorded in the register of shareholders or any other address provided in writing to Naspers by the shareholder. Naspers is not responsible for any loss that may occur when the dividend or other sum payable is transmitted to a shareholder.
 
Any unclaimed dividends may be invested or otherwise utilized by the board for Naspers’ benefit until claimed by the shareholder entitled to payment of the dividend. Unpaid dividends do not accrue interest. The board may declare forfeited any dividends not claimed after a period of 12 years or, if Naspers is to be liquidated or deregistered, a period of three years. Forfeited dividends revert to Naspers or its nominee.
 
 
99

 
 
Holders of Class A ordinary shares are entitled to nominal dividends as determined by the board from time to time. However, dividends declared to holders of Class A ordinary shares may not exceed more than one-fifth of the dividends declared to holders of Class N ordinary shares for the same period.
 
Naspers’ articles of association allow payments to be made to shareholders out of profits, share capital or share premium, subject to certain solvency and liquidity requirements being met by Naspers after such payment is made.
 
8.B.       Significant Changes
 
Except as otherwise disclosed in this annual report, no significant change in our business or financial condition has occurred since April 1, 2006.
 
 
100

 
 
ITEM 9.   THE OFFER AND LISTING

9.A.        Offer and Listing details
 
The following table presents the high and low closing sales prices and the average daily trading volume of Class N ordinary shares on the JSE, and Naspers ADSs on Nasdaq in the United States for the periods indicated.
 

   
     
Class N Ordinary Shares
JSE
   
ADSs
Nasdaq 
 
                                       
 
   
High
   
Low
   
Average dailytrading volume
   
High
   
Low
   
Average daily trading volume
 
 
   
(Rand)
   
(Rand)
 
       
(U.S. $)
 
 
(U.S. $)
 
     
Fiscal 2002
                                     
Year ended March 31, 2002 
   
33.15
   
11.90
   
294,149
   
   
   
 
Fiscal 2003
                                     
Year ended March 31, 2003 
   
26.50
   
12.50
   
637,512
   
30.00
   
23.80
   
21,033
 
Fiscal 2004
                                     
First Quarter ended June 30, 2003 
   
29.20
   
19.35
   
844,906
   
36.28
   
24.57
   
6,553
 
Second Quarter ended September 30, 2003 
   
30.00
   
25.49
   
650,814
   
40.61
   
34.00
   
4,402
 
Third Quarter ended December 31, 2003 
   
46.00
   
27.75
   
1,108,681
   
69.55
   
42.00
   
4,863
 
Fourth Quarter ended March 31, 2004 
   
47.00
   
41.10
   
1,382,428
   
69.44
   
56.44
   
4,728
 
Year ended March 31, 2004 
   
47.00
   
19.35
   
995,765
   
69.55
   
24.57
   
5,161
 
Fiscal 2005
                                     
First Quarter ended June 30, 2004 
   
49.50
   
40.00
   
955,356
   
74.69
   
61.00
   
1,247
 
Second Quarter ended September 30, 2004 
   
52.00
   
42.00
   
600,736
   
80.60
   
68.50
   
1,207
 
Third Quarter ended December 31, 2004 
   
75.45
   
51.21
   
620,415
   
134.15
   
79.01
   
1,184
 
Fourth Quarter ended March 31, 2005 
   
82.00
   
65.85
   
692,910
   
138.99
   
104.00
   
2,238
 
Year ended March 31, 2005 
   
82.00
   
40.00
   
713,826
   
138.99
   
61.00
   
1,499
 
Fiscal 2006
                                     
First Quarter ended June 30, 2005 
   
80.21
   
76.90
   
540,655
   
123.08
   
122.14
   
1,767
 
Second Quarter ended September 30, 2005 (1) 
   
99.85
   
97.01
   
726,081
   
29.08
   
28.61
   
5,128
 
Third Quarter ended December 31, 2005 
   
105.78
   
102.43
   
809,825
   
16.26
   
15.85
   
5,292
 
Fourth Quarter ended March 31, 2006 
   
126.53
   
122.37
   
1,187,107
   
20.51
   
20.00
   
10,043
 
Year ended March 31, 2006 
   
103.09
   
99.68
   
815,917
   
19.54
   
19.17
   
5,558
 
April 2006 
   
134.44
   
129.95
   
1,118,913
   
22.10
   
21.54
   
23,543
 
May 2006 
   
129.49
   
124.45
   
1,488,333
   
20.53
   
19.88
   
15,324
 
June 2006 
   
122.18
   
115.69
   
1,579,986
   
17.97
   
16.79
   
17,148
 
July 2006 
   
119.70
   
115.84
   
962,412
   
16.94
   
16.33
   
20,867
 
August 2006 
   
121.67
   
118.60
   
825,264
   
17.35
   
16.96
   
4,095
 
September 2006 (until September 15, 2006) 
   
125.23
   
121.24
   
766,973
   
17.19
   
16.65
   
4,447
 

(1)         The ratio of Naspers Class N ordinary shares to each ADR was changed from 10 Naspers Class N ordinary shares for each Naspers ADR to one Naspers Class N ordinary share for each Naspers ADR on July 15, 2005.
 
9.C.                 Markets
 
See “-9.A. Offer and Listing Details” above.
 
The principal trading market for Naspers’ Class N ordinary shares is the JSE where the shares trade under the symbol “NPN”. ADSs, each representing ten Class N ordinary shares, nominal value Rand 0.02 per share, were listed on Nasdaq on December 27, 2002 and trade under the symbol “NPSN”. This ratio has been changed to one ADS representing one Class N ordinary share on July 15, 2005.
 
 
101

 
 
ITEM 10.       ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
 
10.B.               Memorandum and Articles of Association
 
Naspers incorporates by reference the information called for by Item 10.B. set forth under “Description of Naspers Capital Stock” in its Registration Statement on Form F-4 (Registration number 333-100938) filed on November 1, 2002. Set forth below is additional information required by Item 10.B.
 
Naspers’ Purposes and Objects
 
Clause 2 of Naspers’ memorandum of association provides: “The main business which the Company is to carry on is: investment in entities with interests in print and electronic media, affiliated technological systems and in education”. Clause 3 of the Memorandum of Association further provides: “The main object of the Company is: to invest in entities with interests in print and electronic media, affiliated technological systems and in education”.
 
Conflict of Interest
 
Article 49 of Naspers’ articles of association provides that a director who discloses a material interest in a contract or arrangement with the company may, in accordance with the Companies Act, vote with respect to such contract or arrangement, provided that it does not relate to the regulation of an office held by the director for remuneration, or of a position held by the director with the company or a subsidiary of the Company.
 
Directors
 
Directors are granted the power to borrow from the company under Article 46 of Naspers’ articles of association. Under Article 50, Directors appointed prior to October 26, 2000 are required to vacate their offices upon reaching the age of seventy five years, and directors appointed after this date are required to vacate their offices upon reaching the age of seventy years. In each case the vacation of office is effective from the date of the annual general meeting held in the relevant year. All internal appointments must also be re-appointed by the shareholders at the subsequent annual general meeting.
 
Dividends
 
For information on dividends, see “Item 8.A. Financial Information - Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information”.
 
The Shares
 
Shareholders’ Meetings
 
Under South African law, Naspers is required to hold an annual general shareholder meeting not more than nine months after the end of each financial year and not later than 15 months after the date of it’s most recent annual general shareholder meeting. The Listing Rules of the JSE require that notice of an annual general shareholder meeting, accompanied by the consolidated financial statements to be considered at such meeting, be distributed to shareholders not later than six months after the end of each financial year. Nasdaq listing rules also require an annual shareholder meeting.
 
The board has the power to convene a general shareholder meeting at any time. In addition, the board must convene a meeting upon the request of at least 100 shareholders entitled to vote at general meetings or upon the request of shareholders holding not less than 5% of the votes entitled to be cast at general meetings. If the board fails to give notice of such meeting to shareholders within 14 days of receipt of the notice, the shareholders that requisitioned the general meeting or any portion of them numbering more than 50 or representing more than half of the total voting rights of all shareholders that requisitioned the meeting, may themselves on no less than 21 days’ notice convene a general meeting. Any two or more shareholders holding 10% or more of the total voting rights of Naspers as of the date of the request may convene a general meeting of Naspers’ shareholders without reference to the directors.
 
Naspers is required to provide at least 21 days’ notice of any annual general shareholder meeting or any general shareholder meeting where a special resolution is to be voted upon, and at least 14 days’ notice of all other general shareholder meetings.
 
 
102


 
Naspers’ articles of association require that any notice of general shareholder meetings be in writing and specify the place, date and time of the meeting and the matters to be considered. For such time as Naspers is primarily listed on the JSE, any notice to shareholders must be given simultaneously to the Manager (Listings) of the JSE.
 
A shareholder is entitled to appoint a proxy (which person is not required to be another shareholder) to represent and vote on behalf of the shareholder at any general shareholder meeting, including the annual general shareholder meeting of Naspers in accordance with South African law.
 
Business may not be transacted at any general shareholder meeting, including the annual general meeting, unless a quorum is present. Unless the shareholders at a general meeting resolve that a higher quorum is required, under South African law shareholders holding not less than 25% of the total votes entitled to be cast at the general meeting are required to be present, in person or by proxy, to constitute a quorum for passing special resolutions, provided that if the rights of any specific class of share are amended or canceled, at least three shareholders holding at least one-third of the issued shares of that class must be present to constitute a quorum at a meeting of shareholders of that class called to approve such amendment or cancellation. In all other cases, three shareholders entitled to vote at the general meeting must be personally present at the general meeting to form a quorum.
 
Naspers applied for and received exemption from Nasdaq Marketplace Rule 4350(f) relating to quorum requirements, as Rule 4350(f) is contrary to generally accepted business practices in South Africa. The listing requirements of the JSE rely on the quorum requirements for public companies as set out in the Companies Act, which requirements are set out in the paragraph above.
 
If a quorum is not present within 30 minutes from the time appointed for the general shareholder meeting to commence, the general meeting will stand adjourned to the same calendar day in the next week, or if that day is a public holiday, the next calendar day which is not a public holiday, at the same time and place.
 
Voting Rights
 
Under South African law, subject to any rights or restrictions attached to any class of ordinary shares, every shareholder present and entitled to vote as a member or as proxy or as a representative in the case of a body corporate member, at any shareholders’ meeting will have one vote if the vote is conducted by way of a show of hands. In the case of a poll, any holder of Class N ordinary shares present, in person or by proxy, will have one vote for each Class N ordinary share held by such shareholder, and holders of Class A ordinary shares present, in person or by proxy, will have 1,000 votes for every Class A ordinary share held by such shareholder. A “poll” is voting by means of a ballot where the number of shares held by each voting shareholder is counted, as opposed to voting by way of a show of hands where the actual number of shares held by voting shareholders is not taken into account.
 
Voting will take place by way of a show of hands unless a poll is demanded. A poll may be demanded by the chairman, by not less than five shareholders having the right to vote at such meeting, by shareholders representing not less than one-tenth of the total voting rights of all shareholders having the right to vote at the meeting or by shareholders entitled to vote at the meeting and holding in the aggregate not less than one-tenth of the issued share capital of the company.
 
Holders of Class A ordinary shares and Class N ordinary shares vote together as a single class, unless the relevant resolution affects the rights of the holders of the Class N ordinary shares or Class A ordinary shares as a separate class, in which case, at least 75% of the holders of the relevant class present or represented at any meeting called to vote on such resolution must approve the resolution.
 
Dividends
 
Either Naspers’ shareholders in general meeting or its board of directors may from time to time declare that final dividends and interim dividends are to be paid to one or more class or classes of shareholders. Naspers’ shareholders in general meeting may not declare a dividend in excess of the amount recommended by the board.
 
Dividends are payable to persons registered as shareholders on a date determined by Naspers’ shareholders in a general meeting or by the board. This date may not be less than 14 days after the date of the publication of the announcement of the dividend, provided that the record date to receive the dividend is a Friday or, if the relevant Friday is not a business day, on the last preceding business day. Any dividend may be paid or satisfied, either in whole or in part, by the distribution of specific assets as the board may determine and direct.
 
 
103

 

                                Any dividend or other sum payable to a shareholder in respect of its shareholding may be transmitted by ordinary post to the address of the shareholder recorded in the register of shareholders or any other address provided in writing to Naspers by the shareholder. Naspers is not responsible for any loss that may occur when the dividend or other sum payable is transmitted to a shareholder.
 
Any unclaimed dividends may be invested or otherwise utilized by the board for Naspers’ benefit until claimed by the shareholder entitled to payment of the dividend. Unpaid dividends do not accrue interest. The board may declare forfeited any dividends not claimed after a period of 12 years or, if Naspers is to be liquidated or deregistered, a period of three years. Forfeited dividends revert to Naspers or its nominee.
 
Holders of Class A ordinary shares are entitled to nominal dividends as determined by the board from time to time. However, dividends declared to holders of Class A ordinary shares may not exceed more than one-fifth of the dividends declared to holders of Class N ordinary shares for the same period.
 
Naspers’ articles of association allow payments to be made to shareholders out of profits, share capital or share premium, subject to certain solvency and liquidity requirements being met by Naspers after such payment is made.
 
Changes in Share Capital
 
Subject to the provisions of the Companies Act, Naspers’ shareholders may by special resolution:
 

 ·      
 
      
increase Naspers’ share capital by creating new shares having a stated par value, or increase the number of no par value shares by creating new no par value shares;
     
  ·      
 
increase Naspers’ share capital constituted by no par value shares by transferring profits or reserves to the stated capital, with or without a distribution of shares;
     
  ·      
 
consolidate and divide all or any part of Naspers’ share capital into shares of a larger amount than its existing shares, or consolidate and reduce the number of the issued no par value shares;
     
  ·      
 
increase the number of Naspers’ issued no par value shares without an increase of its stated capital;
     
  ·      
 
sub-divide all or some of Naspers’ shares into shares of a smaller amount than is fixed by Naspers’ memorandum of association;
     
  ·      
 
convert all Naspers’ ordinary or preference share capital consisting of par value shares into stated capital constituted by no par value shares;
     
  ·      
 
convert Naspers’ stated capital constituted either by ordinary or preference no par value shares into share capital consisting of par value shares;
     
  ·      
 
cancel shares which, as of the date of the resolution in respect thereof, have not been taken up by or agreed to be taken up by any person, and diminish the amount of Naspers’ authorized share capital by the amount of the shares cancelled;
     
  ·      
 
cancel no par value shares which have not been taken up or agreed to be taken up by any person;
     
  ·      
 
convert any of Naspers’ shares, whether or not issued, into shares of another class;
     
  ·      
 
subject to the Listing Rules of the JSE, decrease its share capital, any share premium account, stated capital or capital redemption reserve fund; and
     
 ·      
 
convert all or any of its paid-up shares into stock and reconvert such stock into paid-up shares.
     
 
 
 
104

 
 
The Listings Rules impose a number of requirements on Naspers to remain listed on the Main Board of the JSE. The requirements mean, among other things that:
 
·      
the subscribed capital, including reserves, must amount to at least Rand 25 million;
 
·      
not less than 25 million equity shares must be in issue;
 
·      
20% of each class of listed equity shares must be held by the public (as defined); and
 
·      
the number of public shareholders (as defined), excluding employees, directors and their associates, of listed securities must be at least 500 for equity shares, 50 for preference shares and 25 for debentures.
 
The Nasdaq Stock Market listing rules further require that shareholder approval for the issuance of shares is generally required with respect to the following:
 
·      
for the establishment or material amendment of stock option or purchase plans for the benefit of officers, directors, employees or consultants
 
·      
when the issuance or potential issuance will result in a change of control of Naspers
 
·      
the acquisition of stock or assets of another company if (i) a director, officer or 5% shareholder of Naspers has an interest in 5% or more of the target company or consideration to be paid for the target company, and the issuance of securities will increase outstanding ordinary shares or voting power by 5% or more; or (ii) the proposed issuance constitutes an increase of greater than 20% in the voting power or number of ordinary shares
 
·      
private placements of greater than 20% of the voting power or number of ordinary shares conducted for a price at less than the greater of either market or book value.
 
Liquidation Rights
 
If Naspers is liquidated, whether voluntarily or compulsorily, the assets remaining after the payment of all Naspers’ liabilities and the cost of winding up shall be distributed among the shareholders as follows:
 
·      
holders of Class A ordinary shares and the holders of Class N ordinary shares will be entitled to receive payment out of the surplus of an amount equal to the nominal value of the Class A ordinary shares and Class N ordinary shares held by them; and
 
·      
thereafter, holders of Class A and Class N ordinary shares in Naspers will rank equally with each other and any remaining surplus will be distributed among them in proportion to the number of shares respectively held by them.
 
Any such distribution will be subject to the rights of any shareholders to whom shares have been issued on special conditions and subject to Naspers’ right to set-off against the liability, if any, of shareholders for unpaid capital or premium.
 
The liquidator may distribute among Naspers’ shareholders, in specie or in kind, all or any part of the assets of Naspers, whether or not those assets consist of different types of property.
 
For additional information on Naspers’ shares see “Item 6. Directors, Senior Management and Employees”.
 
10.C.               Material Contracts
 
Investment in Abril SA
 
On May 5, 2006 MIH (UBC) Holdings BV (now renamed MIH Brazil Holdings BV) (“MBH”), a wholly owned indirect subsidiary of Naspers, acquired an equity stake of 30% in Abril SA, a Brazilian media company, for a total consideration in Brazilian Reais equivalent to approximately Rand 2,557.3 million, through a combination of a subscription for newly issued shares of common stock and shares of preferred stock and the purchase of shares of common stock and shares of preferred stock from Ativic SA, certain individual shareholders and two subsidiaries of Capital International, being Brazil April LLC and Brazil May LLC. The acquisition was implemented through (i) a Subscription Agreement between Abril SA, MBH, Mr Roberto Civita and Mr Giancarlo Civita, (ii) a Stock Purchase Agreement between MBH, Mr Roberto Civita, Mr Giancarlo Civita, Mr Victor Civita and Ms Roberta Civita, and (iii) a Stock Purchase Agreement, between MIH Brazil Participacoes Ltda (a wholly owned indirect subsidiary of Naspers) (“MBPL”), Brazil LLC and Brazil May LLC.
 
 
105

 

10.D.               Exchange Controls
 
The following discussion summarizes exchange controls in force in South Africa as of the date of this annual report. South Africa’s exchange controls may change at any time. Naspers cannot predict whether the existing exchange controls will be continued, amended or abolished by any future South African government. You are urged to consult a professional adviser about the effect of exchange controls on your investment in Class N ordinary shares or Naspers ADSs.
 
The Currency and Exchanges Act, 1933 empowers the South African President to make regulations concerning any matter directly or indirectly affecting or relating to currency, banking or stock exchanges in South Africa. South African exchange control regulations are administered by the South African Reserve Bank acting through its Exchange Control Department (“Excon”). Excon’s stated objective is to achieve equality of treatment between residents and non-residents in relation to the flow of capital in and out of South Africa. The exchange control regulations provide for a common monetary area consisting of South Africa, the Kingdom of Lesotho, the Kingdom of Swaziland and the Republic of Namibia. The regulations restrict the export of capital from the common monetary area.
 
The purpose of the exchange controls is to mitigate the decline in foreign capital reserves in South Africa and the devaluation of the Rand against the U.S. dollar and South Africa’s other principal trading currencies. Although the South African government has committed itself to gradually relaxing exchange controls and has recently reaffirmed this commitment, it is likely that exchange controls will continue to operate in South Africa for the foreseeable future.
 
An acquisition of shares or assets of a South African company by a non-resident purchaser solely for cash consideration would not generally be subject to review by Excon under the exchange control regulations. An acquisition of shares or assets of a South African company by a non-resident purchaser will require prior approval from Excon if the consideration paid for the acquisition is in the form of shares of a non-resident company or if the acquisition is financed by a loan from a South African resident. Denial of Excon approval may result in the acquisition of shares or assets of a South African company by a non-resident purchaser not being completed. There are no other exchange control restrictions on non-residents making equity investments in South African companies; however, there are local borrowing restrictions on controlled foreign companies.
 
Under South African exchange control regulations, Class N ordinary shares and Naspers ADSs are freely transferable outside of South Africa between non-residents of the common monetary area. Also, when ordinary shares are sold on the JSE on behalf of Naspers shareholders who are not resident in the common monetary area, the proceeds of such sales will be freely exchangeable into foreign currency and may be remitted to them outside the common monetary area. Any share certificates held by Naspers shareholders not resident in the common monetary area will be endorsed with the words “non-resident”. The same endorsement will not be applicable to Naspers ADSs held by non-resident shareholders.
 
There are currently no exchange control restrictions which prevent Naspers from remitting dividends declared out of operating profits or trading profits to non-residents of the common monetary area. Naspers cannot, in general, remit capital profits without prior Excon approval.
 
10.E.                Taxation
 
United States Tax Considerations
 
This section sets forth the material United States Federal income tax consequences to U.S. Holders as they relate to the ownership and disposition of Class N ordinary shares or Naspers ADSs.
 
This section is based on the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”), its legislative history, existing final, temporary and proposed Treasury Regulations, rulings and judicial decisions, all as currently in effect and all of which are subject to prospective and retroactive rulings and changes.
 
 
 
106


 
For purposes of this section, beneficial owners of Class N ordinary shares or Naspers ADSs are “U.S. Holders” if they are:
 
·      
a citizen or resident of the United States;
 
·      
a corporation, or any other entity taxable as a corporation, created under the laws of the United States (Federal, state or District of Columbia);
 
·      
an estate the income of which is subject to United States Federal income tax regardless of its source; or
 
·      
a trust if a court within the United States is able to exercise primary supervision over its administration and one or more United States persons have the authority to control all substantial decisions of the trust.
 
If a partnership holds Class N ordinary shares or Naspers ADSs, the tax treatment of a partner will generally depend upon the status of the partner and upon the activities of the partnership. Partners of partnerships holding Class N ordinary shares or Naspers ADSs should consult their own tax advisors.
 
A holder of Class N ordinary shares or Naspers ADSs is a “Non-U.S. Holder” if the holder is not a U.S. Holder. Non-U.S. Holders should consult their own tax advisors with respect to the tax consequences of ownership and disposition of Class N ordinary shares or Naspers ADSs.
 
This section does not purport to address all United States Federal income tax consequences that may be relevant to a particular shareholder and holders are urged to consult their own tax advisors regarding their specific tax situation. This section applies only to shareholders who hold their Class N ordinary shares or Naspers ADSs as “capital assets” (generally, property held for investment) under the Code, and does not address the tax consequences that may be relevant to shareholders in special tax situations including, for example:
 
·      
insurance companies;
 
·      
tax-exempt organizations;
 
·      
broker dealers;
 
·      
traders in securities that elect to mark to market;
 
·      
banks or other financial institutions;
 
·      
shareholders whose functional currency is not the U.S. dollar;
 
·      
United States expatriates;
 
·      
shareholders that hold their shares as part of a hedge, straddle, constructive sale or conversion transaction;
 
·      
shareholders that own, directly, indirectly, or constructively 10% or more of the total combined voting power of Naspers; or
 
·      
shareholders that are subject to the alternative minimum tax.
 
This section expressly assumes that Naspers is not a passive foreign investment company for United States Federal income tax purposes. Please see the discussion under “Passive Foreign Investment Company Rules” below.
 
In general, for United States Federal income tax purposes and for purposes of income tax treaties, beneficial owners of Naspers ADSs will be treated as the beneficial owners of the Class N ordinary shares represented by those ADSs.
 
 
 
107


 
This section does not address the state, local and non-United States tax consequences relating to shares. You should consult your own tax advisor regarding the United States Federal, state, local and foreign and other tax consequences of share ownership in your particular circumstances.
 
Ownership and Disposition of Class N Ordinary Shares or Naspers ADSs
 
Taxation of Dividends. The gross amount of a distribution made by Naspers, including any amounts of South African tax withheld, will be taxable to a U.S. Holder to the extent that such distribution is paid out of Naspers’ current or accumulated earnings and profits (“E&P”), as determined for United States Federal income tax purposes. Under recently enacted legislation, if these dividends constitute qualified dividend income (“QDI”), individual United States Holders will generally pay tax on such dividends received during taxable years prior to 2011 at a maximum rate of 15%, provided that certain holding period requirements are satisfied. Dividends paid by Naspers will be QDI if Naspers is a Qualified Foreign Corporation (“QFC”) at the time the dividends are paid. Naspers believes that it is currently, and will continue to be, a QFC so as to allow all dividends paid to be QDI for United States Federal income tax purposes. Corporate U.S. Holders receiving dividends paid by Naspers will not benefit from the reduced tax rate on dividends available to individual U.S. Holders. Because Naspers is not a United States corporation, dividends paid will not be eligible for the dividends received deduction generally allowable to corporations under the Code.
 
To the extent that distributions by Naspers exceed E&P, such distributions will be treated as a tax-free return of capital, to the extent of each U.S. Holder’s basis in Class N ordinary Shares or Naspers ADSs, and will reduce such U.S. Holder’s basis in the Class N ordinary Shares or Naspers ADSs on a U.S. dollar-for-U.S. dollar basis (thereby increasing any gain or decreasing any loss on a disposition of the Class N ordinary Shares or Naspers ADSs). To the extent that the distributions exceed the U.S. Holder’s basis in the Class N ordinary Shares or Naspers ADSs, each such holder will be taxed as having recognized gain on the sale or disposition of the Class N ordinary Shares or Naspers ADSs (see “Tax on Sale or Exchange of Ordinary Shares or ADSs” below).
 
The amount of a distribution will be the U.S. dollar value of the Rand payment, determined at the spot Rand/U.S. dollar rate on the date the dividend is includible in a U.S. Holder’s income, regardless of whether the payment in fact is converted into U.S. dollars. Generally, any gain or loss resulting from currency fluctuations during the period from the date a U.S. Holder includes the dividend in income to the date such U.S. Holder (or a third party acting for such U.S. Holder) converts the payment into U.S. dollars will be treated as ordinary income or loss. Any such income or loss generally will be income or loss from sources within the United States for foreign tax credit purposes.
 
A U.S. Holder will be entitled to claim a foreign tax credit with respect to distributions received from Naspers for foreign taxes (such as South African withholding taxes) imposed on dividends paid to such U.S. Holder but not for taxes imposed on Naspers or on any entity in which Naspers has made an investment. As discussed below, under current South African legislation, no South African tax will be withheld from dividends paid to non-residents of South Africa. Please see the discussion under “South African Tax Considerations—Ownership and Disposition of Class N Ordinary Shares and Naspers ADSs—Tax on Dividends” below.
 
Tax on Sale or Exchange of Ordinary Shares or ADSs. A U.S. Holder will recognize gain or loss on a sale, exchange or other disposition of the Class N ordinary shares or ADSs, unless a specific nonrecognition provision applies. That gain or loss will be measured by the difference between the U.S. dollar value of the amount of cash, and the fair market value of any other property received, and the U.S. Holder’s tax basis in the Class N ordinary shares or ADSs as determined in U.S. dollars. A U.S. Holder’s tax basis in the Class N ordinary shares or ADSs will generally equal the amount paid by the U.S. Holder for the ordinary shares or ADSs. Gain or loss arising from a sale or exchange of Class N ordinary shares or ADSs will be capital gain or loss and will be long-term capital gain or loss if the holding period of the U.S. Holder for the Class N ordinary shares or ADSs exceeds one year. Recently enacted legislation also generally provides that long-term capital gains by individuals, trusts and estates are subject to Federal income taxes at a maximum rate of 15% for taxable years beginning before January 1, 2011 (20% thereafter). In general, gain from a sale or exchange of shares by a U.S. Holder will be treated as United States source income for foreign tax credit purposes.
 
Passive Foreign Investment Company Rules. U.S. Holders might be subject to a special, adverse tax regime that would differ in certain respects from the tax treatment described above, if Naspers is, or were to become, a passive foreign investment company (“PFIC”) for United States Federal income tax purposes. Although the determination of whether a corporation is a PFIC is made annually, and therefore is subject to change, Naspers does not believe that it is, nor does Naspers expect to become, a PFIC for United States Federal income tax purposes. You should consult your own tax advisor regarding the adverse tax consequences of owning the ordinary shares or ADSs of a PFIC and making certain elections designed to ameliorate those adverse consequences.
 
 
108

 
 
U.S. Backup Withholding and Information Reporting. Proceeds from the sale of, and dividends, on Class N ordinary shares or ADSs paid within the United States or through certain U.S. related financial intermediaries are subject to information reporting and may be subject to backup withholding at a rate currently equal to 28% unless the U.S. Holder:
 
·      
is a corporation or other exempt recipient; or
 
·      
provides a taxpayer identification number and properly certifies that no loss of exemption from backup withholding has occurred on an IRS Form W-9.
 
Any amount withheld from a payment to a U.S. Holder under the backup withholding rules will be allowable as a credit against such U.S. Holder’s United States Federal income tax liability, provided that the required information is furnished to the IRS.
 
South African Tax Considerations
 
This section sets forth the material South African income tax (including capital gains tax) consequences for South African resident holders of Class N ordinary shares and Naspers ADSs in relation to the ownership and disposition of Class N ordinary shares and Naspers ADSs.
 
This section is based on the South African Income Tax Act, No. 58 of 1962 (as amended) (“the Act”), various other taxing statutes in South Africa, rulings and judicial decisions, all as currently in effect and all of which are subject to prospective and/or retroactive rulings and changes.
 
For the purposes of this section, the term “South African resident” includes:
 
·      
any natural person who is ordinarily resident in South Africa;
 
·      
a natural person who is not ordinarily resident in South Africa, but satisfies a physical presence test, which involves being present in South Africa for certain prescribed periods of time; and
 
·      
a person other than a natural person, which is incorporated, established or formed in South Africa, or which has its place of effective management in South Africa.
 
A South African resident, as defined in the Act, excludes any person that is deemed to be exclusively resident in another country in terms of a double taxation treaty between South Africa and such other country.
 
This section does not purport to address all South African income tax (including capital gains tax) consequences that may be relevant to a particular shareholder. This section applies only to shareholders who are not share traders and who hold the Class N ordinary shares and Naspers ADSs as “capital assets” under South African law. You should consult your own tax advisor regarding the South African income tax (including capital gains tax) and other tax consequences to you resulting from the ownership and disposition of Class N ordinary shares or Naspers ADSs.
 
Ownership and Disposition of Class N Ordinary Shares and Naspers ADSs
 
Tax on Dividends
 
Dividends declared by a South African resident company to resident shareholders are generally exempt from income tax in South Africa with a few exceptions none of which are relevant in respect of the Naspers shares. For non-residents, only dividends from a South African source are included in gross income, but they are generally exempt from tax.
 
Naspers will not be obliged to withhold any form of non-resident withholding tax on dividends paid to non-residents of South Africa in terms of South African tax legislation. However, in future a decision might be taken to re-impose a withholding tax on dividends paid by South African resident companies to non-resident shareholders. Should this happen the reciprocal tax treaty entered into between South Africa and the United States, in general, limits the withholding tax as follows:
 
·      
to 5% of the gross amount of the dividends if the beneficial owner of the shares is a company holding directly at least 10% of the voting stock of the company paying the dividends; and
 
 
109

 
 
·      
to 15% of the gross amount of the dividends in all other cases.
 
Tax on sale or exchange of Class N ordinary shares by shareholders resident in South Africa
 
South African resident holders of Class N ordinary shares, who hold the shares as capital assets, will realize a taxable capital gain or a capital loss on the sale, exchange or other disposition of Class N ordinary shares, unless that shareholder is entitled at the time of such sale, exchange or other disposition to defer the capital gain by virtue of “roll over” relief provided by the Act or is obliged to limit, exclude or defer the capital loss. The capital gain or loss will be the difference between the base cost to the holders of the Class N ordinary shares, and the proceeds received for the sale, exchange or other disposition of any Class N ordinary shares. The base cost of an asset acquired on or after October 1, 2001 is generally its acquisition cost and certain further expenditure allowable in terms of the Act. The base cost of an asset acquired before October 1, 2001 is determined in accordance with specific formulas and rules in the Act. The proceeds in respect of the disposal of any asset are generally the amount received by or accrued to the seller in respect of such disposal. Where the proceeds constitute an amount other than cash, the proceeds will equal the fair value of the asset received.
 
In general, roll-over relief from capital gains tax only applies in relation to company formation transactions, share-for-share transactions, amalgamation transactions, intra group transactions, unbundling transactions and transactions relating to liquidation, winding up and de-registration, all as defined in the Act. The Act also provides for the roll-over of capital gains in respect of certain involuntary disposals under certain circumstances, at the election of the taxpayer.
 
Tax consequences of the ownership and disposition of Class N ordinary shares or Naspers ADSs by shareholders not resident in South Africa
 
Shareholders not resident in South Africa are liable for South African income tax in respect of income derived by them from a source within or deemed to be within South Africa. Shareholders not resident in South Africa are generally not liable for South African capital gains tax unless the assets disposed of forms part of a permanent establishment of such non-resident in South Africa. Profits derived from the sale of shares in a South African company by a non-resident will be subject to income tax in South Africa if the seller carries on business in South Africa as a share dealer and the profits are in the ordinary course of that business. For more information, please see the below section called “—Taxation of South African Corporations—Capital Gains Tax.”
 
Stamp Duty
 
Stamp duty is no longer payable on the original issue of any shares (apart from certain exceptional instances dealing with tax avoidance) with effect from January 1, 2006.
 
On any subsequent registration of transfer of shares in a South African company, South African stamp duty is payable at 0.25% of the higher of the consideration paid or the market value of the share concerned on the date of the transaction. South African stamp duty is payable regardless of whether the instrument of transfer is executed in or outside South Africa. In respect of transactions involving dematerialized shares, uncertificated securities tax will be payable at the same rate instead of stamp duty.
 
There are certain exemptions to the payment of stamp duty where, for example, the instrument of transfer is executed outside South Africa and registration of transfer is effected in any branch register kept by the relevant company outside of South Africa, subject to certain provisions set forth in the South African Stamp Duties Act, 1968. Exemption from stamp duty is also available on the registration of transfer of shares acquired in terms of a transaction qualifying for roll-over relief (see the reference above to company formation transactions, share-for-share transactions, amalgamation transactions, intra group transactions, unbundling transactions and transactions relating to liquidation, winding up and de-registration), provided certain formal requirements have been met.
 
Transfers of ADSs between non-residents of South Africa will not attract South African stamp duty. If shares are withdrawn from the deposit facility or the relevant deposit agreement is terminated, stamp duty will however be payable on the subsequent registration of transfer of the shares. An acquisition of shares from the depositary in exchange for ADSs representing the shares will also render an investor who has been registered as the holder of shares in the company’s register liable to South African stamp duty at the same rate on a subsequent registration of transfer of the shares.
 
110


Taxation of South African Corporations
 
Basis of Income Taxation
 
The South African income tax system was originally based primarily on the source basis of taxation. Under this system, income sourced or deemed to be sourced in South Africa was taxable in South Africa. A residence based system of taxation was introduced in 2000, under which South African residents are taxed on their worldwide income. Certain categories of income and activities undertaken outside of South Africa are however exempt from taxation. The source basis of taxation is, however, still applicable to non-residents. Non-residents are therefore taxed on income from a source within or deemed to be from a source within South Africa.
 
A South African tax resident must include in its taxable income an amount equal to the proportional amount (calculated in terms of a formula) of all controlled foreign companies’ net income, as defined, for its tax year that ends during the resident’s year of assessment. A “controlled foreign company” is defined as a foreign company in which the relevant South African residents, directly or indirectly, hold more than 50% of the rights to participate (directly or indirectly) in the share capital, share premium, profits or reserves of that foreign company or more than 50% of the voting rights in the foreign company, subject to certain exceptions in as far as the voting rights criteria is concerned (e.g. no regard is had to voting rights in a listed foreign company or its subsidiary).
 
The term “foreign company” means an association, corporation, company, arrangement or scheme (as contemplated in the definition of “company” in the Act) which is not a resident in South Africa.
 
The exemptions from the taxation of income from controlled foreign companies for years of assessment commencing prior to June 1, 2004, include:
 
·      
the designated country exemption;
 
·      
the business establishment exemption;
 
·      
amounts to the extent that is already taxed in South Africa;
 
·      
certain foreign dividend income;
 
·      
capital gains in certain circumstances;
 
·      
certain amounts of interest, royalties, rentals and similar income; and
 
·      
certain amounts received as dividends and from the disposal of interests.
 
Changes to the controlled foreign company rules, arising as a consequence of the changes to the taxation of foreign dividends, were introduced for years of assessment commencing on or after June 1, 2004. In this regard, the designated country exemption and the exemption of certain amounts received as dividends and from the disposal of interests have been removed.
 
All foreign dividends received by or accruing to South African residents are currently, with certain exceptions, subject to income tax. A foreign dividend includes a dividend received by or which accrued to any person from any company, which is either a foreign company or a resident in South Africa to the extent that the dividend is declared from profits derived by such company before such company became a resident.
 
The Minister of Finance announced in his budget speech in February 2003, however, that in the future South African residents who hold a “meaningful interest” in a foreign company will not be subject to tax on the dividends declared by the company. In this regard, for years of assessment commencing on or after June 1, 2004, new exemptions apply to the taxation of foreign dividends. These include:
 
·      
foreign dividends to the extent that it relates to any amount already taxed in South Africa;
 
 
111

 
 
 
·      
foreign dividends to the extent that it relates to any amount that was declared by a listed company of which more than 10% of its equity share capital is at the time of the declaration held collectively by residents;
 
·      
foreign dividends to the extent that it is paid out of profits attributed to the shareholder as “net income” in terms of the controlled foreign companies provisions of the Act; and
 
·      
foreign dividends that accrued to a person when he (for a company, together with any other company in the same group of companies) holds more than 20% of the total equity share capital and voting rights in the company declaring the dividend, subject to certain provisos.
 
Taxable foreign dividends are taxed at the taxpayer’s marginal tax rate which, in the case of a company, is 29%.
 
Capital Gains Tax
 
Capital Gains Tax was introduced in South Africa with effect from October 1, 2001 by way of the addition of the Eighth Schedule to the Act. Under the Eighth Schedule, all natural persons, legal persons and trusts resident in South Africa are liable to pay capital gains tax on capital gains resulting from the disposal or deemed disposal of a capital asset. The definition of an asset is very wide and includes assets that are movable, immovable, corporeal or incorporeal, but excludes certain limited items.
 
Non-residents of South Africa will not be subject to capital gains tax except in respect of the disposal of immovable property situated in South Africa or any interest or right in immovable property situated in South Africa and any assets of a permanent establishment of the non-resident in South Africa.
 
A total of 50% of net capital gains on the disposal of capital assets is included in a company’s taxable income from October 1, 2001. At the current corporate tax rate of 29%, the effective tax rate on a capital gain will therefore be 14.5%.
 
Secondary Tax on Companies
 
Secondary Tax on Companies (“STC”), is paid by South African resident companies at the flat rate of 12.5% in respect of the net amount of dividends (i.e. the amount of dividends declared by the company less all dividends which accrue to the company, subject to certain exclusions, during its relevant “dividend cycle”). A “dividend cycle” is the period commencing on the date following the date of accrual to a company’s shareholders of the last dividend declared by that company and ending on the date on which the dividend in question accrues to the shareholder concerned. Up to May 31, 2004, when a company declared a dividend out of profits derived from sources within and outside of South Africa, STC on the dividend was calculated on the amount which bore to the net amount of the dividend, the same ratio as the sum of the net annual profits of the company from South African actual or deemed sources and from sources outside South Africa (which were not deemed to be from a South African source and which were not exempt from tax under section 10(1)(kA) of the Income Tax Act), bore to its total net annual profits from all sources. However, with effect from June 1, 2004, the STC exemption in respect of foreign sourced profits has been withdrawn from the Act. Any excess of dividends accruing to a company over dividends paid may be carried forward to subsequent dividend cycles as an STC credit.
 
The levying of STC effectively means that a dual corporate tax system exists in South Africa comprising a normal income tax and STC. It should be noted that STC is a tax on the company and is not a withholding tax on dividends. Liability for STC is determined independently from normal income tax. Accordingly, a company without a normal tax liability may have a liability for STC, and vice versa, or a company may be liable for both normal tax and STC. Capitalization shares distributed to shareholders in lieu of cash dividends are generally not regarded as dividends and are not subject to STC. No South African tax (including withholding tax) is payable in respect of the receipt of these shares by the recipients. For capital gains tax purposes, capitalization shares are treated as having been acquired for zero expenditure by the holder. If the issue of the capitalization shares constitute a dividend, the holder will be treated to acquire the shares at an expense equal to the amount of the dividend. Subject to certain exceptions, foreign dividends no longer qualify as a deduction to calculate the net amount of dividends for STC purposes.
 
Transfer Pricing
 
Section 31 of the Act sets out rules dealing with transfer pricing and thin capitalization. Section 31 provides (in respect of transfer pricing) that when goods or services are supplied or acquired under any “international agreement”, if the acquirer is a “connected person” in relation to the supplier, and the goods or services are supplied or acquired at a price which is
 
 
112

 

 
not at arm’s length, the Commissioner for the SARS is entitled, for the purposes of assessing the taxable income of the supplier or acquirer, to adjust the consideration to reflect an arms’ length price.
 
Thin capitalization rules were enacted to reduce the incidence of capital structuring by a company with a relatively small equity capital as compared to its debt capital. The intention of the provisions dealing with thin capitalization is to disallow interest deductions on excessive financial assistance between connected parties in calculating a taxpayer’s taxable income. The term “financial assistance” is widely defined and includes loans, advances, debts and the provision of any security or guarantee.
 
10.H.               Documents on Display
 
Naspers is subject to the informational reporting requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”) and files reports and other information with the SEC. You may examine the documents that are exhibits to this annual report, reports and other information filed by Naspers, without charge, at the public reference facilities maintained by the SEC at 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C., 20549. For more information on the public reference rooms, call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. Naspers’ reports and other information filed with the SEC are also available to the public from commercial document retrieval services and the website maintained by the SEC at http://www.sec.gov.
 
 
113

 
 
ITEM 11.       Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
 
Naspers is exposed to market risks, including interest rate and foreign currency exchange rate risk associated with underlying assets, liabilities and anticipated transactions. Following the evaluation of these exposures, Naspers selectively enters into derivative financial instruments to manage the related risk exposures pursuant to its policies in areas such as counterparty exposure and hedging practices. These policies have been approved by Naspers’ senior management and Naspers does not hold or issue derivative financial instruments for trading or speculative purposes.
 
The following discussion and analysis, which constitute forward looking statements that involve risk and uncertainties, summarizes Naspers’ market sensitive financial instruments including their fair value, maturity and contract terms. The discussion addresses market risk only and does not address other risks which Naspers faces in the normal course of business, including country risk, credit risk and legal risk.
 
Interest Rate Sensitivity
 
Naspers undertakes from time to time specific actions to cover its exposure to interest rate risk. These actions include entering into interest rate swap agreements and other similar derivative instruments to manage the Naspers group’s exposure to movements in interest rates. As at March 31, 2006, Naspers’ liabilities included certain short-term fixed or variable interest rate instruments. The fair value of these instruments will not change significantly as a result of changes in interest rates due to their short-term nature and the variable interest rates. Naspers only hedges against the cash flow risk relating to interest rate movements and does not generally hedge against potential fair value changes.
 
As at March 31, 2006, 31.3% of the Naspers group’s long-term liabilities were interest free. Accordingly, any movement in interest rates will not impact the cashflows related to these liabilities. An additional 50.5% of the Naspers group’s long term liabilities were at fixed interest rates, and only an additional 18.2% had floating interest rates. As at March 31, 2006, the Naspers group also had bank overdrafts at floating interest rates of Rand 364.8 million. Total liabilities (including overdrafts) at floating interest rates as at March 31, 2006 amounted to Rand 1,100.8 million. These liabilities at floating rates were unhedged at March 31, 2006. The floating interest rates are, however, linked to various international interest rates, such as LIBOR in the United Kingdom, the prime banking rate in South Africa (which increased from 10.5% in September 2005 to 11.5% in September 2006) and the prime banking rate in Greece. Fluctuations in interest rates in these jurisdictions vary from time to time. Based on the amount of Naspers’ liabilities linked to floating rates as at March 31, 2006, an average 1% increase in interest rates across the various jurisdictions would increase Naspers group’s interest charges by approximately Rand 11.01 million per annum.
 
As part of the process of managing Naspers’ fixed and floating interest rate borrowing profile, the interest rate characteristics of new borrowings and the refinancing of existing borrowings are positioned according to expected movements in interest rates. Where appropriate, Naspers uses derivative instruments, such as interest rate swap agreements, purely for hedging purposes. As at March 31, 2006 Naspers had not entered into any significant interest rate swap agreement or similar derivative instruments.
 
Foreign Currency Management
 
Naspers’ functional currencies are generally the local currencies in the countries in which it operates. Monetary assets and liabilities in currencies other than Naspers’ functional currencies are translated based on the exchange rates prevailing at fiscal year-end. Any resulting exchange rate gains or losses are included in current results.
 
On consolidation, assets and liabilities of subsidiaries denominated in foreign currencies are translated to Rand based on exchange rates prevailing at year-end. Income and expense items are translated using annual weighted average rates of exchange or, where known or determinable, at the exchange rate on the date of the transaction.
 
Adjustments arising from currency translations are recorded in shareholders’ equity and are reflected in net earnings only upon the sale or liquidation of the underlying investments.
 
Naspers operates internationally and is exposed to foreign exchange risk arising from various currency exposures. Although a substantial portion of Naspers’ revenue is denominated in the currencies of the countries in which it operates, a significant portion of Naspers’ cash obligations, including payment obligations under satellite transponder leases and contracts for pay-television programming and channels, are denominated in U.S. dollars. Where Naspers’ revenue is denominated in local currency such as Rand or Euro, depreciation of the local currency against the U.S. dollar adversely affects Naspers’
 

114


earnings and its ability to meet cash obligations. Companies in the Naspers group use forward exchange contracts to hedge their exposure to foreign currency risk in the local reporting currency. It is not the policy of the group to trade in forward contracts for economic speculative purposes.
 
Naspers’ South African businesses hedge the foreign currency exposure of their contractual commitments to purchase goods, services and film rights mainly in U.S. dollars and Euros. The forward exchange contracts typically expire within one to two years, consistent with the related contractual commitments. The Naspers group generally hedges all major exposures in foreign currencies to an amount of approximately 80% to 100% of the contract value. This strategy is consistent with the strategy followed in prior years. Naspers hedges against the potential change in future cash flows for forecasted and committed purchase transactions in foreign currencies. Some foreign exchange contracts are also entered into to hedge against the change in fair value of a foreign creditor.
 
Forward exchange contracts are recognized in the balance sheet at fair value. The method of recognizing the resulting gain or loss is dependent on the nature of the item being hedged. Changes in the fair value of forward exchange contracts that are designated and qualify as fair value hedges and that are highly effective, are recorded in the income statement, along with changes in the fair value of the hedged asset or liability that is attributable to the hedged risk.
 
Changes in the fair value of forward contracts that are designated and qualify as cash flow hedges, and that are highly effective, are recognized in equity, and the ineffective part of the hedge is recognized in the income statement. Where the forecasted transaction or firm commitment of which the foreign currency risk is being hedged results in the recognition of an asset or a liability, the gains and losses previously deferred in equity are transferred from equity and included in the initial measurement of the cost of the asset or liability. Otherwise, amounts deferred in equity are transferred to the income statement and classified as income or expense in the same periods during which the hedged transaction affects the income statement.
 
Certain derivative transactions, while providing effective economic hedges under the group’s risk management policies, do not qualify for hedge accounting. Changes in the fair value of any derivative instrument that do not qualify for hedge accounting are recognized immediately in the income statement.
 
When a hedging instrument expires or is sold, or when a hedge no longer meets the criteria for hedge accounting, any cumulative gain or loss existing in equity at that time remains in equity and is recognized when the committed or forecasted transaction ultimately is recognized in the income statement. When a committed or forecasted transaction is no longer expected to occur, the cumulative gain or loss that was reported in equity is immediately transferred to the income statement.
 
Naspers’ forward exchange contracts are used primarily to hedge the Rand against the U.S. dollar. During fiscal 2006, the average value of the U.S. dollar increased against the Rand by approximately 2.8%. The value of Naspers’ future hedged foreign currency commitments was approximately Rand 157.0 million less at March 31, 2006 than it was at the end of fiscal 2005 as a result of new forward currency contracts entered into by Naspers during fiscal 2006 at a lower U.S. dollar rate then in fiscal 2005. The total value of hedged foreign currency commitments at March 31, 2006 amounted to Rand 1,418.5 million compared to Rand 1,575.5 million at March 31, 2005. At March 31, 2006, the Naspers group’s net monetary liability position of U.S. dollars and Euros, which is subject to risk of foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations, amounted to U.S. dollar 58.1 million and Euro 58.4 million, respectively. The exposure amount primarily reflects U.S. dollar and Euro denominated debt relating to finance lease commitments and program and film rights. The aggregate hypothetical loss in earnings on an annual basis that would result from a hypothetical appreciation of 10% of the U.S. dollar and Euro against the South African Rand is estimated to be Rand 85.9 million. The Naspers group’s exposure to exchange rate fluctuations in currencies other than the U.S. dollar and Euro is not material.
 
Naspers does not currently hold or issue derivative financial or interest rate instruments for trading purposes, but intends to continue to use forward exchange contracts to limit exposure to expected depreciation of some of its functional currencies relative to foreign currencies in which Naspers incurs a significant portion of its costs.
 
ITEM 12.        DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES OTHER THAN EQUITY SECURITIES
 
Not applicable.
 
 
115

 
 
PART II
 
ITEM 13.       DEFAULTS, DIVIDEND ARREARAGES AND DELINQUENCIES
 
None.
 
ITEM 14.       MATERIAL MODIFICATION TO THE RIGHTS OF SECURITY HOLDERS AND USE OF PROCEEDS
 
None.
 
ITEM 15.       DISCLOSURE CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
 
As of the end of the period covered by this report, the company conducted an evaluation (under the supervision and with the participation of the company’s management, including the chief executive officer and chief financial officer), pursuant to Rule 13a-15 promulgated under the Exchange Act, of the effectiveness of the design and operation of the company’s disclosure controls and procedures. Based on this evaluation, the company’s chief executive officer and chief financial officer concluded that, solely because of the material weaknesses described below, such disclosure controls and procedures were not effective to provide reasonable assurance that information required to be disclosed by the company in reports it files or submits under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the rules and forms of the SEC.
 
A material weakness is a control deficiency, or combination of control deficiencies, that results in more than a remote likelihood that a material misstatement of our annual financial statements would not have been detected or prevented. During the course of the year-end substantive audit, and in anticipation of implementation of the reporting required pursuant to Section 404 of the U.S. Sarbanes-Oxley Act, our independent auditors noted material weaknesses relating to our U.S. GAAP reconciliation processes and our contract review procedures (for potential accounting implications and embedded derivatives). This led to a further management investigation to evaluate the weaknesses. The full impact and nature of the weaknesses were subsequently reported to our Audit Committee.
 
As discussed with the Audit Committee, we will implement appropriate changes to our internal control structure to remedy these weaknesses. In particular, a new group accountant has been appointed. This accountant will be responsible for compiling the U.S. GAAP reconciliation and related disclosure and ensuring that all supporting documentation exists for the adjustments recorded at corporate level. The group financial manager will review the reconciliation, disclosure and supporting documents to ensure the completeness and accuracy of the reconciliation. In addition, an agreement has been put in place with an external professional services firm to provide technical expertise and guidance on matters relating to the U.S. GAAP reconciliation. New contract review procedures are also being implemented, including a requirement that each new material contract be reviewed by a technically proficient accountant and that existing material contracts be reviewed upon any relevant changes in accounting policies. The foregoing steps may be supplemented by additional measures as necessary to remedy the material weaknesses.
 
There has been no change in our internal controls over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by this Report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal controls over financial reporting.
 
As mentioned above, we are currently evaluating our internal controls over financial reporting in order to allow management to complete its assessment of , and our independent registered accounting firm to attest to and report on, the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting for the fiscal year ending March 31, 2007, as required by Section 404 of the U.S. Sarbanes-Oxley Act. Please see “Risk Factors -- Naspers may need to improve its internal controls over financial reporting and Naspers’ independent auditors may not be able to attest to their effectiveness, which could adversely affect Naspers’ business operations, reputation and profitability”. We are undertaking remedial measures to address certain significant deficiencies and material weaknesses which have been identified to date and which, if not remedied, could adversely impact our reporting obligations under Section 404.

ITEM 16.  
 
16.A.               AUDIT COMMITTEE FINANCIAL EXPERT
 
The board of directors of Naspers has determined that Boetie van Zyl, a member of Naspers’ audit committee and risk management committee, qualifies as an “audit committee financial expert” for purposes of the U.S. Sarbanes-Oxley Act. Mr. van Zyl is a former chief executive officer and has served on audit committees of other companies. He is an independent director in accordance with applicable Nasdaq and JSE requirements.
 
16.B.               CODE OF ETHICS
 
The Naspers board approved a revised code of ethics on June 25, 2004. This code of ethics applies to directors, financial officers and staff appointed under the group’s standard service conditions. Nasdaq and SEC rules, among others, were considered in developing the content of the code of ethics. This code is available on the company’s website (www.naspers.com) and a copy will be provided to any person without charge upon request.
 
 
116

 
16.C.               PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES
 
The following table presents fees for professional audit services rendered by PricewaterhouseCoopers Inc. for the audit of the group’s consolidated financial statements for the years ended March 31, 2006, and March 31, 2005, and fees billed for other services rendered by PricewaterhouseCoopers Inc. during those periods.
 
Principal accountant fees
   
2006
 
2005
 
     
Rand in
Thousands
Percentage approved by
audit committee pre-approval policy
 
Rand in
thousands
 Percentage approved by
audit committee pre-approval
policy
 
                 
Audit fees 
   
 33,028
   
 23,937
   
Audit related fees(1) 
   
 4,092
  100%
 8,679
  100%
Tax fees(2) 
   
 4,167
  100%
 6,043
  100%
All other fees(3) 
   
 8,496
  100%
 5,539
  100%
                 
Total fees 
   
 49,783
   
 44,198
   
 
(1)  
Audit related fees consist of assurance and related services that are reasonably related to the performance of the audit or review of the group’s financial statements. This category includes fees related to the performance of audits and attest services not required by statute or regulation and accounting consultations regarding the application of GAAP to proposed transactions.
 
(2)  
Tax fees consist of the aggregate fees billed for professional services rendered by PricewaterhouseCoopers Inc. for tax compliance, tax advice, and tax planning both domestic and international.
 
(3)  
All other fees include, among other things, fees relating to financial information technology services and advice with the implementation of the requirements of section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act.
 
The various audit and risk management committees of the group have concluded that the provision of the non-audit services listed above is compatible with maintaining the independence of PricewaterhouseCoopers Inc.
 
The various audit and risk management committees of the group are directly responsible for the appointment, compensation, retention and oversight of the work of PricewaterhouseCoopers Inc. All audit, review, attest and allowable non-audit services provided by PricewaterhouseCoopers Inc. are required to undergo a pre-approval process.
 
The group’s audit and risk management committees are structured in such a way that Naspers’ audit and risk management committee is ultimately responsible for the oversight of the work performed by PricewaterhouseCoopers Inc. Audit and risk management committees also have been established at each main subsidiary and joint venture. MIH Holdings and Media24 have separate audit and risk management committees. Further audit and risk management committees within such main subsidiaries and joint ventures have been established where there are outside shareholders involved with group companies. Naspers’ audit and risk management committee, therefore, has overall responsibility for services provided by PricewaterhouseCoopers Inc. to group companies and will rely on such subsidiary and joint venture audit and risk management committees to take primary responsibility for the approval of all engagements performed by its auditors.
 
Pursuant to the pre-approval policies of the group, all requests for the approval of non-audit services must be directed to Naspers’ CFO or MIH’s CFO, respectively, to ensure that the necessary pre-approval procedures are followed and to ensure that the specific type of non-audit service is a permissible non-audit service. Naspers’ audit and risk management committee has authorized Naspers’ CFO to approve certain non-audit services for Naspers Limited and Media24 up to an aggregate of Rand 1,000,000 per annum. MIH Holdings’ audit and risk management committee has authorized MIH’s CFO to approve certain non-audit services for the MIH group up to an aggregate of U.S. dollar 500,000 per annum. The approval documentation of all such non-audit services approved by the respective CFO’s are tabled at each audit and risk management committee meeting for review. All anticipated recurring non-audit services and all non-audit services outside of the respective CFO’s authorized aggregate limits are tabled to the full audit and risk management committee for their pre-approval or to the chairman of the audit and risk management committee if such approval is required before the next audit and risk management committee meeting.
 
Any services not specifiscally pre-approved, or which do not fall within the general pre-approvals or which are in excess of the general pre-approval limit must be pre-approved by the chairman of the respective audit and risk management
 
 
117

 
committee. The audit and risk management committee will be informed of such pre-approvals at its next audit and risk management committee meeting.
 
ITEM 16.E     PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES BY THE ISSUER AND AFFILIATED PURCHASERS
 
Neither Naspers nor any affiliated purchasers acquired any of Naspers’ shares during fiscal 2006.
 
PART III
 

ITEM 17.       FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
Naspers is furnishing financial statements pursuant to the instructions of Item 18 of Form 20-F.
 
ITEM 18.       FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
See pages F-1 through F-125.
 
 

 
118


 
SIGNATURES
 
The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this annual report on its behalf.
 
     
  NASPERS LIMITED
 
 
 
 
 
 
  By:   /s/ Koos Bekker
 
Name:      Koos Bekker
Title:        Chief Executive Office 
 

 
     
  By:   /s/ Steve Pacak
 

Name:      Steve Pacak
Title:        Chief Executive Office 
 
 Date: September 29, 2006
 
 
 
119



ITEM 19.  EXHIBITS
The following exhibits are filed as exhibits to this annual report:
 
Exhibit
Number
Description
Page No.

1.1+
Memorandum and Articles of Association of Naspers Limited (English translation).
 
 
2.1+
Form of Deposit Agreement among the Bank of New York, as depository, Naspers Limited, and all owners and beneficial owners from time to time of American Depositary Shares issued thereunder.
 
 
2.2+
Form of American Depositary Agreement.
 
 
     
4.1++
Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of May 8, 2002, among MIH Limited, OTV Holdings Limited, Liberty Media Corporation and LDIG OTV, Inc.
 
 
4.2*
Amendment to Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of August 27, 2002, among MIH Limited, OTV Holdings Limited, Liberty Media Corporation and LDIG OTV, Inc.
 
 
4.3**
Channel Distribution Agreement dated June 18, 1998, between MultiChoice Africa (Proprietary) Limited and Electronic Media Network Limited.
 
 
4.4**
Analog Agreement dated March 31, 1995, between MultiChoice Africa (Proprietary) Limited and Electronic Media Network Limited.
 
 
4.5+
Agreement dated October 1, 2002 between Naspers Limited and Mr. T. Vosloo (English translation).
 
 
4.6
Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of May 5, 2006 among MIH (UBC) Holdings BV, Roberto Civita, Giancarlo Francesco Civita, Victor Civita and Roberta Anamaria Civita.
 
     
4.7
Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of May 5, 2006 among MIH Brazil Participacoes LTDA, Brazil April LLC and Brazil May LLC.
 
     
4.8
Subscription Agreement dated as of May 5, 2006 among Abril S.A. and MIH (UBC) Holding BV, Roberto Civita and Giancarlo F. Civita.
 
     
8.1
List of Naspers’ significant subsidiaries.
 
E-3
12.1
Section 302 Certification of Koos Bekker, Chief Executive Officer.
 
E-4
12.2
Section 302 Certification of Steve Pacak, Chief Financial Officer.
 
E-5
13.1
Certification pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350 as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
E-6
________________
+
Incorporated by reference from Naspers’ registration statement on Form F-4 (No. 333-10098) filed on November 1, 2002.
 
 
 
E-1



 
++
Incorporated by reference from the report on Schedule 13D (No. 005-58285) filed by Liberty Media Corporation on July 22, 2002 in respect of OpenTV Corp. Portions of this exhibit have been omitted pursuant to a request for confidential treatment.
 
*
Incorporated by reference from Amendment No. 1 to the registration statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-98817) filed by Liberty Media Corporation on September 16, 2002. Portions of this exhibit have been omitted pursuant to a request for confidential treatment.
 
**
Incorporated by reference from the registration statement on Form F-1 (No. 333-74227) filed by MIH Limited on November 3, 1999. Portions of some of these exhibits have been omitted pursuant to requests for confidential treatment.
 
 
 
 
 
E-2

 
 
 
 
 
INDEX TO ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
Naspers Limited - Consolidated Annual Financial Statements for the year ended March 31, 2006
 

F-2
Consolidated balance sheets
F-3
Consolidated income statements
F-4
Consolidated cash flow statements
F-5
Consolidated statements of changes in shareholders’ equity
F-6
Notes to the consolidated annual financial statements
F-8

 
 
F-1

 

Reg. no. 1998/012055/21
No 1 Waterhouse Place
Century City 7441
P O Box 2799
Cape Town 8000
Telephone +27 (21) 529 2000
Facsimile +27 (21) 529 3300
www.pwc.com/za
 
 
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
 
To the Shareholders of Naspers Limited
 
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Naspers Limited and its subsidiaries (“the Company”) as of March 31, 2006 and March 31, 2005, and the related consolidated income statements, changes in shareholders’ equity and cash flows for each of the two years in the period ended March 31, 2006. These financial statements are the responsibility of the company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with International Standards on Auditing and the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). These standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company at March 31, 2006 and March 31, 2005, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for the two years in the period ended March 31, 2006 in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards.

International Financial Reporting Standards vary in certain significant respects from accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Information relating to the nature and effect of such differences is presented in note 39 to the consolidated financial statements.
 


PricewaterhouseCoopers Inc
Director: Brendan Deegan
Registered Auditor

Cape Town, South Africa
September 29, 2006
 
 
 

C Beggs
Chief Executive Officer
M J B Kitshoff
Chief Operating Officer
T D Petersen
Chairman Western Cape region
D J Fölscher
Chief Executive Officer Western Cape region
Resident Directors
Z Abrahams, J F Basson, T Blok, J Bouwer, C J Bredenhann, E Brink, J M Calitz, M N Campbell, E Carelse, P M Cromhout,
 
C G de Wet, B M Deegan, N H Döman, C P du Toit, T C Esau, D M Fairbank, D J Fölscher, H Griffiths, A C Legge, D G Malan,
 
E A Maritz, J R Mettler, H D Nel, T D Petersen, S M Roberts, A Stemmet, P A L Strauss, C van den Heever, J P van Wyk,
 
M Vilakazi, A Wentzel, V Wiese, J L Wilkinson
 The Company's principal place of business is at 2 Eglin Road, Sunninghill where a list of directors' names is available for inspection.VAT reg.no. 4950174682
 
F-2

 
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS             
AT MARCH 31, 2006 AND 2005 
           
       
March 31
   
Notes 
 
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
      ASSETS             
      Non-current assets        7,272,262      6,838,739   
           Property, plant and equipment   
5
  3,688,509      3,444,663   
           Goodwill   
6
  789,735      859,034   
           Other intangible assets   
7
  369,449      367,343   
           Investments in associates   
8
  1,308,165      837,688   
           Investments and loans   
8
  74,863      393,160   
           Programme and film rights   
9
  171,145      47,558   
           Derivative financial instruments   
36
  32,647      32,572   
           Deferred taxation   
10
  837,749      856,721   
 
      Current assets        10,067,144      7,203,821   
           Inventory   
11
  504,476      383,467   
           Programme and film rights   
9
  596,033      719,006   
           Trade receivables   
12
  1,536,844      1,412,573   
           Other receivables   
13
  499,727      410,247   
           Related party receivables   
14
  19,839      66,911   
           Investments and loans   
8
  –      8,111   
            Derivative financial instruments   
36
  134,683      169,710   
            Cash and deposits   
34
  6,775,542      4,033,796   
            TOTAL ASSETS        17,339,406      14,042,560   
 
      EQUITY AND LIABILITIES             
            Capital and reserves attributable to the company’s equity holders        7,118,436      4,865,965   
            Share capital and premium   
15
  5,561,320      5,391,151   
            Other reserves   
16
  (3,316,706)    (2,417,691) 
            Retained earnings   
17
  4,873,822      1,892,505   
 
      Minority interest        171,547      227,328   
      TOTAL EQUITY        7,289,983      5,093,293   
 
      Non-current liabilities        3,372,397      2,967,890   
             Post-retirement medical liability   
18
  153,465      161,298   
             Long-term liabilities   
19
  2,355,561      2,275,648   
               Capitalized finance leases   
19
  1,443,636      1,723,656   
               Concession liabilities   
19
        15,489   
               Interest-bearing loans   
19
  722,006      423,160   
               Programme and film rights   
19
  149,971      53,925   
               Non-interest-bearing loans   
19
  39,948      59,418   
             Cash-settled share-based payment liability   
38
  108,371      36,158   
             Provisions   
20
  39,659      17,057   
             Derivative financial instruments   
36
  212,664      9,642   
             Deferred taxation   
10
  502,677      468,087   
 
      Current liabilities        6,677,026      5,981,377   
             Current portion of long-term debt   
19
  1,699,542      917,516   
             Provisions   
20
  28,390      82,015   
             Post retirement medical liability   
18
  8,164      –   
             Trade payables        1,118,353      1,133,246   
             Accrued expenses and other current liabilities   
21
  2,914,208      2,792,581   
             Related party payables   
14
  104,438      86,394   
             Taxation        346,292      250,310   
             Derivative financial instruments   
36
  92,862      285,976   
             Bank overdrafts and call loans   
34
  364,777      433,339   
             TOTAL EQUITY AND LIABILITIES        17,339,406      14,042,560   

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated annual financial statements.
 
F-3

 
CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENTS             
FOR THE YEARS ENDED MARCH 31, 2006 AND 2005 
           
       
March 31
   
Notes 
 
 2006
 
 2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
              Revenue   
23
  15,706,424      13,517,847  
              Cost of providing services and sale of goods   
24
  (8,753,690)    (7,725,819) 
              Selling, general and administration expenses   
24
  (3,948,677)    (3,311,485) 
              Other (losses)/gains - net   
25
  (7)    (11,702) 
       Operating profit   
 
  3,004,050    2,468,841  
              Finance costs - net   
26
  (11,432)    (217,004) 
              Share of equity-accounted results   
8
  151,277     88,597  
              Profit/(loss) on sale of investments   
 
  74,366     (311) 
              Dilution profits   
 
      368,036  
        Profit before taxation   
  3,218,261     2,708,159  
              Taxation   
27
  (934,813)    (256,462) 
        Profit after taxation        2,283,448     2,451,697  
              Profit from discontinued operations   
28
  31,816     50,042  
              Profit arising on discontinuance of operations   
28
  1,032,160      
        Profit for the year        3,347,424     2,501,739  
 
         Attributable to:             
         Equity holders of the Group        3,190,188     2,384,762  
         Minority interest        157,236     116,977  
        3,347,424     2,501,739  
               Earnings per N ordinary share (cents)             
                     Basic   
29
  1,124     860  
                     Fully diluted   
29
  1,063     814  
               Headline earnings per N ordinary share (cents)   
 
       
                     Basic   
29
  756     730  
                     Fully diluted   
29
  715     690  
               Dividend paid per A ordinary share (cents)        14     7  
               Dividend paid per N ordinary share (cents)        70     38  
               Proposed dividend per A ordinary share (cents)        24     14  
               Proposed dividend per N ordinary share (cents)        120     70  
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated annual financial statements.         

F-4

 

CONSOLIDATED CASH FLOW STATEMENTS             
FOR THE YEARS ENDED MARCH 31, 2006 AND 2005             
       
March 31
   
Notes 
 
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
 
Cash flows from operating activities             
       Cash from operating activities   
30
  4,019,905    3,051,265  
       Investment income received        2,170    430  
       Dividends received from equity-accounted companies        44,589    5,632  
       Cash generated from operating activities        4,066,664    3,057,327  
       Net finance costs paid        (78,480)   (214,923) 
       Taxation paid        (821,737)    (474,462) 
Net cash from operating activities        3,166,447    2,367,942  
 
Cash flows from investment activities             
       Property, plant and equipment acquired        (809,661)   (577,542) 
       Proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment        46,025    28,120  
       Intangible assets acquired        (106,805)   (63,384) 
       Acquisition of subsidiaries   
31
  (42,919)   (270,845) 
       Disposal of subsidiaries   
32
  36,726     7,847  
       Additional investment in existing subsidiaries        (193,280)   (66,879) 
       Partial disposal of interest in subsidiaries        10,000     
       Partial disposal of interest in joint ventures   
33
  751,845    (188,097) 
       Net investment in associated companies        (23,212)   (1,004) 
       Net cash movement in other investments and loans        (741)   98,335  
       Disposal of available-for-sale investments        –     429,587  
       Acquisition of available-for-sale investments        (3,417)   (273,245) 
Net cash utilized in investing activities        (335,439    (877,107) 
Cash flows from financing activities             
       Long term loans raised        460,916    29,684  
       Repayments of capitalized finance lease liabilities        (268,052)   (368,976) 
       Proceeds from share issue        166,951    26,372  
       Contributions by minority shareholders        583    8,357  
       Dividend paid by subsidiaries        (127,005)   (98,356) 
       Dividend paid by holding company        (208,871)   (105,645) 
       Other            (5,120) 
Net cash from/(utilized in) financing activities        24,522    (513,684) 
       Net increase in cash and cash equivalents        2,855,530    977,151  
       Forex translation adjustments on cash and cash equivalents        (45,222)   7,696  
       Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of the year        3,600,457    2,615,610  
Cash and cash equivalents at end of the year   
34
  6,410,765    3,600,457  
 
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated annual financial statements         

 
F-5

 
 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
FOR THE YEARS ENDED MARCH 31, 2006 AND 2005
 
 
   
Share capital and
premium
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
Class A
 
Class N
 
 Foreign
currency
translation
reserve
 
Hedging
reserve
 
Fair value
reserve
 
Existing
control
business
combination
reserve
 
Share-based
compen-
sation
reserve
 
Retained
earnings
 
Minority
interest
 
Total
   
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
Balance at April 1, 2004    14,243    4,577,786        (40,099)   (16,945)   (2,404,797)   21,965    (385,799)   245,369    2,011,723 
Share capital movements        760,985                                760,985 
Treasury share movements        38,137                                38,137 
Share-based compensation                                         
movements                            28,591            28,591 
Foreign currency translation effect            (5,984)                       1,652    (4,332)
Share in equity-accounted direct                                         
reserve movements            568    1,024            5,818            7,410 
Net fair value gains                47    12,846                    12,893 
- Fair value adjustment to available-                                         
for-sale investments, gross                66    18,095                    18,161 
- Fair value adjustment to available-                                         
for-sale investments, tax portion                (19)   (5,249)                   (5,268)
Cash flow hedges                20,108                    2,429    22,537 
- Net fair value gains, gross                (4,642)                   2,429    (2,213)
- Net fair value gains, tax portion                1,346                        1,346 
- Derecognized and added to asset,                                         
gross                11,690                        11,690 
- Derecognized and added to asset,                                         
tax portion                (3,390)                       (3,390)
- Derecognized and reported in                                         
income when recognition criteria                21,273                        21,273 
failed, gross                                         
- Derecognized and reported in                                         
income when recognition criteria                (6,169)                       (6,169)
failed, tax portion                                         
Other movements                    27,895    (68,728)       (813)   (42,782)   (84,428)
Release of fair value reserve                    27,895                    27,895 
Transactions with minorities and                                         
successive acquisitions                        (68,728)               (68,728) 
Other                                (813)   (42,782)   (43,595) 
Profit for the year                                2,384,762    116,977    2,501,739 
Dividends                                (105,645)   (102,380)   (208,025)
Other minority interest movements                                    6,063    6,063 
Balance at March 31, 2005    14,243    5,376,908    (5,416)   (18,920)   23,796    (2,473,525)   56,374    1,892,505    227,328    5,093,293 

F-6

 
 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
FOR THE YEARS ENDED MARCH 31, 2006 AND 2005 (continued)
 
  
   
Share capital and
premiun
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
Class A 
 
Class N 
 
Foreign
currency
translation
reserve
 
Hedging
reserve
 
Fair value
reserve
 
Existing
control
business
combination
reserve
 
Share
compen-
sation 
reserve
 
Retaining
earnings
 
Minority
interest
 
Total
   
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
  R’000  
R’000
 
R’000
Balance at April 1, 2005    14,243    5,376,908    (5,416)   (18,920)    23,796    (2,473,525)    56,374    1,892,505     227,328     5,093,293  
Share capital movements        69,723                –                  69,723  
Treasury share movements        64,537                –                  64,537  
Share-based compensation                                           
movements        35,909                –      134,808     –         170,717  
Foreign currency translation effect            18,223             –              1,010     19,233  
Purchase in existing subsidiary                        (1,028,058)            (49,592)    (1,077,650) 
Sale of existing subsidiary                        908                 908  
Net fair value gains                    (23,623)   –                  (23,623) 
- Fair value adjustment to available-                                           
for-sale investments, gross                    (17,849)   –                  (17,849) 
- Fair value adjustment to available-                                         
for-sale investments, tax portion                    5,176    –                  5,176  
- Realization of fair value on sale of                                         
available-for-sale investments, gross                –     (15,422)   –                  (15,422) 
   
- Realization of fair value on sale of                                         
available-for-sale investments, tax               
–  
  4,472    –                  4,472  
portion                                         
Cash flow hedges                (1,273)        –              (1,109)    (2,382) 
- Net fair value gains, gross                19,917         –              (317)    19,600  
- Net fair value gains, tax portion                (5,776)        –              98     (5,678) 
- Derecognized and added to asset,                                          
gross                (9,837)         –              (1,153)    (10,990) 
- Derecognized and added to asset,                                         
tax portion                2,853         –              263     3,116  
- Derecognized and reported in                                         
income, gross                (11,873)        –                  (11,873) 
- Derecognized and reported in                                         
income, tax portion                3,443         –                  3,443  
Profit for the year                        –          3,190,188    157,236     3,347,424  
Dividends                        –          (208,871)   (127,514)    (336,385) 
Other minority interest movements                        –              (35,812)    (35,812) 
Balance at March 31, 2006    14,243    5,547,077    12,807    (20,193)    173    (3,500,675)    191,182    4,873,822    171,547     7,289,983  
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated annual financial statements.                 

F-7

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
1.      NATURE OF OPERATIONS
 
  Naspers Limited was incorporated in 1915 under the laws of the Republic of South Africa. The principal activities of Naspers and its operating subsidiaries, joint ventures and associated companies (collectively, “the group”) are the operation of pay television, internet and instant messaging subscriber platforms and the provision of related technologies, the publishing, distribution and printing of magazines, newspapers and books, and the provision of private education services. These activities are conducted primarily in South Africa, sub-Saharan Africa, Greece, Cyprus, Thailand, China, the Netherlands and the United States of America.
 
2.      TRANSITION TO INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS (“IFRS”)
 
  A.      Introduction
 
    For the year ended March 31, 2005 the Naspers Limited group (“Naspers” or “the group”) prepared its financial statements under South African Statements of Generally Accepted Accounting Practice (“SA GAAP”) as effective at that date. In accordance with the JSE Limited (“JSE”) Listing Requirements the group is required to prepare its first annual consolidated financial statements in accordance with IFRS for the year ended March 31, 2006.
 
    As the group publishes comparative information in its financial statements, the date for transition to IFRS is April 1, 2004, which represents the beginning of the earliest period of comparative information to be presented as required in terms of the requirements of the JSE Limited and the Securities and Exchange Commission in the United States of America.
 
    In order to describe how Naspers’s reported results of operations and financial position are impacted by IFRS, the group has restated information previously published under SA GAAP to the equivalent basis under IFRS. This restatement follows the guidelines set out in IFRS 1 “First-time Adoption of International Financial Reporting Standards” (“IFRS 1”).
 
  B.      Transitional arrangements
 
    The date of transition to IFRS for the group is April 1, 2004 and therefore, as required by IFRS 1, the group’s opening balance sheet at April 1, 2004 has been restated to reflect all existing IFRS statements and interpretations effective at March 31, 2006. However, IFRS 1 allows for a number of exemptions and exceptions from full retrospective application of IFRS.
 
    The group has adopted the following exemptions in accordance with IFRS 1:
     
  (a) 
Business combinations 
     
   
The group has applied IFRS 3 “Business Combinations” (“IFRS 3”) to all business combinations that have occurred since April 1, 2004 (the date of transition to IFRS). In addition, the group has elected to apply IFRS 3 retrospectively to all business combinations that occurred between December 20, 2002 and the date of transition to IFRS. The group therefore applied the principles of IFRS 3 with effect from December 20, 2002. This retrospective application of IFRS 3 ensured that all the significant business combination transactions entered into by the group over the past three years have been treated in a consistent manner.
 
  (b)  Fair value as deemed cost 
     
      
The group has elected to measure certain items of property, plant and equipment at fair value and to use these fair values as the items’ deemed costs as at April 1, 2004. These items relate mainly to land and buildings in the group’s private education segment.
 
  (c)  Cumulative translation differences 
     
   
Naspers has elected not to apply the requirements of IAS 21 “Effects of Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates” (“IAS 21”) retrospectively for cumulative translation differences of all foreign operations. The group therefore set the cumulative translation differences to zero at April 1, 2004 and applied IAS 21 from this date. 
 
  (d) Exemption from restatement of comparatives for IAS 32 and IAS 39 
     
   
The group has elected to apply the exemption that allows it to apply the previous SA GAAP principles under AC 125 “Financial Instruments: Disclosure and Presentation (“AC 125”) and AC 133 “Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement” (“AC 133”) to derivatives, financial assets and financial liabilities and to hedging relationships for its comparative information relating to the financial year ended March 31, 2005. It therefore only applied IAS 32 and IAS 39 with effect from April 1, 2005. 
 
  (e)   Share-based payment transactions 
     
   
The group has applied the share-based payment exemption, therefore IFRS 2 “Share-based payments” (“IFRS 2”) was only applied to equity instruments that were granted after November 7, 2002 but that have not vested by January 1, 2005. Naspers also did not apply IFRS 2 to liabilities arising from share-based payment transactions that were settled before January 1, 2005. For instruments vesting on or after January 1, 2005, the amortization of the fair value charge has been recorded as an expense in the income statements in the respective periods and the cumulative effect of prior years in equity.
 
  (f)   Decommissioning liabilities included in property, plant and equipment 
     
    The group has elected in terms of IFRS 1 not to apply the requirements of IFRIC 1 “Changes in Existing Decommissioning, Restoration and Similar Liabilities” (“IFRIC 1”) for changes in such liabilities that occurred before April 1, 2004. 
 
F-8

 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
TRANSITION TO INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS (continued)
 
  B.    Transitional arrangements (continued)
     
  The group has applied the following exceptions from retrospective application in accordance with IFRS 1: 
     
      (a)  Derecognition of financial assets and liabilities
     
   
The application of the exemption from restating comparatives for IAS 32 “Financial Instruments: Disclosure and Presentation” (“IAS 32”) and IAS 39 “Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement” (“IAS 39”) means that the group’s effective date for these standards was April 1, 2005. Financial assets and liabilities derecognized before April 1, 2005 have not been re- recognized under IFRS.
 
      (b)  Hedge accounting
     
   
On adoption of IFRS the group is not allowed to designate a transaction as a hedge, if such transaction was not designated as a hedge and it qualified for hedge accounting in terms of AC 133 under SA GAAP.
 
     (c)   Estimates
     
   
Estimates under IFRS at April 1, 2004 are consistent with the estimates made at the same date under SA GAAP. Naspers therefore did not adjust any estimates it had made under SA GAAP for information it received subsequent to the date of transition to IFRS.
 
  (d)       Assets held for sale and discontinued operations
     
   
The group has applied IFRS 5 “Non-current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations” (“IFRS 5”) prospectively from April 1, 2005 to all non-current assets held for sale and/or discontinued operations.
 
  C.   Reconciliation of Net Profit and Equity from SA GAAP to IFRS
 
The reconciliations of Net Profit and Equity below present the impact of the various adjustments on the group’s financial position and financial performance. The numbering of the adjustments corresponds with the numbering used in section D “IFRS adjustments and reclassifications”.
 
 
Reconciliation of Net Profit 
      Year ended 
          March 31, 2005 
          R’m 
   
  As previously reported under SA GAAP         
  - Attributable to Naspers shareholders        2,600 
  - Attributable to minority shareholders        120 
          2,720 
  Adjusted for:         
   - share-based payments   
1
  (128)
   - amortization of goodwill and intangible assets   
2
  - 
   - transactions with minority shareholders   
3
  (59)
   - recognition of intangible assets   
4
  (20)
   - property, plant and equipment   
5 & 6 
  (11)
   - currency translation differences   
7
  4 
   - operating leases   
8
  (4)
   - decommission liabilities   
9
  - 
   - discounting of financial liabilities   
10
  (1)
  As reported under IFRS        2,501 
 
 
F-9

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     
(CONTINUED)             
 
TRANSITION TO INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS (continued)     
 
       C. Reconciliation of Net Profit and Equity from SA GAAP to IFRS (continued)         
 
 
           Reconciliation of Equity        March 31, 2005    April 1, 2004 
        R’m    R’m 
 
           As previously reported under SA GAAP             
           - Naspers shareholders’ interest        6,630     3,231  
           - Minority shareholders’ interest        223     237  
        6,853     3,468  
 
           Adjusted for:             
             - share-based payments   
1
  (155)    (62) 
             - amortization of goodwill and intangible assets   
2
  219     219  
           - transactions with minority shareholders   
3
  (1,956)    (1,782) 
           - recognition of intangible assets   
4
  40     61  
           - property, plant and equipment   
5 & 6
  116     128  
           - currency translation differences   
7
  -     -  
           - operating leases   
8
  (21)    (18) 
           - decommission liabilities   
9
  (2)    (2) 
           - discounting of financial liabilities   
10
  (1)    -  
           As reported under IFRS        5,093     2,012  
 
 
  D. IFRS adjustments and reclassifications
     
  The group made the following adjustments to its SA GAAP financial statements in order to restate the information in terms of IFRS:
     
      (1)  IFRS 2: Share-based payments
   
The group grants share options to its employees under a number of equity compensation plans. In terms of SA GAAP, these equity compensation plans did not result in any expense being recorded by the group, other than costs incurred in administering the schemes and a dilution in earnings per share when the shares were delivered to the employee. 
 
   
In accordance with IFRS 2, the group has recognized a compensation expense in the income statement, representing the fair value of share options granted to the group’s employees. A corresponding credit to equity has been raised for equity-settled plans, whereas a corresponding credit to liabilities has been raised for cash-settled plans. The fair value of the options at the date of grant under equity-settled plans is charged to income over the relevant vesting periods, adjusted to reflect actual and expected levels of vesting. For cash-settled plans, the group remeasures the fair value of the liability at each reporting date and at the date of settlement, with any changes in fair value recognized in income for the period.
 
      (2) 
IAS 38: Amortization of goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite useful lives
 
   
The group has adopted IFRS 3 “Business Combinations” (“IFRS 3”), IAS 36 “Impairment of Assets” (“IAS 36”) and IAS 38 “Intangible Assets” (“IAS 38”) on April 1, 2004. As discussed previously the group elected to apply IFRS 3 with effect from December 20, 2002 in terms of the exemption provided under IFRS 1. Owing to this application of IFRS 3, the group has also applied the principles of IAS 36 and IAS 38 from that date.
   
 
     (3)   IFRS 3: Transactions with minority shareholders
    As discussed above the group has elected to apply the principles of IFRS 3 to all business combinations as from December 20, 2002. Under SA GAAP, before the adoption of AC 140 “Business Combinations” (“AC 140”), the group accounted for transactions with minority shareholders by allocating the cost of the transaction to identifiable tangible and intangible assets at their fair values at the transaction date and recognizing goodwill relating to the excess of the cost over the acquirer’s interest in the net fair value of the identifiable assets and liabilities. After the adoption of AC 140 on April 1, 2004, the group applied the modified parent company model and allocated the full excess of the cost of the transaction with minority shareholders over the acquirer’s interest in previously recognized assets and liabilities to goodwill under SA GAAP.

F-10

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
TRANSITION TO INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS (continued)
 
 
  D. IFRS adjustments and reclassifications (continued)
     
  (3)  IFRS 3: Transactions with minority shareholders (continued) 
   
In terms of IFRS 3, the group has elected to account for transactions with minority shareholders as equity transactions in terms of the economic entity model. Under this model, any excess of the cost of the transaction over the acquirer’s interest in previously recognized assets and liabilities is allocated to a separate component of equity.
 
The impact of the adoption of IFRS 3 as from December 20, 2002 has led to the derecognition of all intangible assets, all adjustments to the fair value of tangible assets and all goodwill accounted for under SA GAAP that resulted from transactions with minority shareholders since that date. 
 
      (4)  IAS 38: Recognition of intangible assets
   
Before the adoption of AC 131 “Business Combinations” and AC 128 “Intangible Assets” on April 1, 2000, the group accounted for all intangible assets purchased and acquired in business combinations against shareholders’ equity. In terms of the requirements of IFRS 1, IAS 38 should be applied retrospectively, requiring the group to recognize all intangible assets that have previously been recognized in the group’s financial statements and that meet the recognition and measurement criteria of IAS 38. On transition to IFRS the group has therefore re-instated all such intangible assets which were previously accounted for against shareholders’ equity under SA GAAP.
 
      (5) 
IAS 16: Useful lives and residual values
   
IAS 16 “Property, plant and equipment” (“IAS 16”) differs in certain respects from the previous SA GAAP equivalent, AC 123 “Property, plant and equipment” (“AC 123”), applied by the group until March 31, 2005. IAS 16 states that an entity is required to measure the residual value of an item of property, plant and equipment as the amount the entity estimates it would receive currently for the asset if the asset were already of the age and in the condition expected at the end of its useful life. The group has previously under SA GAAP accounted for residual values based on the requirement of AC 123 that regards residual value as the net amount that the entity expected to obtain for the asset at the end of its useful life. The group has therefore reviewed its residual values for individual items of property, plant and equipment and adjusted the carrying value of some items at the date of transition accordingly in terms of the requirements of IAS 16. 
 
   
IAS 16 further requires that the useful lives of the individual components of property, plant and equipment items be reviewed at least annually, whereas the requirement under the previous SA GAAP equivalent, AC 123, has been to review the useful lives of items of property, plant and equipment on a non-mandatory periodic basis. The group has reassessed the useful lives of all individual components of property, plant and equipment and adjusted the carrying value of some items at the date of transition accordingly.
 
   
The adjustments to the residual values and useful lives of certain items of property, plant and equipment and the corresponding change in their carrying values at April 1, 2004 has also impacted depreciation charges subsequent to April 1, 2004.
 
     (6)   IFRS 1 and IAS 16: Fair value as deemed cost
   
In terms of the requirements of IFRS 1 the group is required to apply IAS 16 retrospectively. As explained in the transitional arrangements section, the group has elected to apply the exemption under IFRS 1 whereby the fair value of certain assets at April 1, 2004 is used as its deemed cost on the transition date. The group adjusted the carrying values of the individual items of property, plant and equipment for those items to which the exemption was applied. The aggregate of these fair values were Rand 89.6 million and the total adjustment to the carrying amounts was Rand 36 million.
 
  (7)
IFRS 1 and IAS 21: Reset of cumulative translation differences
   
In terms of the requirements of IFRS 1 the group is required to apply IAS 21 “The Effects of Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates” (“IAS 21”) retrospectively. As explained in the transitional arrangements section, the group has elected to apply the exemption under IFRS 1 whereby all cumulative translation differences for all foreign operations are deemed to be zero at the date of transition. The group has therefore reset its cumulative translation differences relating to foreign entities as previously recognized under SA GAAP. A corresponding entry was made to retained earnings.
 
  (8) IAS 17: Operating leases
    The South African Institute of Chartered Accountants issued Circular 7/2005 during August 2005. The purpose of the circular was to clarify the requirements of IAS 17 “Leases” (“IAS 17”) in respect of operating leases, which include fixed rental increases. IAS 17 and its SA GAAP equivalent standard AC 105 “Leases” (“AC 105”) require that lease payments under an operating lease should be recognized as an expense on a straight-line basis over the lease term unless another systematic basis is more representative of the time pattern of the user’s benefit. In South Africa most lessees, including Naspers, have in the application of AC 105 recognized rental expenses with fixed rental increases on the basis of the cash flow in the lease agreements, interpreting that such an approach represented “another systematic basis” that was “more representative of the time pattern of the user’s benefits”. Circular 7/2005, however, clarified that the way many South African entities, including Naspers, applied the “other systematic basis” in terms of AC 105 was not consistent with the requirements of IAS 17 and AC as applied internationally. IAS 17 only permits a treatment other than straight-line recognition when another basis is more representative of the time pattern of the user’s benefit, which is unaffected by the timing of payments. 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
TRANSITION TO INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS (continued)
 
 
  D. IFRS adjustments and reclassifications (continued)
     
  (8)  IAS 17: Operating leases (continued) 
   
Naspers applied the principles of IAS 17, as clarified by Circular 7/2005, to all its lease agreements with fixed rental increases on adoption of IFRS. The requirements of IAS 17 were applied retrospectively and an adjustment to retained earnings at the transition date was accounted for. The net profit for the year ended March 31, 2005 was adjusted accordingly.
 
      (9)  IFRIC 1: Decommissioning, restoration and similar liabilities
   
IFRS 1 requires that the group apply the requirements of IFRIC 1 retrospectively. As explained in the transitional arrangements section, the group has elected to apply the exemption under IFRS 1, whereby the group need not account for changes in decommissioning, restoration and similar liabilities that occurred before the date of transition to IFRS. The group identified only one such liability, pertaining to leasehold premises and related improvements. The value of the assets are immaterial to the group.
 
      (10)  IAS 39: Discounting of programme and film rights liabilities
   
The group has certain programme and film rights liabilities that are classified as financial liabilities in terms of IAS 39. IAS 39 requires that financial liabilities be measured at amortized cost using the effective interest method. Certain programme and film rights liabilities have settlement dates that are not short term in nature, therefore these liabilities have been discounted in terms of IAS 39. These liabilities were not previously discounted in terms of the group’s SA GAAP reporting.
   
 
 
In the process of transition to IFRS, the group identified instances where reclassifications were required between certain balance sheet items compared with the classifications that were previously presented under SA GAAP. The following reclassifications were made by the group in restating its balance sheet under IFRS.
 
     (11)   Reclassification of computer software from property, plant and equipment to intangible assets
   
The group reclassified certain computer software from “property, plant and equipment” to “intangible assets” on its balance sheet. Computer software is required to be classified as an intangible asset in terms of IAS 38, unless the software is an integral part of the related hardware. This adjustment had no impact on the group’s income statements or its net equity.
 
  (12) Reclassification between non-current and current assets and liabilities
   
The group reclassified certain assets and liabilities from non-current assets and liabilities to current assets and liabilities, respectively. The reason for these reclassifications was to accurately reflect the nature of certain assets and liabilities between its current and non-current portions as required by IAS 1. Certain derivative financial assets were reclassified from current assets to non-current assets. This reclassification had no impact on the group’s income statements or its net equity.
 
  (13) Reclassification of deferred income and provisions
   
The group reclassified credit balances relating to deferred income that were included under “accounts receivable” to “accrued expenses” on its balance sheet. This reclassification had no impact on the group’s income statements or its net equity. A reclassification was also made between “accrued expenses” and “provisions” on the balance sheet relating to a warranty provision.
 
 
 The following represent the significant presentation adjustments that have been made to the group’s income statement:
 
   (1) Presentation of expenses
   
The group previously applied the provisions of AC 101 “Presentation of Financial Statements” (“AC 101”) under SA GAAP to present its expenditure items on the face of its income statement. IAS 1 “Presentation of Financial Statements” (“IAS 1”) provides additional guidance relating to the presentation of expenditure in its income statement. In applying this guidance certain reclassifications were made between “cost of providing services and sale of goods”, “selling, general and administration expenses” and “other (losses) / gains - net”.
 
   (2) Reallocation of depreciation, amortization and impairment captions
   
Depreciation and amortization expenses that were separately disclosed on the face of the SA GAAP income statement have been reallocated to “cost of providing services and sale of goods” and “selling, general and administration expenses” on the face of the IFRS income statement. Impairments and adjustments to goodwill and other intangible assets have been reallocated to the caption “other (losses) / gains - net”.
 
   (3) Share of equity accounted results presented net of taxation
   
Under SA GAAP the group previously presented its share of equity-accounted results gross of its share of the associated companies’ taxation charges, which were included under “taxation” in the group’s income statement. In terms of IAS 1, the group is required to present its share of equity-accounted results relating to associated companies after taxation and minority interests in the associates. The group therefore reclassified these taxation expenses from “taxation” to “share of equity- accounted results” to reflect a post-taxation result.
 
 
F-12

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
TRANSITION TO INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS (continued)
 
 
  D. IFRS adjustments and reclassifications (continued)
   
 
      (4)  Exceptional items
   
 
   
Under SA GAAP the group previously presented certain items that are of such nature or incidence that their separate disclosure is relevant to explain the group’s performance and make comparisons of operating margins more meaningful under a heading “exceptional items” on the face of its income statement. Under IFRS the group is not allowed to aggregate such items under “exceptional items”, therefore such items have been presented separately on the face of the income statement under headings such as “profit on sale of investments” and “dilution profits” to provide a description of each item’s nature. Certain items previously included under “exceptional items” that are of an operational nature have been reclassified to “other (losses) / gains - net” and are therefore included in operating profit under IFRS.
 
   
Certain presentation changes have been made to the group’s cash flow statement. The most significant adjustment related to the classification of dividends paid by the group. Under SA GAAP the group previously presented dividends paid to shareholders as part of its operating activities, as it assisted readers of the financial statements to determine the ability of the group to pay dividends out of operating cash flows. Under IFRS the group elected to present dividends paid as part of financing activities in terms of IAS 7 “Cash Flow Statements” (“IAS 7”) as it is a cost to obtain financial resources. Dividends paid of Rand 204 million for the year ended March 31, 2005 have been reclassified from operating to financing activities. A number of additional immaterial adjustments and reclassifications were also made to the group’s SA GAAP cash flow statement in order to present it on an IFRS basis.
 
 3.
 
PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES
 
 
 The consolidated annual financial statements of the group are presented in accordance with, and comply with, International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) and International Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee (IFRIC) interpretations issued and effective at the time of preparing these financial statements. The disclosure required by IFRS1 “First time adoption of IFRS” concerning the transition from SA GAAP to IFRS is provided in note 2. The consolidated financial statements are prepared according to the historic cost convention as modified by the revaluation of available-for-sale financial assets and financial assets and liabilities (including derivative instruments) at fair value through profit or loss.
 
The preparation of the consolidated financial statements necessitates the use of estimates, assumptions and judgments. These estimates and assumptions affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities at the balance sheet date as well as affecting the reported income and expenses for the year. Although estimates are based on management’s best knowledge and judgment of current facts as at the balance sheet date, the actual outcome may differ from these estimates, possibly significantly. Refer to the individual notes for details of estimates, assumptions and judgments used.
 
   (a)    
Basis of consolidation
 
   
The consolidated annual financial statements include the results of Naspers Limited and its subsidiaries, associates, joint ventures and related share incentive trusts.
 
   
Subsidiaries
 
   
The consolidated annual financial statements include the results Naspers Limited and its subsidiaries. Subsidiaries are those companies in which the group, directly or indirectly, has an interest of more than half of the voting rights, or otherwise has the power to exercise control over their operations. The existence and effect of potential voting rights that are presently exercisable or convertible without restriction are considered when assessing whether the group controls another entity. Subsidiaries are consolidated from the date that effective control is transferred to the group and are no longer consolidated from the date that effective control ceases. Similarly, the results of a subsidiary divested during an accounting period are included in the consolidated financial statements only to the date of disposal. For certain entities, the group has entered into contractual arrangements (such as nominee relationships and escrow arrangements) which allow the group, along with its direct interests in such entities, to control a majority of the voting rights or otherwise have power to exercise control over the operations of such entities. Because the group controls such entities in this manner they are considered to be subsidiaries and are therefore consolidated in the annual financial statements.
 
All intergroup transactions and balances are eliminated as part of the consolidation process. The interests of minority shareholders in the consolidated equity and results of the group are shown separately in the consolidated balance sheet and income statement, respectively. Where the losses attributable to the minority shareholders in a consolidated subsidiary exceed their interest in that subsidiary, the excess, and any further losses attributable to them, are recognized by the group and allocated to those minority interests only to the extent that the minority shareholders have a binding obligation and are able to fund the losses. Where the group previously did not recognize the minority shareholders’ portion of losses and the subsidiary subsequently turns profitable, the group recognizes all the profits until the minority shareholders’ share of losses previously absorbed by the group has been recovered.
 
The purchase method of accounting is used to account for the acquisition of subsidiaries by the group. The cost of an acquisition is measured as the fair value of the assets given, equity instruments issued and liabilities incurred or assumed at the date of exchange, plus costs directly attributable to the acquisition. Identifiable assets acquired and liabilities and contingent liabilities assumed in a business combination are measured initially at their fair values at the acquisition date, irrespective of the extent of any minority
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
 
 3.       
PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
 
  (a)     
Basis of consolidation (continued)
     
   
Subsidiaries (continued)
 
   
interest. The excess of the cost of acquisition over the fair value of the group’s share of the identifiable net assets acquired is recorded as goodwill. If the cost of acquisition is less than the fair value of the net assets of the subsidiary acquired, the difference is recognized directly in the income statement.
 
The group applies the economic entity model in accounting for transactions with minority shareholders. In terms of this model, minority shareholders are viewed as equity participants of the group and all transactions are therefore accounted for as equity transactions and included in the statement of changes in equity. On acquisition of an interest from a minority shareholder, any excess of the cost of the transaction over the acquirer’s proportionate share of the net asset value acquired is allocated to a separate component of equity. Dilution profits and losses relating to non-wholly owned subsidiary entities are similarly accounted for in the statement of changes in equity in terms of the economic entity model.
Where necessary, accounting policies for subsidiaries have been changed to ensure consistency with the policies adopted by the group.
 
   
Associated companies
 
   
Investments in associated companies are accounted for under the equity method. Associated companies are those companies in which the group generally has between 20% and 50% of the voting rights, or over which the group exercises significant influence, but which it does not control.
 
Equity-accounting involves recognizing in the income statement the group’s share of the associate’s post-acquisition results net of taxation and minority interests in the associate. The group’s share of post-acquisition movements in reserves is accounted for in the reserves of the group. The group’s interest in the associate is carried on the balance sheet at cost, adjusted for the group’s share of the change in post-acquisition net assets, and inclusive of goodwill and other identifiable intangible assets recognized on acquisitions. Where the group’s share of losses exceeds the carrying amount of its investment, the carrying amount of the investment as well as any loans to the associate are reduced to nil and no further losses are recognized, unless the group has incurred obligations to the associate or the group has guaranteed or committed to satisfy obligations of the associate. Unrealized gains and losses on transactions between the group and its associates are eliminated to the extent of the group’s interest in the associates, unless the loss provides evidence of an impairment of the asset transferred.
 
 
Joint ventures
 
   
The group’s interest in jointly controlled entities is accounted for by way of proportionate consolidation. The group combines its share of the joint ventures’ individual income and expenses, assets and liabilities and cash flows on a line-by-line basis with similar items in the group’s financial statements. The group recognizes the portion of gains or losses on the sale of assets by the group to the joint venture that is attributable to the other venturers. The group does not recognize its share of gains or losses from the joint venture that result from the purchase of assets by the group from the joint venture until it resells the assets to an independent third party. However, if a loss on the transaction provides evidence of a reduction in the net realizable value of current assets or an impairment loss, the loss is recognized immediately.
 
  (b)  Investments
     
    The group classifies its investments in debt and equity securities into the following categories: at fair value through profit and loss, held-to-maturity, available-for-sale and loans and receivables. The classification is dependent on the purpose for which the investments were acquired. Management determines the classification of its investments at the time of purchase and re-evaluates such designation on an annual basis. At fair value through profit and loss assets has two sub-categories: financial assets held for trading and those designated at fair value through profit or loss at inception. A financial asset is classified into this category at inception if acquired principally for the purpose of selling in the short term, if it forms part of a portfolio of financial assets in which there is evidence of short term profit-taking, or if so designated by management. For the purpose of these financial statements short-term is defined as a period of three months or less. The group does not hold financial assets for trading, therefore assets held as at fair value through profit and loss are designated as such on initial recognition. Derivatives are also classified as held for trading unless they are designated as hedges.
 
Investments with a fixed maturity that management has the intent and ability to hold to maturity are classified as held-to-maturity and are included in non-current assets, except for maturities within 12 months from the balance sheet date, which are classified as current assets. Loans and receivables are non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments that are not quoted in an active market other than those that the group intends to sell in the short term or that it has designated as at fair value through income or available-for-sale. All other investments, including those that are intended to be held for an indefinite period of time, which may be sold in response to needs for liquidity, changes in fair value or interest rates, are classified as available-for-sale. Available for sale assets are included in non-current assets unless management has the express intention of holding the investment for less than 12 months from the balance sheet date or unless they will need to be sold to raise operating capital, in which case they are included in current assets.
 
 
 3.       
PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
 
  (b)     
Investments (continued)
     
   
Purchases and sales of investments are recognized on the trade date, which is the date that the group commits to purchase or sell the asset. Investments are initially recognized at fair value plus, in the case of all financial assets not carried at fair value through profit or loss, transaction costs that are directly attributable to their acquisition. At fair value through profit and loss and available-for-sale investments are subsequently carried at fair value. Held-to-maturity investments and loans and receivables are carried at amortized cost using the effective yield method. Realized and unrealized gains and losses arising from changes in the fair value of at fair value through profit and loss investments are included in the income statement in the period in which they arise. Unrealized gains and losses arising from changes in the fair value of investments classified as available-for-sale are recognized in equity.
 
The fair values of investments are based on quoted bid prices or amounts derived from cash flow models. Fair values for unlisted equity securities are estimated using applicable price/earnings or price/cash flow ratios refined to reflect the specific circumstances of the issuer. Equity securities for which fair values cannot be measured reliably are recognized at cost less impairment. When securities classified as available-for-sale are sold or impaired, the accumulated fair value adjustments are included in the income statement as “profit / loss on sale of investments”
 
Investments are derecognized when the rights to receive cash flows from the investments have expired or where they have been transferred and the group has also transferred substantially all risks and rewards of ownership.
 
  (c)  
Property, plant and equipment
     
   
Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost, being the purchase cost plus any cost to prepare the assets for their intended use, less accumulated depreciation and any accumulated impairment losses. Cost includes transfers from equity of any gains/losses on qualifying cash flow hedges of foreign currency purchase costs. Property, plant and equipment, with the exception of land, are depreciated in equal annual amounts over each asset’s estimated useful economic life. Land is not depreciated as it is deemed to have an indefinite life. Depreciation periods vary in accordance with the conditions in the relevant industries, but are subject to the following maximum limits: 
 
  Land & Buildings:    Factory buildings    50 years 
      Other buildings    50 years 
  Manufacturing equipment:    Printing presses    25 years 
      Production equipment    25 years 
  Office equipment:        20 years 
  Furniture:        20 years 
  Computer equipment:    Manufacturing    20 years 
      Office    20 years 
  Vehicles:        12 years 
  Transmission equipment:    Set-top boxes    20 years 
      Transponders and transmitters    20 years 
 
    Major leasehold improvements are amortized over the shorter of their respective lease periods and estimated useful economic life.
 
Concession assets are capitalized and depreciated over the shorter of their useful life of five years and the remaining concession period.
 
Borrowing costs directly attributable to the acquisition, construction or production of qualifying assets are capitalized as part of the cost of those assets. Capitalization of such borrowing costs ceases when the assets are substantially ready for their intended use or sale. All other borrowing costs are expensed in the period in which they are incurred.
 
Subsequent costs are included in the asset’s carrying amount or recognized as a separate asset, as appropriate, only when it is probable that future economic benefits associated with the item will flow to the group and the cost of the item can be measured reliably. All other repairs and maintenance are charged to the income statement during the financial period in which they are incurred. The cost of major renovations is included in the carrying amount of the asset when it is probable that future economic benefits will flow to the group and the cost can be reliably measured. Major renovations are depreciated over the remaining useful economic life of the related asset.
 

 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
3.      PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
 
  (c)      Property, plant and equipment (continued)
 
    The carrying values of property, plant and equipment are reviewed periodically to assess whether or not the net recoverable amount has declined below the carrying amount. In the event of such impairment, the carrying amount is reduced and the reduction is charged as an expense against income.
 
    The assets’ residual values and useful lives are reviewed, and adjusted if appropriate, at each balance sheet date. Gains and losses on disposals are determined by comparing the proceeds with the asset’s carrying amount.
 
  (d)      Leased assets
 
    Leases of property, plant and equipment, except land, are classified as finance leases where, substantially all risks and rewards associated with ownership of an asset are transferred from the lessor to the group as lessee. Assets classified as finance leases are capitalized at the lower of the fair value of the leased asset and the estimated present value of the underlying minimum lease payments, with the related lease obligation recognized at the estimated present value of the minimum lease payments. Bank rates are used to calculate present values of minimum lease payments. Capitalized leased assets are depreciated over their estimated useful lives, limited to the duration of the lease agreement.
 
    Each lease payment is allocated between the liability and finance charges so as to achieve a constant rate on the finance balance outstanding. The corresponding rental obligations, net of finance charges, are included in other long-term payables. The interest element of the finance cost is charged to the income statement over the lease period so as to produce a constant periodic rate of interest on the remaining balance of the liability for each period.
 
    Leases of assets under which substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership are effectively retained by the third-party lessor are classified as operating leases. Operating lease rentals (net of any incentives received from the lessor) are charged to the income statement on a straight-line basis over the period of the lease.
 
  (e)      Goodwill and other intangible assets
 
    Goodwill represents the excess of the cost of an acquisition over the fair value of the group’s share of the net identifiable assets of the acquired subsidiary, associate or joint venture at the date of acquisition. Goodwill on acquisition of subsidiaries and joint ventures is included in “goodwill” on the balance sheet. Goodwill on acquisitions of associates is included in ‘investments in associates’. Separately recognized goodwill is tested annually for impairment and carried at cost less accumulated impairment losses. Impairment losses on goodwill are not reversed. Gains and losses on the disposal of an entity include the carrying amount of goodwill relating to the entity sold.
 
    Goodwill is allocated to cash-generating units for the purpose of impairment testing. Impairment is determined by assessing the recoverable amount of the cash-generating unit to which the goodwill relates. Where the recoverable amount of the cash-generating unit is less than the carrying amount, an impairment loss is recognized.
 
    Patents, brand names, trademarks, title rights, concession rights, software and other similar intangible assets acquired are capitalized at cost. Intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are not amortized, but tested annually for impairment and carried at cost less accumulated impairment losses. Intangible assets with finite useful lives are being amortized using the straight-line method over their estimated useful lives. The carrying amount of each intangible asset is reviewed annually and adjusted for impairment where the carrying amount exceeds the recoverable amount. The useful lives and residual values of intangible assets are reassessed on an annual basis. Amortization periods for intangible assets with finite useful lives vary in accordance with the conditions in the relevant industries, but are subject to the following maximum limits:
 
 
 
Patents 
  5 years 
  Title rights    10 years 
  Brand names & trademarks    20 years 
  Software    5 years 
  Intellectual property rights    7 years 
  Concession rights    20 years 
  Subscriber base    8 years 

No value is attributed to internally developed trademarks or similar rights and assets. The costs incurred to develop these items are charged to the income statement in the period in which they are incurred.
 

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
3.      PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
 
  (f)      Programme and film rights
 
    Purchased programme and film rights are stated at acquisition costs less accumulated amortization. The group has certain programme and film rights liabilities that are classified as financial liabilities in terms of IAS 39 which requires that financial liabilities be measured at amortized cost using the effective interest method. Certain programme and film rights liabilities have settlement dates that are long term in nature; therefore these liabilities are recorded as non-current liabilities and have been discounted in terms of IAS 39. Licenses are recorded as assets and liabilities for rights acquired, and obligations incurred under license agreements when the license period begins and the cost of each programme is known or reasonably determinable. Sports rights are written off on initial broadcasting of the event whereas general entertainment and films are amortized either on a straight- line basis over the duration of the license or based on broadcasts where the number of screenings are restricted. Amortization of programme and film rights is included in the cost of providing services and sale of goods. The costs of in-house programmes are expensed as incurred.
 
  (g)      Impairment
 
    Financial assets
 
    The group assesses at each balance sheet date whether there is any objective evidence that an investment or group of investments is impaired. If any such evidence exists, the entity applies the following principles for each class of financial assets to determine the amount of any impairment loss:
 
    Financial assets carried at amortized cost
 
    If there is objective evidence that an impairment loss on loans and receivables or held-to-maturity investments carried at amortized cost has been incurred, the amount of the loss is measured as the difference between the asset’s carrying amount and the present value of estimated future cash flows (excluding future credit losses that have not been incurred) discounted at the financial asset’s original effective interest rate (ie the effective interest rate computed at initial recognition). The carrying amount of the asset is reduced directly through profit and loss. If, in a subsequent period, the amount of the impairment loss decreases and the decrease can be related objectively to an event occurring after the impairment was recognized, the previously recognized impairment loss shall be reversed through profit and loss. The reversal shall not result in a carrying amount of the financial asset that exceeds what the amortized cost would have been had the impairment not been recognized at the date the impairment is reversed. The reversal is recognized in the income statement in the same line as the original impairment charge.
 
    Available-for-sale financial assets
 
    When a decline in the fair value of an available-for-sale financial asset has been recognized directly in equity and there is objective evidence that the asset is impaired, the cumulative loss that had been recognized directly in equity shall be removed from equity and recognized in profit or loss even though the financial asset has not been derecognized.
 
    Impairment losses recognized in profit or loss for an investment in an equity instrument classified as available for sale shall not be reversed through profit or loss.
 
    If, in a subsequent period, the fair value of a debt instrument classified as available for sale increases and the increase can be objectively related to an event occurring after the impairment loss was recognized in profit or loss, the impairment loss shall be reversed, with the amount of the reversal recognized in profit or loss.
 
    Long lived assets
 
    The group evaluates the carrying value of assets with finite useful lives annually and when events and circumstances indicate that the carrying value may not be recoverable. Indicators of possible impairment include, but are not limited to: significant underperformance relative to expectations based on historical or projected future operating results; significant changes in the manner of use of the assets or the strategy for the group’s overall business; significant negative industry or economic trends; a significant and sustained decline in an investment’s share price or market capitalization relative to its net asset value. Assets that have an indefinite useful life are not subject to amortization and are tested annually for impairment.
 
    An impairment loss is recognized in the income statement when the carrying amount of an asset exceeds its recoverable amount. An asset’s recoverable amount is the higher of the amount obtainable from the sale of an asset in an arm’s length transaction between knowledgeable willing parties, or its value in use. Value in use is the present value of estimated future cash flows expected to arise from the continuing use of an asset and from its disposal at the end of its useful life. The estimated future cash flows are discounted to their present value using a pre-tax discount rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the asset. For the purposes of assessing impairment, assets are grouped at the lowest levels for which there are separately identifiable cash flows.
 
    An impairment loss recognized for an asset in prior years is reversed if there has been a change in the estimates used to determine the asset’s recoverable amount since the last impairment loss was recognized and the recoverable amount exceeds the new carrying amount. The reversal of the impairment is limited to the carrying amount that would have been determined (net of depreciation or
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
3.      PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
 
  (g)      Impairment (continued)
 
    Long lived assets (continued)
 
    amortization) had no impairment loss been recognized in prior years. The reversal of such an impairment loss is recognized in the income statement in the same line item as the original impairment charge.
 
  (h)      Development activities
 
    Research and development costs
 
    Research expenditure is recognized as an expense as incurred. Costs incurred on development projects (relating to the design and testing of new or improved products) are recognized as intangible assets when it is probable that the project will be profitable considering its commercial and technical feasibility and its costs can be measured reliably. Other development expenditures that do not meet these criteria are recognized as an expense as incurred. Development costs previously recognized as an expense are not recognized as an asset in a subsequent period. Capitalized development costs are recorded as intangible assets and amortized from the point at which the asset is ready for use on a straight-line basis over its useful life, not exceeding the limits stated in note (e). Development assets are tested for impairment annually, and the impairment loss is recognized in the income statement when the carrying amount of the asset exceeds its recoverable amount. This loss is also reversed if there has been a change in the estimates used to determine the asset’s recoverable amount since the last impairment loss was recognized and the recoverable amount exceeds the new carrying amount. The reversal of the impairment is limited to the carrying amount that would have been determined (net of depreciation or amortization) had no impairment loss been recognized in prior years. The reversal of such an impairment loss is recognized in the income statement in the same line item as the original impairment charge.
 
    Software development costs
 
    Costs that are directly associated with the production of identifiable and unique software products controlled by the group, and that will probably generate economic benefits exceeding costs beyond one year, are recognized as intangible assets. Direct costs include the software development team’s employee costs and an appropriate portion of relevant overheads. All other costs associated with developing or maintaining computer software programmes are recognized as an expense as incurred.
 
    Website development costs
 
    Website development costs are capitalized as intangible assets if it is probable that the expected future economic benefits attributable to the asset will flow to the group, and its cost can be measured reliably, otherwise these costs are charged against operating profit as the expenditure is incurred.
 
  (i)      Inventory
 
    Inventory is stated at the lower of cost or net realizable value. The cost of inventory is determined by means of the first-in-first-out basis or the weighted average method. The majority of inventory is valued using the first-in-first-out basis, but for certain inventories with a specific nature and use which differs significantly from other classes of inventory, the weighed average is used. The cost of finished products and work-in-progress comprises raw materials, direct labour, other direct costs and related production overheads, but excludes finance costs. Costs of inventories include the transfer from equity of any gains or losses on qualifying cash flow hedges relating to inventory purchases. Net realizable value is the estimate of the selling price, less the costs of completion and selling expenses. Provisions are made for obsolete, unusable and unsaleable inventory and for latent damage first revealed when inventory items are taken into use or offered for sale.
 
  (j)      Trade receivables
 
    Trade receivables are recognized at fair value less provision made for impairment. A provision for impairment of trade receivables is established when there is objective evidence that the group will not be able to collect all amounts due according to the original terms of receivables. The amount of the provision is the difference between the carrying amount and the estimated recoverable amount.
 
  (k)      Cash and cash equivalents
 
    Cash and cash equivalents are carried in the balance sheet at cost. Cash and cash equivalents comprise cash on hand, deposits held at call with banks and investments in money market instruments with maturities of three months or less at the date of purchase. Certain cash balances are restricted from immediate use according to terms with banks or other financial institutions. For cash flow purposes, cash and cash equivalents are presented net of bank overdrafts.
 

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
3.      PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
 
  (l)      Borrowings
 
    Borrowings are recognized initially at fair value, net of transaction costs incurred. Borrowings are subsequently stated at amortized cost using the effective yield method; any difference between proceeds and the redemption value is recognized in the income statement over the period of the borrowings.
 
  (m)      Provisions
 
    Provisions are recognized when the group has a present legal or constructive obligation as a result of past events, it is probable that an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation and a reliable estimate of the amount of the obligation can be made.
 
    The group recognizes the estimated liability on all products still under warranty at the balance sheet date. The group recognizes a provision for onerous contracts when the expected benefits to be derived from a contract are less than the unavoidable costs of meeting the obligations under the contract. Restructuring provisions are recognized in the period in which the group becomes legally or constructively committed to payment. Costs related to the ongoing activities of the group are not provided in advance.
 
  (n)      Taxation
 
    Taxation rates
 
    The normal South African company tax rate used for the year ending March 31, 2006 is 29% (2005: 30%). Deferred tax assets and liabilities for South African entities at March 31, 2006 have been calculated using this rate, being the rate that the group expects to apply to the periods when the assets are realized or the liabilities are settled. Secondary tax on companies is calculated at 12,5%, and capital gains tax is calculated at 50% of the company tax rate. International tax rates vary from jurisdiction to jurisdiction.
 
    Deferred taxation
 
    Deferred taxation is provided in full, using the balance sheet liability method, for all timing differences arising between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their carrying values for financial reporting purposes. Currently enacted, or where appropriate, substantially enacted tax rates are used to determine deferred taxation.
 
    Using this method, the group is required to make provision for deferred taxation, in relation to an acquisition, on the difference between the fair values of the net assets acquired and their tax base. Provision for taxes, mainly withholding taxes, which could arise on the remittance of retained earnings, is only made if there is a current intention to remit such earnings.
 
    The principal timing differences arise from depreciation on property, plant and equipment, other intangibles, provisions and other current liabilities, income received in advance and tax losses carried forward. Deferred taxation assets are recognized to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profit will be available against which timing differences and unused tax losses can be utilized.
 
    Deferred taxation is provided on temporary differences arising on investments in subsidiaries and associates, except where the timing of the reversal of the temporary difference is controlled by the group and it is probable that the temporary difference will not reverse in the foreseeable future.
 
    Secondary tax on companies (“STC”)
 
    Dividends declared by South African companies are subject to STC, but the STC liability is reduced by dividends received during the dividend cycle. Where the dividends received exceed dividends declared within a cycle, there is no liability to pay STC. The potential tax benefit related to excess dividends received are carried forward to the next dividend cycle. Where dividends declared exceed the dividends received during a cycle, STC is payable at the current STC rate. The STC expense is included in the taxation charge in the income statement in the period that the dividend is paid. Deferred tax assets are recognized on unutilized STC credits to the extent that it is probable that the group will declare future dividends to utilize such STC credits.
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
3.      PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
 
  (o)      Foreign currencies
 
    The consolidated financial statements are presented in Rands which is the Company’s functional and presentation currency. However, the group separately measures the transactions of each of its material operations using the functional currency determined for that specific entity, which in most instances, but not always, is the currency of the primary economic environment in which the operation conducts its business.
 
    For transactions and balances
 
    Foreign currency transactions are translated into the functional currency using the exchange rates prevailing at the dates of the transactions. Foreign exchange gains and losses resulting from the settlement of such transactions and from the translation at year- end exchange rates of monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are recognized in the income statement, except when deferred in equity as qualifying cash flow hedges and qualifying net investment hedges.
 
    Translation differences on non-monetary items, such as equities held at fair value through profit or loss, are reported as part of the fair value gain or loss. Translation differences on non-monetary items, such as equities classified as available-for-sale financial assets, are included in the fair value reserve in equity.
 
    For translation of group companies
 
    The results and financial position of all the group entities (none of which has the currency of a hyperinflationary economy) that have a functional currency different from the presentation currency are translated into the presentation currency as follows:
 
    (i)      assets and liabilities for each balance sheet presented are translated at the closing rate at the date of that balance sheet;
 
    (ii)      income and expenses for each income statement are translated at average exchange rates (unless this average is not a reasonable approximation of the cumulative effect of the rates prevailing on the transaction dates, in which case income and expenses are translated at the dates of the transactions); and
 
    (iii)      all resulting exchange differences are recognized as a separate component of equity.
 
    On consolidation, exchange differences arising from the translation of the net investment in foreign entities, and of borrowings and other currency instruments designated as hedges of such investments, are taken to shareholders’ equity. When a foreign operation is sold, such exchange differences are recognized in the income statement as part of the gain or loss on sale.
 
    Goodwill and fair value adjustments arising on the acquisition of a foreign entity are treated as the foreign entity’s assets and liabilities and are translated at the closing rate.
 
  (p)      Derivative financial instruments
 
    The group uses derivative instruments to reduce exposure to fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates and interest rates. These instruments mainly comprise foreign exchange contracts, interest rate caps and interest rate swap agreements. Foreign exchange contracts protect the group from movements in exchange rates by fixing the rate at which a foreign currency asset or liability will be settled. Interest rate caps and swap agreements protect the group from movements in interest rates. It is the policy of the group not to trade in derivative financial instruments for economically speculative purposes.
 
    The group documents at the inception of the transaction the relationship between hedging instruments and hedged items, as well as its risk management objective and strategy for undertaking various hedge transactions. The group also documents its assessment, both at hedge inception and on an ongoing basis, of whether the derivatives that are used in hedging transactions are expected to be and have been highly effective in offsetting changes in fair values or cash flows of hedged items. The fair values of various derivative instruments used for hedging purposes are disclosed in note 37. Movements on the hedging reserve are shown in the statement of changes in shareholders’ equity.
 
    Derivative financial instruments are recognized in the balance sheet at fair value. The method of recognizing the resulting gain or loss is dependent on the nature of the item being hedged. The group designates derivatives as either (1) a hedge of the fair value of a recognized asset or liability or firm commitment (fair value hedge), or (2) a hedge of a forecasted transaction or of the foreign currency risk of a firm commitment (cash flow hedge), or (3) a hedge of a net investment in a foreign entity on the date a derivative contract is entered into.
 
    Changes in the fair value of derivatives that are designated and qualify as fair value hedges and that are highly effective, are recorded in the income statement, along with changes in the fair value of the hedged asset or liability that is attributable to the hedged risk.
 
    Changes in the fair value of derivatives that are designated and qualify as cash flow hedges and that are highly effective are recognized in equity, and the ineffective part of the hedge is recognized in the income statement. Where the forecasted transaction


NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
3.      PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
 
  (p)      Derivative financial instruments (continued)
 
    or firm commitment of which the foreign currency risk is being hedged results in the recognition of an asset or a liability, the gains and losses previously deferred in equity are transferred from equity and included in the initial measurement of the cost of the asset or liability. Otherwise, amounts deferred in equity are transferred to the income statement and classified as income or expense in the same periods during which the hedged transaction affects the income statement.
 
    Certain derivative transactions, while providing effective economic hedges under the group’s risk management policies, do not qualify for hedge accounting. Changes in the fair value of any derivative instrument that do not qualify for hedge accounting are recognized immediately in the income statement.
 
    When a hedging instrument expires or is sold, or when a hedge no longer meets the criteria for hedge accounting, any cumulative gain or loss existing in equity at that time remains in equity and is recognized when the committed or forecasted transaction ultimately is recognized in the income statement. When a committed or forecasted transaction is no longer expected to occur, the cumulative gain or loss that was reported in equity is immediately transferred to the income statement.
 
    Hedges of net investments in foreign entities are accounted for similarly to cash flow hedges. Where the hedging instrument is a derivative, any gain or loss on the hedging instrument relating to the effective portion of the hedge is recognized in equity; the gain or loss relating to the ineffective portion is recognized immediately in the income statement. However, where the hedging instrument is not a derivative, all foreign exchange gains and losses arising on translation are recognized in the income statement.
 
    Embedded derivatives are derivative instruments that are embedded in another contract or host contract. The group separates an embedded derivative from its host contract and accounts for it separately, when its economic characteristics are not clearly and closely related to those of the host contract. These separated embedded derivatives are classified as trading assets or liabilities and marked to market through the income statement, provided that the combined contract is not measured at fair value with changes through the income statement.
 
  (q)      Revenue recognition
 
    Product sales
 
    Sales are recognized upon delivery of products and customer acceptance, net of sales taxes, VAT and discounts, and after eliminating sales within the group.
 
    Subscription fees
 
    Pay-television and Internet subscription fees are earned over the period the services are provided. Subscription revenue arises from the monthly billing of subscribers for pay-television and internet services provided by the group. Revenue is recognized in the month the service is rendered. Any subscription revenue received in advance of the service being provided is recorded as deferred revenue and recognized in the month the service is provided.
 
    Advertising revenues
 
    The group mainly derives advertising revenues from advertisements published in its newspapers and magazines, broadcasted on its pay television platforms and shown online on its websites and instant messaging windows. Advertising revenues from pay television and print media products are recognized upon showing or publication over the period of the advertising contract. Publication is regarded to be when the print media product has been delivered to the retailer and is available to be purchased by the general public. Online advertising revenues are recognized over the period in which the advertisements are displayed.
 
    Printing and distribution
 
    Revenues from print and distribution services are recognized upon completion of the services and delivery of the related product and customer acceptance, net of taxes, VAT and discounts, and after elimination of sales within the group. The recognition of print services revenue is based upon delivery of the product to the distribution depot and acceptance by the distributor of the client, or where the customer is responsible for the transport of the customers’ products, acceptance by the customer or its nominated transport company. Revenues from distribution services are recognized upon delivery of the product to the retailer and acceptance thereof.

 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
3.      PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
 
  (q)      Revenue recognition (continued)
 
    Printing and distribution (continued)
 
    Print and distribution services are separately provided by different entities within the group and separately contracted for by third party customers. Where these services are provided to the same client, the terms of each separate contract are consistent with contracts where an unrelated party provides one of the services. Revenue is recognized separately for print and distribution services as the contracts are separately negotiated based on fair value for each service.
 
    Technology contracts and licensing
 
    For contracts with multiple obligations (e.g. maintenance and other services), and for which vendor-specific objective evidence of fair value for the undelivered elements exists, revenue from product licenses are recognized when delivery has occurred, collection of the receivables is probable, the fee is fixed or determinable and objective evidence exists to allocate the total fee to all delivered and undelivered elements of the arrangement. Generally, the group has vendor-specific objective evidence of the fair value of the maintenance element of software arrangements based on the renewal rates for maintenance in future years as specified in the contracts. In such cases, the maintenance revenue is deferred at the outset of the arrangement and is recognized rateably over the period during which the maintenance is to be provided. That period generally commences on the date that the software is delivered. Vendor-specific objective evidence of fair value for the service element is determined based on the price charged when those services are sold separately. The group recognizes revenue allocated to maintenance and support fees, for ongoing customer support and product updates rateably over the period of the relevant contracts. Payments for maintenance and support fees are generally made in advance and are non-refundable. For revenue allocated to consulting services and for consulting services sold separately, the group recognizes revenue as the related services are performed.
 
    The group enters into arrangements with network operators whereby application software is licensed to network operators in exchange for a percentage of the subscription revenue they earn from their customers. Where all of the software under the arrangement has been delivered, the revenue is recognized as the network operator reports to the group its revenue share, which is generally done on a quarterly basis. Under arrangements where the group has committed to deliver unspecified future applications, the revenue earned on the delivered applications is recognized on a subscription basis over the term of the arrangement.
 
    Instant messaging services
 
    The group’s activities include operating instant messaging platforms from which it derives revenues from provision of mobile and telecommunications value-added services and internet value-added services.
 
    Mobile and telecommunication value-added services revenues are derived principally from providing users with mobile instant messaging services, mobile chat services and other mobile value-added services. These services are substantially billed on a monthly subscription basis with certain portions billed on a per message basis (“Mobile and Telecom Service Fees”). These services are predominantly delivered through the platforms of various mobile operators and they also collect the Mobile and Telecom Service Fees on behalf of the group. Mobile and Telecom Service Fees are recognized at the amount invoiced to the group’s customers by the various mobile operators, less any sales taxes. Fixed commissions, other expenses and bad debt expenses are recorded as an element of cost of providing services.
 
    Revenue from internet value-added services (“Internet Service Fees”) are derived from subscriptions received or receivable from the provision of a comprehensive customer service platform that utilizes instant messaging and online entertainment services. Similar to mobile and telecommunication value-added services these services are substantially delivered to the group’s customers through the platforms of various mobile operators with monthly subscriptions paid or payable by the users. In addition, a small portion of the Internet Service Fees is prepaid by the customers to the group in the form of prepaid point cards. Revenue related to these prepaid services are recorded as deferred revenue and amortized on a straight-line basis into income over the estimated usage period.
 
    Tuition fees
 
    Tuition fees are non-refundable and are recognized on a percentage of completion method over the term of the applicable course for face to face learning, and for distance learning it is recognized as a percentage of cost.
 
  (r)      Other income
 
    Interest and dividends received on available for sale financial assets are included in investment income and not as part of the fair value movement in equity.
 
    Interest income
 
    Interest is accrued on a time-proportion basis, recognizing the effective yield on the underlying assets.
 
 

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
3.      PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
 
  (r)      Other income (continued)
 
    Dividend income
 
    Dividends are recognized when the right to receive payment is established.
 
  (s)      Employee benefits
 
    Retirement benefits
 
    The group provides retirement benefits for its full-time employees, primarily by means of monthly contributions to a number of defined contribution pension and provident funds in the countries in which the group operates. The assets of these funds are generally held in separate trustee-administered funds. The group’s contributions to retirement funds are recognized as an expense in the period in which employees render the related service.
 
    Medical aid benefits
 
    The group’s contributions to medical aid benefit funds for employees are recognized as an expense in the period during which the employees render services to the group.
 
    Post-retirement medical aid benefit
 
    Some group companies provide post-retirement health-care benefits to their retirees. The entitlement to post-retirement health-care benefits is based on the employee remaining in service up to retirement age and completing a minimum service period. The expected costs of these benefits are accrued over the period of employment, using an accounting methodology similar to that for defined benefit pension plans. Independent qualified actuaries carry out annual valuations of these obligations. All actuarial gains and losses are recognized immediately in the income statement. The actuarial valuation method used to value the obligations is the Projected Unit Credit Method. Future benefits are projected using specific actuarial assumptions and the liability to in-service members is accrued over their expected working lifetime. These obligations are unfunded.
 
  (t)      Equity compensation benefits
 
    The group grants share options/share appreciation rights (SARs) to its employees under a number of equity compensation plans. In accordance with IFRS 2, the group has recognized an employee benefit expense in the income statement, representing the fair value of share options/SARs granted to the group’s employees. A corresponding credit to equity has been raised for equity-settled plans, whereas a corresponding credit to liabilities has been raised for cash-settled plans. The fair value of the options/SARs at the date of grant under equity-settled plans is charged to income over the relevant vesting periods, adjusted to reflect actual and expected levels of vesting. For cash-settled plans, the group re-measures the fair value of the recognized liability at each reporting date and at the date of settlement, with any changes in fair value recognized in profit or loss for the period. A share option scheme/SAR is considered equity-settled when the option/gain is settled by the issue of a Naspers N share. They are considered cash-settled when they are settled in cash or any other asset, ie not by the issue of a Naspers N share.
 
  (u)      Segment reporting
 
    The primary segmental reporting has been prepared based on the group’s method of internal reporting, which disaggregates its business by service or product. The secondary segmental reporting has been prepared on a geographical basis. Inter-segment transfers or transactions are entered into under normal commercial terms and conditions that would also be available to unrelated third parties. These inter- and intra group transactions are eliminated on consolidation.
 
  (v)      Discontinuing operations
 
    A discontinuing operation results from the sale or abandonment of an operation that represents a separate, major line of business and for which the assets, net profits or losses and activities can be distinguished physically, operationally and for reporting purposes. The results of discontinuing operations up to the point of sale or abandonment, net of taxation, are separately disclosed.
 
  (w)      Advertising expenses
 
    Advertising expenses are expensed in the financial period in which they are incurred.
 
  (x)      Treasury shares
     
   
Where subsidiaries hold shares in the holding company’s equity share capital, the consideration paid to acquire these shares including any attributable incremental external costs is deducted from total shareholders’ equity as treasury shares. Where such shares are subsequently sold or reissued, any consideration received is included in shareholders’ equity. Shares issued to or held by share incentive plans within the group are treated as treasury shares until such time when participants pay for and take delivery of such shares. The same applies to treasury shares held by joint ventures. 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
3.      PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
 
  (y)      Recently issued accounting standards
 
    The International Accounting Standards Board (“IASB”) issued a number of standards, amendments to standards and interpretations during 2005 and 2006. These amendments will therefore be implemented by the group during the financial year starting April 1, 2006.
 
    The amendment to IAS 19 – “Employee Benefits”, has been issued to allow the option of recognizing actuarial gains and losses in full in the period in which they occur, outside profit or loss, in a statement of recognized income and expenses. The amendment was issued during December 2004 with immediate effect. The group will continue to apply option of recognizing the actuarial gains in losses in the income statement.
 
    The amendments that have been made to IAS 39 included amendments to the accounting of Cash Flow Hedges of Forecasted Intragroup Transactions, the scope of IAS 39 to include Financial Guarantee Contracts and the amendment to the Fair Value Option. These amendments were made during April, August and June 2005 with immediate effect. The group will adopt these amendments during its financial year ending March 31, 2007 and is currently evaluating the effects of these amendments.
 
    The amendment to IAS 1 – “Presentation of Financial Statements: Capital Disclosures” states that an entity shall disclose information that enables users of its financial statements to evaluate the entity’s objectives, policies and processes for managing capital. The group will adopt these amendments during its financial year ending March 31, 2007 and is currently evaluating the effects of these amendments.
 
    IFRS 7 – “Financial Instruments: Disclosures” was issued August 18, 2005, with an effective date of January 1, 2007. This new standard adds certain new disclosures about financial instruments to those currently required by IAS 32 - Financial Instruments: Presentation. The group will adopt these amendments during its financial year ending March 31, 2007 and is currently evaluating the effects of these amendments.
 
    The IASB has also amended the accounting treatment of monetary items in IAS 21 – “The Effect of Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates” during December 2005 with immediate effect. The amendment stated that if a monetary item forms part of an entity’s investment in a foreign operation, the accounting treatment in the consolidated financial statements should not be dependent on the currency of the monetary item. Also, the accounting should not depend on which entity within the group conducts a transaction with the foreign operation. The group will adopt these amendments during its financial year ending March 31, 2007 and is currently evaluating the effects of the standard.
 
    IFRIC Interpretation 4 - “Determining whether an Arrangement contains a Lease” was issued by the IASB and is effective for annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2006, and the Interpretation specifies that an arrangement that meets certain criteria is, or contains, a lease that should be accounted for in accordance with IAS 17 – “Leases”. The group will adopt these amendments during its financial year ending March 31, 2007 and is currently evaluating the effects of the standard.
 
    IFRIC Interpretation 6 – “Liabilities arising from Participating in a Specific Market – Waste Electronic and Electronic Equipment” clarifies when certain producers of electrical goods are required to recognize a liability under IAS 37 for the cost of waste management relating to the decommissioning of waste electrical and electronic equipment supplied to private households. IFRIC 6 is effective for annual periods beginning on or after December 1, 2005. The group will adopt these amendments during its financial year ending March 31, 2007 and is currently evaluating the effects of the standard.
 
    IFRIC Interpretation 8 – “Scope of IFRS 2” clarifies that IFRS 2 – “Share-based Payment” applies to arrangements where an entity makes share-based payments for apparently nil or inadequate consideration. IFRIC 8 is effective for annual periods beginning on or after May 1, 2006, and the group will adopt these amendments during its financial year ending March 31, 2007 and is currently evaluating the effects of the standard.
 
    IFRIC Interpretation 9 – “Reassessment of Embedded Derivatives” clarifies that an entity shall assess whether an embedded derivative is required to be separated from the host contract and accounted for as a derivative when the entity first becomes a party to the contract. Subsequent reassessment is prohibited unless there is a change in the terms of the contract that significantly modifies the cash flows that otherwise would be required under the contract, in which case reassessment is required. IFRIC 9 is effective for annual periods beginning on or after June 1, 2006, and the group will adopt these amendments during its financial year ending March 31, 2007 and is currently evaluating the effects of the standard.
 
    AC 503 – “Accounting for Black Economic Empowerment (“BEE”) Transactions” states that if equity instruments are granted at a discount to a BEE partner, this must be expensed. BEE credentials acquired as part of a business combination shall be subsumed in goodwill and not recognized as a separate intangible asset. Where the BEE transaction includes service conditions, the fair value of the equity instruments shall be measured at grant date and the expense should be recognized over the period of the service conditions. Where the BEE transaction includes no service conditions, the fair value of the equity instruments shall be measured at grant date and the expense should be recognized immediately on grant date. AC 503 is effective for annual periods beginning on or after May 1, 2006, and the group will adopt these amendments during its financial year ending March 31, 2007 and is currently evaluating the effects of the standard.
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
4.      SIGNIFICANT ACQUISITIONS AND DIVESTITURES
 
  Financial year ended March 31, 2006:
 
  On April 1, 2005, Media24 Limited (“Media24”) acquired an additional interest of 7.5% in its subsidiary, Paarl Media Holdings (Proprietary) Limited (“Paarl Media”), for a purchase consideration of Rand 180 million in cash. This increased Media24’s effective financial interest in Paarl Media to 92.11%. This transaction was accounted for as a common control transaction, and the excess of the purchase consideration over the net asset value was recognized in equity.
 
  During February 2006, MIH QQ (BVI) Limited acquired a 25% interest in ChineseAll for a cash consideration of Rand 24.6 million. The total purchase consideration was allocated based upon an appraisal, as follows: net assets (Rand 1.7 million) and goodwill (Rand 22.9 million).
        
  During October 2005, the company disposed of its investment in Computicket (Proprietary) Limited for a cash consideration of Rand 67.5 million. A profit on sale of investments of Rand 56.7 million was realized on this transaction and is included in profit from continuing operations. 
 
  On November 7, 2005, the group publicly announced that it had entered into an agreement in terms of which it would sell its entire interest in United Broadcasting Corp. and MKSC World Dot Com Co. to True Corp. for a consideration of approximately US$164 million. A profit on discontinuance of operations of Rand 1,032.2 million was realized on the transaction. Details relating to this transaction are highlighted in note 28 to the consolidated annual financial statements.
 
  During December 2005 the company acquired 100% of the equity of Orbicom (Proprietary) Limited (“Orbicom”) from MTN Group Limited (“MTN”) for a cash consideration of Rand 44.2 million. The total purchase consideration was allocated based upon appraisal, as follows: net assets (Rand 35.1 million) and goodwill (Rand 9.1 million).
 
  Subsequent to March 31, 2006, Naspers Limited acquired, through its offshore subsidiary MIH B.V., a 30% stake in leading Brazilian media company Abril S.A. (“Abril”), for a cash consideration of Rand 2,557.3 million. Irdeto Eindhoven B.V. acquired the Cryptotec Conditional Access business from Koninklijke Philips Electronics NV for a cash consideration of Rand 230.7 million. MIH subscribed for new shares equal to a 25% interest in Tixa Tech Group Inc. for a cash consideration of Rand 60.5 million.
 
  Financial year ended March 31, 2005:
 
  On April 1, 2004, Media24 Limited acquired the remaining 50% interest it did not already own in Alchemy Publishing (Proprietary) Limited for a cash consideration of Rand 4.6 million. The total purchase consideration of Rand 4.6 million was allocated based upon an appraisal, as follows: net assets (Rand 0.7 million) and goodwill (Rand 3.9 million).
 
  On April 13, 2004, Johnnic Communications Limited (“Johncom”) exercised a call option on Naspers relating to 39.1% of the M-Net and SuperSport ordinary shares acquired from minority shareholders in terms of the Section 311 schemes of arrangement concluded during March 2004. Naspers sold 33,686,280 M-Net and SuperSport shares respectively for a total cash consideration of Rand 286.3 million resulting in a loss of Rand 27.9 million on disposal. Naspers retained an effective 60.12% interest in both M-Net and SuperSport.
 
  Tencent Holdings Limited (“Tencent”) completed an initial public offering of shares on June 16, 2004 and listed on the Hong Kong Stock Exchange. The group’s interest in Tencent was diluted from 50% to approximately 36.1%. Tencent’s net proceeds were approximately HK$1.64 billion. The group realized a dilution profit of Rand 358.4 million. The group exercised joint control over the operations of Tencent until June 16, 2004 and therefore proportionately consolidated the results of Tencent until that date. After the listing of Tencent the group retained significant influence over Tencent’s financial and operating policies, therefore Tencent was equity accounted by the group from June 16, 2004.
 
  NetMed NV (“NetMed”) announced on June 19, 2003, that subject to the fulfillment of certain conditions precedent, it had reached an agreement with Teletypos SA (“Teletypos”), in terms of which Teletypos will exchange its interest in MultiChoice Hellas SA for approximately €6.6 million in cash and a 12.5% equity interest in NetMed. On September 22, 2004 the last regulatory approvals and conditions precedent were fulfilled, therefore this transaction was accounted for in the year ended March 31, 2005. The group realized a profit of Rand 215.7 million on the dilution of its interest in NetMed. Goodwill of Rand 312.9 million was accounted for on the acquisition of the remaining interest that the group did not already own in MultiChoice Hellas.
 
  Beijing Media Corporation Limited (“BMC”) completed an initial public offering of shares on December 22, 2004 and listed on the Hong Kong Stock Exchange. The group acquired an interest of 9.9% in BMC through its participation in the initial public offering. The group paid Rand 273.2 million in cash for its interest. The group has classified the investment as an available-for-sale investment and is carrying it on its balance sheet at fair value.
 
  On February 1, 2005, MWEB Holdings (Proprietary) Limited (“MWEB”) acquired from Tiscali International BV its South African ISP business (“Tiscali”) for a purchase consideration of Rand 309.3 million in cash.
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
4.  SIGNIFICANT ACQUISITIONS AND DIVESTITURES (continued) 
     
  The fair value of the identifiable assets and liabilities of Tiscali as at the date of the acquisition were:
 
           
Recognized
 
Carrying
           
on acquisition
 
value
           
R’000
 
R’000
                 
Property, plant and equipment
     
6,368  
 
30,079  
Subscriber base
     
224,013  
 
-  
Deferred tax
     
(49,831)
 
10,260  
Cash and cash deposits
     
39,160  
 
39,160  
Other current assets
     
3,633  
 
3,633  
Current liabilities
     
(52,622)
 
(60,511)
Fair value of net assets
     
170,721  
 
22,621 
Goodwill arising on acquisition
     
138,579  
   
Purchase consideration
     
309,300  
   
                 
The cash outflow on acquisition is as follows:
         
R’000
                 
Net cash acquired with the Tiscali business
         
39,160  
Cash paid
         
(309,300)
Net cash outflow
         
(270,140)
 
The purchase agreement contained terms where any excess in net asset value acquired greater than Rand 44.5 million would be payable on a rand for rand basis to the seller. The group paid an additional Rand 11.7 million on closing of the transaction. This was recorded as an adjustment to goodwill. Included in the goodwill recognized are certain intangible assets that cannot be individually separated and reliable measured from the acquiree due to their nature. These assets consist of synergy benefits.  benefits
   
During the 2005 financial year the company disposed of the balance of its investment in Liberty Media Corporation for a consideration of Rand 141.6 million. A profit on sale of investments of Rand 18.7 million was realized on this transaction.
 
Subsequent events disclosure
 
During August 2006, MIH Print Media Holdings Limited (“MIH Print Media”) acquired a 20.2% interest in Titan, a leading company in the field of Chinese sports publishing, for a cash consideration of approximately Rand 114.5 million. It is anticipated that through a further acquisition MIH Print Media’s shareholding will increase to 37%.
 
In September 2006, Naspers announced that, in furtherance of its empowerment objectives, the group intents to implement a Broad-Based Black Economic Empowerment ownership initiative in relation to Media24 Limited (“Media24”) and MultiChoice South Africa (“MCSA”).  
 
The BEE transactions are expected to result in the acquisition by qualifying Black Persons and Black Groups of ordinary shares in the issued share capital of Welkom Yizani Investments Limited (“Welkom Yizani”), which will hold ordinary shares in the issued share capital of Media24 Holdings (Proprietary) Limited (“Media24 Holdings”), the holding company of Media24 as well as Phuthuma Nathi Investments Limited (“Phuthuma Nathi”), which will hold ordinary shares in the issued share capital of MultiChoice South Africa Holdings (Proprietary) Limited (“MCSA Holdings”), the holding company of MCSA.
 
Naspers will sell up to 14.6 million shares in Media24 Holdings to Welkom Yizani for a consideration of approximately Rand 730 million. Welkom Yizani will fund the acquisition through cash and the issuance of preference shares to Naspers. MIHH will sell up to 45 million shares in MCSA Holdings to Phuthuma Nathi, for a consideration of approximately Rand 2,250 million. Phuthuma Nathi will fund the acquisition through cash and the issuance of preference shares to MIHH. 
 
The empowerment transactions are subject to Welkom Yizani and Phuthuma Nathi undertaking public offers to the General Black Public to subscribe for ordinary shares in Welkom Yizani and Phuthuma Nathi. The number of Media24 Holdings and MCSA Holdings ordinary shares to be acquired by Welkom Yizani and Phuthuma Nathi will depend on the amount raised by Welkom Yizani and Phuthuma Nathi in terms of the public offers. The closing date for the public offers is expected to be at the end of October 2006. The public offers may not ultimately be undertaken and the final terms of the empowerment transactions are subject to change. 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED
 
       
March 31   
5.    PROPERTY, PLANT & EQUIPMENT   
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
 
    Land and buildings - owned    648,013    571,547 
     Cost price    744,504    668,664 
     Accumulated depreciation    96,491    97,117 
 
    Land and buildings - leased    128,047    95,621 
     Cost price    157,581    116,363 
     Accumulated depreciation    29,534    20,742 
 
    Manufacturing equipment - owned    847,715    520,885 
     Cost price    1,303,009    973,918 
     Accumulated depreciation    455,294    453,033 
 
    Manufacturing equipment - leased    69,811    76,323 
     Cost price    148,768    149,819 
     Accumulated depreciation    78,957    73,496 
 
    Transmission equipment - owned    99,625    105,936 
     Cost price    356,374    555,464 
     Accumulated depreciation    256,749    449,528 
 
    Transmission equipment - leased    1,211,234    1,369,372 
     Cost price    2,689,472    2,734,447 
     Accumulated depreciation    1,478,238    1,365,075 
 
    Vehicles, computer and office equipment - owned    596,413    545,016 
     Cost price    1,769,894    1,724,852 
     Accumulated depreciation    1,173,481    1,179,836 
 
    Vehicles, computer and office equipment - leased    6,367    11,365 
     Cost price    9,359    22,055 
     Accumulated depreciation    2,992    10,690 
    Subtotal    3,607,225    3,296,065 
    Work-in-progress    81,284    148,598 
    Net book value    3,688,509    3,444,663 
 
    Total cost price    7,260,245    7,094,180 
    Total accumulated depreciation    3,571,736    3,649,517 
    Net book value    3,688,509    3,444,663 

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS         
(CONTINUED)                         
 
5.   
PROPERTY, PLANT & EQUIPMENT (Continued) 
               
                     
                   
Vehicles,
       
 
 
Land &
 
Manufacturing 
 
Transmission 
 
computers
 
Total
 
Total
       
Buildings 
 
equipment
 
equipment
 
office equipment
 
2006
 
2005
       
 R’000 
 
R’000 
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
Cost                         
Opening balance    785,027    1,123,737    3,289,911    1,746,907    6,945,582    6,508,523 
Disposal of interest in joint ventures    (10,453)   (25,629)   (326,207)   (66,377)   (428,666)   (53,977)
Foreign currency translation effects    (2,052)   (1,708)   (104,170)   (26,535)   (134,465)   27,403 
Reallocation    (7,505)   129    30,715    (23,339)   -    - 
Impairment    -    -    -    -    -    (4,748)
Acquisition of subsidiaries    6    -    3,248    27,631    30,885    7,588 
Disposal of subsidiaries    -    -    -    (16,896)   (16,896)   (2,419)
Acquisitions    148,413    401,956    196,397    281,647    1,028,413    606,369 
Disposals    (11,351)   (46,708)   (44,048)   (143,785)   (245,892)   (143,157)
Closing balance    902,085    1,451,777    3,045,846    1,779,253    7,178,961    6,945,582 
Work-in-progress March 31, 2006                    81,284    148,598 
TOTAL COST                    7,260,245    7,094,180 
 Accumulated depreciation                         
Opening balance    117,859    526,529    1,814,603    1,190,526    3,649,517    3,197,386 
Disposal of interest in joint ventures    (9,820)   (25,629)   (250,131)   (52,848)   (338,428)   (11,488)
Foreign currency translation effects    (1,949)   (1,700)   (76,997)   (22,266)   (102,912)   30,405 
Reclassifications    726    (470)   10,220    (10,476)   -    - 
Impairment    -    -    -    326    326    (1,270)
Reversal of previous impairment    (673)   -    -    (1,402)   (2,075)   - 
Acquisition of subsidiaries    -    -    -    -    -    543 
Disposal of subsidiaries    -    -    -    (12,968)   (12,968)   (745)
Depreciation    25,168    81,479    281,697    207,202    595,546    555,533 
Disposals    (5,286)   (45,958)   (44,405)   (121,621)   (217,270)   (120,847)
Closing balance    126,025    534,251    1,734,987    1,176,473    3,571,736    3,649,517 
 
Cost    902,085    1,451,777    3,045,846    1,779,253    7,178,961    6,945,582 
Accumulated depreciation    126,025    534,251    1,734,987    1,176,473    3,571,736    3,649,517 
Net book value    776,060    917,526    1,310,859    602,780    3,607,225    3,296,065 
Work-in-progress                    81,284    148,598 
Total Net book value                    3,688,509    3,444,663 
 
 
F-28

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
5.  PROPERTY, PLANT & EQUIPMENT (continued) 
     
 
In terms of IAS 8 “Accounting Policies, Changes in Accounting Estimates and Errors” an assessment of the expected future benefits associated with property, plant and equipment was determined. Based on the latest available and reliable information there was a change in the estimated useful life and residual value which resulted in a decrease in depreciation of Rand 0.3 million (2005: increase of Rand 13.3 million).
 
During the financial year ended March 31, 2006, the group recognized an impairment of property, plant and equipment with a net book value of Rand 0.3 million (2005: Rand 3.5 million). The impairment loss has been included in “other (losses) / gains - net” in the income statement. The recoverable amount has been determined based on a value in use calculation. The impairment resulted from the recoverable amount of the assets being lower than the carrying value thereof.
 
The group has pledged property, plant and equipment with a carrying value of Rand 452.4 million at March 31, 2006 (2005: Rand 464.9 million) as security against certain term loans and overdrafts with banks.
 
Registers containing additional information on land and buildings are available for inspection at the registered offices of the respective group companies. The directors are of the opinion that the recoverable amount of each class of property exceeds the carrying amount at which it is included in the balance sheet.
 
 
6.  GOODWILL 
     
 
 
     
March 31   
       
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
 
       Cost         
       Opening balance    867,045    813,528 
       Foreign currency translation effects    (3,736)   (1,704)
       Acquisitions    2,500    3,578 
       Disposal of subsidiaries    -    (356)
       Disposal of interest in joint ventures    (2,284)   (96,360)
       Acquisition of subsidiaries    9,145    150,662 
       Successive acquisition    (5,915)   (2,303)
       Closing balance    866,755    867,045 
       Accumulated impairment         
       Opening balance    8,011    - 
       Impairment    69,009    8,011 
       Closing balance    77,020    8,011 
             
       Net book value    789,735    859,034 
 
     
 
The group recognized impairment losses on goodwill of Rand 69.0 million (2005: Rand 8.0 million) during the financial year ended March 31, 2006, due to the fact that the recoverable amount of certain cash-generating units were less than their carrying value. The impairment charges have been included in “other (losses) / gains - net” in the income statement. The recoverable amounts have been based on value in use calculations.
 
 
 
F-29


 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
6.  GOODWILL 
     
   The changes in the carrying amount of goodwill on a segmental basis for the year ended March 31, 2006 are as follows:
 
 
   
  Electronic media
 
Print media
   
                   
           
Conditional
    Newspapers,        
   
Pay
     
Access
 
magazines and         
   
television 
 
Internet 
 
Systems
 
printing
 
Books
 
Education 
 
Total
   
 R’000
 
 R’000 
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
   R’000
 
R’000
Net book value                             
Opening balance    375,546     258,791     54,618     75,089    11,536     83,454     859,034 
Foreign currency translation effects    (3,005)        (731)                (3,736)
Impairment    (9,144)                (3,980)    (55,885)   
(69,009)
Acquisitions                    2,500        
2,500  
Acquisition of subsidiaries    9,145                        
9,145  
Successive acquisition        (7,889)        1,974            (5,915)
Disposal of interest in joint ventures    (2,284)                        (2,284)
Closing balance    370,258     250,902     53,887     77,063    10,056     27,569     789,735  

Impairment testing of goodwill
 
The group has allocated its goodwill to various cash-generating units. The recoverable amounts of these cash-generating units have been determined based on either a value in use calculation or on a fair value less costs to sell basis. The value in use is based on discounted cash flow calculations. The group based its cash flow calculations on three to five year budgeted and forecasted information approved by senior management and the various boards of directors of group companies. Long-term average growth rates for the respective countries in which the entities operate were used to extrapolate the cash flows into the future. Where fair value was used to calculate recoverable amounts, it is based on publicly traded market prices. The group allocated goodwill to the following cash-generating units:
 
 
       
Basis of
 
Discount
 
Growth rate 
   
Net book 
 
determination
 
rate
 
used to
   
 value
 
of recoverable
 
applied to 
 
extrapolate
   
 R’000
 
amount 
 
cash flows
 
cash flows
Cash-generating unit                 
Multichoice Cyprus Limited    42,388    Value in use    14.0%    3.6% 
Electronic Media Network Limited & SuperSport International                 
Holdings Limited    327,870    Value in use    16.6%    4.0% 
Irdeto Access BV    53,887    Value in use    10.7%    2.5% 
M-Web Holdings Limited    250,902    Value in use    20.7%    4.0% 
Boland Newspapers (Proprietary) Limited    23,581    Value in use    13.5%    4.0% 
Paarl Media Holdings (Proprietary) Limited    34,669    Value in use    13.5%    4.0% 
Natal Witness Printing and Publishing Company (Proprietary)                 
Limited    14,370    Value in use    13.5%    4.0% 
Educor Holdings Limited    27,569    Value in use    16.5%    4.0% 
Via Afrika Limited    8,056    Value in use    14.2%    4.0% 
Various other units    6,443    Value in use    various    various 
    789,735             

 
F-30

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
7.  OTHER INTANGIBLE ASSETS 
     
 
 
       
Intellectual 
                       
       
property 
     
Brand
               
       
rights & 
 
Subscriber 
 
names and 
 
Concession
     
Total
 
Total
       
patents
 
base
 
title rights 
 
   rights
 
Software 
 
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
   R’000
 
 R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
    Cost                             
    Opening balance    119,055    226,340    203,954    12,579    76,243    638,171    356,888 
    Disposal of interest in joint                             
    ventures    -    -    -    (11,792)   -    (11,792)   - 
    Foreign currency translation                             
    effects    (1,029)   -    -    (787)   -    (1,816)   (1,825)
    Acquisition of subsidiaries    -    -    -    -    -    -    246,806 
    Disposal of subsidiaries    (1,000)   -    -    -    (2,578)   (3,578)   - 
    Acquisitions    27,830    1,387    5,443    -    66,221    100,881    52,650 
    Disposals    527    -    97    -    (7,803)   (7,179)   (16,348)
    Work in Progress    -    -    -    -    8,102    8,102    - 
    Closing balance    145,383    227,727    209,494        140,185    722,789    638,171 
    Accumulated amortization                             
    Opening balance    82,300    8,845    141,811    5,819    32,053    270,828    226,631 
    Disposal of interest in joint                             
    ventures                (5,852)       (5,852)    
    Foreign currency translation                             
    effects    (358)           (390)       (748)   (1,878)
    Impairment    131        707            838    4,992 
    Reversal of previous                             
    impairment                    (413)   (413)    
    Disposal of subsidiaries    (50)       10        (899)   (939)    
    Disposals    527        97        (6,710)   (6,086)   (16,348)
    Amortization    10,530    45,741    11,023    423    27,995    95,712    57,431 
    Closing balance    93,080    54,586    153,648        52,026    353,340    270,828 
                                 
    Net book value    52,303    173,141    55,846        88,159    369,449    367,343 
 
 
The group recognized impairment losses on other intangible assets of Rand 0.8 million (2005: Rand 5.0 million) during the financial year ended March 31, 2006, due to the fact that the recoverable amounts of certain cash-generating units were less than their carrying values. The impairment charges have been included in “other (losses) / gains - net” on the income statement. The recoverable amounts have been based on value in use calculations with discount rates comparable to those used in assessing the impairment of goodwill.
 
In terms of IAS 8 “Accounting Policies, Changes in Accounting Estimates and Errors” an assessment of the expected future benefits associated with other intangible assets were determined. Based on the latest available and reliable information there was a change in the estimated useful life which resulted in a decrease in amortization of Rand 12.6 million (2005: nil).
     
 
 
F-31

 

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
8.  INVESTMENT AND LOANS 
     
 
 
     
March 31   
       
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
 
    Investments in associates         
         Listed    1,249,055    805,048 
         Unlisted    59,110    32,640 
        1,308,165    837,688 
 
    Investments and loans         
    Loans to related parties         
         Unlisted    23,114    24,779 
    At fair value through profit & loss investments         
         Listed        8,111 
         Unlisted    32,031    30,458 
        32,031    38,569 
    Available-for-sale investments         
         Listed        313,763 
         Unlisted    387    1,033 
        387    314,796 
    Originated loans         
         Unlisted    19,331    23,127 
 
             
    Total investments and loans    74,863    401,271 
 
    Investments classified on balance sheets         
         Non-current    74,863    393,160 
         Current        8,111 
        74,863    401,271 
 
The market value of the group’s listed investments at March 31, 2006 amounted to Rand 6,505.5 million (2005: Rand 3,208.0 million). Tencent Holdings Limited contributed Rand 6,309.5 million (2005: Rand 2,886.1 million) and Beijing Media Corporation Limited Rand 196.0 million (2005: Rand 313.8 million). The valuation of total unlisted investments and loans, as approved by the director’s of the respective group companies amounted to Rand 134.0 million (2005: Rand 112.0 million).
 
During the financial year ended March 31, 2005, the investment in Beijing Media Corporation Limited was held as an Available-for-sale investment, at a value of Rand 313.8 million. This investment was reclassified to Investments in associates during the financial year ended March 31, 2006, as significant influence is established through co-operation agreements, board representation, and the placement of key management. Unrealized gains and losses, to the value of Rand 41.7 million, that arose from the changes in the fair value of this investment were previously accounted for in equity, but have been transferred to the carry value of the investment in associate.
     

F-32

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
8.  INVESTMENT AND LOANS (Continued)
 
 
The following information relates to Naspers Limited’s financial interest in its significant subsidiaries, over which the group has voting control through its direct and indirect interests in respective intermediate holding companies and other entities:
     
 
 
   
   Effective
               
   
 percentage
     
Country of
 
Functional 
   
Name of subsidiary 
 
   interest*
             Nature of business   
incorporation
 
currency 
 
D or I 
   
2006 
 
2005 
               
   
 %
 
%
               
LISTED COMPANIES                         
MultiChoice Cyprus Limited    26.4    26.4    Subscription Television    Cyprus    CYP   
I 
 
UNLISTED COMPANIES                         
Media24 Limited    100.0    100.0    Print media Company    South Africa    ZAR   
D 
Paarl Media Holdings (Proprietary)                         
Limited    92.1    83.8    Printing    South Africa    ZAR   
I 
Touchline Media (Proprietary)                         
Limited    100.0    100.0    Publishing of magazines    South Africa    ZAR   
I 
 
Boland Koerante (Proprietary) Limited    75.0    75.0    Publishers of newspapers    South Africa    ZAR   
I 
Via Afrika Limited    100.0    100.0    Publishing of books    South Africa    ZAR   
I 
 
Educor Holdings (Proprietary) Limited    100.0    100.0    Education    South Africa    ZAR   
I 
MIH Investments (Proprietary)                         
Limited    100.0    100.0    Investment Holding company    South Africa    ZAR   
D 
MIH Holdings Limited    100.0    100.0    Holding Company    South Africa    ZAR   
I 
MultiChoice Africa (Proprietary)                         
Limited    100.0    100.0    Subscription Television    South Africa    ZAR   
I 
M-Web Holdings (Proprietary)                         
Limited    100.0    100.0    Internet content provider    South Africa    ZAR   
I 
MIH (BVI) Limited    100.0    100.0    Investment Holding    British Virgin Islands    USD   
I 
Myriad International Holdings BV    100.0    100.0    Investment Holding    The Netherlands    EUR   
I 
MultiChoice Africa Limited    100.0    100.0    Investment Holding    Mauritius    USD   
I 
NetMed NV    74.5    74.5    Investment Holding    The Netherlands    EUR   
I 
NetMed Hellas SA    74.5    74.5    Subscription Television    Greece    EUR   
I 
MultiChoice Hellas SA    44.9    44.9    Subscription Television    Greece    EUR   
I 
Entriq Inc.    100.0    100.0    Technology development    USA    USD   
I 
Irdeto Access BV    100.0    100.0    Technology development    The Netherlands    USD   
I 
M-Web (Thailand) Limited    100.0    100.0    Internet content provider    Thailand    THB   
I 
 
MultiChoice Cyprus Holdings Limited    51.7    51.7    Holding Company    Cyprus    CYP   
I 
Shanghai Sportcn.com Information                         
Technology Company Limited    87.7    87.7    Online sport content    China    CNY   
I 

D      – Direct interest
I      – Combined direct and indirect effective interest
* 
– The percentage interest shown is the financial effective interest, after adjusting for the interests of the group’s equity compensation
    plans treated as treasury shares.
 
 
 
F-33


 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
8.  INVESTMENT AND LOANS (Continued)
 
 
The following information relates to Naspers Limited’s financial interest in its significant joint ventures, over which the group has joint voting control through its direct and indirect interests in respective intermediate holding companies and other entities:
     
 
 
    Effective percentage       
Country of 
 
Functional
 
D or 
Name of joint venture               interest*               Nature of business   
incorporation
 
currency
 
I
   
2006
 
2005
               
   
%
 
 %
               
 
LISTED COMPANIES                         
United Broadcasting Corporation Public                         
Company Limited        30.6    Subscription television    Thailand    THB    I 
 
UNLISTED COMPANIES                         
MNH Holdings (1998) (Proprietary) Limited    50.0    50.0    Investment Holding Company    South Africa    ZAR    D 
Electronic Media Network Limited    60.1    60.1    Pay TV content provider    South Africa    ZAR    I 
SuperSport International Holdings Limited    60.1    60.1    Pay TV content provider    South Africa    ZAR    I 
MultiChoice Supplies (Proprietary) Limited    50.0    50.0    Set-top box rentals    South Africa    ZAR    I 
                Thailand         
KSC Commercial Internet Company Limited        40.6    Internet service provider        THB    I 
 
Myriad International Programming Services BV    80.0    80.0    Programme and Film Rights    Netherlands    EUR    I 
The Natal Witness Printing and Publishing            Publishing and printing of             
Company (Proprietary) Limited    50.0    50.0    newspapers    South Africa    ZAR    I 

D      – Direct interest
 
I      – Combined direct and indirect effective interest
*  – The percentage interest shown is the financial effective interest, after adjusting for the interests of the group’s equity compensation plans treated as treasury shares. 
 
The group has pledged a 29.98% interest in Electronic Media Network Limited and SuperSport International Holdings Limited as security with a bank against a term loan.  
 
 
Additional joint venture disclosure
 
The following is the group’s interest in the combined summarized balance sheets and income statements of the joint ventures as per their financial statements:
 
   
March 31
   
2006
 
2005
   
R’000
 
R’000
    Balance sheet information         
     Non-current assets    340,680    391,918 
     Current assets    879,660    1,119,611 
     Non-current liabilities    64,184    420,078 
     Current liabilities    813,915    838,182 
 
    Income statement information         
     Revenue    2,277,088    1,992,190 
     Net profit    356,060    211,199 

The group’s interest in the joint ventures’ capital commitments and contingent liabilities at March 31, 2006 amounted to Rand 78.4 million (2005: Rand 36.8 million) and Rand 3.0 million (2005: Rand 5.5 million) respectively.
 
F-34


 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
Name of associated company   
Effective
percentage
 
Nature of business
 
Country of
incorporation
 
Functional
currency
 
D or I 
   
2006
% 
 
2005
% 
               
LISTED COMPANIES                         
                Peoples Republic         
Tencent Holdings Limited   
36.1 
 
35.6 
  Instant-messaging services    of China   
CNY
 
I 
            Print media advertising and print    Peoples Republic         
Beijing Media Corporation Limited   
9.9 
 
9.9 
  related services    of China   
HKD
 
I 
 
 
UNLISTED COMPANIES                         
The Hometrader (Eastern Cape) (Proprietary)                         
Limited   
25.0 
 
25.0 
  Production of newspaper inserts    South Africa   
ZAR
 
I 
Alibiprops 12 (Proprietary) Limited   
19.6 
 
49.0
  Educational book retailer    South Africa   
ZAR
 
I 
                Peoples Republic         
Chinese All   
25.0 
 
0.0  
  Internet related services    of China   
CNY
 
I 
Internet Music Company (Proprietary)                         
Limited   
34.0 
 
0.0  
  Internet related services    South Africa   
ZAR
 
I 
 
Free State Cheetahs (Proprietary) Limited   
14.7 
 
14.7 
  Rugby operations    South Africa   
ZAR
 
I 
Griqualand West Rugby (Proprietary)                         
Limited   
14.7 
 
14.7 
  Rugby operations    South Africa   
ZAR
 
I 
Natal Sharks (Proprietary) Limited   
24.0 
 
24.0 
  Rugby operations    South Africa   
ZAR
 
I 

I – Combined direct and indirect effective interest
* – The effective percentage interest shown is the financial effective interest, after adjusting for the interests of the group’s equity compensation plans treated as treasury shares.
 
 
F-35


 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
8. 
INVESTMENT AND LOANS (Continued)
 
     
 
   
March 31
       
2006
 
2005
    Investments in associated companies   
R’000
 
R’000
 
               Opening balance    837,688    29,438 
               Associated companies acquired - gross consideration    325,404    729,413 
                   Net assets acquired        659,881 
                   Goodwill and intangibles recognized    383,688    68,347 
                   Deferred taxation recognized    (61,642)     
                   Other    3,358    1,185 
               Associated companies sold    (1,388)   (10,084)
               Share of current year other reserve movements    (50)   4,415 
               Share of equity-accounted results    154,155    88,597 
                   Net income before amortization    145,984    93,583 
                   Net (loss) before amortization    (269)     
                   Taxation    8,440    (4,986)
               Equity accounted results due to purchase accounting    (2,878)    
                   Amortization of other intangible assets    (3,184)    
                   Realization of deferred taxation    306     
               Dividends received    (44,589)   (4,091)
               Foreign currency translation adjustments    39,823     
               Closing balance    1,308,165    837,688 
             
   
The group recognized Rand 151.3 million (2005: Rand 88.6 million) as its’ share of equity-accounted results in the income statement.
 
    Additional associate disclosure
     
     The following are the combined summarized balance sheets and income statements of the associated companies as per their financial statements:
 
     
March 31   
     
2006
 
2005
  Balance sheet information   
R’000
 
R’000
  Non-current assets    882,808    307,076 
  Current assets    3,488,656    1,963,300 
  Total assets    4,371,464    2,270,376 
   
  Non-current liabilities    124,503    205,669 
  Current liabilities    848,425    5,931 
  Total liabilities    972,928    211,600 
     Total shareholders’ equity    3,398,536    2,058,776 
         Total equity and liabilities    4,371,464    2,270,376 
   
  Income statement information         
  Revenue    1,764,681    703,389 
  Operating profit    495,013    231,470 
  Net profit    484,477    244,929 
           
   

The group discontinued the recognition of its share of losses of some associated companies. The accumulated unrecognized portion of the group’s share of losses amounted to Rand 1.3 million at March 31, 2006 (2005: Rand 1.2 million).
 
F-36



NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
8. 
INVESTMENT AND LOANS (Continued)
 
 
The following are entities with more than 50% ownership, which are not consolidated due to immaterial operations:
     
 
 
Name of entity   
Effective percentage interest % 
  Country of incorporation 
M-Web Zimbabwe (Proprietary) Limited   
70.0
  Zimbabwe 
Betung Cable (China) Limited   
100.0
  Hong Kong 

The following entities are consolidated due to management control through shareholder agreements even though ownership is less than 50%. These entities would normally be accounted for as associates, but are now consolidated:
 
Name of entity   
Effective percentage interest % 
  Country of incorporation 
MultiChoice Namibia (Proprietary) Limited   
49.0
  South Africa 
Details Nigeria (Proprietary) Limited   
49.0
  Nigeria 
Multichoice Hellas SA   
44.9
  Greece 
Afribooks (Proprietary) Limited   
40.0
  South Africa 
MultiChoice Cyprus Limited   
26.4
  Cyprus 

The following entity has less than 20% ownership, but is classified as an associate as significant influence is established through co-operation agreements, board representation, and the placement of key management:
 
Name of entity   
Effective percentage interest % 
  Country of incorporation 
Beijing Media Corporation Limited   
9.9
  China 

  
F-37

 
 
 
8.  
INVESTMENT AND LOANS (Continued)
 
March 31 
    Investments and loans   
2006
 
2005
    Loans to related parties  
R’000
 
R’000
                 Uppercase Media (Proprietary) Limited    6,733    9,504 
                 Natal Witness Printing and Publishing Company (Proprietary) Limited    5,000    5,000 
                 8 Ink Publishing (Proprietary) Limited    6,642    3,629 
                 KSC Commercial Internet Company Limited        4,269 
                 Shape SA (Proprietary) Limited    1,050    200 
                 East African Magazines (Proprietary) Limited    2,706     
                 Other    983    2,177 
         Total loans to related parties    23,114    24,779 
 
    At fair value through profit & loss investments         
                 Sanlam Dividend Income Fund    32,029    30,458 
                 Andreou & Paraskevaides Enterprises Limited        7,151 
                 Other    2    960 
         Total at fair value through profit & loss investments    32,031    38,569 
         Less: Short term portion        (8,111)
         Long term at fair value through profit & loss investments    32,031    30,458 
 
    Available-for-sale investments and loans         
                 Beijing Media Corporation Limited        313,763 
                 Other    387    1,033 
         Long-term available for sale investments and loans    387    314,796 
 
    Originated loans         
                 Thebe Scitech (Proprietary) Limited    13,000    15,000 
                 Other    6,331    8,127 
         Total originated loans    19,331    23,127 
 
 
F-38


 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
       
March 31   
9.     PROGRAMME AND FILM RIGHTS    
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
 
    Cost price         
         - programme rights    1,015,155    722,104 
         - film rights    504,365    559,702 
        1,519,520    1,281,806 
 
    Accumulated amortization         
         - programme rights    (518,732)   (296,430)
         - film rights    (233,610)   (218,812)
        (752,342)   (515,242)
 
    Net book value         
         - programme rights    496,423    425,674 
         - film rights    270,755    340,890 
        767,178    766,564 
 
    Classified on the balance sheet as follows:         
           - non-current assets    171,145    47,558 
           - current assets    596,033    719,006 
        767,178    766,564 
 
 
10.     DEFERRED TAXATION        
 
    Opening balance    388,634    428,879 
    Acquisition of subsidiaries and joint ventures    (5,087)   (49,833)
    Disposal of subsidiaries and joint ventures    (7,677)   (1,280)
    Accounted for in income statement    (29,450)   8,388 
    Accounted for against reserves    10,687    2,281 
    Foreign currency translation effects    (22,035)   199 
    Closing balance    335,072    388,634 

 
F-39


 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
10. 
DEFERRED TAXATION (Continued)
 
 
The deferred tax assets and liabilities and movement thereon are attributable to the following items: 
     
 
       
April 1, 2005
 
Charged
to income
 
Charged
to equity
 
Acquisition
of subisidiary
and joint
venture
 
Disposal of
subsidiary
and joint
venture
 
Foreign
exchange
adjustment
 
March 31,
2006
       
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
 R’000
 
R’000
    Deferred taxation assets                             
    Property, plant and equipment    51,825    48,896            1,514    (10,161)   92,074 
    Intangible assets    13,926    (693)           278    16,775    30,286 
    Receivables and current assets    47,875    (8,267)       12,485    12,895    (21,585)   43,403 
    Provisions and other current liabilities    188,196    2,068        (11,505)   (182)   52,717    231,294 
    Programme and film rights    69,555    44,357                (81,343)   32,569 
    Income received in advance    81,373    20,781            745    (946)   101,953 
    Tax losses carried forward    998,597    (210,101)           (9,011)   (108,691)   670,794 
    Capitalized finance leases    252,325    (19,575)               (22,276)   210,474 
    Derivative assets    (21,807)   49,343                    27,536 
    Hedging reserve        (23)   10,224                10,201 
    STC credits    93,989    14,862                    108,851 
    Other        (3,490)               9,250    5,760 
        1,775,854    (61,842)   10,224    980    6,239    (166,260)   1,565,195 
    Valuation allowance    919,133    (49,733)           1,460    (143,414)   727,446 
        856,721    (12,109)   10,224    980    4,779    (22,846)   837,749 
 
    Deferred taxation liabilities                             
    Property, plant and equipment    307,944    26,035        6,067        (6,596)   333,450 
    Intangible assets    65,431    2,595        56        (65,398)   2,684 
    Receivables and current assets    6,891    (8,454)       (56)   12,456    64,403    75,240 
    Provisions and other current liabilities    519                        519 
    Capitalized finance leases    68,796    (6,198)               (6,014)   56,584 
    Derivative assets    4,543    16,878                    21,421 
    Hedging reserve    1,744        (463)               1,281 
    Programme and film rights    20,403    (10,032)                   10,371 
    Other    (8,184)   (3,483)               12,794    1,127 
        468,087    17,341    (463)   6,067    12,456    (811)   502,677 
                                 
    Net deferred taxation    388,634    (29,450)   10,687    (5,087)   (7,677)   (22,035)   335,072 
 
 
F-40


 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
10. 
DEFERRED TAXATION (Continued)
 
 
Valuation allowances are created against the net deferred tax assets, when it is probable that the deferred tax assets will not be realized in the near future, due to the timing on available tax loss carry-forwards that arose on these losses. Further valuation allowances have been raised when it is uncertain if future taxable profits will be available to utilize unused tax losses and timing differences: 
     
 
   
South
Africa
R’000
 
Rest of
Africa
R’000
 
Greece
and Cyprus
R’000
 
Thailand
R’000
 
Netherlands
R’000
 
USA
R’000
 
Total
R’000 
 Valuation allowance   
362,306 
 
6,470
 
           101,620 
 
         33,278 
 
63,876 
 
 159,896 
 
727,446 
 
 
The group has tax loss carry-forwards of approximately Rand 2,313.1 million (2005: Rand 3,345.9 million).  A summary of the tax loss carry-forwards at March 31, 2006 by tax jurisdiction and the expected expiry dates are set out below: 
 
  
   
South
 
Rest of
 
Greece
               
   
Africa
 
Africa
 
and Cyprus
 
Thailand
 
Netherlands
 
USA
 
Total
   
R’000
 
R’000
 
 R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 Expires in year one            30,410    11,565            41,975 
 Expires in year two            67,978    9,265            77,243 
 Expires in year three            22    7,081            7,103 
 Expires in year four        19,898    33,776    5,356            59,030 
 Expires in year five            9    11            20 
 Expires after year five    1,265,101    143,259            309,606    409,746    2,127,712 
    1,265,101    163,157    132,195    33,278    309,606    409,746    2,313,083 

The ultimate outcome of additional taxation assessments may vary from the amounts accrued. However, management believes that any additional taxation liability over and above the amount accrued would not have a material adverse impact on the group’s income statement and balance sheet.
 
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset when the income tax relates to the same fiscal authority and there is a legal right to offset at settlement. The following amounts are shown in the consolidated balance sheets: 
 
 
   
2006
 
2005
   
R’000
 
R’000
Classification on balance sheet         
Deferred tax assets   
837,749 
 
856,721 
Deferred tax liabilities   
(502,677) 
 
(468,087) 
Net deferred tax assets   
335,072   
 
388,634    
 
 
The group charged deferred income tax of Rand 10.7 million (2005: Rand 2.3 million) to equity as a result of changes in the fair value of derivative financial instruments where the forecasted transaction or commitment has not resulted in an asset or liability.
 
 
F-41

 

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
11.   INVENTORY    
 March 31
       
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
       Carry value         
       Raw materials    157,809    101,126 
       Finished products, trading inventory and consumables    302,783    216,244 
       Work-in-progress    26,136    17,824 
       Decoders, internet and associated components    136,383    170,028 
       Gross Inventory    623,111    505,222 
       Provision for slow-moving and obsolete inventories   
(118,635)
 
(121,755)
       Net Inventory    504,476    383,467 

The total impairment charged to write inventory down to net realizable value in the income statement amounted to Rand 34.2 million (2005: Rand 16.1 million), and reversals of these impairments amounted to Rand 24.8 million (2005: Rand 8.2 million).
 
 
12.    TRADE RECEIVABLES
 
Carry value
       
Trade accounts receivable, gross
  1,747,922    1,651,260 
Less: provision for impairment of receivables
  (211,078)   (238,687)
    1,536,844    1,412,573 

Included in trade receivables are Rand 949.5 million at March 31, 2006 (2005: Rand 837.1 million), pre-billed to customers and credit balances, which have been included in deferred income (see note 21). The group has pledged accounts receivable with a carrying value of Rand 2.5 million at March 31, 2006 (2005: Rand 15.8 million) as security against certain term loans and overdrafts with banks.
 
13.    OTHER RECEIVABLES         
 
    Prepayments and accrued income    237,042    235,060 
    Receivables from minority shareholders    8,917    851 
    Staff debtors    8,587    9,226 
    VAT and related taxes receivable    28,821    30,808 
    Other receivables    216,360    134,302 
        499,727    410,247 
 
 
F-42


 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
14.      RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS AND BALANCES
 
The group entered into transactions and has balances with a number of related parties, including equity investees, directors, shareholders and entities under common control. Transactions that are eliminated on consolidation are not included. The transactions and balances with related parties are summarized below:
 
 
       
March 31
       
2006
2005
       
R’000
R’000
Sale of goods and services to related parties 
 
Notes
     
     Electronic Media Network Limited   
[a] 
  50,431  43,212 
     Supersport International Holdings Limited   
[a] 
  3,490  15,673 
     Myriad International Programming Services BV   
[a] 
    2,615 
     United Broadcasting Corporation Public Company Limited   
[a] 
  159  6,361 
     Jane Raphaely & Associates (Proprietary) Limited   
[b] 
  13,405  10,252 
     New Media Publishers (Proprietary) Limited   
[b] 
  39,702  32,885 
     East African Magazines (Proprietary) Limited   
[b] 
  204  1,016 
     8 Ink (Proprietary) Limited   
[b] 
  4,939  2,455 
     Capital Media (Proprietary) Limited   
[b] 
  1,822  2,183 
     Rodale & Touchline Publishers (Proprietary) Limited   
[b] 
  11,336  12,214 
     Shape (Proprietary) Limited   
[b] 
  3,956  4,854 
     Uppercase Media (Proprietary) Limited   
[b] 
  17,120  10,244 
     CTP Limited   
[b] 
  13,334   
     Associated Magazines (Proprietary) Limited   
[b] 
  1,722   
        161,620  143,964 

Notes:
 
[a] Sale of goods and services to M-Net, Supersport, United Broadcasting Corporation Public Company Limited and Myriad International Programming Services BV.
[b] Media 24 Limited receives revenue from a number of its related parties mainly for the printing and distribution of magazines and newspapers.
 
    Purchase of goods and services             
         Electronic Media Network Limited and Supersport International             
         Holdings Limited   
[a] 
  2,182,677    1,909,895 
         CTP Limited   
[b] 
  12,897     
         New Media Publishers (Proprietary) Limited   
[b] 
  5,513    4,292 
         Natal Witness Printing and Publishing Company (Propietary)             
         Limited   
[b] 
  4,672    1,365 
            2,205,759    1,915,552 
 
Notes: 
[a]      Channel and programming rights purchased by MultiChoice Africa (Proprietary) Limited.
[b]      Media 24 Limited purchases goods and services from a number of its related parties mainly for the printing and distribution of magazines and newspapers.
 
 
F-43

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
14.      RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS AND BALANCES (continued)
 
  Other transactions with related parties
 
  Tencent Holdings Limited (“Tencent”)
  The group entered into a number of intellectual property and know-how licensing agreements with Tencent. On June 27, 2002, Tencent granted a sole and exclusive license to a group company to use, and to authorize its affiliates (“the operators”) which carry on business in sub-Saharan Africa (including South Africa), Indonesia, Thailand, Greece and Cyprus to use certain proprietary intellectual property and know-how of Tencent for a license fee computed at 40% of gross revenue derived by the operators by using this proprietary information. The agreement is for a term of 15 years and expires in 2017.
 
  MultiChoice Nigeria Limited (MCN)
  The group has a loan of Rand 39.0 million (2005: Rand 35.6 million) with MCN’s minority shareholder which bears interest at 10.22%. An impairment charge of Rand 30.9 million was raised during the year against the outstanding balance as this was not deemed recoverable. The remaining balance of Rand 8.1 million is due by March 31, 2007.
 
  MultiChoice Ghana Limited (MGL)
  An advance of US$0.4 million was made during the 2004 financial year to a minority shareholder in MGL. The MGL minority shareholders’ loan bears interest at 1% above LIBOR and is secured by a pledge of shares in MGL. There was no outstanding balance on this advance at March 31, 2006.
 
  Antenna TV (Antenna)
  In prior years, NetMed NV entered into agreements with Antenna for the purchase of a 5% interest (plus a 10% option) in NetMed NV and for the right to distribute three Antenna channels. In October 2001, Antenna concluded the transaction for the acquisition of 5% of the shares in NetMed NV for a consideration of approximately Rand 94.7 million (US$12 million). Two channels were aired in the current year. On January 2, 2006, Antenna exercised a put option to sell the above stake to Myriad International Holdings BV at a price equal to the fair value of each share. At March 31, 2006, the valuation process in respect of determining the fair value of each share, was still in progress.
 
  Electronic Media Network Limited (M-Net)
  M-Net reduced its capital by paying a total of Rand 84.3 million to its shareholders in March 2006. The group participated in this transaction to the extent of its shareholding in M-Net.
 
  SuperSport International Holdings Limited (SuperSport)
  SuperSport reduced its capital by paying a total of Rand 62.4 million to its shareholders in March 2006. The group participated in this transaction to the extent of its shareholding in SuperSport.
 
  M-Net and SuperSport ceded forward exchange contracts (FEC’s) totaling US$49.9 million on March 31, 2003 at no consideration to the group. The FEC’s ceded are at an average rate of Rand 12.16 and matured between November 28, 2003 and March 31, 2005.
 
 
F-44

 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED) 
 
       
March 31
14.    RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS AND BALANCES (continued)   
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
 
    The balances of advances, deposits, receivables and payables between         
    the group and related parties are as follows:         
 
    Receivables         
         Electronic Media Network Limited    2,176    2,477 
         SuperSport International Holdings Limited    1,301     
         United Broadcasting Corporation Public Company Limited        7,432 
         KSC Commercial Internet Company Limited        2,082 
         Capital Media (Proprietary) Limited        487 
         Jane Raphaely & Associates (Proprietary) Limited    2,381    1,984 
         New Media Publishers (Proprietary) Limited    8,096    6,315 
         Rodale & Touchline Publishers (Proprietary) Limited    3,246    2,554 
         Shape (Proprietary) Limited    965    728 
         East African Magazines (Proprietary) Limited        2,008 
         Associated Magazines (Proprietary) Limited    1,517    2,056 
         Minority shareholder loans        37,555 
         Other related parties    157    1,233 
        19,839    66,911 
 
    Payables         
         Electronic Media Network Limited    84,270    72,613 
         SuperSport International Holdings Limited    3,476    2,934 
         Alibiprops 12 (Proprietary) Limited    586    3,673 
         Natal Witness Printing and Publishing Company (Propietary) Limited    7,925     
         Jane Raphaely & Associates (Proprietary) Limited    1,238    1,043 
         Rodale & Touchline Publishers (Proprietary) Limited        1,241 
         Multichoice Eastern Cape (Proprietary) Limited (Transkei)        1,358 
         Uppercase Media (Proprietary) Limited    2,544     
         CTP Limited    1,857     
         New Media Publishers (Proprietary) Limited    1,709     
         Other related parties    833    3,532 
        104,438    86,394 

 
F-45


 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     
(CONTINUED)         
 
14. 
  RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS AND BALANCES (continued)         
       
March 31
       
2006 
 
2005
       
R’000 
 
R’000
 
    Directors’ emoluments         
 
    Executive directors:         
         Remuneration for other services paid by subsidiary companies    314   
         4,023 
 
    Non-executive directors:         
         Fees for services as directors    3,082   
         2,805 
         Fees for services as directors of subsidiary companies    2,030   
         2,120 
        5,426   
         8,948 

No director has a notice period of more than one year.
 
No director’s service contract includes pre-determined compensation as a result of termination that would exceed one year’s salary and benefits.
 
 
F-46

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
14.      RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS AND BALANCES (continued)
 
Directors’ emoluments (continued)
 
The individual directors received the following remuneration and emoluments during the current financial year: 
   
                   
       
Executive directors             
Salary
R’000
 
Bonuses and
performance
related fees
R’000
 
Pension
Contributions
R’000
 
Total
R’000
2006               
JP Bekker                             
SJZ Pacak                1,957    2,200    196    4,353 
                1,957    2,200    196    4,353 
2005               
JP Bekker                             
SJZ Pacak                1,846    2,000    177    4,023 
                1,846    2,000    177    4,023 
Non-executive directors   
Directors’
fees
R’000
 
Committee1
and trustee2
fees
R’000
 
Total
2006
R’000
 
Directors’
fees
R’000
 
Committee1
and trustee2
fees
R’000
 
Total
2005
R’000
T Vosloo3,4,5    1,863        1,863    1,788        1,788 
JJM van Zyl3,4,5    535    460    995    629    355    984 
E Botha4      157        157    265        265 
LN Jonker      175        175    130        130 
NP van Heerden    175        175    130    105    235 
BJ van der Ross    175    4    179    130    39    169 
GJ Gerwel3,4,6    435    60    495    570    51    621 
HSS Willemse    175    3    178    130    3    133 
F du Plessis      175    220    395    140    155    295 
FTM Phaswana    175        175    130        130 
RCC Jafta      175    150    325    140    35    175 
        4,215    897    5,112    4,182    743    4,925 
 
Notes on non-executive directors’ remuneration
     
Note 1:   
Committee fees include fees for the attendance of the audit committee, the human resources committee, the budget committee and the executive committee
meetings of the board. 
         
Note 2:   
Trustee fees include fees for the attendance of the various retirement fund trustee meetings of the group’s retirement funds, as well as for the attendance of
Welkom trustee meetings. 
         
Note 3:   
Directors fees include fees for services as directors of Media24 Limited.
 
Note 4:   
Directors fees includes fees for services as directors of Via Afrika Limited.
 
Note 5:   
Directors fees includes fees for services as directors of MIH Holdings Limited and MIH BV. 
   
Note 6:    Directors fees include fees for services as directors of Educor Holdings Limited.     
 
 
F-47

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
14.     RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS AND BALANCES (continued)
 
Directors’ interests in scheme shares of the Naspers Share Incentive Scheme
 
The executive directors of Naspers are allowed to participate in the Naspers Share Incentive Scheme. Details in respect of their participation in scheme shares not yet released are as follows:
 
   
Purchase
 
Number of
 
Purchase
 
Release
Name 
 
date
 
N - shares
 
price
 
period
 
JP Bekker ¹   
01/10/2002
 
1,634,941
 
R22,39 -
 
01/10/2006 -
           
R24,50
 
01/10/2007
   
17/12/2002
 
1,490,854
 
R29,09 -
 
17/12/2006 - 
           
R31,54
 
17/12/2007
 
SJZ Pacak   
02/01/2003
 
333,334
 
R23,50
  02/01/2007 - 
                02/01/2008 
   
09/09/2004
 
100,000
 
R50.00
  09/09/2007 - 
                09/09/2009 

1.      The managing director of Naspers has allocations, as indicated above, in the share incentive scheme, in terms of which Naspers Class N ordinary shares can be acquired at certain prices, with vesting of three tranches taking place over periods of five years. The purchase prices relating to the allocations were set at the middle market price of the shares on the purchase date, but increased by anticipated inflation over the course of the vesting periods of three, four and five years respectively for each of the tranches. Inflation expectations were calculated by the Bureau for Economic Research of the University of Stellenbosch. The managing director does not earn any remuneration from the group, in particular no salary, bonus, car scheme, medical or pension contributions of any nature whatever are payable. The managing director’s contract is for a five-year period starting on October 1, 2002. No compensation will apply to termination.
 
On July 22, 2005, 50,000 released Naspers N ordinary shares were sold by SJZ Pacak upon payment of the amount of an average price of Rand 21.22 per share (the original average offer prices based on the listed market prices of Naspers Limited N ordinary shares on the dates of the offers) due to the Naspers Share Incentive Trust, at an average selling price of Rand 92.12 per Naspers N ordinary share.
 
On July 29, 2005, 50 000 released Naspers N ordinary shares were sold by SJZ Pacak upon payment of the amount of an average price of Rand 21.22 per share (the original average offer price based on the listed market price of Naspers Limited N ordinary shares on the dates of the offer) due to the Naspers Share Incentive Trust, at an average selling price of Rand 97.07 per Naspers N ordinary share.
 
Directors’ interest in MIH Holdings Share Incentive Scheme
 
Historically SJZ Pacak has been a participant under the MIH Holdings Share Incentive Scheme. In December 2002, Naspers Limited acquired all the MIH Holdings ordinary shares held by the MIH Holdings Share Trust in exchange for Naspers Class N ordinary shares. Participants exchanged their rights to MIH Holdings shares for Naspers Class N ordinary shares. On July 22, 2005, 44,444 Naspers N ordinary shares were delivered to SJZ Pacak upon payment of the amount of an average price of Rand 13.64 per share and, on the same day, 5,333 Naspers N ordinary shares were delivered to SJZ Pacak upon payment of the amount of an average price of Rand 20.05 per share (the original average offer prices based on the listed market prices of MIH Holdings Limited shares on the dates of the offers) due to the MIH Holdings Share Trust. The closing price of a Naspers N ordinary share on July 22, 2005 was Rand 92.35. SJZ Pacak still owns these shares. At March 31, 2006, a total of 66,531 (2005: 116,308) Naspers N ordinary shares have been allocated to SJZ Pacak with vesting periods until February 18, 2007.
 
Directors’ interest in SuperSport Share Incentive Scheme
 
Historically SJZ Pacak has been a participant under the SuperSport Share Incentive Scheme. In March 2003, SuperSport completed a capital reduction, in terms of which Naspers Class N ordinary shares were distributed to its shareholders, including the SuperSport Share Incentive Trust. In terms of his participation in the SuperSport Share Incentive Scheme, 2,119 Naspers Class N ordinary shares have been allocated to SJZ Pacak with vesting periods until August 26, 2004.
 
In March 2004 Naspers Limited acquired all the SuperSport ordinary shares held by the SuperSport Share Incentive Trust in exchange for Naspers Class N ordinary shares. Participants could exchange their rights to SuperSport shares for Naspers Class N ordinary shares. A total of 5,305 Naspers Class N ordinary shares have been allocated to SJZ Pacak with vesting periods until August 26, 2004.
 
 
F-48

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
14.    RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS AND BALANCES (continued)
 
Directors’ interest in M-Net Share Incentive Scheme
 
Historically SJZ Pacak has been a participant under the M-Net Share Incentive Scheme. In March 2004, Naspers Limited acquired all the M-Net ordinary shares held by the M-Net Share Incentive Trust in exchange for Naspers Class N ordinary shares. Participants could exchange their rights to M-Net shares for Naspers Class N ordinary shares. A total of 5,805 Naspers Class N ordinary shares have been allocated to SJZ Pacak with vesting periods until August 26, 2004.
 
Directors’ interests in Naspers shares
 
The directors of Naspers had the following interest in Naspers A ordinary shares as at March 31, 2006:
 
       
March 31, 2006
         
March 31, 2005
   
       
Naspers A ordinary shares
         
Naspers A ordinary shares 
   
   
Beneficial
 
Non-beneficial
 
         Beneficial
 
Non-beneficial
Name    Direct    Indirect    Direct    Indirect    Direct    Indirect    Direct    Indirect 
 
JJM van Zyl   
745
             
       745 
           

On January 25, 2006, an agreement was reached in terms of which Sanlam Limited sold 168,605 Naspers Beleggings Limited ordinary shares, 16,860,500 Keeromstraat 30 Beleggings Limited ordinary shares and 133,350 Naspers ‘A’ shares into a new entity, Wheatfields 221 (Proprietary) Limited (Wheatfields). Sanlam owns 50% of Wheatfields, while Mr JP Bekker acquired an indirect 25% interest in Wheatfields.
 
No other director of Naspers had any interest in Naspers A ordinary shares at March 31, 2006 or March 31, 2005.
 
 
The directors of Naspers had the following interest in Naspers N ordinary shares as at 31 March:    
   
 March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
   
  Naspers N ordinary shares
 
  Naspers N ordinary shares
   
Beneficial
 
Non-beneficial
 
Beneficial
 
Non-beneficial
Name  
Direct
 
Indirect
 
Direct
 
Indirect
 
Direct
 
Indirect
 
Direct
 
Indirect
 
T Vosloo    25,000    250,000            25,000    300,000         
JP Bekker                4,917,316    314,754            3,532,756 
SJZ Pacak    94,510    291,267        122,707    44,733    262,078        135,007 
JJM van Zyl    50,361    173,793            50,361    173,793         
E Botha                    15,332             
LN Jonker    1,000            67,000    1,000            67,000 
NP van Heerden        1,300                        2,300 
BJ van der Ross                                 
GJ Gerwel                                 
HSS Willemse                                 
F du Plessis                500                500 
FTM Phaswana    630                630             
RCC Jafta                                 


F-49

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
14.    RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS AND BALANCES (continued)
 
Key management remuneration and participation in share-based incentive plans
 
Comparatives have not been restated to account for the change in the composition of key management.
 
The total of executive directors’ and key management emoluments amounted to Rand 97.2 million (2005: Rand 76.1 million); comprising short-term employee benefits of Rand 65.4 million (2005: Rand 50.5 million), post-employment benefits of Rand 5.4 million (2005: Rand 5.4 million), and share-based payment charge of Rand 26.4 million (2005: Rand 20.2 million). The aggregate number of share options granted to the executive directors and key management during the 2006 financial year and the number of shares allocated to the executive directors and key management at March 31, 2006 respectively are:
 
For shares listed on a recognised stock exchange as follows: 794,678 (2005: 559,652) Naspers Limited Class N ordinary shares were allocated during the 2006 financial year and an aggregate of 13,200,771 (2005: 15,256,032) Class N ordinary shares were allocated as at March 31, 2006.
 
For shares in unlisted companies as follows: 17,238 (2005: 45,399) Media24 Limited ordinary shares were allocated during 2006 and an aggregate of 487,977 (2005: 635,039) ordinary shares were allocated as at March 31, 2006; nil (2005: 192,780) Via Afrika Limited ordinary shares were allocated during 2006 and 243,840 (2005: 192 780 ) ordinary shares were allocated as at March 31, 2006; 50,000 (2005: 150,000) Irdeto Access BV ordinary shares were allocated during 2006 and an aggregate of 207,500 (2005: 157,500) ordinary shares were allocated as at March 31, 2006; nil (2005: 45,000) Paarl Media Holdings (Proprietary) Limited ordinary shares were allocated during 2006 and 185,000 (2005: 185,000) ordinary shares were allocated as at March 31, 2006; 18,250 (2005: 5,000) MIH QQ (BVI) Limited ordinary shares were allocated during 2006 and an aggregate of 32,625 (2005: 20,000) shares were allocated as at March 31, 2006; nil (2005: 2,080,000) Entriq (Mauritius) Limited shares were allocated during 2006 and an aggregate of 2,200,000 (2005: 2,200,000) shares were allocated as at March 31, 2006.
 
During the year, three share appreciation rights plans (SARs) were introduced. The number of SARs allocated to the executive directors and key management at March 31, 2006 are: 1,182,923 Media24 SARs; 928,213 MCA SARs; and 1,793,890 M-Net/SS SARs.
 
These shares and SARs were granted on the same terms and conditions as those offered to employees of the group.
 

F-50

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
     
 March 31
15.    SHARE CAPITAL AND PREMIUM   
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
    Authorized        
    1,250,000 Class A ordinary shares of R20 each    25,000    25,000 
    500,000,000 Class N ordinary shares of 2c each    10,000    10,000 
        35,000    35,000 
    Issued         
    712,131 Class A ordinary shares of R20 each (2005: 712,131)    14,243    14,243 
    315,113,700 Class N ordinary shares of 2c each (2005: 314,548,700)    6,302    6,291 
        20,545    20,534 
    Share premium    6,278,880    6,173,258 
        6,299,425    6,193,792 
    Less: 24,558,886 Class N ordinary shares held as treasury shares         
         (2005: 31,959,017 Class N ordinary shares)    (738,105)   (802,641)
        5,561,320    5,391,151 

Treasury shares
 
The group holds a total of 24,558,886 Class N ordinary shares (2005: 31,959,017), or 7.8% of the gross number in issue (2005: 10,2%) at March 31, 2006 as treasury shares. Equity compensation plans hold 19,849,615 of the Class N ordinary shares (2005: 27,249,746) and the remaining 4,709,271 Class N ordinary shares (2005: 4,709,271) are held by various group companies.
 
Voting and dividend rights
 
The Class A ordinary shareholders are entitled to 1,000 votes per share and may receive nominal dividends as determined from time to time by the board of directors, but always limited to one fifth of the dividend to which Class N ordinary shareholders are entitled. The Class A ordinary shareholders do not have a right to receive a dividend when dividends are declared to Class N ordinary shareholders, although a dividend to Class A ordinary shareholders could be proposed by the Board. In respect of all other rights, the Class A ordinary shares rank pari passu with the Class N ordinary shares of the company.
 
Naspers Beleggings Limited holds 350,000 Class A ordinary shares (2005: 350,000) and Keeromstraat 30 Beleggings Limited holds 219,344 Class A ordinary shares (2005: 219,344) of the total 712,131 Class A ordinary shares in issue at the year-end. As a result of the voting rights attached to these shares, the companies have significant influence over the group.
 

F-51

 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
15.      SHARE CAPITAL AND PREMIUM (continued)
 
  Unissued share capital
 
  The directors of the company have unrestricted authority until after the following annual general meeting to allot and issue the unissued 537,869 Class A ordinary shares and 184,886,300 Class N ordinary shares in the company, subject to the provisions of section 221 of the Companies Act, 1973, and the JSE Listing Requirements.
 
  Share Incentive Plans holding Naspers Class N ordinary shares
 
Directors may, from time to time, instruct the trustees of the Naspers Limited Share Incentive Trust to offer employees options and / or contracts relating to such number of Class N ordinary shares in the company which in total, together with the shares already in the existing scheme, shall not exceed 11% of the company’s issued shares. With the acquisition of the minority interests in MIH Holdings Limited and MIH Limited in December 2002, the MIH Holdings Share Incentive Plan and the MIH (BVI) Plan received Naspers N ordinary shares. The SuperSport Share Incentive Plan received Naspers Class N ordinary shares in February 2003 from the distribution of Naspers Class N ordinary shares by SuperSport as part of a capital reduction exercise. The SuperSport Share Incentive Plan and the M-Net Share Incentive Plan received Naspers Class N ordinary shares in April 2004 from the acquisition of the minority interests in Electronic Media Network Limited and SuperSport International Holdings Limited by Naspers. Aggregate information on Naspers Class N ordinary shares held by the Naspers, MIH Holdings, MIH (BVI), M-Net and SuperSport plans are as follows:
 
 
   
N shares
 
N shares
Movement in Class N ordinary shares in issue during the year         
Shares in issue at April 1    314,548,700    296,816,639 
Shares issued to acquire M-Net/SuperSport shares from minority shareholders        17,532,061 
Shares issued to Share Incentive Trusts    565,000    200,000 
Shares in issue at March 31    315,113,700    314,548,700 
 
Movement in Class N ordinary shares held as treasury shares during the year         
Shares held as treasury shares at April 1    31,959,017    35,197,406 
Shares acquired by M-Net and SuperSport equity compensation plans        1,089,686 
Shares issued to Share Incentive Trusts    565,000    200,000 
Shares acquired by entities in the group        86,573 
Shares sold in open market    (486,972)    
Shares acquired by participants from equity compensation plans    (7,478,159)   (4,614,648)
Shares held as treasury shares at March 31    24,558,886    31,959,017 
         
Net number of shares in issue at March 31   290,554,814    282,589,683 
 

 
   
March 31
   
2006
 
2005
   
R’000
 
R’000
Share premium         
     Balance at April 1    6,173,258    5,412,628 
     Share premium on share issues    69,766    762,574 
     Share issue expenses    (53)   (1,944)
     On vesting of shares - transfer to share premium    35,909    - 
     Balance at March 31    6,278,880    6,173,258 

Shares allocated to participants of the incentive schemes vest in equal numbers after respectively three, four and five years after the date of allocation. The plans are obliged to deliver the shares to the participants at any time after vesting up to a maximum of 10 years after the allocation date, when participants request and pay for the shares.
 
Share options outstanding
 
In terms of the Welkom Trust share scheme, share options were issued to the participants to subscribe for 5,605,236 Naspers Class N ordinary shares at a subscription price of Rand 31.96 per Class N ordinary share during the 30-day period from September 9, 2006.
 
F-52


NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
       
March 31
16.    OTHER RESERVES   
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
    Other reserves on the balance sheet comprise:         
         Fair value reserve    173    23,796 
         Hedging reserve    (20,193)   (18,920)
         Foreign currency translation reserve    12,807    (5,416)
         Other reserves    (3,500,675)   (2,473,525)
         Share-based compensation reserve    191,182    56,374 
        (3,316,706)   (2,417,691)

The fair value reserve relates to unrealized profits and losses arising from changes in the fair value of investments classified as available-for-sale.
 
The hedging reserve relates to the changes in the fair value of derivative financial instruments that hedges forecasted transactions or the foreign currency part or firm commitments. The changes in fair value are recorded in the hedging reserve until the forecasted transaction or firm commitment results in the recognition of an asset or liability, when such deferred gains or losses are then included in the initial measurement of the asset or liability.
 
The foreign currency translation reserve relates to exchange differences arising from the translation of foreign subsidiaries’ and joint ventures’ income statements at average exchange rates for the year and their balance sheets at the ruling exchange rates at the balance sheet date if the functional currency differs.
 
The other reserves are used to account for transactions with minority shareholders in terms of the economic entity model, whereby the excess of the cost of the transactions over the acquirer’s interest in previously recognized assets and liabilities is allocated to this reserve in equity.
 
The fair value of options issued to employees is accounted for in the share-based compensation reserve over the vesting period. The reserve is adjusted when the entity revises its estimates of the number of share options that are expected to become exercisable. It recognizes the impact of the revision of original estimates, if any, in the income statement, with a corresponding adjustment to this reserve in equity for equity-settled plans.
 
17.    RETAINED EARNINGS
 
Any future dividends declared from the distributable reserves of the company or its subsidiaries, which are not wholly-owned subsidiaries of the company and are incorporated in South Africa, may be subject to secondary taxation on companies (“STC”) at a rate of 12.5% of the dividends declared. Dividends received by group companies during their various dividend cycles can be carried forward as unutilized STC credits. These STC credits can then be utilized to reduce any STC payable on future dividends declared by group companies. The group’s total unutilized STC credits at March 31, 2006 amounted to Rand 870,8 million (2005: Rand 751.9 million). The group has no unutilized STC credits at March 31, 2006 (2005: Rand 243.3 million) on which deferred tax assets have not been raised , due to uncertainties relating to the utilization of these credits.
 
The board of directors has proposed that a dividend of 120 cents (2005: 70 cents) per N ordinary share and 24 cents (2005: 14 cents) per A ordinary share be paid to shareholders on September 11, 2006. If approved by the shareholders of the company at its annual general meeting, the company will pay a total dividend of Rand 378.3 million based on the number of shares in issue at March 31, 2006. The company has enough STC credits carried-forward to cover such a dividend. The utilization of these STC credits will however lead to the realization of a deferred tax asset of Rand 47.3 million that will be charged to the income statement during the 2007 financial year.
 
 
F-53


NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
18.      POST-RETIREMENT LIABILITIES
 
  18.1 Medical liability
 
  The group operates a number of post-retirement medical benefit schemes. The obligation of the group to pay medical aid contributions after retirement is no longer part of the conditions of employment for new employees. A number of pensioners and current employees, however, remain entitled to this benefit. The entitlement to this benefit for current employees is dependent upon the employees remaining in service until retirement age and completing a minimum service period. The group provides for post-retirement medical aid benefits on the accrual basis determined each year by an independent actuary. The directors believe that adequate provision has been made for future liabilities.
 
  Media24 Limited and Via Afrika Limited entered into agreements during the year ended March 31, 2004 with certain employees to terminate their future participation in the post-retirement medical aid benefits plan, in exchange for certain future contributions to endowment policies for these employees. At March 31, 2006 the group had a liability of Rand 17.9 million (2005: Rand 21.6 million) relating to these future contributions to be made in a further three installments over the next three years.
 
 
 
March 31
Post-retirement medical liability: 
 
2006
 
2005
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
             Opening balance    161,298    171,070 
             Additional provisions charged to income statement    20,689    3,894 
             Provisions reversed to income statement    (3,019)   (693)
             Provisions credited/charged to other accounts    -    (6,661)
             Provisions utilized    (12,953)   (6,256)
             Partial disposal of interest in joint venture    (4,026)   - 
             Foreign currency translation effect    (360)   (56)
    161,629    161,298 
             Less: Short-term portion    (8,164)   - 
             Closing balance    153,465    161,298 
 
The principal actuarial assumptions used for accounting purposes were:         
     Health care cost inflation    6.5%    7.0% 
     Discount rate    7.5%    8.5% 
     Continuation at retirement    100%    100% 
     Average retirement age    60    60 

  18.2 Pension and provident benefits
 
The group provides retirement benefits for its full-time employees by way of various separate defined contribution pension and provident funds. All full-time employees have access to these funds. Contributions to these funds are paid on a fixed scale. The South African retirement funds of the group are governed by the Pension Fund Act of South Africa. Substantially all the group’s full-time employees are members of either one of the group’s retirement benefit plans or a third-party plan.
 
An amount of Rand 178.7 million (2005: Rand 172.8 million) was recognized as an expense in relation to the group’s retirement funds.
 
 
F-54


NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
       
March 31
19.    LONG-TERM LIABILITIES   
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
 
    Interest-bearing: Capitalized finance leases    1,443,636    1,723,656 
    Total liabilities    1,731,711    1,983,108 
    Less: current portion    (288,075)    (259,452) 
 
    Interest-bearing: Concession liabilities        15,489 
    Total liabilities        15,559 
    Less: current portion        (70) 
 
    Interest-bearing: Loans and other    722,006    423,160 
    Total liabilities    1,053,326    636,199 
    Less: current portion    (331,320)    (213,039) 
 
    Non-interest-bearing: Programme and film rights    149,971    53,925 
    Total liabilities    636,827    458,575 
    Less: current portion    (486,856)    (404,650) 
 
    Non-interest-bearing: Loans and other    39,948    59,418 
    Total liabilities    633,239    99,723 
    Less: current portion    (593,291)    (40,305) 
    Net long-term liabilities    2,355,561    2,275,648 

 
F-55

 

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
19.    LONG-TERM LIABILITIES (continued)                     
 
    Interest-bearing: Capitalized finance leases                     
           
Year of
           
           
final
 
Year-end
 
 2006
 
 2005
    Type of lease       Currency   
repayment
 
interest rate 
 
R’000
 
R’000
    Land and buildings    ZAR   
2010
 
14.0%
  14,262    15,869 
        ZAR   
2007
 
21.5%
  26,925    35,795 
        ZAR   
2012
 
17.0%
  52,808    53,133 
        ZAR   
2023
 
10.5%
  123,742    119,503 
                    217,737    224,300 
 
    Manufacturing equipment    ZAR   
2007
 
10.0%
      2,462 
        ZAR   
2008
 
10.0%
      2,991 
        ZAR   
2010
 
10.9%
  1,714     
                    1,714    5,453 
    Transmission equipment and satellites    EUR   
various
 
5.0%
  68    6,637 
        THB   
various
 
various
      1,781 
        USD   
2012
 
8.2%
  537,287    613,738 
        EUR   
2013
 
9.0%
  268,754    322,660 
        EUR   
2013
 
4.0%
  59,153    72,071 
        USD   
2013
 
4.0%
  219,873    249,753 
        EUR   
2011
 
4.0%
  94,385    117,696 
        EUR   
2010
 
10.0%
  274,542    296,212 
        USD   
2012
 
6.5%
  53,864    67,958 
                    1,507,926    1,748,506 
    Vehicles, computers and office equipment    ZAR   
various
 
10.5%
  3,040    3,567 
        ZAR   
various
 
various
  1,294    1,282 
                    4,334    4,849 
                         
    Total capitalized finance leases                1,731,711    1,983,108 
 
 
F-56


NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
19.    LONG-TERM LIABILITIES (continued)         
 
    Interest-bearing: Capitalized finance leases (continued)   
 2006
 
 2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
    Minimum installments         
    Payable within year one    407,545    415,457 
    Payable within year two    383,943    415,419 
    Payable within year three    373,141    386,239 
    Payable within year four    323,619    375,127 
    Payable within year five    271,344    324,355 
    Payable after year five    567,699    847,897 
        2,327,291    2,764,494 
    Future finance costs on finance leases    (595,580)   (781,386)
    Present value of finance lease liabilities    1,731,711    1,983,108 
 
    Present value         
    Payable within year one    288,075    259,452 
    Payable within year two    288,945    277,245 
    Payable within year three    301,468    273,935 
    Payable within year four    273,757    287,294 
    Payable within year five    240,527    256,931 
    Payable after year five    338,939    628,251 
    Present value of finance lease liabilities    1,731,711    1,983,108 
 
 
F-57

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
19.    LONG-TERM LIABILITIES (continued)                     
 
    Interest-bearing: Concession liabilities                     
            Year of final    Year-end    2006    2005 
    Type of concession liability   
Currency
  repayment    interest rate    R’000    R’000 
    Licence concession liability   
THB
 
2014
 
13.0%
                     6,546 
    Licence concession liability   
THB
 
2019
 
13.0%
                     9,013 
                                       15,559 

Concession obligations pertain to United Broadcasting Corporation which was disposed of during the year ended March 31, 2006.
 
 
   
Asset
     
Year of final 
 
Year-end
 
 2006
 
2005
Loan   
secured
 
Currency 
 
repayment 
 
interest rate 
 
R’000
 
R’000
Secured                         
Term loan: Investec Bank Limited   
Investments
 
ZAR
 
2008
 
9.0%
  400,098    300,000 
Term loan: ABSA Bank Limited   
Investments
 
USD
 
2011
 
6.9%
  309,208     
Term loan: Nedbank Limited   
Receivables
 
ZAR
 
2006
 
15.5%
      244,382 
Installment sale: Wesbank Limited   
Machinery
 
ZAR
 
2010
 
11.0%
  446    9,242 
Hire purchase: Nedbank Limited   
Vehicles
 
ZAR
 
2008
 
9.5%
  35     
Bond finance: Nedbank Limited   
Land
 
ZAR
 
2012
 
9.4%
  5,990     
Loan from minority shareholders   
Land
 
ZAR
 
2012
 
12.9%
      6,699 
 
Unsecured                         
Term loan: FirstRand Bank Limited       
ZAR
 
2006
 
10.2%
      68,768 
Term loan: CommerzBank and Futuregrowth  
ZAR
 
2007
 
10.5%
  35,143    77,931 
Term loan: ABSA Bank Limited       
ZAR
 
2009
 
15.6%
  195,295    183,200 
Term loan: Nedbank Limited       
ZAR
 
2012
 
14.7%
  43,279    42,194 
Term loan: Rand Merchant Bank, Commerz Bank and   
ZAR
 
2009
 
8.9%
  196,844     
Standard Bank                         
Term loan: Bangkok Bank plc       
THB
 
2008
 
4.8%
      2,834 
Loan: Afrinacol Investment Limited       
ZAR
 
None
 
11.0%
  7,314    7,314 
Other loans       
various
 
various
 
various
  1,226    1,751 
Loans from minority shareholders       
ZAR
 
various
 
various
  23,184    26,782 
Preference share investments       
ZAR
 
2012
 
14.7%
  (16,532)   (28,068)
Right to subscription shares       
ZAR
 
various
 
various
  (148,204)   (306,830)
                    1,053,326    636,199 

 
F-58



NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
19.      LONG-TERM LIABILITIES (continued)                 
 
 
    Non-interest bearing: Programme and film rights                 
               
Year of final
 
2006
 
2005
    Liabilities    Currency   
repayment
 
R’000
 
R’000
    Unsecured                 
    Programme and film rights liabilities   
   EUR
 
2009
  302,403   
214,633
           
   USD
 
Various
  334,424   
243,942
                    636,827   
458,575
 
 
    Non-interest-bearing: Loans and other                 
               
Final
 
2006
 
2005
    Loans and liabilities   
Currency 
 
repayment
 
R’000
 
R’000
    Gordon Sports Properties   
ZAR
 
2013
  683    783 
    Tiscali International BV   
ZAR
 
2006
      40,114 
    Customer deposit   
THB
 
      36,909 
    Service Leaving Indemnity   
EUR
 
  10,398    9,272 
    Loans from minority shareholders   
various
 
various
  29,068    12,645 
    NetMed shareholders’ liability   
EUR
 
  593,090     
                    633,239    99,723 
 
    Total long-term liabilities                 
 
    Repayment terms of long-term liabilities (excluding capitalised finance leases)         
   
-
  payable within year one            1,411,467    657,994 
   
-
  payable within year two            420,036    255,390 
   
-
  payable within year three            233,344    104,413 
   
-
  payable within year four            89,200    71,111 
   
-
  payable within year five            89,261    1,299 
   
-
  payable after year five            80,084    119,849 
                    2,323,392    1,210,056 
    Interest rate profile of long-term liabilities (Long- and short-term portion, including capitalised finance leases)     
    - Loans at fixed rates: 1 - 12 months            211,811    132,656 
    - Loans at fixed rates: more than 12 months            1,837,197    2,081,435 
    - Interest free loans            1,270,066    558,298 
    - Loans linked to variable rates            736,029    420,775 
                    4,055,103    3,193,164 

In accordance with IFRS 1, Naspers elected not to restate its comparative information for the year ended March 31, 2006 in terms of IAS 39 and IAS 32. Information for the year ended March 31, 2005 is therefore prepared based on AC 133 Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement (Revised September 2002) and AC 125 Financial Instruments: Disclosure and Presentation (Issued August 1997) (“AC 125”) as applicable under SA GAAP. The effective date for the application of IAS 32 and IAS 39 for the group is April 1, 2005 and the group therefore applied these standards in accounting for financial instruments for the year ended March 31, 2006.
 
IAS 32 provides additional guidance on the classification of derivatives based on an entity’s own shares. The standard specifies that where an issuer has an obligation to purchase its own shares for cash or another financial asset, this will result in the recognition of a liability for the amount that the issuer is obliged to pay. In the application of AC 125 under SA GAAP, the raising of such a liability was not required.
 
On application of IAS 32 in the current year, put options as described above were identified at subsidiary entities within the group. As required by IFRS 1, the resulting liabilities were recognized at their fair value on April 1, 2005 directly in equity. Corresponding adjustments were made to long-term derivatives (Rand 203 million) and the current portion of non-interest bearing long-term liabilities (Rand 593 million), respectively. The movement in the fair value for the year ended March 31, 2006 is reflected in the income statement in “other (losses) / gains – net” (refer to note 25).
 
 
F-59



NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
20.  PROVISIONS 
                                   
 
The following account balances have been determined based on management’s estimates and assumptions: 
           
 
       
April 1,
2005
R’000
 
Additional
provisions
raised
R’000
 
Unutilized
provisions
reversed to
income
R’000
 
Credited/
charged to
other
accounts
R’000
 
Provisions
utilized
R’000
 
Foreign
currency
translation
R’000
 
March 31,
2006
R’000 
 
Less
short-term
portion
R’000 
 
Long-term
portion
R’000 
Group                                         
Warranties    3,889        (247)        (626)    (13)    3,003    (3,003)    
Pending litigation    25,862    7,622    (8,107)    1,683    (2,429)    (83)   24,548    (16,337)   8,211 
Discontinued operations    4,267                (4,267)                 
Reorganization    808                (808)                 
Onerous contracts    27,016    2,224    (11,257)   (1,494)   (4,158)    (891)   11,440    (6,640)   4,800 
Ad valorem duties    23,100                        23,100        23,100 
Redundancy    583                (577)    (6)            
Contract dispute    9,316            (9,921)       605             
Decommissioning costs    2,556    1,058                (66)   3,548        3,548 
Other        1,675                    735    2,410    (2,410)    
                                         
        99,072    10,904    (19,611)   (9,732)   (12,865)   281    68,049    (28,390)   39,659 
 
 
 

 
   
April 1,
2004
 
Additional
provisions
raised
 
Unutilized
provisions
reversed to
income
 
Provisions
utilized
 
Foreign
currency
translation
 
March 31,
2005
 
Less
short-term
portion
 
Long-term
portion 
   
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
 
R’000
Group                                 
Warranties    3,891    247        (188)    (61)    3,889    (3,889)     
Pending litigation    22,341    9,163    (4,065)    (1,445)    (132)    25,862    (21,830)    4,032 
Discontinued operations    20,786            (16,519)        4,267    (4,267)     
Reorganization    871    808        (871)        808    (808)     
Onerous contracts    14,514    14,868        (2,141)    (225)    27,016    (18,222)    8,794 
Ad valorem duties    23,100                    23,100    (23,100)     
Redundancy    592    9            (18)    583    (583)     
Contract dispute    9,465                (149)    9,316    (9,316)     
Decommissioning costs    2,415                141    2,556        2,556 
Other    4,990        (3,315)            1,675        1,675 
                                 
    102,965    25,095    (7,380)    (21,164)    (444)    99,072    (82,015)    17,057 
 
F-60

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
20.      PROVISIONS (continued)
 
  Further details describing the provisions at March 31, 2006 are included below:
 
  Irdeto provides a 12 month warranty on all hardware provided.
 
  The group is currently involved in various litigation matters. The litigation provision has been made based on legal counsel and management’s estimates of costs and claims relating to these actions (refer note 22).
 
  The provision for onerous contracts relates to obligations that the group has in terms of lease agreements, but the premises have been vacated. The group is liable for the rent under these contracts. The obligation will be settled over the remaining lease periods until 2010.
 
  The provision of Ad Valorem relates to an investigation by tax authorities in to the value ascribed to digital satellite decoders purchased for onward sale to major retailers. The provision was raised for the payment of these duties.
 
  The provision for decommissioning relates to the estimated costs of decommissioning rented buildings. The lease agreements require that we return the rented buildings in the original state.
 
  Other provisions relate to various liabilities of the group with uncertain timings and amounts.
 
 
 
21. 
  ACCRUED EXPENSES AND OTHER CURRENT LIABILITIES   
March 31   
       
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
 
    Deferred income    949,503    837,100 
    Accrued expenses    1,052,584    1,106,737 
    Amounts owing in respect of investments acquired    44,370    55,674 
    Taxes and social security    245,742    199,595 
    Bonus provision    142,488    59,813 
    Provision for leave    110,235    83,192 
    Other personnel provisions    41,749    27,514 
    Cash-settled share-based payment liability (short-term)    23,191    107,030 
    Other current liabilities    304,346    315,926 
        2,914,208    2,792,581 

22.      COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
 
  The group is subject to contingencies, which occur in the normal course of business including legal proceedings, and claims that cover a wide range of matters. These contingencies include contract and employment claims, product liability and warranty. None of these claims are expected to result in a material gain or loss to the group.
 
  (a)      Capital expenditure
 
  Commitments in respect of contracts placed for capital expenditure at March 31, 2006 amounted to Rand 445.4 million (2005: Rand 446.5 million).
 
  (b)      Programme and film rights
 
  At March 31, 2006 the group had entered into contracts for the purchase of programme and film rights. The group’s commitments in respect of these contracts amounted to Rand 1,425.9 million (2005: Rand 1,483.1 million).
 
  (c)      Set-top boxes
 
  At March 31, 2006 the group had entered into contracts for the purchase of set-top boxes (decoders). The group’s commitments in respect of these contracts amounted to Rand 265.7 million (2005: Rand 97.5 million).
 
 
F-61

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
22.      COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (continued)
 
  (d) Other commitments
 
  At March 31, 2006 the group had entered into contracts for the receipt of various services. These service contracts are for the receipt of advertising, security, cleaning, computer support services and contractual relationships with customers, suppliers and employees. The group’s commitments in respect of these agreements amounted to Rand 363.7 million (2005: Rand 358.3 million).
 
(e) Operating lease commitments
 
March 31
The group has the following operating lease liabilities at 31 March 2006 and 2005:   
2006
 
2005
   
R’000
 
R’000
Minimum operating lease payments         
Payable in year one    134,501    312,161 
Payable in year two    103,783    285,472 
Payable in year three    61,572    247,499 
Payable in year four    28,855    184,718 
Payable in year five    15,487    163,581 
Payable after five years    14,864    317,966 
    359,062    1,511,397 

The group leases office, manufacturing and warehouse space under various non-cancellable operating leases. Certain contracts contain renewal options and escalation clauses for various periods of time.
 
(f)  Litigation claims
 
Call Centre Nucleus (Proprietary) Limited
Call Centre Nucleus (Proprietary) Limited (“CCN”) has claimed approximately Rand 13.5 million from MWEB Holdings Limited arising out of the purchase of MWEB of a subscriber base from CCN. The matter has been referred to arbitration, but no further steps have been taken by CCN to proceed with the matter.
 
PaySmart Africa (Proprietary) Limited
PaySmart Africa (Proprietary) Limited (“Paysmart”) has claimed approximately Rand 10.4 million from Electronic Media Network Limited (“M-Net”) and Endemol South Africa Limited (“Endemol”) (in its capacity as producer of Big Brother Africa). Paysmart alleges that it would have realized this amount of M-Net and Endemol had granted to it the rights to provide an SMS voting system for Big Brother Africa and Idols, as allegedly contemplated in Head of Agreement executed by the parties in April 2003. Paysmart has not taken the proceedings any further at this stage.
 
Taxation matters
In December 2000, MultiChoice Hellas SA (“MCH”) received a tax assessment for approximately €5.4 million flowing from the tax treatment of advertising and marketing costs and municipal duties. The company challenged the assessment and the Court of First Instance found against the company. MCH appealed the decision and the Appeal Court found in favour of MCH. The tax authorities had a certain period of time within which to lodge a further appeal – this they failed to do. However, in February 2006 the tax authorities sent MCH a further assessment for the same amount plus arrear interest amounting to approximately € 8.0 million. MCH has advised the tax authorities that their claim is legally unjustified and, in any case, out of time. Nevertheless, the authorities have indicated that they intend pursuing their claim in the Greek courts.
 
Onshelf Trading Forth Four (Proprietary) Limited t/a Mail and Guardian Online (“Onshelf”) vs. Q-Online (Proprietary) Limited (“Q-Online”)
Onshelf (in which MWEB South Africa (“MWEB”)has a 65% shareholding), which had sold its Q business to Q-Online, issued summons against Q-Online for the payment of an outstanding portion of the purchase price of Rand 200,000. Q-Online then instituted a counterclaim for specific performance of the sale agreement and damages of between Rand 11.0 million and Rand 13.0 million. The litigation has reached the stage where the parties have exchanged discovery affidavits. MWEB believes that the damages claim is hugely inflated.
 
Equity compensation claims
Three former employees of the group have made claims against the Royal Bank of Canada Trustees Limited, being the trustees of the Mindport Share Trust, alleging that the trustees used an incorrect valuation methodology in valuing their scheme shares at the time of the cessation of their employment. Since these claims were made, one of these former employees has started legal proceedings against the Royal Bank of Canada Trustees Limited, which proceedings are being defended. A provision of Rand 8.8 million has been raised, and is included in the total provision in note 20.
 
 
F-62

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
22.      COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (continued)
 
  (f) Litigation claims (continued)
 
  Cyprus
 
  A. Lumiere TV Public Company Limited
 
  In February 2006, NetMed NV (“NetMed”) became aware of the fact that Lumiere TV Public Company Limited (“LTV”), its co-shareholder in MultiChoice Holdings (Cyprus) Limited (“Holdings”) (which, in turn, owns the majority of the shares in a listed entity, MultiChoice (Cyprus) Public Company Limited (“MCC”)) , had entered into arrangements with CYTA (the Cyprus Telecommunications Authority) which NetMed believed were in conflict with LTV’s contractual obligations to NetMed, Holdings, MCC and certain of NetMed’s affiliates, specifically such obligations as flow from a Shareholders’ Agreement dated June 23, 2000 between NetMed, LTV and Holdings (“the Shareholders Agreement”), a Channel Distribution Agreement of June 21, 2004 between MCC and LTV (the “CDA”) and a programme supply agreement dated January 1, 2004 between LTV and affiliates of NetMed (the “PSA”).
 
  Pursuant to the abovementioned facts the following proceedings have been instituted:
 
1.      NetMed and Holdings have commenced arbitration proceedings under the auspices of the London Court of International Arbitration (“LCIA”) against LTV, claiming, inter alia, an injunction to restrain LTV from breaching its contractual obligations under the Shareholders Agreement as well as damages for breach of contract.
 
2.      MCC and NetMed are also participating in an enquiry launched by the CPC (the Cypriot Competition Protection Committee) as to the validity, from a competition law perspective, of the proposed arrangements between LTV and CYTA.
 
3.      Holdings and MCC have instituted legal proceedings against LTV’s erstwhile nominees on the Holdings and MCC boards of directors (who had resigned in February when news of the proposed arrangements with CYTA became public) on the basis that they had breached their fiduciary duties as directors.
 
4.      Holdings and NetMed have instituted injunction proceedings against LTV in Cyprus in support of the Arbitration referred to in 1 above.
 
5.      In March 2006, LTV proposed a public offer in terms whereof it offered the shareholders of MCC to acquire their shares in MCC either for cash or for shares in LTV. The Public Offer is conditional, inter alia, upon the CPC declaring the CDA and the non-compete provisions in the Shareholders’ Agreement to be invalid. The validity of these agreements is currently being reviewed by the CPC and NetMed, MCC and Holdings are participating in the hearings relating thereto. The public offer terminated on June 5, 2006.
 
B. Lefkoniko
In 2005 MCC instituted action against Lefkoniko, a Cypriot financial institution, to recover monies that it had invested with Lefkoniko. In order to expedite proceedings, MCC applied for summary judgment alleging that Lefkoniko did not have a proper defense to its claim. The application was heard in October and on November 11, the court gave judgment in MCC’s favour. Since then further proceedings have been instituted in the Cypriot courts to give effect to the summary judgment against Lefkoniko. A provision for this claim has been raised during 2005.
 
Greece
On February 23, 2006, NetMed Hellas Pay TV SA filed a request for arbitration under the auspices of the LCIA against the Greek football club PAE Akratitos (“Akratitos”) on the basis that Akratitos had breached its TV Rights Agreement with NetMed Hellas. The claimant is claiming a declaration that Akratitos had breached the agreement, specific performance and damages from Akratitos.
 
Electronic Media Network Limited (“M-Net”)
Gold Reef City has instituted a claim for damages of Rand 10.6 million against M-Net arising from a statement in a Carte Blanche programme that the Gold Reef City amusement rides were not safe. The matter is proceeding.
 
MultiChoice South Africa (“MCSA”)
MCSA has recently appealed to the High Court against an ad valorem tariff determination on decoders made by the South African Revenue Services (“SARS”) in 2004. SARS have given notice that they will defend the application. A provision of Rand 23.1 million has been raised, and is included in the total provision in note 20.
 
Zietsman Patent Infringement
In December 2004, DW Zietsman instituted action against Endemol South Africa, M-Net, Multichoice Africa (Pty) Ltd, Vodacom and iTouch alleging that the defendants had, in the course of certain Big Brother television shows, infringed a patent belonging to him and that he had, as a result of such infringement, suffered unspecified damages. The defendants are defending the action and the matter is proceeding.
 
 
F-63



NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
22.      COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (continued)
 
  (g)      Guarantees
 
  At March 31, 2006 the group had provided guarantees of Rand 26.0 million (2005: Rand 33.3 million) mainly in respect of office rental, services and other contracts.
 
  (h)      Assets pledged as security
 
  The group pledged property, plant and equipment, investments, cash and cash equivalents and accounts receivable with a net carrying value of Rand 1,562.0 million at March 31, 2006 (2005: Rand 538.8 million) to a number of banks as security for certain term loans and bank overdrafts.
 
  The group plans to fund the above commitments and liabilities out of existing loan facilities and internally generated funds.
 
       
March 31   
23.    REVENUE   
 2006 
 
 2005 
       
R’000 
 
R’000 
 
    Revenues - continuing operations         
    Subscription revenue    8,236,706    7,136,234 
    Hardware sales    510,325    436,646 
    Technology revenue    390,714    280,872 
    Circulation revenue    915,077    796,745 
    Advertising revenue    2,489,890    2,035,946 
    Distribution revenue    139,765    97,452 
    Printing revenue    751,476    654,824 
    Book publishing & book sales revenue    856,858    709,822 
    Tuition fees    485,943    480,381 
    e-Commerce revenue    304,253    229,645 
    Other revenue    625,417    659,280 
        15,706,424    13,517,847 
 
    Revenue - discontinuing operations         
    United Broadcasting Corporation    307,163    374,238 
    MKSC World Dot Com Company    51,510    66,663 
        358,673    440,901 
 
    Other revenues include revenues from decoder maintenance, backhaul charges and financing service fees.     
 
 
    Barter revenue         
    Amount of barter revenue included in total revenue    47,239    38,430 
 
    Amount of barter revenue included in deferred income    9,106    4,457 
 
 
F-64

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)         
       
March 31
24.    EXPENSES BY NATURE   
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
    Operating profit includes the following items:         
 
    Depreciation classification         
    Cost of providing services and sale of goods    411,653     366,676  
    Selling, general and administration expenses    157,186     148,765  
        568,839     515,441  
    Amortization classification         
    Cost of providing services and sale of goods    59,625     6,380  
    Selling, general and administration expenses    35,664     50,512  
        95,289     56,892  
    Operating leases         
    Buildings    113,035     120,686  
    Satellite and transponders    5,940     35,102  
    Other equipment    23,070     21,985  
        142,045     177,773  
    Transportation         
    Net transportation costs (including fuel)    222,635     77,416  
 
    Auditors’ remuneration         
    Audit fees    33,028     23,937  
    Audit related fees    4,092     8,679  
    Tax fees    4,167     6,043  
    All other fees    8,496     5,539  
        49,783     44,198  
    Forex profits/(losses)         
    On capitalization of forward exchange contracts in hedging transactions    5,069     2,525  
    On derecognition of embedded derivatives    (127,822)    (204,726) 
    Other    4,043     (485) 
        (118,710)    (202,686) 
 
 
F-65



NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)         
       
March 31
24.    EXPENSES BY NATURE (continued)   
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
    Staff costs         
    As at March 31, 2006, the group had 12,067 (2005: 12,072) permanent employees.         
 
    The total cost of employment of all employees, including directors, was as follows:         
 
    Salaries, wages and bonuses    2,434,244    2,025,953 
    Retirement benefit costs (defined contribution plan)    177,937    170,414 
    Retirement benefit costs (defined benefit plan)    764    2,431 
    Medical aid fund contributions    153,434    125,189 
    Post-retirement benefits    19,007    6,706 
    Training costs    26,179    26,819 
    Share-based compensation charges    135,494    129,989 
    Total staff costs    2,947,059    2,487,501 
 
    Fees paid to non-employees for         
    administration, management and technical         
    services    201,093    137,367 
 
    Research and development costs    54,921    10,104 
 
    Advertising expenses    491,091    443,056 
 
    Programme & film rights directly expensed    3,205,132    3,273,609 
 
    Amortization of programme & film rights    1,125,783    1,114,939 
 
    Cost of inventories recognized as expense in ’providing services’    2,226,031    1,091,570 
 
 
F-66


 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
       
March 31
25.    OTHER (LOSSES) / GAINS - NET   
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
 
    Dividends - listed investments    574      
 
    Dividends - unlisted investments    1,596     780  
 
    Profit on sale of assets    15,370     7,392  
 
    Fair value adjustment for shareholders’ liabilities    49,764     –   
 
    Impairment losses    (69,152)    (20,045) 
         Impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets    (69,847)    (13,003) 
         Impairment of property, plant & equipment and other assets    (326)    (5,333) 
         Reversal of impairment of property, plant & equipment and other assets    2,488     –   
         Other impairments    (1,467)    (1,709) 
 
    Compensation received from third parties for property,         
    plant & equipment impaired, lost or stolen    1,841     171  
 
    Other (losses) / gains - net    (7)    (11,702) 
 
26.    FINANCE COSTS - NET         
 
    Interest paid         
    Loans and overdrafts    212,056     216,004  
    Finance lease equipment    176,601     173,296  
    Other    9,164     23,921  
        397,821     413,221  
    Interest capitalized to fixed assets    (4,074)    –   
    Preference dividends and rights    (118,451)    (126,920) 
        275,296     286,301  
    Interest received         
    Loans and bank accounts    (279,458)    (176,056) 
 
    Net (profit) / loss from foreign exchange translation    21,819     (2,100) 
    On translation of normal assets and liabilities    72,034     (27,335) 
    On translation of transponder leases    (49,164)    25,950  
    On translation of loans    (1,051)    (715) 
    Net (profit) / loss from fair value adjustments on derivative         
    financial instruments    (6,225)    108,859  
    On translation of forward exchange contracts    57,682     167,703  
    On accounting for embeddeded derivatives    (63,907)    (58,844) 
 
    Finance costs - net    11,432     217,004  
 
 
F-67


 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)         
       
March 31   
27.    TAXATION   
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
 
    Normal taxation         
    South Africa    726,067     211,004  
         Current year    739,734     265,051  
         Prior year    (13,667)   
   (54,047) 
    Foreign taxation    158,066     16,006  
         Current year    153,563     105,025  
         Prior year    4,503    
   (89,019) 
    Secondary taxation on companies    21,230     37,840  
    Income taxation for the year    905,363     264,850  
    Deferred taxation    29,450     (8,388) 
         Current year    (20,519)    286,888  
         Change in rate    35,472     (5,829) 
         Prior year    (73,495)   
(391,825) 
         Foreign    87,992     102,378  
    Total tax per income statement    934,813     256,462  
 
    Reconciliation of taxation         
    Taxation at statutory rates    1,061,313     674,899  
    Adjusted for:         
         Non-deductable expenses    47,037     138,218  
         Non-taxable income    (124,086)   
(172,977) 
         Unprovided timing differences    5,433     161,631  
         Assessed losses utilized    (120,748)   
   (29,095) 
         Assessed losses expired    –      (4,049) 
         Prior year adjustments    (82,659)   
(534,890) 
         Other taxes    113,051     28,555  
         Changes in taxation rates    35,472     (5,829) 
    Taxation provided in income statement    934,813    256,462 
 
 
F-68

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
28.         DISCONTINUING OPERATIONS
 
United Broadcasting Corporation Public Company Limited and MKSC World Dot Com Co. Limited
On November 7, 2005, the group publicly announced that it had entered into an agreement in terms of which it would sell its entire interest in United Broadcasting Corporation and MKSC World Dot Com Company to True Corporation for a gross amount of approximately US$164 million. This transaction was concluded on January 6, 2006. The results of these operations were previously included in the pay television and internet segments of the group.
 
Selected financial information relating to these operations:         
   
March 31   
   
2006
 
2005
   
R’000
 
R’000
Profit from discontinued operations         
Revenue    358,673     440,901  
Cost of providing services and sale of goods    (249,416)    (316,908) 
Selling, general and administration expenses    (43,244)    (56,697) 
Other (losses)/gains - net    5,710     (441) 
Operating profit    71,723     66,855  
Finance Costs - net    (8,476)    (16,809) 
Profit before taxation    63,247     50,046  
Taxation    (19,029)    (4) 
Net profit for the year    44,218     50,042  
 
Attributable to:         
Equity holders of the Group    43,107     50,352  
Minority interest    1,111     (310) 
    44,218     50,042  
 
Profit arising on discontinuance of operations         
Profit on disposal of United Broadcasting Corporation    972,882      
Profit on disposal of MKSC World Dot Com Company    59,278      
    1,032,160     
 
Cash flow information         
Amounts of net cash flow relating to the discontinued operation:         
 
Operating cash flow    79,104     98,311  
Investing activities    (33,015)    (31,730) 
Financing activities    (6,247)    (8,636) 
Net cash flow    39,842    57,945 

Lyceum College
 
Effective as at the end of September 2001, the group terminated the operations of Lyceum College, a distance-learning operation. The decision was taken to embark on a teach-out programme for students enrolled under current course programmes. Current students were allowed to complete their current courses, but no new enrolments were allowed. During the current year, the group utilized the remaining provision for discontinued operations of Rand 4.3 million and incurred additional net teach-out and other related closure costs of approximately Rand 12.4 million. The results of this operation were previously included in the group’s private education segment. Total revenue for the year amounted to Rand 7.8 million (2005: Rand 14.1 million).
 
 
F-69

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
       
       
March 31   
29.    EARNINGS PER SHARE   
   2006
 
 2005
       
   R’000
 
 R’000
    Earnings         
         Net profit attributable to shareholders    3,190,188    2,384,762  
    Headline adjustments         
    Profits    (82,836)   (375,425) 
         Reversal of impairment charge    (1,473)   –   
         Disposal of investments and businesses    (65,821)   (440) 
         Profit on sale of assets    (15,542)   (6,949) 
         Dilution profits    –     (368,036) 
    Losses    2,023    7,042  
         Impairment of assets    225    3,716  
         Impairment of associates    –     1,709  
         Impairment of investments    1,467    –   
         Impairment of other assets    331    1,617  
    Impairment and reversal of impairment of goodwill    69,009    8,011  
    Profit arising on discontinuance of operations    (1,032,160)   –   
    Headline earnings    2,146,224    2,024,390 
    Headline profit from discontinued operations      (31,816)   (50,042)
    Headline earnings from continuing operations    2,114,408    1,974,348 
 
 
    Number of N ordinary shares in issue at year end    290,554,814     282,589,683  
     Adjusted for movement in shares held by share trusts    (6,835,955)    (5,296,139) 
    Weighted average number of N ordinary shares in issue during the year    283,718,859     277,293,544  
     Adjusted for effect of future share based compensation payments    16,523,922     15,832,724  
    Diluted weighted average number of N ordinary shares in issue during the year    300,242,781    293,126,268 
 
 
    Earnings per N ordinary share (cents)         
         Basic    1,124     860  
         Fully diluted    1,063     814  
    Headline earnings per N ordinary share (cents)         
         Basic    756     730  
         Fully diluted    715     690  
 
    Discontinuing operations         
    Headline earnings per N ordinary share (cents)         
         Basic    11     18  
         Fully diluted    11     17  
 
 
F-70

 

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
       
March 31   
30.    CASH FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES   
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
 
    Operating profit per income statement    3,004,050    2,468,841 
    Operating profit from discontinued operations    59,311    66,855 
        3,063,361    2,535,696 
    Adjustments:         
    - Non-cash and other    832,854    728,425 
     Profit on sale of property, plant and equipment    (21,079)   (6,949)
     Depreciation and amortization    691,258    612,964 
     Share-based compensation expenses    112,560    129,989 
     Other    50,115    (7,579)
    - Working capital    123,690    (212,856)
       Cash movement in trade and other receivables    (389,247)   (147,026)
       Cash movement in payables, provisions and accruals    479,272    (138,785)
       Cash payments for programme and film rights    171,781    90,019 
       Cash movement in inventories    (138,116)   (17,064)
             
    Cash from operating activities    4,019,905    3,051,265 
 
31.    ACQUISITION OF SUBSIDIARIES         
 
    Fair value of assets and liabilities acquired:         
     Property, Plant and Equipment    30,885    7,045 
     Intangible assets    –     246,806 
     Net current assets/(liabilities)    21,036    (39,600)
     Deferred taxation    (5,087)   (49,833)
     Long-term liabilities    –     (885)
        46,834    163,533 
    Minority shareholders’ interest    –     (5,000)
    Goodwill    9,145    152,365 
    Purchase consideration    55,979    310,898 
    Cash in subsidiaries acquired    (13,060)   (40,053)
    Net cash outflow from acquisition of subsidiaries    42,919    270,845 
 
32.    DISPOSAL OF SUBSIDIARIES         
 
    Book value of assets and liabilities:         
           Property, Plant and Equipment    3,928    1,674 
           Goodwill and intangible assets    2,639    1,680 
           Net current assets    11,956    1,691 
           Deferred taxation    (7,677)   (1,274)
           Long-term liabilities        (619)
        10,846    3,152 
    Minority shareholders’ interest        (5,017)
    Profit on sale    56,663    9,349 
    Selling price    67,509    7,484 
    Cash in subsidiaries disposed of    (30,783)   363 
    Net cash inflow from disposal of subsidiaries    36,726    7,847 
 
F-71


 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
33.        PARTIAL DISPOSAL OF INTEREST IN JOINT VENTURES
       
March 31   
       
2006
 
2005
       
R’000
 
R’000
 
    Property, plant and equipment    90,238    42,489 
    Investments and loans    5,097     
    Goodwill and intangible assets    8,224    96,360 
    Net current assets    86,210     
    Long-term liabilities    (118,174)    
    Foreign currency translation release        (23,197)
        71,595    115,652 
    Minority shareholders’ interest    (5,789)   (483,244)
    Profit on sale    933,472     367,592 
    Selling price    999,278     
    Cash in joint ventures disposed of    (247,433)   (188,097)
    Net cash inflow / (outflow) on disposal of interest in joint ventures    751,845    (188,097)
 
 
34.    CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS         
    Cash and deposits    6,775,542    4,033,796 
    Bank overdrafts and call loans    (364,777)   (433,339)
        6,410,765    3,600,457 

 
Restricted cash
 
The following cash balances are restricted from immediate use according to agreements with banks and other financial institutions:
 
 
    South Africa    -    52,139
    Meditteranean    212    1,163
    Netherlands     233,085    1,922
    China     -    8
    Thailand    484    1,293
    USA     3,987   1,145
    Total restricted cash   237,768    58,120
         
 
                   

F-72

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
35.      BUSINESS AND GEOGRAPHICAL SEGMENTS
 
  Primary reporting format – business segments
 
  The group has determined that its primary reporting format for segments is based on its method of internal reporting that disaggregates its businesses by service or product. The group’s reportable business segments are electronic media, print media and corporate services. Electronic media is further disaggregated into pay television, internet, conditional access systems and Entriq. The print media segment is further disaggregated into newspapers, magazines and printing, books and education. The group’s business is conducted in the following main business segments:
 
  Electronic media
 
  Pay television - through the group’s subsidiaries, associated companies and joint ventures based in South Africa, sub-Saharan Africa, Cyprus and Greece, which generate revenue mainly from local customers.
 
  Internet - through the group’s subsidiaries, associated companies and joint ventures based in South Africa, sub-Saharan Africa, Thailand and China which generate revenue mainly from local customers.
 
  Conditional access systems – through Irdeto provides digital content management and protections systems to customers globally.
 
  Entriq – to protect, manage and monetize all digital media worldwide on any platform.
 
  Print media
 
  Newspapers, magazines and printing - through the group’s subsidiaries, joint ventures and associated companies in Southern Africa, which publish, print and distribute various newspapers and magazines for the local market.
 
  Books - through the group’s subsidiaries in Southern Africa, which generate income mainly from local customers.
 
  Private education - through the group’s subsidiaries in South Africa, which generate income mainly from local customers.
 
  Corporate services – represent the group’s holding company and head office infrastructure.
 
  The accounting policies applied by the reportable segments are consistent with the accounting policies applied in the consolidated financial statements, as described in note 3.
 
 
 
F-73

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS             
(CONTINUED)                                         
 
35.   
BUSINESS AND GEOGRAPHICAL SEGMENTS (continued) 
                           
 
       
  Electronic media   
 
  Print media   
           
March 2006    
Pay
television 
R’000
 
Internet
R’000
 
Conditional
access
systems
R’000
 
Entriq
R’000
 
Newspapers,
magazines &
printing
R’000
 
Books
R’000
 
Private
education
R’000
 
Corporate
services
R’000
 
Eliminations
R’000
 
 Consolidated
total
R’000
Revenue                                         
External    8,903,324     897,992     352,320     65,864     3,983,131     980,933     536,338     9,805     (23,283)    15,706,424  
Intersegmental    8,280     31,301     112,965     7,538     885,790     21,971     773     73,944     (1,142,562)     
Total revenue    8,911,604     929,293     465,285     73,402     4,868,921     1,002,904     537,111     83,749     (1,165,845)    15,706,424  
Cost of providing services and sale of goods    (4,863,668)    (501,503)    (123,419)    (25,244)    (3,309,974)    (620,570)    (277,032)    (67,364)    1,035,084     (8,753,690) 
Selling, general and administration expenses    (1,296,260)    (578,832)    (342,653)    (213,325)    (960,790)    (311,765)    (301,043)    (74,770)    130,761     (3,948,677) 
Other (losses) / gains - net    33,768     (1,548)    411     (2)    13,937     (3,800)    (42,799)    26     –      (7) 
Operating profit/(loss)    2,785,444     (152,590)    (376)    (165,169)    612,094     66,769     (83,763)    (58,359)    –      3,004,050  
Finance costs - net    (106,029)    70,254     7,716    6,124    (69,113)    68     (29,347)    108,895     –      (11,432) 
Share of equity accounted results    3,755     150,264             (2,791)    49             –      151,277  
Profit / (loss) on sale of investments                    (1,133)    56,772     334     18,393     –      74,366  
Profit/(loss) before taxation    2,683,170     67,928     7,340     (159,045)    539,057     123,658     (112,776)    68,929     –      3,218,261  
Taxation    (790,098)    (59,706)    (4,912)    698    (76,201)    1,309     93     (5,996)    –      (934,813) 
Net profit/(loss) from continuing operations    1,893,072     8,222     2,428     (158,347)   462,856     124,967     (112,683)    62,933     –      2,283,448  
Profit/(loss) from discontinued operations    43,810     408                     (12,402)        –      31,816  
Profit arising on discontinuance of operations    972,882     59,278                             –      1,032,160  
Net profit/(loss)    2,909,764     67,908     2,428     (158,347)    462,856     124,967     (125,085)    62,933         3,347,424  
Attributable to:                                         
Equity holders of the group    2,822,897     54,277     2,428     (158,347)    419,679     111,567     (125,352)    63,039         3,190,188  
Minority interest    86,867     13,631             43,177     13,400     267     (106)    –     157,236  
        2,909,764     67,908     2,428    (158,347)    462,856     124,967     (125,085)    62,933         3,347,424  
 
Segment assets    7,907,837     1,659,436     509,396    89,894     3,286,504     553,396     514,438     9,961,390     (7,980,634)    16,501,657  
Investments in associates    32,378     773,064             292,887     3,956         205,880         1,308,165  
Segment liabilities    10,161,933     2,138,130     617,814    870,961     2,373,326     304,970     781,630     (504,143)    (7,544,167)    9,200,454  
Capital expenditure    285,643     69,298     17,286    27,905     535,555     45,044     38,649     5,360         1,024,740  
Amortisation of programme and film rights*    1,125,783                                     1,125,783  
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment    344,748     63,854     13,026     12,291     130,118     9,082     20,368     2,059         595,546  
Amortisation of intangible assets    9,075     53,411     6,267         17,225     4,018     2,543     3,173         95,712  
Impairment of tangible assets                        326         –         326  
Impairment of intangible assets    9,144     95             557     4,166     55,885             69,847  
Reversal of impairment of tangible assets                    1,706     369                 2,075  
Reversal of impairment of intangible assets                        413                 413  
* - Included in operating profit                                         

 
F-74

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS             
(CONTINUED)                                         
 
35. BUSINESS AND GEOGRAPHICAL SEGMENTS (continued)                             
 
 
   
Electronic media
 
Print media
           
March 2005   
Pay
television
R’000
 
Internet
R’000
 
Conditional
access
systems
R’000
 
Entriq
R’000
 
Newspapers,
magazines &
printing
R’000
 
Books
R’000
 
Education
R’000
 
Corporate
services
R’000
 
Eliminations
R’000
 
Consolidated
total
R’000
Revenue                                         
External    7,746,628     696,265     255,330     33,877     3,374,106     860,581     547,186     3,889     (15)    13,517,847  
Intersegmental    23,938     13,680     78,667     20,514     86,750     22,629     449     62,227     (308,854)     
Total revenue    7,770,566     709,945     333,997     54,391     3,460,856     883,210     547,635     66,116     (308,869)    13,517,847  
Cost of providing services and sale of goods    (4,378,632)    (362,864)    (101,355)    (11,745)    (2,114,382)    (539,691)    (257,645)    (58,648)    99,143     (7,725,819) 
Selling, general and administration expenses    (1,273,513)    (410,853)    (279,628)    (132,131)    (821,709)    (288,529)    (264,338)    (50,510)    209,726     (3,311,484) 
Other (losses) / gains - net    1,429     (3,852)    454     250     3,485     (2,181)    (3,051)    (8,236)        (11,702) 
Operating profit/(loss)    2,119,850     (67,624)    (46,532)    (89,235)    528,250     52,809     22,601     (51,278)        2,468,841  
Finance costs - net    (249,772)    64,575     17,866     10,926     (49,552)    (12,721)    (23,349)    25,023         (217,004) 
Share of equity accounted results    4,558     83,878             161                     88,597  
Profit / (loss) on sale of Investments    15         18,659             (1,074)    9,350     (27,261)        (311) 
Dilution profits / (losses)        374,501             (3,007)    (3,097)        (361)        368,036  
Profit/(loss) before taxation    1,874,651     455,330     (10,007)    (78,309)    475,852     35,917     8,602     (53,877)        2,708,159  
Taxation    (80,959)    (107,510)    (1,834)    (2,019)    (88,220)    30,132     (2,610)    (3,442)        (256,462) 
Net profit/(loss) from continuing operations    1,793,692     347,820     (11,841)    (80,328)    387,632     66,049     5,992     (57,319)        2,451,697  
Profit/(Loss) from discontinued operations    54,342     (4,300)                                50,042  
Net profit/(loss)    1,848,034     343,520     (11,841)    (80,328)    387,632     66,049     5,992     (57,319)        2,501,739  
 
Attributable to:                                         
Equity holders of the Group    1,780,080     343,212     (11,841)    (80,328)    354,019     50,906     5,992     (57,278)        2,384,762  
Minority interest    67,954     308             33,613     15,143         (41)        116,977  
    1,848,034     343,520     (11,841)    (80,328)    387,632     66,049     5,992     (57,319)        2,501,739  
 
Segment assets    8,670,585    6,134,569    1,807,057    57,564    2,491,980    680,506    528,388    1,199,380    (8,384,190)    13,185,839 
Investments in associates    21,412    805,114            1,586    3,907        5,669        837,688 
Segment liabilities    11,465,857    4,507,198    407,329    704,231    1,498,068    656,270    656,773    (3,263,507)    (8,401,349)    8,230,870 
Capital expenditure    142,243    74,182    40,922    18,532    299,603    29,419    24,339    11,143        640,383 
Amortization of programme and film rights*    1,151,538                                    1,151,538 
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment    331,389    63,132    11,511    4,486    115,402    11,423    16,955    1,235        555,533 
Amortization of intangible assets    15,520    11,365            25,291    4,359    896            57,431 
Impairment of tangible assets                        3,069    409            3,478 
Impairment of intangible assets        12,495                508                13,003 
* - Included in operating profit                                         

 
F-75

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
35.      BUSINESS AND GEOGRAPHICAL SEGMENTS (continued)
 
  Secondary reporting format – geographical segments
 
  The group operates in five main geographical areas:
 
  Africa - The group derives revenues from television platform services, print media activities, internet services, technology products and services, book publishing and private education. The activities in the Republic of South Africa are the most significant in this segment and therefore South Africa has been presented separately.
 
  United States of America - The group’s activities comprise a portion of services and goods rendered by the technology operations, based in the United States of America.
 
  Greece and Cyprus - The group generates revenue from television platform services with operations in Greece and Cyprus.
 
  Asia - The group’s activities comprise its interest in internet activities based in Thailand and China. Furthermore, the group generates revenue from interactive television and technology products and services, provided by subsidiaries based in the Netherlands.
 
  Other - Includes the group’s provision of interactive television and technology products through subsidiaries, located mainly in the Netherlands.
 
   
Africa
                           
   
South
Africa
R’000
 
Rest of
Africa
R’000
 
USA
R’000
 
Greece and
Cyprus
R’000
 
Asia
R’000
 
Other
R’000
 
Eliminations
R’000
     
Consoli-
dated
total
R’000
March 2006                                     
External revenue    11,993,868    1,837,828    48,825    1,469,148    77,977    278,778            15,706,424 
Segment assets    19,095,383    2,310,481    108,479    1,155,227    1,347,838    15,551,875    (23,067,626)    (a)    16,501,657 
Capital expenditure    806,074    16,007    29,049    109,563    50,463    13,584            1,024,740 
Impairment of tangible assets    326                                326 
Impairment of intangible assets    69,847                                69,847 
March 2005                                     
External revenue    10,140,059    1,545,290    46,871    1,432,795    229,721    123,111            13,517,847 
Segment assets    10,675,600    2,046,555    114,622    1,120,533    6,081,407    12,297,664    (19,150,542)    (a)    13,185,839 
Capital expenditure    456,215    25,464    18,532    11,242    71,047    57,883            640,383 
Impairment of tangible assets    3,478                                3,478 
Impairment of intangible assets    508                12,495                13,003 

(a)    Represents adjustments to the assets and liabilities of the segments relating to intersegment loans and investments that eliminate on consolidation.
 
 
 
F-76

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
36.   FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT
 
   Financial risk factors
 
The group’s activities expose it to a variety of financial risks, including the effects of changes in debt and equity markets, foreign currency exchange rates and interest rates. The group’s overall risk management programme focuses on the unpredictability of financial markets and seeks to minimize the potential adverse effects on the financial performance of the group. The group uses derivative financial instruments, such as forward exchange contracts and interest rate swaps, to hedge certain risk exposures. The group does not speculate with, or engage in the trading of financial instruments.
 
Risk management is carried out by the management of the group under policies approved by the board of directors. Management identifies, evaluates and hedges financial risks. The various boards of directors within the group provide written policies covering specific areas, such as foreign exchange risk, interest rate risk, credit risk, the use of derivative instruments and the investment of excess liquidity.
 
  Foreign exchange risk
 
The group operates internationally and is exposed to foreign exchange risk arising from various currency exposures, primarily with respect to the US dollar. Entities in the group use forward exchange contracts to hedge their exposure to foreign currency risk in connection with their functional currencies. Management is responsible for hedging the net position in each foreign currency by using forward currency contracts. The group generally covers forward 80% to 100% of firm commitments in foreign currency for up to two years.
 
The group has classified some of its forward exchange contracts relating to forecasted transactions and firm commitments as cash flow hedges, and states them at fair value. The transactions relate mainly to programming costs, transponder lease installments and the acquisition of inventory items. An after tax loss of Rand 20.2 million (2005: Rand 18.9 million loss) has been deferred in a hedging reserve at March 31, 2006. This amount is expected to realize as an expense over the next two years. Changes in the fair value of forward exchange contracts that economically hedge monetary liabilities in foreign currencies and for which no hedge accounting is applied, are recognized in the income statement. Both the changes in fair value of the forward contracts and the foreign exchange gains and losses relating to the monetary items are recognized as part of “finance costs - net” (see note 26).
 
The fair value of all forward exchange contracts at March 31, 2006 was a net liability of Rand 101.9 million (2005: Rand 273.2 million), comprising assets of Rand 0.3 million (2005: Rand 10.3 million) and liabilities of Rand 102.2 million (2005: Rand 283.5 million), that were recognized as derivative financial instruments. The fair value of embedded derivative instruments, mainly relating to programming contracts with content providers, at March 31, 2006 was a net asset of Rand 166.5 million (2005: Rand 179.9 million), comprising assets of Rand 167.1 million (2005: Rand 192.0 million) and liabilities of Rand 0.6 million (2005: Rand 12.1 million), that were recognized in derivative assets and liabilities.
 
  Credit risk
 
Receivables consist primarily of invoiced amounts from normal trading activities. The group has a large diversified customer base across many geographical areas. Strict credit control is exercised through monitoring customers’ payment history and when necessary, provision is made for specific doubtful accounts. As at March 31, 2006, the directors were unaware of any significant unprovided or uninsured concentration of credit risk.
 
The group is exposed to certain concentrations of credit risk relating to its cash and current investments. It places its cash and current investments mainly with major banking groups and high-quality institutions that have high credit ratings. The group’s policy is designed to limit exposure to any one institution and invests its excess cash in low-risk investment accounts. The counterparties that are used by the group are evaluated on a continuous basis. At March 31, 2006 cash and current investments were held with numerous financial institutions.
 
 
F-77

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
36.      FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (continued)
 
  Liquidity risk
 
  Prudent liquidity risk management implies maintaining sufficient cash and marketable securities, the availability of funding through an adequate amount of committed credit facilities and the ability to close out market positions. In terms of the articles of association of the company, no limitation is placed on its borrowing capacity. The facilities expiring within one year are subject to renewal at various dates during the next year. The group had the following unutilized banking facilities as at March 31, 2006 and 2005:
 
 
    
                   March 31   
   
2006
 
2005
   
R’000
 
R’000
 
On call   
   252,200 
  944,313 
Expiring within one year   
1,554,539 
  4,339 
   
1,806,739 
  948,652 
 
The facilities expiring within one year are annual facilities
subject to review at various dates during the next year.
       

  Interest rate risk
 
As part of the process of managing the group’s fixed and floating borrowings mix, the interest rate characteristics of new borrowings and the refinancing of existing borrowings are positioned according to expected movements in interest rates. Where appropriate, the group uses derivative instruments, such as interest rate swap agreements, purely for hedging purposes. The interest rate profile of the loans as at March 31, 2006 was as follows:
 
   
Interest-free
R’000
 
Floating
R’000
 
Fixed - 12
months
R’000
 
Fixed more
than 12
months
R’000
 
Total
R’000
 
Loans    1,270,066    
   736,029  
  211,811    
 1,837,197  
 
4,055,103  
% of loans                         31%    18%    5%    46%    100% 

 
F-78

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
36.     
FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (continued)
 
Foreign exchange rates
 
  The exchange rates used by the group to translate foreign entities’ income statements and balance sheets are as follows:
 
 
 
   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
Currency (1FC = ZAR)                                
Average
rate
 
Closing
rate
 
Average
rate
 
Closing
rate
 
USA dollar    6.3915    6.1490    6.2146    6.2114 
Cyprus pound    13.0127    12.9453    13.5045        13.7862 
Euro    7.7570    7.4636    7.8428    8.0539 
Nigerian naira    0.0478    0.0482    0.0464    0.0467 
Thai baht    0.1581    0.1583    0.1546    0.1583 
Chinese yuan renminbi    0.7871    0.7671    0.7507    0.7505 

The average rates listed above are only approximate average rates for the year. The group measures separately the transactions of each of its material operations using the particular currency of the primary economic environment in which the operation conducts its business, translated at the prevailing exchange rate on the transaction date.
 
   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
   
Assets
R’000
 
Liabilities
R’000
 
Assets
R’000
 
Liabilities
R’000
Derivative financial instruments                 
 
       Current portion                 
       Foreign exchange contracts    279    92,337    9,326    283,492 
       Embedded derivatives    134,404    525    160,384    2,484 
    134,683    92,862    169,710    285,976 
 
       Non-current portion                 
       Foreign exchange contracts        9,908    941    - 
       Embedded derivatives    32,647    122    31,631    9,642 
       Paarl Media shareholders’ liability (1)        202,634        - 
    32,647    212,664    32,572    9,642 
Total    167,330    305,526    202,282    295,618 
 
Note:                 
(1) Refer to note 19 for additional information                 

 
F-79

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
36. FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (continued)

 
   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
   
Foreign
currency
amount
’000
 
R’000
 
Foreign
currency
amount
’000
 
R’000
Foreign currency exchange commitments
    The group had the following forward foreign
    currency exchange contract commitments:
 
 
           
USA dollar                         150,430    979,205    159,512    1,186,736 
Sterling    4,871    53,796    7,114    82,970 
Euro    47,544    376,435    33,749    274,373 
Swiss franc    1,259    6,357    5,013    30,968 
Hong Kong dollar    191    157         
Singapore dollar    322    1,282    128    441 
Australian dollar    284    1,277         
                 
Uncovered foreign liabilities
    The group had the following uncovered 
      liabilities: 
               
                 
     USA dollar   58,142    422,564    74,952    465,553 
     Sterling   3,353    35,627    3,213    37,684 
     Chinese yuan renminbi   –    –    8,266    6,204 
     Euro   58,377    436,547    72,576    584,513 
     Swiss francs   10    47    160    833 
     Austrialian dollar   880    4,197    1,073    5,149 
     Cyprian pound   228    2,960    –    – 
     South Korean Kwon   482,739    5,009    –    – 
 
 
 
Foreign exchange contracts are entered into to manage the exposure to movements in exchange rates on specific transactions.
 
 
F-80

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
37.    FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS                 
 
   
The fair values together with the carrying amounts of financial instruments are as follows: 
       
 
       
March 31, 2006 
 
March 31, 2005 
       
Carrying
value
R’000
 
Fair value
R’000
 
Carrying
value
R’000
 
Fair value
R’000
    Assets                 
           Investments and loans    1,383,027    6,639,451    1,238,959    3,320,060 
           Receivables and loans    2,027,589    2,027,589    1,858,923    1,858,923 
           Derivative financial instruments    167,330    167,330    202,282    202,282 
           Cash and cash deposits    6,775,542    6,775,542    4,033,796    4,033,796 
 
    Liabilities                 
           Long-term liabilities    2,617,395    2,621,547    2,473,104    2,528,014 
           Payables and loans    5,598,967    5,599,343    4,730,142    4,742,867 
           Derivative financial instruments    305,526    305,526    295,618    295,618 
           Bank overdrafts    364,777    364,777    433,339    433,339 

The fair values of financial instruments were calculated using market information and other relevant valuation techniques, and do not necessarily represent the values that the group will realize in the normal course of business. The carrying amounts of cash and cash deposits, bank overdrafts, receivables and payables are deemed to reflect fair value due to the short maturities of these instruments. The fair values of forward exchange contracts and embedded derivative instruments are based on quoted market prices. The fair values of interest-bearing loans are calculated based on discounted expected future principal and interest cash flows.
 
 
F-81

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
38.     EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS
 
The following share incentive plans were in operation during the financial year:
 
Naspers Limited
 
On August 14, 1987, the group established the Naspers Share Incentive Trust (“the Naspers Plan”) under which it may award options for no more than 11% of the total number of N ordinary shares in issue. Share options may be granted with an exercise price of not less than 100% of the market value of the shares at the time of the grant. One third of the share options generally vest at the anniversary of each of the third, fourth and fifth years after the grant date of the share options and expire after ten years. Unvested share options are subject to forfeiture upon termination of employment. Cancelled options are options cancelled by mutual agreement between the employer and employee. This plan is classified as equity-settled.
 
Movements in terms of the Naspers Plan are as follows:                 
   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
   
Shares
 
Weighted
average
exercise
price (Rand)
 
Shares
 
Weighted
average
exercise
price (Rand)
 
                         Outstanding at April 1    10,522,517    26.92    10,912,637    26.35 
                         Granted        -    217,817    48.17 
                         Exercised    (655,496)   24.07    (567,831)   24.07 
                         Forfeited    (44,284)   27.56    (40,106)   27.56 
                         Outstanding at March 31    9,822,737    27.06    10,522,517    26.92 
 
                         Available to be implemented at March 31    5,604,438    26.46    4,309,745    36.23 

No share options expired or were cancelled during the years ended March 31, 2006 and March 31, 2005.
 
 
Taken up during the year:                 
   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
   
Shares
 
Weighted
average
exercise
price (Rand)
 
Shares
 
Weighted
average
exercise
price (Rand)
 
                                 Weighted average share price of options                    
                                  taken up during the year   
 655,496 
  102.30   
 567,831 
  63.89 

 
F-82

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.     EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
Naspers Limited (continued)
 
Share option allocations outstanding and currently available to be implemented at March 31, 2006 by exercise price:
           
Share options outstanding 
 
Share options currently available 
Range of exercise
prices (Rand)
 
Number
outstanding at 31
March 2006
 
Weighted
average
remaining
contractual life
(years)
 
Weighted
average exercise
price (Rand)
 
Exercisable at 31
March 2006
 
Weighted
average exercise
price (Rand)
10.00        15.00    1,500    5.92    13.65    1,000    13.65 
15.01        20.00    112,005    6.51    18.44    16,665    18.50 
20.01        25.00    3,309,347    6.14    23.19    1,340,938    22.22 
25.01        30.00    4,605,286    3.79    27.67    4,156,573    27.72 
30.01        35.00    1,570,707    6.55    30.98    79,853    31.40 
35.01        40.00                     
40.01        45.00    53,359    7.36    42.94    5,859    43.65 
45.01        50.00    100,000    8.45    50.00         
50.01        60.15    70,533    8.21    50.82    3,550    57.84 
            9,822,737        27.06    5,604,438    26.46 

Grants made during the year:         
   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
Weighted average fair value at measurement date                           -    21.96     
 
This weighted average fair value has been calculated using the         
Bermudan Binomial option pricing model, using the following inputs         
and assumptions:         
 
Weighted average share price (Rand)                           -    48.74     
Weighted average exercise price (Rand)                           -    48.74     
Weighted average expected volatility (%) *                           -    27.1% 
Weighted average option life (years)                           -    10.0     
Weighted average dividend yield (%)                           -    1.2% 
Weighted average risk-free interest rate (%) (based on zero rate bond         
yield at perfect fit)                           -    9.6% 
Weighted average in-the-money rate (%)                           -    56.0% 
Weighted average vesting period (years)                           -    4.0     
 
Expectations of early exercise are not considered due to the         
unpredictability of early exercise scenarios.         
* The expected weighted average volatility is determined using         
historical daily share prices.         

 
F-83

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.     EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
Media24 Limited
 
On August 31, 2000 the group established the Media24 Share Trust (“the Media24 Plan”) in terms of which it may award options for no more than 15% of the total number of ordinary shares in issue. Share options may be granted with an exercise price of not less than 100% of the fair value of the share options at the time of the grant. One third of the options generally vest at the anniversary of each of the third, fourth and fifth years after the grant date of the share options and expire after ten years. Unvested share options are subject to forfeiture upon termination of employment. Cancelled options are options cancelled by mutual agreement between the employer and employee. This plan is classified as cash-settled.
 
Movements in terms of the Media 24 Plan is as follows:             
   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
   
Shares
 
Weighted
average
exercise
price (Rand)
 
Shares
 
Weighted
average
exercise
  price (Rand)
 
Outstanding at April 1    6,100,496    7.18    6,676,862    6.80 
Granted    71,235    19.35    522,591    11.46 
Exercised   
(1,416,300)
  6.83    (761,587)   6.81 
Forfeited    (190,775)   7.34    (337,370)   7.03 
Outstanding at March 31    4,564,656    7.50    6,100,496    7.18 
 
Available to be implemented at March 31    3,183,823     6.77    2,772,577     6.82 

No share options expired or were cancelled during the years ended March 31, 2006 and March 31, 2005.
 
Taken up during the year:                                        
   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
   
Shares
 
Weighted
average
exercise
price (Rand)
 
Shares
 
Weighted
average
exercise
price (Rand)
 
Weighted average share price of options                 
taken up during the year   
1,416,300 
  20.13   
 761,587 
  10.89 

 
F-84

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.     EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
Media24 Limited (continued)
 
Share option allocations outstanding and currently available to be implemented at March 31, 2006 by exercise price:
   
Share options outstanding 
 
Share options currently available
Exercise price (Rand)   
Number
outstanding at
March 31, 2006
 
Weighted
average
remaining
contractual life
(years)
 
Weighted
average
exercise price
(Rand)
 
Exercisable at
March 31, 2006
 
Weighted
average
exercise price
(Rand)
6.04    957,127    5.70    6.04    541,757    6.04 
6.90    202,479    6.69    6.90    54,872    6.90 
6.92    2,591,484    4.75    6.92    2,587,194    6.92 
8.12    258,953    7.71    8.12         
11.63    488,998    8.50    11.63         
20.42    65,615    9.46    20.42         
    4,564,656        7.50    3,183,823    6.77 

Grants made during the year:         
   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
Weighted average fair value at measurement date    12.24        10.73     
 
This weighted average fair value has been calculated using the         
Bermudan Binomial option pricing model, using the following inputs         
and assumptions:         
 
Weighted average share price (Rand)    28.74        20.35     
Weighted average exercise price (Rand)    20.42        11.63     
Weighted average expected volatility (%) *    15.3%    20.0% 
Weighted average option life (years)    9.8        9.9     
Weighted average dividend yield (%)   
                                     - 
                                       - 
Weighted average risk-free interest rate (%) (based on zero rate bond         
yield at perfect fit)    7.4%    8.5% 
Weighted average in-the-money rate (%)    89.5%    57.0% 
Weighted average vesting period (years)    4.0        4.0    
         
Expectations of early exercise are not considered due to the         
unpredictability of early exercise scenarios.         
* The weighted average expected volatility is determined using both         
historical and future annual (bi-annual) company valuations.         
 
 
F-85

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.     EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)

Paarl Media Holdings (Proprietary) Limited
 
On May 29, 2001, the group established the Paarl Media Holdings Share Trust (“the Paarl Media Plan”) in terms of which it may award options for no more than 5% of the total number of ordinary shares in issue. Share options may be granted with an exercise price of not less than 100% of the fair value of the shares at the time of the grant. One third of the shares generally vest at the anniversary of each of the third, fourth and fifth years after the grant date of the share options and expire after ten years. Unvested shares are subject to cancellation upon expiration or termination of employment. This plan is classified as cash-settled.
 
Movements in terms of the Paarl Media Plan are as follows:
   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
   
Shares
 
Weighted
average
exercise price
(Rand)
 
Shares
 
Weighted
average exercise
price (Rand)
Outstanding at April 1   4,146,535     7.23   
           3,580,200  
  5.18 
Granted   -    -   
           1,305,000  
  11.50 
Exercised   (1,053,466)    4.81   
  (667,109) 
  4.83 
Forfeited   (329,000)    8.32   
  (71,556) 
  5.24 
Outstanding at March 31    2,764,069     7.23   
 4,146,535   
  7.23 
 
Available to be implemented at March 31                          182,937    4.80   
1,733,935  
  4.80 
 
 
Taken up during the year:
   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
   
Shares
 
Weighted
average
exercise price
(Rand)
 
Shares
 
Weighted
average exercise
price (Rand)
Weighted average share price of options taken up during the year   1,053,466     16.59   
667,109  
  11.50
 
 
 
 
 
Share option allocations outstanding and currently available to be implemented at March 31, 2006 by exercise price:
   
Share options outstanding
 
Share options currently available
Exercise
price (Rand)
 
Number outstanding
at March 31, 2006
 
Weighted average
remaining contractual
life (years)
 
Weighted average
exercise price
(Rand)
 
Exercisable at
March 31, 2006
 
Weighted average 
exercise price (Rand) 
4.80    1,001,936    5.61    4.80    182,937    4.80 
6.93    1,116,000    7.75    6.93    -    6.93 
11.50    646,133    9.00    11.50    -    11.50 
    2,764,069        7.23    182,937    4.80 

 
F-86

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.     EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
Via Afrika Limited
 
On November 21, 2003 the group established the Via Afrika Share Trust (“the Via Afrika Plan”) in terms of which it may award options for no more than 10% of the total number of ordinary shares in issue. Share options may be granted with an exercise price of not less than 100% of the fair value of the shares at the time of the grant. One third of the shares generally vest at the anniversary of each of the third, fourth and fifth years after the grant date of the share options and expire after ten years. Unvested share options are subject to forfeiture upon termination of employment. Cancelled options are options cancelled by mutual agreement between the employer and employee. This plan is classified as cash-settled.
 
Movements in terms of the Via Afrika Limited Plan is as follows:             
   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
       
Weighted
     
Weighted
       
average
     
average
       
exercise
     
exercise
   
Shares
 
price (Rand)
 
Shares
  price (Rand)
Outstanding at April 1    3,972,226    5.00         
Granted            4,012,606    5.00 
Forfeited    (575,435)   5.00    (40,380)   5.00 
Outstanding at March 31    3,396,791    5.00    3,972,226    5.00 
 
Available to be implemented at 31 March                 
No share options expired or were cancelled or exercised during the years ended March 31, 2006 and March 31, 2005.
 
Share option allocations outstanding and currently available to be implemented at March 31, 2006 by exercise price:
       
Share options outstanding 
 
Share options currently available 
       
Weighted
           
       
average
           
   
Number
 
remaining
 
Weighted
     
Weighted
   
outstanding at
 
contractual life
 
average exercise
 
Exercisable at
 
average exercise
Exercise price (Rand)   
March 31, 2006
 
(years)
 
price (Rand)
 
March 31, 2006
 
price (Rand)
5.00    3,396,791    8.43    5.00         
 
 
F-87

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
Via Afrika Limited (continued)
 
Grants made during the year:
 
 
 
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
 
Weighted average fair value at measurement date 
 
-
 
2.04
 
           
This weighted average fair value has been calculated using the Bermudan Binomial option pricing model, using the following inputs and assumptions:
 
       
Weighted average share price (Rand) 
 
-
 
5.00
 
Weighted average exercise price (Rand) 
 
-
 
5.00
 
Weighted average expected volatility (%) * 
 
-
 
20.0
%
Weighted average option life (years) 
 
-
 
10.0
 
Weighted average dividend yield (%) 
 
-
 
-
 
Weighted average risk-free interest rate (%) (based on zero rate bond yield at perfect fit) 
 
-
 
8.5
%
Weighted average in-the-money rate (%) 
 
   
57.0
%
Weighted average vesting period (years) 
 
-
 
4.0
 
           
Expectations of early exercise are not considered due to the unpredictability of early exercise scenarios. 
 
       
* The weighted average expected volatility is determined using both historical and future annual (bi-annual) company valuations.
 
       
 
MIH Holdings Limited
 
In terms of the plan, MIH Holdings may grant options to its employees for up to 26.4 million shares of MIH Holdings ordinary share capital. Share options may be granted with an exercise price of not less than 100% of the fair value of the shares at the time of the grant. One third of the shares generally vest at the anniversary of each of the third, fourth and fifth years after the grant date of the share options and expire after ten years. Unvested share options are subject to forfeiture upon termination of employment. Cancelled options are options cancelled by mutual agreement between the employer and employee. This plan is classified as equity-settled.
 
In terms of a section 311 scheme of arrangement, Naspers Limited offered one Naspers Class N ordinary share to all the minority shareholders of MIH Holdings Limited, including the MIH Holdings Plan, for every 2.25 MIH Holdings shares that it held. All the MIH Holdings shares were exchanged for Naspers Class N ordinary shares on December 20, 2002. Unvested share options are subject to forfeiture upon termination of employment. Cancelled options are options cancelled by mutual agreement between the employer and employee. This plan is classified as equity-settled.
 
 
F-88

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(CONTINUED)                 
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)             
 
MIH Holdings Limited (continued)                 
 
Movements in terms of the MIH Holdings Plan are as follows:             
NASPERS N (Rand)   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2006
           
Weighted
     
Weighted
           
average
     
average
           
exercise
     
exercise
       
Shares
price (Rand)
 
Shares
 
price (Rand)
Outstanding at April 1    3,417,626    25.77    4,910,162    25.49 
Granted    259,908    104.97    12,742    19.60 
Exercised    (1,530,111)   24.18   
(1,329,861)
  24.62 
Forfeited    (97,440)   30.33     (175,417)   26.22 
Outstanding at March 31    2,049,983    36.77    3,417,626    25.77 
 
Available to be implemented at March 31    454,373    23.20    1,376,154    25.06 
No share options expired or were cancelled during the years ended March 31, 2006 and March 31, 2005.
 
Taken up during the year:                 
   
     March 31, 2006
 
     March 31, 2005
       
Weighted
     
Weighted
       
average
     
average
       
share
     
share
   
Shares
 
price (Rand)
 
Shares
 
price (Rand)
 
Weighted average share price of options
taken up during the year
 
1,530,111 
  114.92   
1,329,861 
  63.89 

Share option allocations outstanding and currently available to be implemented at March 31, 2006 by exercise price:
               
Share options outstanding
 
Share options currently available
Range of exercise
prices (Rand)
 
Number
outstanding at
March 31, 2006
 
Weighted
average
remaining
contractual life
(years)
 
Weighted
average exercise
price (Rand)
 
Exercisable at
March 31, 2006
 
Weighted
average exercise
price (Rand)
6.91        20.00    356,317    5.90    13.97    146,903    14.05 
20.01        40.00    1,045,697    5.89    25.50    301,060    26.11 
40.01        60.00    385,118    7.90    41.58    1,227    50.54 
60.01        130.50    262,851    9.36    105.49    5,183    106.98 
            2,049,983        36.77    454,373    23.20 
 
 
F-89

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
MIH Holdings Limited (continued)
 
Grants made during the year:
   
March 31, 2006 
 
March 31, 2005 
 
Weighted average fair value at measurement date 
 
41.13
 
17.78
 
           
This weighted average fair value has been calculated using the 
         
Bermudan Binomial option pricing model, using the following 
         
inputs and assumptions:
         
           
Weighted average share price (Rand) 
 
105.35
 
45.25
 
Weighted average exercise price (Rand) 
 
105.35
 
45.25
 
Weighted average expected volatility (%) * 
 
25.8
%
29.2
%
Weighted average option life (years) 
 
9.0
 
9.9
 
Weighted average dividend yield (%) 
 
0.9
%
1.2
%
Weighted average risk-free interest rate (%) (based on zero rate 
         
bond yield at perfect fit) 
 
8.0
%
10.2
%
Weighted average in-the-money rate (%) 
 
26.6
%
110.0
%
Weighted average vesting period (years) 
 
4.0
 
4.0
 
           
Expectations of early exercise are not considered due to the 
         
unpredictability of early exercise scenarios. 
         
* The weighted average expected volatility is determined using
both historical and future annual (bi-annual) company valuations.
         
 
MIH (BVI) Limited         

On March 25, 1999 the group established the MIH Limited Share Scheme (“the MIH Limited Plan”) in terms of which it may award options for no more than 10% of the total number of ordinary shares. Share options may be granted with an exercise price of not less than 100% of the fair value of the shares at the time of the grant. One third of the shares generally vest at the anniversary of each of the third, fourth and fifth years after the grant date of the share options and expire after ten years. Unvested share options are subject to forfeiture upon termination of employment. Cancelled options are options cancelled by mutual agreement between the employer and employee. This plan is classified as equity-settled.
 
As part of the merger between MIH Limited and MIH (BVI) Limited, Naspers offered 3.5 Naspers Class N ordinary shares for each MIH Limited share held by minority shareholders, including the MIH Limited Plan. The MIH Limited Plan was converted into the MIH (BVI) Limited Plan at which time all its MIH Limited shares were exchanged for Naspers Class N ordinary shares and Naspers ADS’s.
 
 
F-90

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)         
 
MIH (BVI) Limited (continued)                 
 
Movements in terms of the MIH (BVI) Limited Plan are as follows:         
NASPERS N (US$)   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
           
Weighted
     
Weighted
           
average
     
average
           
exercise
     
exercise
       
 Shares
 
price (US$)
 
 Shares
 
price (US$)
Outstanding at April 1    1,578,462    2.65    2,364,490    2.73 
Granted                 
Exercised    (573,591)   2.94    (726,659)   3.08 
Forfeited    (103,959)   2.43    (59,369)   0.60 
Outstanding at March 31    900,912    2.61    1,578,462    2.65 
 
Available to be implemented at March 31    256,692    2.65    136,597    2.32 
 
NASPERS N (Rand)   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
           
Weighted
     
Weighted
           
average
     
average
           
exercise
     
exercise
       
 Shares
 
price (Rand)
 
 Shares
 
price (Rand)
Outstanding at April 1    10,008,128    23.33    11,030,434    21.59 
Granted    975,958    104.97    856,804    45.86 
Exercised    (4,495,479)   24.18    (1,825,918)   23.64 
Forfeited    (56,831)   30.33    (53,192)   15.35 
Outstanding at March 31    6,431,776    39.55    10,008,128    23.33 
 
Available to be implemented at March 31    711,343    20.36    2,254,940    21.01 
 
No share options expired or were cancelled during the years ended March 31, 2006 and March 31, 2005.
 
 
F-91

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)         
 
MIH (BVI) Limited (continued)                 
 
Taken up during the year:                 
NASPERS N (US$)   
     March 31, 2006
       March 31, 2005
           
Weighted
 
 
Weighted
           
average
     
average
           
share
     
share
       
Shares
 
price (US$)
 
Shares
 
price (US$)
 
Weighted average share price of options
taken up during the year
 
 573,591 
  14.40   
 726,659
  10.03 
 
NASPERS N (Rand)                 
       
     March 31, 2006
 
     March 31, 2005
           
Weighted
     
Weighted
           
average
     
average
           
share
     
share
       
Shares
 
price (Rand)
 
Shares
 
price (Rand)
 
Weighted average share price of options
taken up during the year
 
4,495,479  
  114.13   
1,825,918 
  68.71 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
MIH (BVI) Limited (continued)
 
Share option allocations outstanding and currently available to be implemented at March 31, 2006 by exercise price:
NASPERS N (US$)                     
           
Share options outstanding
 
Share options currently available
               
Weighted
           
               
average
 
Weighted
     
Weighted
           
Number
 
remaining
 
average
     
average
Range of exercise
 
outstanding at
 
contractual life
 
exercise price
 
Exercisable at
 
exercise price
prices (US$)
 
March 31, 2006
 
(years)
 
(US$)
 
March 31, 2006
 
(US$)
1.10   
  2.50    356,522    5.24    1.90    135,782    1.99 
2.51   
  5.00    537,120    6.76    3.00    113,640    3.04 
5.01   
  7.50                     
7.51   
  9.97    7,270    3.81    8.65    7,270    8.65 
            900,912        2.61    256,692    2.65 
 
 
NASPERS N (Rand)                     
           
Share options outstanding
 
Share options currently available
               
Weighted
           
               
average
 
Weighted
     
Weighted
           
Number
 
remaining
 
average
     
average
Range of exercise 
 
outstanding at
 
contractual life
 
exercise price 
 
Exercisable at
 
exercise price
prices (Rand)
 
March 31, 2006
 
(years)
 
(Rand)
 
March 31, 2006
 
(Rand)
8.19   
  15.00    491,713    6.00    8.19    109,667    8.19 
15.01   
  40.00    3,702,949    6.53    22.02    592,616    21.79 
40.01   
  65.00    1,272,194    8.00    44.17         
65.01   
  75.00    9,060    4.00    74.22    9,060    74.22 
75.01   
  100.00                     
100.01   
  125.00    955,860    9.65    117.14         
            6,431,776        39.55    711,343    20.36 

 
F-93

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
MIH (BVI) Limited (continued)
 
Grants made during the year:
 
NASPERS N (US$)
There were no new grants of Naspers N shares in US$ for the years ended March 31, 2006 and 2005
 

NASPERS N (Rand) 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
 
Weighted average fair value at measurement date 
 
42.44
 
20.09
 
           
This weighted average fair value has been calculated using the 
         
Bermudan Binomial option pricing model, using the following inputs 
         
and assumptions: 
         
           
Weighted average share price (Rand) 
 
105.37
 
45.86
 
Weighted average exercise price (Rand) 
 
105.37
 
45.86
 
Weighted average expected volatility (%) * 
 
25.8
%
29.0
%
Weighted average option life (years) 
 
9.3
 
8.1
 
Weighted average dividend yield (%) 
 
0.9
%
1.2
%
Weighted average risk-free interest rate (%) (based on zero rate bond 
         
yield at perfect fit) 
 
8.0
%
9.9
%
Weighted average in-the-money rate (%) 
 
78.5
%
54.5
%
Weighted average vesting period (years) 
 
4.0
 
4.0
 
           
Expectations of early exercise are not considered due to the 
         
unpredictability of early exercise scenarios. 
         
* The expected weighted average volatility is determined using 
         
historical daily share prices. 
         
 
 
F-94

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
Irdeto Access BV
 
On October 14, 1999 Mindport Holdings Limited established the Irdeto Access Share Scheme. In terms of the schemes, options of no more than 10% of the total number of issued ordinary shares of Irdeto Access BV may be awarded. Share options may be granted with an exercise price of not less than 100% of the fair value of the shares at the time of the grant. One third of the shares generally vest at the anniversary of each of the third, fourth and fifth years after the grant date of the share options and expire after ten years. Unvested share options are subject to forfeiture upon termination of employment. Cancelled options are options cancelled by mutual agreement between the employer and employee. This plan is classified as cash-settled.
 
Movements in terms of the Irdeto Access BV Plan are as follows:         
   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
       
Weighted
     
Weighted
       
average
     
average
       
exercise
     
exercise
   
 Shares
 
 price (US$)
 
 Shares
 
 price (US$)
Outstanding at April 1    739,974    7.38    288,167    9.05 
Granted    166,509    7.90    516,610    6.70 
Forfeited   
   (47,278)
  7.65   
   (64,803)
  9.33 
Outstanding at March 31    859,205    7.47    739,974    7.38 
 
Available to be implemented at March 31    89,363    10.24    35,458   
11.87 

No share options expired or were cancelled or exercised during the years ended March 31, 2006 and March 31, 2005.
 
Share option allocations outstanding and currently available to be implemented at March 31, 2006 by exercise price:
           
  Share options outstanding
 
Share options currently available
               
Weighted
           
               
average
           
           
Number
 
remaining
 
Weighted
     
Weighted
Range of exercise
 
outstanding at
 
contractual life
 
average exercise
 
Exercisable at
 
average exercise
prices (US$)
 
March 31, 2006
 
(years)
 
price (US$)
 
March 31, 2006
 
price (US$)
6.70   
 
   7.89 
  496,839    8.00    6.70         
7.90   
 
   8.29 
  321,396    7.56    7.90    51,584    7.90 
8.30   
 
 12.00 
  3,170    3.16    8.88    3,170    8.88 
12.01   
 
 14.80 
  37,800    5.19    13.80    34,609    13.85 
            859,205        7.47    89,363    10.24 
 
 
F-95

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
Irdeto Access BV (continued)
 
Grants made during the year:
 
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
 
Weighted average fair value at measurement date 
 
1.62
 
1.40
 
           
This weighted average fair value has been calculated using the 
         
Bermudan Binomial option pricing model, using the following inputs 
         
and assumptions: 
         
           
Weighted average share price (Rand) 
 
7.90
 
6.70
 
Weighted average exercise price (Rand) 
 
7.90
 
6.70
 
Weighted average expected volatility (%) * 
 
20.0
%
23.0
%
Weighted average option life (years) 
 
5.3
 
5.3
 
Weighted average dividend yield (%) 
 
-
 
-
 
Weighted average risk-free interest rate (%) (based on zero rate bond 
         
yield at perfect fit) 
 
4.6
%
4.2
%
Weighted average in-the-money rate (%) 
 
141.0
%
54.5
%
Weighted average vesting period (years) 
 
3.8
 
3.8
 
           
Expectations of early exercise are not considered due to the 
         
unpredictability of early exercise scenarios. 
         
* The weighted average expected volatility is determined using both 
         
historical and future annual (bi-annual) company valuations. 
         
 
MIH QQ (BVI) Limited         

On February 23, 2003 MIH QQ (BVI) Limited established the MIH QQ (BVI) Limited Share Trust (“the MIH QQ Plan”), in terms of which it can award options, but for no more than 10% of the total number of ordinary shares. Share options may be granted with an exercise price of not less than 100% of the fair value of the shares at the time of the grant. One quarter of the shares generally vest at the anniversary of each of the first, second, third and fourth years after the grant date. The share options expire after ten years. Unvested share options are subject to forfeiture upon termination of employment. Cancelled options are options cancelled by mutual agreement between the employer and employee. This plan is classified as equity-settled.
 
On September 30, 2005 MIH QQ (BVI) Limited established the 2005 MIH QQ (BVI) Limited Share Trust (“the 2005 MIH QQ Plan”), in terms of which it can award options, provided that when added to the reserved shares and unreserved shares already held by the trustees of the 2005 MIH QQ plan, or by the trustees of any other share trust, including the MIH QQ (BVI) Limited Share Trust, they represent no more than 10% of the greater of the MIH QQ (BVI) Limited’s (MIH QQ) total issued share capital at the time of such acquisition, or, if applicable, MIH QQ’s subsequently increased issued share capital. Share options may be granted with an exercise price of not less than 100% of the fair value of the shares at the time of the grant. One quarter of the shares generally vest at the anniversary of each of the first, second, third and fourth years after the grant date. The share options expire after five years. Unvested share options are subject to forfeiture upon termination of employment. Cancelled options are options cancelled by mutual agreement between the employer and employee. This plan is classified as equity-settled.
 
 
F-96

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
MIH QQ (BVI) Limited (continued)
 
Movements in terms of the MIH QQ (BVI) and 2005 MIH QQ (BVI) Plans are as follows:
MIH QQ (BVI) Limited Share Trust
 
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
       
Weighted 
     
Weighted
       
average
     
average
       
exercise
     
exercise
   
Shares
 
price (US$)
 
Shares
 
price (US$)
Outstanding at April 1    34,124    120.96    34,500    34.00 
Granted            8,874    368.41 
Exercised    (7,850)   34.00    (9,250)   34.00 
Forfeited    (1,250)   368.41         
Outstanding at March 31    25,024    127.53    34,124    120.96 
 
Available to be implemented at March 31    12,585    118.63    8,000    34.00 
 
 
 
2005 MIH QQ (BVI) Limited Share Trust                 
   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
       
Weighted
 
 
Weighted
       
average
     
average
 
 
exercise
     
exercise
   
Shares
 
price (US$)
 
Shares
 
price (US$)
Outstanding at April 1                 
Granted    28,497    613.69         
Outstanding at March 31    28,497    613.69         
 
Available to be implemented at March 31                 

No share options expired or were cancelled during the years ended March 31, 2006 and March 31, 2005.
 
Taken up during the year:                 
MIH QQ (BVI) Limited Share Trust                 
   
     March 31, 2006
 
     March 31, 2005
       
Weighted
     
Weighted
       
average
     
average
 
 
share
     
share
   
Shares
 
price (US$)
 
Shares
 
price (US$)
 
Weighted average share price of options taken
up during the year
         7,850    940.67           9,250    349.75 
 
 
F-97

 

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
MIH QQ (BVI) Limited (continued)
 
Share option allocations outstanding and currently available to be implemented at March 31, 2006 by exercise price:
MIH QQ (BVI) Limited Share Trust
   
 Share options outstanding
 
 Share options currently available
       
Weighted
           
       
average
           
   
Number
 
remaining
 
Weighted
     
Weighted
   
outstanding at 
 
contractual life
 
average exercise
 
Exercisable at
 
average exercise
Exercise price (US$) 
  March 31, 2006   
(years)
 
price (US$)
 
March 31, 2006
 
price (US$)
34.00    18,025    7.00    34.00    9,400    34.00 
368.41    6,999    8.00    368.41    3,185    368.41 
    25,024        127.53    12,585    118.63 
 
MIH QQ (BVI) Limited Share Trust
   
 Share options outstanding
 
 Share options currently available
       
Weighted
           
       
average
           
   
Number
 
remaining
 
Weighted
     
Weighted
   
outstanding at 
 
contractual life
 
average exercise
 
Exercisable at
 
average exercise
Exercise price (US$) 
  March 31, 2006   
(years)
 
price (US$)
 
March 31, 2006
 
price (US$)
612.75    27,850    9.00    612.75         
654.02    647    9.00    654.02         
    28,497        613.69         
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
MIH QQ (BVI) Limited (continued)
 
Grants made during the year:
MIH QQ (BVI) Limited Share Trust

 
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
 
Weighted average fair value at measurement date
 
-
 
189.99
 
           
This weighted average fair value has been calculated using the
 
 
 
 
 
Bermudan Binomial option pricing model, using the following inputs
 
 
 
 
 
and assumptions:
 
 
 
 
 
           
Weighted average share price (Rand)
 
-
 
458.31
 
Weighted average exercise price (Rand)
 
-
 
368.41
 
Weighted average expected volatility (%) *
 
-
 
44.0
%
Weighted average option life (years)
 
-
 
10.0
 
Weighted average dividend yield (%)
 
-
 
-
 
Weighted average risk-free interest rate (%) (based on zero rate bond
 
 
 
 
 
yield at perfect fit)
 
-
 
4.2
%
Weighted average in-the-money rate (%)
 
-
 
158.0
%
Weighted average vesting period (years)
 
-
 
4.0
 
           
Expectations of early exercise are not considered due to the
 
 
 
 
 
unpredictability of early exercise scenarios.
 
 
 
 
 
* The weighted average expected volatility is determined using both
 
 
 
 
 
historical and future annual (bi-annual) company valuations.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2005 MIH QQ (BVI) Limited Share Trust         
    March 31, 2006    March 31, 2005 
Weighted average fair value at measurement date   
359.81 
 
 
This weighted average fair value has been calculated using the         
Bermudan Binomial option pricing model, using the following inputs         
and assumptions:         
 
Weighted average share price (Rand)   
743.64
 
Weighted average exercise price (Rand)   
612.75
 
Weighted average expected volatility (%) *   
47.5
 %
Weighted average option life (years)   
                       7.5
 
Weighted average dividend yield (%)   
-
 
Weighted average risk-free interest rate (%) (based on zero rate bond         
yield at perfect fit)   
                     4.0
 %
-
Weighted average in-the-money rate (%)   
73.0
 %
-
Weighted average vesting period (years)   
                       4.0
 
-
         
Expectations of early exercise are not considered due to the         
unpredictability of early exercise scenarios.         
* The weighted average expected volatility is determined using both         
historical and future annual (bi-annual) company valuations.         
 
 
F-99

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
Entriq (Mauritius) Limited
 
On May 6, 2003 Entriq (Mauritius) Limited established the Entriq Share Trust (“the Entriq Plan”), in terms of which it can award options, but for no more than 15% of the total number of ordinary shares. Share options may be granted with an exercise price of not less than 100% of the fair value of the shares at the time of the grant. One quarter of the shares generally vest at the anniversary of each of the first, second, third and fourth years after the grant date. The share options expire after ten years. Unvested share options are subject to forfeiture upon termination of employment. Cancelled options are options cancelled by mutual agreement between the employer and employee. This plan is classified as cash-settled.
 
Movements in terms of the Entriq (Mauritius) Limited Plan are as follows:         
   
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
       
Weighted
     
Weighted
       
average
     
average
       
exercise
     
exercise
   
Shares
 
price (US$)
 
Shares
 
price (US$) 
Outstanding at April 1    4,395,200    0.65    104,600    1.30 
Capitalisation split - March 11, 2005            104,000     
Granted    1,115,900    0.65    4,187,200    0.65 
Forfeited    (110,100)   0.65    (600)   1.30 
Outstanding at March 31    5,401,000    0.65    4,395,200    0.65 
 
Available to be implemented at March 31    2,717,950    0.65    104,000    0.65 

No share options expired or were cancelled or exercised during the years ended March 31, 2006 and March 31, 2005.
 
Share option allocations outstanding and currently available to be implemented at March 31, 2006 by exercise price:
 
   
  Share options outstanding
 
 Share options currently available
       
Weighted
           
       
average
           
   
Number
 
remaining
 
Weighted
     
Weighted
    outstanding at  
contractual life
 
average exercise
 
Exercisable at
 
average exercise
Exercise price (US$)
  March 31, 2006  
(years)
 
price (US$)
 
March 31, 2006
 
price (US$)
0.65    5,401,000    8.93    0.65    2,717,950    0.65 
 
F-100

 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
Entriq (Mauritius) Limited (continued)
 
Grants made during the year:
 
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
 
Weighted average fair value at measurement date
 
0.27
 
0.32
 
           
This weighted average fair value has been calculated using the
         
Bermudan Binomial option pricing model, using the following inputs
         
and assumptions:
         
           
Weighted average share price (Rand)
 
0.65
 
0.65
 
Weighted average exercise price (Rand)
 
0.65
 
0.65
 
Weighted average expected volatility (%) *
 
50.0
%
50.0
%
Weighted average option life (years)
 
9.5
 
8.6
 
Weighted average dividend yield (%)
 
-
 
-
 
Weighted average risk-free interest rate (%) (based on zero rate bond
         
yield at perfect fit)
 
4.6
%
4.4
%
Weighted average in-the-money rate (%)
 
141.0
%
54.5
%
Weighted average vesting period (years)
 
3.8
 
3.8
 
           
Expectations of early exercise are not considered due to the
         
unpredictability of early exercise scenarios.
         
* The weighted average expected volatility is determined using both
         
historical and future annual (bi-annual) company valuations.
         
 
 
Electronic Media Network Limited         

On June 12, 1991 M-Net established the M-Net Share Trust (“the M-Net plan”), under which it may award shares or options for no more than 10% of the total number of ordinary shares. Shares or options may be granted with an exercise price of not less than 100% of the market value of the shares or options at the time of the grant. One third of the shares or options generally vest at the anniversary of each of the third, fourth and fifth years after the grant date of the shares or options and expire after ten years. Unvested share options are subject to forfeiture upon termination of employment. Cancelled options are options cancelled by mutual agreement between the employer and employee. This plan is classified as equity-settled.
 
In terms of a section 311 scheme of arrangement, Naspers Limited offered one Naspers Class N ordinary share to all the minority shareholders of M-Net, including the M-Net Plan, for every 4.5 M-Net/SuperSport linked unit that it held, or Rand 8.50 per M-Net/SuperSport linked unit. The transaction became unconditional on March 24, 2004. The linked units were exchanged for 574,726 Naspers Class N ordinary shares during April 2004.
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)         
 
Electronic Media Network Limited (continued)             
 
Movements in terms of the M-Net Plan are as follows:             
       
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
           
Weighted
      Weighted 
           
average
     
average
 
 
 
exercise
 
 
exercise
       
Shares
 
price (Rand)
 
Shares
 
price (Rand)
Outstanding at April 1    488,805    13.30    574,726    8.39 
Granted            40,000    64.20 
Exercised    (161,143)   2.90   
(119,367)
  6.96 
Forfeited    (45,679)   57.35    (6,554)   8.64 
Outstanding at March 31    281,983    8.72    488,805    13.30 
 
Available to be implemented at March 31    73,564    8.93    109,439    9.25 

No share options expired or were cancelled during the years ended March 31, 2006 and March 31, 2005.
 
Taken up during the year:                 
   
     March 31, 2006 
 
     March 31, 2005 
       
Weighted
     
Weighted
       
average
     
average
       
share
     
share
   
Shares
 
price (Rand)
 
Shares
 
price (Rand)
 
Weighted average share price of options                 
taken up during the year   
 161,143 
  111.60   
 119,367 
  56.12 

Share option allocations outstanding and currently available to be implemented at March 31, 2006 by exercise price:
 
           
Share options outstanding 
 
Share options currently available 
           
Weighted
           
           
average
           
 
 
Number
 
remaining
 
Weighted
     
Weighted
Range of exercise
 
outstanding at
 
contractual life
 
average exercise
 
Exercisable at
 
average exercise
   prices (Rand)
 
March 31, 2006
 
(years)
 
price (Rand)
 
March 31, 2006
 
price (Rand)
4.01 
   8.50 
  36,089    3.70    6.36    24,479    5.79 
8.51 
  
 13.50 
  235,861    6.81    8.74    39,052    8.87 
13.51 
 30.50 
  10,033    1.24    16.82    10,033    16.82 
        281,983        8.72    73,564    8.93 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
Electronic Media Network Limited (continued)
 
Grants made during the year:
 
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
 
Weighted average fair value at measurement date
 
-
 
24.36
 
           
This weighted average fair value has been calculated using the
         
Bermudan Binomial option pricing model, using the following inputs
         
and assumptions:
         
           
Weighted average share price (Rand)
 
-
 
64.20
 
Weighted average exercise price (Rand)
 
-
 
64.20
 
Weighted average expected volatility (%) *
 
-
 
24.9
%
Weighted average option life (years)
 
-
 
10.0
 
Weighted average dividend yield (%)
 
-
 
1.2
%
Weighted average risk-free interest rate (%) (based on zero rate bond
         
yield at perfect fit)
 
-
 
8.8
%
Weighted average in-the-money rate (%)
 
-
 
46.0
%
Weighted average vesting period (years)
 
-
 
4.0
 
           
Expectations of early exercise are not considered due to the
         
unpredictability of early exercise scenarios.
         
* The weighted average expected volatility is determined using both
         
historical and future annual (bi-annual) company valuations.
         
 
 
SuperSport International Holdings Limited         

On June 12, 1991 SuperSport established the SuperSport Share Trust (“the SuperSport plan”), under which it may award shares or options for no more than 10% of the total number of ordinary shares. Shares or options may be granted with an exercise price of not less than 100% of the market value of the shares or options at the time of the grant. One third of the shares or options generally vest at the anniversary of each of the third, fourth and fifth years after the grant date of the shares or options and expire after ten years. Unvested share options are subject to forfeiture upon termination of employment. Cancelled options are options cancelled by mutual agreement between the employer and employee. This plan is classified as equity-settled.
 
In terms of a section 311 scheme of arrangement, Naspers Limited offered one Naspers Class N ordinary share to all the minority shareholders of SuperSport, including the SuperSport Plan, for every 4.5 M-Net/SuperSport linked unit that it held, or Rand 8.50 per M-Net/SuperSport linked unit. The transaction became unconditional on March 24, 2004. The linked units were exchanged for 525,228 Naspers Class N ordinary shares during April 2004.
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)         
 
SuperSport International Holdings Limited (continued)             
 
Movements in terms of the SuperSport Plan are as follows:         
       
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2005
           
Weighted
     
Weighted
           
average
     
average
           
exercise
     
exercise
       
Shares
 
price (Rand)
 
Shares
 
price (Rand)
Outstanding at April 1    579,329    32.20    742,326    30.25 
Exercised   
(211,367)
  8.88   
(154,051)
  22.83 
Forfeited    (7,694)   32.85    (8,946)   31.69 
Outstanding at March 31    360,268    33.83    579,329    32.20 
 
Available to be implemented at March 31   
   96,287
  29.17    145,206    41.78 

No share options expired or were cancelled during the years ended March 31, 2006 and March 31, 2005.
 
Taken up during the year:                 
   
     March 31, 2006
 
     March 31, 2005
       
Weighted
     
Weighted
 
 
average
 
 
average
       
share
     
share
   
Shares
 
price (Rand)
 
Shares
 
price (Rand) 
 
Weighted average share price of options             
taken up during the year   
  211,367
 
  111.60
 
 154,051
 
55.12

Share option allocations outstanding and currently available to be implemented at March 31, 2006 by exercise price:
       
  Share options outstanding
 
Share options currently available
           
Weighted
           
           
average
           
       
Number
 
remaining
 
Weighted
     
Weighted
     Range of exercise
 
outstanding at
 
contractual life
 
average exercise
 
Exercisable at
 
average exercise
prices (Rand)
 
March 31, 2006
 
(years)
 
price (Rand)
 
March 31, 2006
 
price (Rand)
   –
      102,502    6.11        28,984     
     10.00     25.00    884    2.93    24.51    884    24.51 
     25.01     40.00    34,143    2.74    32.47    30,607    31.89 
     40.01     55.00    220,028    6.80    49.54    33,101    49.90 
     55.01     60.00    2,711    3.95    58.66    2,711    58.66 
        360,268        33.83    96,287    29.17 
 
Grants made during the year:                 
There were no new grants made for the years ended March 31, 2006 and 2005.         
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
Educor Holdings Limited
 
On June 12, 2001, the group established the Educor Share Incentive Scheme (“the Educor Plan”) in terms of which it may award options for no more than 20% of the total number of ordinary shares in issue. Share options may be granted with an exercise price of not less than 100% of the fair value of the shares at the time of the grant. One third of the shares generally vest at the anniversary of each of the third, fourth and fifth years after the grant date of the share options and expire after ten years. Unvested shares are subject to cancellation upon expiration or termination of employment. At March 31, 2005 no shares were allocated under the Educor Plan, and the plan was terminated during 2006.
 
Movements in terms of the Educor Plan are as follows: 
           
 
   
March 31, 2006 
 
         March 31, 2005 
   
Shares 
 
Weighted
average
exercise
price (Rand) 
 
Shares 
 
Weighted
average
exercise
price (Rand) 
           Outstanding at April 1           
11,462,505 
  0.96 
               Exercised           
(7,972,855)
  0.98 
               Forfeited           
(3,489,650)
  0.90 
           Outstanding at March 31                                    

 
F-105

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
United Broadcasting Corporation Public Company Limited (“UBC”)
 
On December 12, 2000 UBC established the UBC Employee Securities Option Plan (“the UBC plan”), in terms of which it can award options, but for no more than 3,95% of the total number of ordinary shares in issue. Share options may be granted with an exercise price of not less than 100% of the fair value of the shares at the time of the grant. One third of the shares generally vest at the anniversary of each of the first, second and third years after the grant date. The share options expire after nine years. Unvested shares are subject to cancellation upon expiration or termination of employment. At March 31, 2005 there were 14,879,000 options outstanding and exercisable under the UBC plan with a remaining weighted average contractual life of 5.75 years and an exercise price of 10 baht per share.
 
On November 7, 2005, the group publicly announced that it had entered into an agreement in terms of which it would sell its entire interest in UBC and this transaction was concluded on January 6, 2006.
 
Movements in terms of the UBC Plan are as follows: 
           
 
   
March 31, 2006 
 
         March 31, 2005 
   
Shares 
 
Weighted
average
exercise
price (THB) 
 
Shares 
 
Weighted
average
exercise
price (THB) 
           Outstanding at April 1           
17,103,200 
  10.00 
               Exercised          
(2,172,400)
  10.00 
               Forfeited          
(51,800)
  10.00 
           Outstanding at March 31                    14,879,000    10.00 
 
 
 
Tencent Holdings Limited
 
On July 27, 2001 Tencent Holdings Limited established a share option scheme (“the Tencent plan”), in terms of which it can award options, but for no more than 5% of the total number of ordinary shares in issue. Share options may be granted with an exercise price of not less than 100% of the fair value of the shares at the time of the grant, unless agreed otherwise by the Tencent board of directors. One third of the shares generally vest at the anniversary of each of the first, second and third years after the grant date. The share options expire after nine years. Unvested shares are subject to cancellation upon expiration or termination of employment.
 
During the year ended March 31, 2005 Tencent also issued Hong Kong dollar share options. At March 31, 2005 a total of 27 065 604 Hong Kong dollar options were outstanding at a weighted average exercise price of HKD4,40.
 
At March 31, 2005 there were 46,545,508 US dollar options outstanding, with exercise prices between US$0.05 and US$0.44, with remaining contractual lives of between 6.48 and 8.99 years. There were also 27 065 604 Hong Kong dollar options outstanding with exercise prices of between HKD3.67 and HKD5.55 with remaining contractual lives of between 9.46 and 9.98 years. At March 31, 2005 there were 23,530,004 US dollar options exercisable at exercise prices between US$0.05 and US$0.44. No Hong Kong dollar options were exercisable at March 31, 2005.
 
During 2005, the group changed it’s accounting for Tencent from consolidation to equity-accounting. As it is not required to disclose share-based compensation information for associate entities, the 2005 information is shown for comparative purposes only.
 
 
F-106

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
Tencent Holdings Limited (continued)
 
Movements in terms of the Tencent Plan are as follows:
 
 

 
Share appreciation rights schemes
 
On September 20, 2005 the group established the Media24 Limited, Electronic Media Network Limited/SuperSport International Holdings Limited (M-Net/SS) and MultiChoice Africa (Proprietary) Limited (MCA) share appreciation rights plans. The aggregate number of scheme shares in respect of which they may award share appreciation rights (SARs) is no more than 10% of the total number of ordinary shares in issue in the respective companies. SARs may be granted with an exercise price of not less than 100% of the fair value of the SARs at the time of the grant. One third of the SARs generally vest at the anniversary of each of the third, fourth and fifth years after the grant date of the SARs and expire after five years and fourteen days. Unvested SARs are subject to forfeiture upon termination of employment. Cancelled SARs are SARs cancelled by mutual agreement between employer and employee. These plans are classified as equity-settled.
 
 
F-107

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
Share appreciation rights schemes (continued)
 
Movements in terms of the SAR Plan are as follows:
       
Media24
March 31, 2006 
 
MCA
March 31, 2006   
 
M-Net/SS
March 31, 2006   
           
Weighted 
     
Weighted 
     
Weighted 
           
average 
     
average 
     
average 
           
exercise 
     
exercise 
     
exercise 
       
SARs 
 
price (Rand) 
 
SARs 
 
price (Rand) 
 
 SARs 
 
price (Rand) 
Outstanding at April 1                         
Granted    10,637,655    21.55    5,375,529    23.70    5,922,318    9.00 
Forfeited    (52,865)   21.55    (80,941)   23.70    (2,965)   9.00 
Outstanding at March 31    10,584,790    21.55    5,294,588     23.70    5,919,353    9.00 
 
Available to be implemented at 31 March                         

No SARs expired or were cancelled during the year ended March 31, 2006.
 
SAR option allocations outstanding and currently available to be implemented at March 31, 2006 by exercise price:
 
Media24                     
   
  SARs outstanding   
 
SARs currently available 
       
Weighted 
           
   
Number 
 
average 
 
Weighted 
       
   
outstanding at 
 
remaining 
 
average 
     
Weighted average 
   
March 31, 
 
contractual life 
 
exercise price 
 
Exercisable at 
 
exercise price 
       Exercise price (Rand)   
2006 
 
(years) 
 
(Rand) 
 
March 31, 2006
 
(Rand)
                                                 21.55    10,584,790    4.50    21.55         
 
 
MCA                     
   
  SARs outstanding   
 
SARs currently available 
       
Weighted 
           
   
Number 
 
average 
 
Weighted 
       
   
outstanding at 
 
remaining 
 
average 
     
Weighted average 
   
March 31, 
 
contractual life 
 
exercise price 
 
Exercisable at 
 
exercise price 
       Exercise price (Rand)   
2006 
 
(years) 
 
(Rand) 
 
March 31, 2006 
 
(Rand) 
                                                 23.70    5,294,588    4.50    23.70         
 
 
M-Net/SS                     
   
  SARs outstanding   
 
SARs currently available 
       
Weighted 
           
   
Number 
 
average 
 
Weighted 
       
   
outstanding at 
 
remaining 
 
average 
     
Weighted average 
   
March 31, 
 
contractual life 
 
exercise price 
 
Exercisable at 
 
exercise price 
       Exercise price (Rand)   
2006 
 
(years) 
 
(Rand) 
 
March 31, 2006 
 
(Rand) 
                                                   9.00    5,919,353    4.50    9.00         
 
 
F-108

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
38.    EQUITY COMPENSATION BENEFITS (continued)
 
Share appreciation rights schemes (continued)
 
Grants made during the year

 
Media24
 
MCA
 
M-Net/SS
 
 
 
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2006
 
March 31, 2006
 
Weighted average fair value at measurement date
 
7.37
 
6.88
 
2.95
 
               
This weighted average fair value has been calculated using
             
the Bermudan Binomial option pricing model, using the
             
following inputs and assumptions:
             
               
Weighted average SAR price (Rand)
 
21.55
 
23.70
 
9.00
 
Weighted average exercise price (Rand)
 
21.55
 
23.70
 
9.00
 
Weighted average expected volatility (%) *
 
20.0
%
14.0
%
14.2
%
Weighted average SAR life (years)
 
5.0
 
5.0
 
5.0
 
Weighted average dividend yield (%)
 
-
 
-
 
-
 
Weighted average risk-free interest rate (%) (based on zero
             
rate bond yield at perfect fit)
 
7.8
%
7.7
%
7.8
%
Weighted average in-the-money rate (%)
 
38.0
%
46.3
%
40.0
%
Weighted average vesting period (years)
 
4.0
 
4.0
 
4.0
 
               
Expectations of early exercise are not considered due to the
             
unpredictability of early exercise scenarios.
             
               
* The weighted average expected volatility is determined
             
using both historical and future annual (bi-annual) company
             
valuations.
             
 
 
 
Share-based payment liability                 
       
  March 31   
       
2006 
 
 2005 
       
 R’000 
 
 R’000 
             
Total carrying amount of cash-settled transaction liabilities shares      
 108,371
 
 36,158 
             
Total instrinsic value of liability for vested benefits      
 43,459 
 
    13,336 

 
F-109

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
 39.   DIFFERENCES BETWEEN INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS AND UNITED STATES GENERALLY
              ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES
 
The Group’s consolidated annual financial statements are prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”), which differ in certain material respects from accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“US GAAP”). Such differences include methods for measuring and presenting the amounts shown in the consolidated annual financial statements, as well as additional disclosures required by US GAAP. The principle differences between IFRS and US GAAP are presented below together with explanations of certain adjustments that affect total consolidated shareholders’ equity and consolidated net profit as of and for the years ended March 31, 2006 and 2005.
 
For the year ended March 31, 2005 the Naspers Limited Group (“Naspers” or “the Group”) prepared its financial statements under South African Statements of Generally Accepted Accounting Practice (“SA GAAP”) as effective at that date. In accordance with the JSE Limited (“JSE”) Listing Requirements, the Group is required to prepare its first annual consolidated financial statements in accordance with IFRS for the year ended March 31, 2006. As the Group publishes comparative information in its financial statements, the date for transition to IFRS is April 1, 2004, which represents the beginning of the earliest period of comparative information to be presented as required in terms of the requirements of the JSE Limited and the Securities and Exchange Commission in the United States of America.
 
In order to describe the impact of IFRS on the Group’s reported results of operations and financial position, the Group has restated information previously published under SA GAAP to the equivalent basis under IFRS. This restatement is described in note 2 of the annual financial statements and follows the guidelines set out in IFRS 1 “First-time Adoption of International Financial Reporting Standards” (“IFRS 1”). Accordingly, the US GAAP adjustments presented below as of and for fiscal year ended March 31, 2005 have also been adjusted to reflect the adjustments between IFRS and the previously reported SA GAAP information.
 
For the convenience of understanding these adjustments, a condensed consolidated income statement and condensed consolidated balance sheet prepared in accordance with US GAAP have been presented on pages F-121and F-122.
 
           
March 31   
           
2006 
 
2005 
           
R’000 
 
R’000 
 
Net profit under IFRS    3,190,188     2,384,762  
US GAAP adjustments:         
(a)   Business combinations        (14,858) 
   (i) Date of acquisition         
   (ii)  Value of purchase consideration        (14,858) 
   (iii)  Exchange for non-monetary assets         
(b)   Goodwill    (12,492)    1,817  
(c)   Intangible assets    (44,734)    (12,311) 
(d)   Purchase of minority interests (sucessive acquisition), net    (90,508)    (38,403) 
(e)   Share based compensation    (36,494)    (27,705) 
(g)   Post-retirement employee liability    5,598     (11,934) 
(h)   Property, plant and equipment    35,470     16,829  
(j)   Onerous contracts    (17,795)    27,015  
(l)   Impairment of investment    (98,866)     
(m)   Put option liability    (56,509)     
(n)   Other    (5,509)    (28,925) 
   Effect of adjustments on taxation    1,622     (4,208) 
   Effect of adjustments on minority interests    (4,981)    1,901  
Profit under US GAAP before discontinued operations    2,864,990     2,293,980  
(o)   Discontinued operations    (348,216)    (8,026) 
Net profit under US GAAP    2,516,774     2,285,954  
 
 
F-110

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
39.    DIFFERENCES BETWEEN INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS AND UNITED STATES GENERALLY
                 ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES
      (continued)
 
   
March 31 
   
2006 
 
2005 
   
R’000 
 
R’000 
         
Total shareholders’ equity under IFRS    7,118,436     4,865,965  
         
US GAAP adjustments:         
(a) 
 Business combinations    (306,019)    (311,210) 
   (i) Date of acquisition    224,126     218,935  
   (ii)  Value of purchase consideration    (27,600)    (27,600) 
   (iii)  Exchange for non-monetary assets    (502,545)    (502,545) 
(b)   Goodwill    563,382     845,837  
(c)   Intangible assets    6,116     55,372  
(d)   Purchase of minority interests (sucessive acquisition), net    1,236,008     1,471,583  
(e)   Share based compensation    (249,703)    (173,633) 
(f)   Adjustment to dilution gains/(losses)    (149,467)    (268,287) 
(g)   Post-retirement employee liability   (40,301)    (45,899) 
(h)   Property, plant and equipment    (122,127)    (156,869) 
(i)   Proportionate consolidation       46,397  
(j)   Onerous contracts    4,755     22,555  
(k)   Consolidation of entities under FIN 46R   33,172     (34,530) 
(l)   Impairment of investment    (94,896)     
(m)   Put option liability    774,276      
(n)   Other    (2,321)    25,700  
   Effect of adjustments on taxation    (45,867)    (54,070) 
   Effect of adjustments on minority interests    (16,947)    (14,411) 
Total shareholders’ equity under US GAAP    8,708,497     6,274,500  
 
 
(a)    Business combinations
 
Under both IFRS and US GAAP, the acquisitions of the Group have been accounted for under the purchase method. Both IFRS and US GAAP require the purchase consideration to be allocated to the identifiable net assets acquired at their fair value at the date of acquisition, with the difference between the consideration paid and the fair value of the identifiable net assets acquired recorded as goodwill. The Group has applied IFRS 3 “Business Combinations” (“IFRS 3”) to all business combinations that have occurred since April 1, 2004 (the date of transition to IFRS). In addition, the Group has elected to apply IFRS 3 retrospectively to all business combinations that occurred between December 20, 2002 and the date of transition to IFRS. The date of December 20, 2002 was used because this was the date of the company’s most significant acquisition; the purchase of the remaining interests in MIH Limited and MIH Holdings Limited. This retrospective application of IFRS 3 ensured that all the significant business combination transactions entered into by the Group over the past three years have been treated in a consistent manner. Business combinations prior to December 20, 2002 were not affected by the transition to IFRS. Certain differences between IFRS and US GAAP in the application of the purchase method of accounting for business combinations arise as set out below:
 
  (i)    Date of acquisition
 
Prior to December 20, 2002, the date on which earnings of an acquired entity were included in the Group’s consolidated results of operations could be based on an effective date identified in the acquisition agreement when management control is ceded. Under US GAAP, when regulatory approval or other substantive conditions precedent exist, the consummation of the acquisition is not considered effective until such conditions are satisfied and irrevocable control of the company is obtained or consideration is exchanged. This adjustment includes the shareholders’ equity impact of reversing the results of operations for the period for which the acquired entities would not have been consolidated under US GAAP. The impact on goodwill and other intangible assets as a result of the different dates of acquisition under US GAAP, net of accumulated amortization, are included separately in notes (b) and (c) below.
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
39.      DIFFERENCES BETWEEN INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS AND UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES (continued)
 
  (a)      Business combinations (continued)
 
      (ii)    Value of purchase consideration
 
Previously, the value of the purchase consideration was determined based on the market or fair value of the shares issued or cash paid on the date the transaction was consummated, normally the date the shares were exchanged or cash was paid. The purchase consideration did not include the fair value of options issued to replace vested options of the acquired company. Under US GAAP, the value of the purchase consideration, using shares, is determined by using the average market value of the shares a few days before and after the announcement date. In addition, under US GAAP, the fair value of options issued to replace vested options of the acquired company are also recorded as part of the purchase consideration based on the fair market value of the vested options outstanding at the acquisition date.
 
     (iii)    Exchange of non-monetary assets
 
In prior years the Group has undertaken a number of transactions involving the exchange of non-monetary assets, normally the exchange or swap of shares. Previously, the gain recorded and cost of investments acquired were based on the value of the shares received. Under US GAAP, the gain recorded and cost of the investments acquired were based on the market value of the shares surrendered on the dates that the exchanges were consummated. This adjustment decreases the goodwill previously recognized and subsequently written off to reserves which has been reinstated under US GAAP (refer to note (b)).
 
  (b) Goodwill
 
Goodwill recorded on acquisitions prior to April 1, 2000 was written off against retained earnings in the year of acquisition. For purposes of US GAAP prior to the adoption of FAS 142, “Goodwill and other intangible assets”, all goodwill written off against retained earnings has been reinstated as an asset on the balance sheet and amortized. Upon adoption of FAS 142 on April 1, 2002, the Group no longer amortizes goodwill and annually tests goodwill, by reporting unit, for impairment. Under IFRS, prior to April 1, 2004, goodwill was amortized over an estimated useful life not exceeding 20 years. As of April 1, 2004, the Group adopted IAS 36, “Impairment of Assets” and IFRS 3, “Business Combinations”, with retrospective application to December 20, 2002, and discontinued the amortization of goodwill which is consistent with the accounting treatment under US GAAP. Although the statements are similar, the difference in the prospective adoption dates will give rise to a continuing equity difference between IFRS and US GAAP.
 
Under US GAAP, the Group has impaired goodwill related to certain Group companies based on the goodwill impairment tests required by FAS 142. Under US GAAP, an indication of impairment exists when the carrying value of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, which is based on undiscounted cash flows or market values for listed companies. The impairment charge for the reporting unit is calculated based on an allocation of the fair value of the reporting unit to the underlying tangible and intangible assets and then comparing the remaining implied goodwill to the recorded goodwill of that reporting unit.
 
Goodwill also includes an adjustment related to the recognition of deferred tax assets at Netmed NV during the 2005 financial year. A portion of the deferred tax asset was reversed, however, the classification was recorded in different line items on the income statement. For US GAAP income statement presentation purposes, this transaction was included in the taxation line, whereas for IFRS it was included in the goodwill amortization and taxation lines.
 
  (c) Intangible assets
 
Patents, trademarks, title rights, subscriber bases and similar other intangible assets acquired before April 1, 2000 were written off against retained earnings in the year of acquisition. Under US GAAP, all other intangible assets written off against retained earnings have been reinstated as assets on the balance sheet and are being amortized using the straight-line method over a range of estimated useful lives of three to eight years. Upon adoption of FAS 142 on April 1, 2002, these intangible assets were determined to have a finite useful life and therefore continue to be amortized over their remaining estimated useful lives. During the current year, certain brandnames that were previously considered indefinite lived were determined to have finite lives and are now being amortized over the estimated useful lives.
 
Under IFRS, prior to April 1, 2004, intangible assets, including goodwill, were amortized over their estimated useful lives not exceeding 20 years. As of April 1, 2004, the Group adopted IAS 38, “Intangible Assets” and discontinued the amortization of intangible assets with indefinite lives which is consistent with the accounting treatment under US GAAP. Under both IFRS and US GAAP, the carrying value of other intangible assets is assessed for impairment whenever changes in circumstances indicate that the historical carrying value may not be appropriate.
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
39.      DIFFERENCES BETWEEN INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS AND UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES (continued)
 
 (c) Intangible assets (continued)
   
  The expected intangible amortisation expense, in accordance with US GAAP, is presented below:
 
       
 R’000
    12 months to:     
         
    March 31, 2007   
181,498 
    March 31, 2008   
179,787 
    March 31, 2009   
179,787 
    March 31, 2010   
109,288 
    March 31, 2011   
109,288 
 
 
(d)     Purchase of minority interests (successive acquisition), net     

Upon adoption of IFRS effective April 1, 2004, the Group chose to take the IFRS 1 business combination exemption as explained in note 2 of the annual financial statements. Therefore when undertaking transactions with minorities in successive acquisitions, the entire difference between the purchase consideration and the net assets acquired of the remaining interest in an entity that it did not own was included within a separate category of equity. The minority interest is recorded at the minority’s proportion of the net fair value of the net assets acquired. Under US GAAP transactions with minorities are treated as a purchase business combination. The minority interest is valued at its historical cost book value and fair values are assigned upon the step up purchase of the minority interest. Therefore, for all successive acquisitions since December 20, 2002, all the purchase price step-up adjustments recorded under US GAAP as well as those related to the underlying US GAAP – IFRS differences have been treated as reconciling adjustments.
 
The largest of these successive acquisition differences related to the purchase of the remaining minority interests in MIH Limited and MIH Holdings Limited on December 20, 2002, the purchase of an additional minority interest in Multichoice Hellas SA in September 2004 and the acquisition of the remaining interest in Netmed NV in January 2006 (see (l)). Certain of these acquisitions also had differences in the value of purchase consideration as discussed in (a)(ii).
 
The amounts determined in the purchase price allocation under US GAAP were recorded to goodwill, brand names, patents and technology, subscriber bases, equity accounted investments and the related deferred tax accounts. The adjustments for these items have been recorded in one line item on the reconciliation of net profit and the reconciliation of total shareholders’ equity but have been presented separately in the related US GAAP condensed consolidated income statement and condensed consolidated balance sheet presented on page F-121 and F-122.
 
(e)  Share-based compensation
 
The Group accounts for its share options in accordance with IFRS 2, “Share-based Payments” and has recognised compensation expense in the income statement, representing the fair value of share options granted to employees. The weighted average fair value of the options granted was based on the inputs and assumptions as disclosed in note 38.
 
For US GAAP purposes, the Group accounts for its share options granted to employees under Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25 “Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees” (“APB 25”), as permitted by Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123 “Accounting for Stock Based Compensation” (“FAS 123”). In general, APB 25 requires that the intrinsic value of the options, defined as the market value of the share at the grant date less the exercise price, be recognised as compensation expense prospectively, over the vesting period of the related options. The Group established four new stock appreciation right plans during the year. Under US GAAP these plans are considered variable plans and compensation expense is calculated using the fair market value movement in the shares of these plans. Amounts related to minority interest and to compensation expense for shares issued to non-employees were immaterial.
 
As permitted by FAS 123, for purposes of US GAAP, the Group applies APB 25 and related interpretations in accounting for its option plans. Had compensation costs for the Group’s share option plans been determined based on the fair value at the grant dates for awards under those plans consistent with the method of FAS 123, the Group’s net profit and net profit per share under US GAAP would have been adjusted to the pro forma amounts indicated below:
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
39.      DIFFERENCES BETWEEN INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS AND UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES (continued)
 
  (e) Share-based compensation (continued)
 
           
2006 
 
2005 
           
(Rand thousands except per share data) 
 
    Profit as reported under US GAAP    2,516,774    2,285,954 
    Add:    Share-based compensation expense included         
        in reported profit under US GAAP    171,988    155,320 
    Deduct:    Total share-based compensation expense         
        determined under fair value method    (233,094)   (168,524)
    Pro forma profit under US GAAP    2,455,668    2,272,750 
    Profit per N ordinary share (cent)         
    - Basic - as reported         
          - continuining operations    636    810 
          - discontinuing operations    253    15 
    - Basic - pro forma         
          - continuining operations    614    806 
          - discontinuing operations    253    15 
    - Diluted - as reported         
          - continuining operations    598    758 
          - discontinuing operations    238    14 
    - Diluted - pro forma         
          - continuining operations    578    759 
          - discontinuing operations    238    14 
 
(f)     Adjustment to dilution (losses)/gains         

In prior years, certain subsidiaries issued shares to third parties for cash or non-cash assets, which resulted in a dilution of the Group’s ownership in these entities. Under IFRS, the Group has recorded dilution (losses)/gains resulting from these transactions as the value received for the subsidiaries’ shares issued were (less than)/greater than the Group’s carrying value prior to the transactions. Generally, the calculation of, and accounting for, dilution losses and gains is similar under US GAAP as it is under IFRS. However, the amount of the recognised dilution loss or gain under US GAAP differs from the amount recognised under IFRS as a result of the different carrying values for certain subsidiaries’ net assets under US GAAP.
 
(g)   Post-retirement employee liability
 
The Group maintains a number of post-retirement medical benefit plans. In general, there is little difference in the determination of post-retirement employee benefits under IFRS and US GAAP. However, the amounts recorded under US GAAP differ from the amounts recorded under IFRS as under IFRS the full amount of service costs and actuarial gains/losses have been recognized in the financial statements. Under US GAAP the Company has unrecognized past service gains and unrecognized actuarial losses that are being amortized over a longer period.
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
39.     
DIFFERENCES BETWEEN INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS AND UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES (continued)
 
(g)    Post-retirement employee benefits (continued)
 
   
March 31   
   
2006 
 
2005 
   
R’000 
 
R’000 
Change in benefit obligation         
Benefit obligation at April 1    101,274    153,710 
Service cost    814    1,316 
Interest cost    8,364    13,506 
Policy change        (52,221)
Actuarial loss/(gain)    36,861    (3,533)
Settlement gain        (4,220)
Benefits paid    (5,749)   (7,284)
Benefit obligation at March 31    141,564    101,274 

The assumptions used to determine the benefit obligation as at, and the net healthcare costs for the years ended March 31, 2006 and 2005 are listed below:
 
 
 
   
March 31   
 
   
2006 
 
2005 
 
Benefit obligation      
Rate of future healthcare inflation per annum (1)
  6.5  % 7.0  %
Discount rate per annum (2)
  7.5  % 8.5  %
Average retirement age     60   60  
Continuaton at retirement    100  % 100  %
           
Net Healthcare Cost
         
Rate of future healthcare inflation per annum (1)
  6.5   % 7.0  %
Discount rate per annum (2)
  7.5  % 9.0  %
 
(1)      In regards to the future healthcare inflation assumption, the initial trend and ultimate trend are the same.
(2)      The discount rate is based on current bond yields of appropriate term gross of tax and is determined by reference to current market yields on government bonds. The discount rate is based on the yield curve and not on a particular benchmark bond. The returns on the yield curve are converted to effective rates. The discount rate is set at a level consistent with the effective yields in a range of medium to long durations of, say, 5 to 15 years. There is no adjustment for tax or expenses.
 
The expected employer benefit payments for the next five years and cumulatively thereafter following March 31, 2006 is presented below:
 
   
R’000 
Period     
Year ending March 31, 2007    6,297 
Year ending March 31, 2008    6,707 
Year ending March 31, 2009    7,143 
Year ending March 31, 2010    7,607 
Year ending March 31, 2011    8,101 
April 1, 2011 to March 31, 2016    49,125 

The post-retirement medical benefit plans are unfunded. The Group’s best estimate of expected contributions for the next year equals the expected benefit payment of Rand 6.3 million.
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
39.      DIFFERENCES BETWEEN INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS AND UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES (continued)
 
 (g)  Post-retirement employee benefits (continued)
 
Net periodic post-employment cost under US GAAP includes the following components:         
 
   
March 31   
   
2006 
 
2005 
   
R’000 
 
R’000 
 
Net period post-retirement benefit cost charged to operating profit         
Service cost    814    1,316 
Interest cost    8,364    13,506 
Amortization of transition obligation        2,188 
Prior service cost recognized    (2,138)    
Recognized net actuarial gain    (1,393)   (870)
Net post-retirement benefit cost charged to operating profit    5,647    16,140 

 
The actuarial and recorded liabilities for post-retirement health care benefits, none of which are funded, under US GAAP are as follows:
 
   
March 31   
   
2006 
 
2005 
   
R’000 
 
R’000 
Funded status at March 31         
Funded status    (141,564)   (101,274)
Unrecognized net actuarial losses/(gains)    6,250    (32,004)
Unrecognized past service cost    (31,433)   (33,571)
Net amount recognized pension cost    (166,747)   (166,849)

At March 31, 2006 an amount of Rand 166.7 million (2005: Rand 166.8 million) is recognized in the US GAAP balance sheet relating to the accrued benefit liability attributable to these plans.
 
A one percentage point increase in the assumed health-care cost inflation rate would increase the accumulated post-retirement benefit obligation as at March 31, 2006 by Rand 22.7 million (2005: Rand 11.0 million) and the net period post-retirement benefit cost for 2006 by Rand 2.6 million (2005: Rand 1.2 million). A one percentage point decrease in the assumed health-care cost inflation rate would decrease the accumulated post-retirement benefit obligation as at March 31, 2006 by Rand 18.1 million (2005: Rand 12.5 million) and the net period post-retirement benefit cost for 2006 by Rand 1.4 million (2005: Rand 1.2 million). The valuation of the liability was performed as at March 31, 2006.
 
(h)  Property, plant and equipment
 
In terms of the requirements of IFRS 1 the Group is required to apply IAS 16 “Property, Plant & Equipment” retrospectively. The Group has reviewed individual items of property, plant and equipment in terms of their carrying values (fully depreciated assets), residual values and depreciation lives and adjusted the carrying value and useful lives of some items at the date of transition to IFRS in terms of the requirements of IAS 16 and IFRS 1 (fair value – deemed cost exemption) (see note 2). These adjustments have changed the previously recorded carrying values and subsequent depreciation charges for the years ended March 31, 2006 and 2005. Under US GAAP, the changes in useful lives to certain property and equipment have been amended prospectively effective April 1, 2005. However, the revaluation of fully depreciated assets and other selected property and equipment is not allowed under US GAAP.
 
Under IFRS, borrowing costs are only capitalized to qualifying assets if the borrowings directly relate to the financing of the purchase or construction of that particular asset. Under US GAAP borrowing costs are capitalized to qualifying assets if interest charges are incurred at any level within the Group and do not need to be specifically related to that particular asset.
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
39.      DIFFERENCES BETWEEN INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS AND UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES (continued)
 
  (i)      Proportionate consolidation
 
  Under IFRS, the Group proportionately consolidates its interests in jointly controlled entities (“Joint Ventures”). This benchmark treatment in IAS 31, “Interests in Joint Ventures” results in the Group reporting in its consolidated financial statements the proportionate share of the income, expenses, assets and liabilities of the joint venture. Under US GAAP, interest in joint ventures is accounted for in accordance with APB No. 18 “The Equity Method of Accounting for Investments in Common Stock”. Under the equity method, the investment is initially recognized at cost and the carrying amount is increased or decreased to recognize the investor’s share of the profits or losses of the investee after the date of acquisition. If under the equity method the Group’s share of losses of a joint venture equals or exceeds the carrying amount of its investment, the Group ordinarily discontinues equity accounting. Additional losses are provided for to the extent that the Group has incurred obligations or made payments on behalf of the joint venture that the Group has guaranteed or otherwise committed. Accordingly, net profit may differ between IFRS and US GAAP with the joint venture losses fully accounted for under IFRS but potentially limited under US GAAP. Differences in US GAAP and IFRS shareholders’ equity relates to the cumulative difference of such losses allowed for under proportionate consolidation.
 
  (j)      Onerous contracts
 
  IFRS defines an onerous contract as a contract in which the unavoidable costs of meeting the obligations under the contract exceed the economic benefits expected to be received under it. The unavoidable costs under the contract reflect the least net cost of exiting the contract, which is the lower of the cost of fulfilling it and any compensation or penalties arising from failure to fulfill it. Under IFRS, the Group has provided for such onerous contracts which arose as a result of certain business combinations. Under US GAAP, FAS 146 “Accounting for Costs Associated with Exit of Disposal Activities,” allows for creation of a liability for certain costs that will continue to be incurred under a contract for its remaining term without economic benefit only when the company ceases using the rights conveyed by that contract. At that date, a liability can be recorded for the difference between the lease payments to be made reduced by the fair value of sublease rentals that could be reasonably obtained from the property. The Group’s onerous leases did not meet this criteria under US GAAP and therefore the liability and related expense recorded under IFRS has been reversed.
 
  (k)      Consolidation of entities under FIN 46R
 
  The Group adopted FIN 46R, “Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities”, prospectively on April 1, 2004 for US GAAP. Under the revised interpretation, certain entities known as Variable Interest Entities (VIE’s) must be consolidated by the primary beneficiary of the entity. The primary beneficiary is generally defined as having the majority of the economic risks and rewards arising from the VIE.
 
  In terms of FIN 46R, the Group has consolidated certain investments from April 1, 2004. In the past these investments were equity- accounted. Under US GAAP, equity accounting was discontinued for certain investments as these investments were carried at Rnil value due to the entities’ having negative asset value. On adoption of FIN 46R with the application of full consolidation accounting rules, losses previously limited have now been taken into account.
 
  The most significant entity that required consolidation under FIN 46R was MNH Holdings (1998) (Proprietary) Limited (“MNH 98”), a joint venture in which Naspers holds a 50% interest. MNH 98 is a limited liability company and exists only to provide a vehicle with which to hold a 52.7% investment in both M-Net and SuperSport, both pay television content providers. In addition to Naspers’ 50% interest in MNH 98, it directly owns a 33.8% interest in both M-Net and SuperSport. Approximately 70% of the revenues of M-Net and SuperSport are derived from activities with the Naspers Group of companies.
 
  MNH 98’s only activities are to receive and re-distribute dividends. It has no employees, management, or other inputs and outputs associated with an ongoing operation. MNH 98 has been capitalized with limited equity and the other investment partners in MNH 98 are unrelated third-party competitors. As of April 1, 2005 MNH 98 had negative shareholder’s equity of Rand 96 million and total assets of Rand 1,794 million. The assets of M-Net and SuperSport of Rand 1,890 million serve as collateral for the obligations of MNH 98. The other interest holders in MNH 98 have no recourse to the general credit of Naspers in the event of default by MNH 98.
 
  Because Naspers has been determined to be the primary beneficiary of MNH 98 through its direct ownership interests and business transactions with M-Net and SuperSport, this company was consolidated as of April 1, 2004 and continues to be consolidated as of March 31, 2006. The results of its operations for the years ended March 31, 2006 and 2005 have also been consolidated by Naspers. The adjustments to net profit and shareholders equity under IFRS related to the consolidation of entities under FIN 46R were related to the recording of additional losses previously not recognized under equity method accounting of certain investments and the adjustment to treasury shares of 100% of the holdings of Naspers shares by the M-Net and SuperSport employee share trusts, respectively.
 
  Other interests that have been consolidated relating to the adoption of FIN 46R include Free State Cheetahs and Griqualand West Rugby. The impact on the Group’s US GAAP balance sheet and income statement related to the consolidation of these entities was insignificant.
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
39.      DIFFERENCES BETWEEN INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS AND UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES (continued)
 
  (l)      Impairment of Investments
 
  Throughout the year the stock price of one of the Group’s equity method investees, Beijing Media Corporation (“BMC”), declined from its original purchase price, resulting in an indication of a potential impairment. The investment was analyzed for impairment under both IFRS and US GAAP. Under IFRS, the impairment was assessed in accordance with IAS 36 “Impairment of Assets” based on estimated discounted cash flows from holding the investment and its ultimate disposition. It was determined that the sum of these future cash flows exceeded the current carrying value and therefore no impairment was recorded.
 
  Under US GAAP, the impairment was assessed in accordance with Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 59. It was determined that the impairment was other than temporary since the carrying value had exceeded the market value for nine months during the year and the calculation of the impairment was based on the market value of BMC at the balance sheet date, resulting in an impairment charge for US GAAP purposes.
 
  (m)      Put option liability
 
  In January 2006, the minority interest of NetMed NV exercised a put on their shares to the Group, requiring the Group to purchase a specified number of NetMed NV shares.
 
  Under US GAAP, the transaction was accounted for at the time the option was exercised by recording the fair value of the put option liability. The transaction was accounted for as a step acquisition and the percentage of the assets and liabilities acquired were increased to their current fair value, including the recognition of goodwill and other intangible assets – primarily subscriber base and brand names with the remainder being recorded as goodwill. The adjustments for these items have been recorded in one line item on the reconciliation of net profit and the reconciliation of total shareholders’ equity, but have been presented separately in the related US GAAP condensed consolidated income statements and condensed consolidated balance sheet on pages F-122 and F-123.
 
  Under IFRS this put option with minority shareholders was considered outstanding from the time it was entered into, based on the amended guidance in IAS 32R. However, the Group elected the IFRS 1 allowance to present comparative information for IAS 32 and 39 in accordance with former GAAP and therefore this derivative liability has been recorded as of April 1, 2005 with a corresponding adjustment to shareholders’ equity since it is treated as a successive acquisition. The fair value movement between April 1, 2005 and March 31, 2006 has been recorded in the income statement. The movement between April 1, 2005 and January 2006 has been reversed for US GAAP.
 
  Media24 Limited entered into a contract containing a put option whereby the option holder can require Media24 Limited to purchase the option holder’s remaining 7.5% interest in Paarl Media Holdings (Proprietary) Limited (“Paarl Media”). This put option may be exercised within 30 days from the date of acceptance by the board of the annual financial statements of Paarl Media for the year ending March 31, 2008. For IFRS purposes, the put option has been considered outstanding from the time that it was entered into and has been recorded as a derivative financial instrument liability in the financial statements. For US GAAP purposes, the transaction will not be accounted for until the option is exercised.
 
  (n)      Other
 
  There are a number of other miscellaneous adjustments that are required to reconcile the Group’s IFRS net profit and shareholders’ equity to US GAAP which individually are not significant and therefore have been presented in aggregate. These adjustments relate to software and website development costs, accounting for leases, provision for teach out costs and write-back of asset impairment. Should any of these adjustments become more substantial in the future, they will be disaggregated and separately presented.
 
  (o)      Discontinued operations
 
  As discussed in note 28, the Group entered into an agreement to dispose of its interest in United Broadcasting Corporation (“UBC”) and MKSC World Dot Com Company (“KSC”) on November 7, 2005 and this transaction was concluded on January 6, 2006. Under the exemption allowed upon adoption of IFRS 1, the cumulative translation adjustment was reset to zero, resulting in a difference in the calculation of the profit on disposal under US GAAP and IFRS. The profit on disposal included a release of the cumulative translation adjustment under US GAAP of Rand 154.6 million. The remainder of the income statement difference between IFRS and US GAAP resulted from differing net asset values of the disposed businesses between IFRS and US GAAP.
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
39.     DIFFERENCES BETWEEN INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS AND UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES
      (continued)
 
Additional disclosure requirements
 
Presentation in the financial statements – condensed consolidated income statements
 
Under IFRS, the presentation of earnings per share is not limited to basic and diluted earnings per share on the net profit/(loss) attributable to shareholders. Presentation of additional earnings per share data is allowed when management believes that it provides useful information to an investor and presents a true and fair view of the Group’s results. Under US GAAP, earnings per share may only be presented on a basic and diluted basis for profit and loss from continuing operations, discontinuing operations, cumulative effect of change in accounting principle and net profit/(loss) for the period. Accordingly, the presentation of “headline earnings per N ordinary share”, “dividend per N ordinary share”, “dividend per A ordinary share”, “proposed dividend per A ordinary share” and “proposed dividend per N ordinary share” are not allowed under US GAAP.
 
Presentation in the financial statements – treatment of certain financial asset investments
 
Under IFRS, the Group holds certain financial asset investments that are related to certain long-term debt arrangements. For financial reporting presentation purposes these assets have been treated as a contra liability within long-term debt. Under US GAAP, in accordance with FIN 39, “Offsetting of Amounts Related to Certain Contracts, an interpretation of APB Opinion No. 10 and FASB No. 105”, these financial asset investments do not qualify for right of set-off with the long-term debt and therefore would be separately presented as marketable equity securities. The impact of this difference would be to increase marketable equity securities and long-term debt at March 31, 2006 by Rand 164.9 million (2005: Rand 417.4 million), presented in accordance with US GAAP. The reclassification has been presented in the US GAAP condensed consolidated balance sheets.
 
  Segment information
 
Under FAS 131, “Disclosure about Segments of an Enterprise and Related Information”, Group management’s primary performance measure is defined as operating profit/(loss) before amortization and other gains/(losses) - net, but including finance costs on transponder and transmitter finance leases. Using Group management’s primary performance measure under FAS 131, the segment results for the electronic media segment would have been Rand 2,362.9 million (2005: Rand 1,792.6 million) and for the print media segment Rand 651.5 million (2005: Rand 635.8 million). The consolidated segment total would have been Rand 2,959.3 million (2005: Rand 2,385.4 million).
 
The consolidated segment assets as reported exclude any deferred tax assets.
 
  Certain risk concentrations
 
The Group’s digital programming is or will be transmitted to customers through different satellites around the world, and in certain regions the terrestrial analogue signal is also transmitted to regional broadcast points through satellites. In addition, the Group receives a significant amount of its programming through satellites. Satellites are subject to significant risks that may prevent or impair commercial operations. Although the Group has not experienced any significant disruption of its transmissions, the operation of satellites is beyond the control of the Group. Disruption of satellite transmissions could have a material adverse effect on the Group.
 
  Programme and film rights
 
The Group accounts for fixed price programme and film rights contracts and the portion of variable price programme and film rights contracts for which the cost can be reliably measured as an asset and liability under IAS 38, “Intangible assets” and IAS 37, “Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets”. Under FAS 63 “Financial Reporting by Broadcasters” the asset and liability are recorded when the license period begins, the programme is available for its first broadcast and the cost of each program is known or reasonably determinable. Under US GAAP, sporting and other live event programmes are therefore only accounted for when available for telecast. The different treatment does not have an impact on net profit/(loss) or shareholders’ equity. The total assets as at March 31, 2006 relating to programme and film rights and the related total liabilities decreased from the amount reported under IFRS by Rand 242.1 million (2005: Rand 127.8 million decrease).
 
  Secondary Tax on Companies (“STC”)
 
STC is a tax levied on South African companies at a rate of 12.5% of dividends distributed. However, in the case of companies liquidated after April 1, 1993, STC is only payable on undistributed earnings earned after April 1, 1993. On declaration of a dividend, the Group includes the tax of 12.5% on this dividend in its computation of the income tax expense in the period of such declaration.
 
Under IFRS, a deferred tax liability is not raised on dividends until they are actually declared. With the adoption of AC501, “Accounting for South African secondary tax on companies” the Group has recorded a deferred tax asset related to STC credits where it is probable that a dividend will be declared and that the credit would be able to be utilized. Under US GAAP, the Group has adopted the allowed disclosure only approach related to the deferred taxation impact of STC on unremitted earnings of Group companies. All deferred tax assets recorded in accordance with AC501 have been reversed for US GAAP purposes.
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
39.    DIFFERENCES BETWEEN INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS AND UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES
      (continued)
 
Additional disclosure requirements (continued)
 
Secondary Tax on Companies (STC) (continued)
 
If the Group distributed all of its undistributed retained earnings as at March 31, 2006, of which Rand 9,854.2 million (2005: Rand 7,591 million) would be subject to STC, the Group would have to pay additional taxes of Rand 1,095 million (2005: Rand 780 million), net of STC credits the company could utilize. If all the earnings attributable to shareholders for the year ended March 31, 2006 were distributed, there would be a Rand 398.8 million STC charge (2005: Rand 298.1 million).
 
  Derivative financial instruments
 
The Group uses derivative instruments to reduce exposure to fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates and interest rates. These instruments mainly comprise foreign exchange contracts, interest rate caps and interest rate swap agreements. Derivative financial instruments are recognised in the balance sheet at fair value. Changes in the fair value of derivatives that are designated and qualify as fair value hedges and that are highly effective, are recorded in the income statement, along with changes in the fair value of the hedged asset or liability that is attributable to the hedged risk. Changes in the fair value of derivatives that are designated and qualify as cash flow hedges and that are highly effective are recognised in equity, and the ineffective part of the hedge is recognised in the income statement. Hedges of net investments in foreign entities are accounted for similarly to cash flow hedges.
 
During the year, there was no ineffectiveness recognised in the income statement on the Group’s hedges. Derivative instruments are recorded on the face of the balance sheet and as part of COGS and Finance costs – net in the income statement. The cash flows from hedges are recorded as part of operating and investing cash flows.
 
  Reclassifications
 
In the process of transition to IFRS, the Group identified instances where reclassifications were required between certain balance sheet items compared with the classifications that were presented under former GAAP (see note 2). These reclassifications were also reflected for US GAAP purposes in the US GAAP balance sheet on page F-122.
 
Additionally during the year, certain prior year amounts were reclassified to reflect the nature of the items. The reclassifications included an adjustment from investment in associates to goodwill for amounts recorded for the consolidation of MNet/SuperSport and a reclassification of items recorded to reflect the equity accounting of the joint venture.
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
39.    DIFFERENCES BETWEEN INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS AND UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES
      (continued)
 
To provide a better understanding of the differences in accounting standards and the overall impact of the adjustments on the financial statements, the information below presents the condensed consolidated income statements under US GAAP in a format consistent with the presentation of US GAAP consolidated income statements and after processing the adjustments in (a) to (o), all of which are discussed above.
 
   
March 31   
   
2006 
 
 2005 
   
R’000 
 
 R’000 
   
(in thousands except for share information) 
Net revenues    15,751,272    13,189,371 
Operating expenses    (12,674,608)   (10,725,685)
Operating profit    3,076,664    2,463,686 
Finance costs - net    (35,394)   (249,182)
Share of equity-accounted results    62,894    194,159 
Profit on sale and dilution of interest in subsidiaries, joint venture         
and associates, net    72,718    590,760 
Profit from continuing operations before tax and minority         
interest    3,176,882    2,999,423 
Income tax    (1,002,305)   (523,949)
 
Profit from continuing operations before minority interest    2,174,577    2,475,474 
Minority interest    (373,563)   (231,536)
 
Profit from continuing operations    1,801,014    2,243,938 
Discontinued operations    715,760    42,016 
Net profit attributable to shareholders    2,516,774    2,285,954 
 
Weighted average N ordinary shares outstanding    283,297,671    276,883,635 
Diluted weighted average N ordinary shares outstanding    301,263,329    294,253,524 
 
Basic profit/(loss) per Class N ordinary share (cent)         
       Continuing operations    636    810 
       Discontinuing operations    253    15 
    889    825 
Diluted profit/(loss) per Class N ordinary share (cent)         
       Continuing operations    598    763 
       Discontinuing operations    238    14 
    836    777 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
39.    DIFFERENCES BETWEEN INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS AND UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES
      (continued)
 
To provide a better understanding of the differences in accounting standards and the overall impact of the adjustments on the financial statements, the information below presents the condensed consolidated balance sheets under US GAAP after processing the adjustments in (a) to (o), discussed above and including other US GAAP disclosures and reclassifications.
 
   
March 31   
   
 2006 
 
 2005 
   
R’000 
 
R’000 
 
ASSETS 
       
Non-current assets         
         Property, plant and equipment    3,673,628    3,313,720 
         Goodwill and other intangibles    3,411,723    2,824,993 
         Investments and loans    1,513,578    1,820,842 
         Available-for-sale investments    32,540    314,796 
         Programme and film rights    71,072    32,184 
         Derivative financial instruments    54,303    54,179 
         Deferred taxation    642,876    524,367 
                           Total non-current assets    9,399,720    8,885,081 
Current assets         
         Deferred taxation    73,119    180,302 
         Inventory    491,704    377,653 
         Programme and film rights    448,974    608,530 
         Receivables    2,352,619    2,114,801 
         Investments and loans        8,111 
         Derivative financial instruments    144,324    178,694 
         Restricted cash    237,768    70,665 
         Cash and cash deposits    6,559,191    3,766,272 
                           Total current assets    10,307,699    7,305,028 
 
         TOTAL ASSETS    19,707,419    16,190,109 
 
EQUITY AND LIABILITIES 
       
Shareholders’ equity         
         Share capital and premium    5,220,735    4,893,469 
         Other reserves    (151,207)   54,201 
         Retained income    3,638,969    1,326,830 
                           Total shareholders’ equity    8,708,497    6,274,500 
Minority interest    280,966    295,868 
Non-current liabilities         
         Post-retirement medical liability    193,766    207,198 
         Long-term liabilities    2,590,025    2,675,876 
         Derivative financial instruments    16,684    16,038 
         Deferred taxation    714,780    604,511 
                           Total non-current liabilities    3,515,255    3,503,623 
Current liabilities         
         Current portion of long-term liabilities    1,775,557    1,008,014 
         Provisions    62,553    69,150 
         Accounts payable, accrued expenses and other current liabilities    4,875,367    4,164,963 
         Derivative financial instruments    105,471    404,239 
         Bank overdraft and short-term loans    383,753    469,752 
                           Total current liabilities    7,202,701    6,116,118 
         TOTAL EQUITY AND LIABILITIES    19,707,419    16,190,109 
 
F-122

 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
39.   
DIFFERENCES BETWEEN INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS AND UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES
    (continued)         
             
    Comprehensive income           
 
 
       
March 31   
       
2006 
 
2005 
       
R’000 
 
R’000 
           Net profit under US GAAP   
2,516,774  
  2,285,954 
           Other comprehensive income:         
                       Foreign currency translations   
   (78,524) 
  36,681 
                       Net change in fair value of cash flow hedges   
   (20,499) 
  16,878 
                       Unrealized profits on marketable securities   
                  
  1,723 
           Comprehensive income   
2,417,751 
  2,341,236 

Amounts in other comprehensive income have been recorded net of tax at an average rate of 29% (2005: 30%).
 
  Cash flow information
 
Under IFRS, the consolidated cash flow statements are presented in accordance with IAS 7, “Cash flow statements”. The statements prepared under IAS 7 present substantially the same information as required under US GAAP as interpreted by FAS 95 “Statement of Cash Flows.” However, the definition of cash flow differs between IFRS and US GAAP. Cash flow under IFRS represents increases or decreases in cash and cash equivalents, which comprises cash in hand and repayable on demand, restricted cash and overdrafts. Under US GAAP, cash flow represents increases or decreases in cash and cash equivalents, which include short term, highly liquid investments with original maturities of less than 90 days, and excludes restricted cash and overdrafts. The movement in restricted cash and overdrafts have been included within financing activities under US GAAP.
 
The principal non-cash investing and financing activities are the issue of shares as consideration for business acquisitions and the acquisition of property, plant and equipment using finance leases.
 
A summary of the Group’s operating, investing and financing activities, classified in accordance with US GAAP, are as follows:
 
       
March 31   
       
2006 
 
2005 
       
R’000 
 
R’000 
    Net cash provided by operating activities   
3,392,997  
 
2,346,984  
    Net cash used in investing activities   
 (133,623) 
 
 (683,603) 
    Net cash used in financing activities   
 (420,448) 
 
 (364,272) 
    Net increase in cash and cash equivalents   
2,838,926  
 
1,299,109 
    Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year   
3,766,272  
 
2,453,651 
    Exchange adjustments   
   (46,007) 
  13,512 
    Cash and cash equivalents at end of year   
6,559,191 
 
3,766,272 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
39.    DIFFERENCES BETWEEN INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS AND UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES
      (continued)
 
  Recently issued accounting standards
 
  US GAAP
 
In September 2004, the Emerging Issues Task Force (“EITF”) reached a consensus (EITF 04-10) with regard to applying Paragraph 19 of FASB Statement No. 131 (“SFAS 131”)”, Disclosures about Segments of an Enterprise and Related Information and Related Information, in determining whether to aggregate operating segments that do not meet the quantitative thresholds. There is diversity in practice regarding how an entity might consider the aggregation criteria listed in SFAS 131 to operating segments that do not meet the qualitative thresholds. At the September 2004 meeting the Task Force reached a consensus that operating segments must always have similar economic characteristics and meet a majority of the remaining five aggregation criteria listed in SFAS 131, in order to be aggregated. The effective date is for fiscal years ending after September 15, 2005. The adoption of this standard did not have a significant effect on the Group’s financial statements.
 
In December 2004, the FASB issued SFAS No. 123R, “Share-Based Payment,” (“SFAS 123R”) which is a revision of SFAS No. 123, “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation” (“SFAS 123”). Statement 123R supersedes APB Opinion No. 25, “Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees,” and amends SFAS No. 95, “Statement of Cash Flows.” Generally, the approach in SFAS 123R is similar to the approach described in SFAS 123. SFAS 123R requires all share-based payments to employees to be recognized in the income statement based on their grant date fair values over the corresponding service period and also requires estimation of forfeitures when calculating compensation expense. In April of 2005 the FASB revised the adoption date of this revised statement effective the first annual reporting period that begins after June 15, 2005. Accordingly, the Group will adopt this revised statement on April 1, 2006. The Group will adopt the modified-prospective application of the standard and is currently evaluating the impact of SFAS 123R on its financial position and results of operations.
 
In December 2004, the FASB issued SFAS No. 153 “Exchanges of Non-monetary Assets - An Amendment of APB Opinion No. 29”. SFAS No. 153 eliminates the exception to fair value accounting for exchanges of similar productive assets contained in APB Opinion No. 29 and replaces it with a general exception for exchange transactions that do not have commercial substance. The exception in APB Opinion No. 29 required certain non-monetary asset exchanges to be recorded on a carryover basis with no gain or loss recognition. Under SFAS No. 153, exchange transactions with commercial substance are required to be accounted for at fair value with gain or loss recognition on assets surrendered in exchange transactions. The group will be required to adopt SFAS No. 153 on April 1, 2006, and believes the adoption of this standard will not have a material impact on the Group’s financial statements.
 
In May 2005, the FASB issued SFAS 154, “Accounting Changes and Error Corrections – a replacement of APB Opinion No. 20 and FASB Statement No.3”. Among other things, SFAS 154 requires voluntary changes in accounting principle to be retrospectively applied in the financial statements. It also applies to changes required by an accounting pronouncement in the unusual instance that the pronouncement does not include specific transition provisions. When a pronouncement includes specific transition provisions, those provisions should be followed. The Group will be required to adopt SFAS 154 on April 1, 2006. The Group is currently evaluating the impact of SFAS 154 on its financial position and results of operations.
 
In November 2005, the FASB issued FSP Nos. FAS 115-1 and FAS 124-1, the Meaning of Other-Than-Temporary Impairment and Its Application to Certain Investments (FSP 115-1 and 124-1). This statement amends FASB Statements No. 115, Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities, and No. 124, Accounting for Certain Investments Held by Not-for-Profit Organizations, and APB Opinion No. 18, The Equity Method of Accounting for Investments in Common Stock. The guidance addresses the determination as to when an investment is considered impaired, whether that impairment is other than temporary, and the measurement of an impairment loss. The guidance also includes accounting considerations subsequent to the recognition of an other-than-temporary impairment and requires certain disclosures about unrealized losses that have not been recognized as other-than-temporary impairments. The guidance includes three steps in determining when an investment is considered impaired, whether that impairment is other than temporary, and the measurement of an impairment loss. FSP 115-1 and 124-1 is effective for reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2005 and will be adopted by the Group on April 1, 2006. The Group believes it will not have a material impact on the financial statements.
 
In April 2006, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position 46(R)-6 (FSP FIN 46(R)-6) to address how a reporting enterprise should determine the variability to be considered in applying FASB Interpretation No. 46 (revised December 2003), Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities, (FIN 46(R)).
 
The variability that is considered in applying FIN 46(R) affects the determination of (a) whether the entity is a variable interest entity (VIE), (b) which interests are variable interests in the entity, and (c) which party, if any, is the primary beneficiary of the VIE. That variability will affect any calculation of expected losses and expected residual returns, if such a calculation is necessary. The variability to be considered in applying FIN 46(R) is based on an analysis of the design of the entity by a) analyzing the nature of the risks in the entity and b) determining the purpose(s) for which the entity was created and determine the variability the entity is designed to create and pass along to its interest.
 
After determining the variability to consider, the reporting enterprise can determine which interests are designed to absorb that variability. FSP FIN 46(R)-6 provides examples of the cash flow and fair value methods that can be used to measure the amount of variability (that is, expected losses and expected residual returns) of an entity. However, a method that is used to measure the amount of variability does not provide an appropriate basis for determining which variability should be considered in applying FIN 46(R).
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(CONTINUED)
 
 
39.   DIFFERENCES BETWEEN INTERNATIONAL FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS AND UNITED STATES GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES
     (continued)
 
  Recently issued accounting standards (continued)
    
FSP FIN 46(R)-6 is effective the first day of the first reporting period beginning after June 15, 2006. The Group will adopt the provisions of this statement on April 1, 2007. The Group is evaluating the impact of this statement and believes that it will not have a material impact on our financial statements.
 
In June 2006 the FASB issued FASB Interpretation No. 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes (FIN 48) to clarify the accounting for uncertainty in income taxes recognized in an entity’s nancial statements in accordance with FASB Statement No. 109, Accounting for Income Taxes. The guidance requires an entity to determine whether it is more likely than not that a tax position will be sustained upon examination, including resolution of any related appeals or litigation processes, based on the technical merits of the position. In evaluating whether a tax position has met the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold, the enterprise should presume that the position will be examined by the appropriate taxing authority that has full knowledge of all relevant information. A tax position that meets the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold is measured to determine the amount of bene t to recognize in the nancial statements. The tax position is measured at the largest amount of bene t that is greater than 50 percent likely of being realized upon ultimate settlement.
 
Tax positions that previously failed to meet the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold should be recognized in the first subsequent financial reporting period in which that threshold is met. Previously recognized tax positions that no longer meet the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold should be derecognized in the rst subsequent nancial reporting period in which that threshold is no longer met. Use of a valuation allowance as described in Statement 109 is not an appropriate substitute for the derecognition of a tax position. The Group will be required to adopt FIN 48 on April 1, 2007 and is currently evaluating the expected impact on the financial statements.
 
In September 2006, The FASB issued SFAS No. 157 , Fair Value Measurements, (SFAS 157). This Statement defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring fair value and expands disclosures about fair value measurements. This Statement does not require any new fair value measurements, it emphasizes that fair value is a market-based measurement, not an entity-specific measurement. Therefore, a fair value measurement should be determined based on the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. SFAS 157 expands disclosures about the use of fair value to measure assets and liabilities in interim and annual periods subsequent to initial recognition. This statement applies for derivatives and other financial instruments measured at fair value under SFAS No. 133, Derivative Financial Instruments at initial recognition and in all subsequent periods. The group will be required to adopt SFAS 157 on April 1, 2008, and is currently evaluating the impact of SFAS 157 on its financial position and results of operations.
 
In September 2006, the SEC issued Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 108 (“SAB 108”). The interpretations in SAB 108 express the staff's views regarding the process of quantifying financial statement misstatements. The staff believes registrants must consider the impact of correcting all misstatements, including the effect of misstatements that were not corrected at the end of the prior year. These prior year misstatements should be considered in quantifying misstatements in current year financial statements. Thus, a registrant's financial statements would require adjustment when the assessment in the current year or in prior years results in quantifying a misstatement that is material, after considering all relevant quantitative and qualitative factors. The group will be required to adopt SAB 108 on April 1, 2007, and is currently evaluating the impact of SAB 108 on its financial position and results of operations.